Implementation of 2022 Wassenaar Arrangement Decisions and Request for Comments on License Exception Eligibility for Certain Supersonic Aero Gas Turbine Engine Component Technology, 71932-71985 [2023-22299]
Download as PDF
71932
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
DEPARTMENT OF COMMERCE
Bureau of Industry and Security
15 CFR Parts 734, 740, 742, 772, and
774
[Docket No. 230929–0236]
RIN 0694–AI95
Implementation of 2022 Wassenaar
Arrangement Decisions and Request
for Comments on License Exception
Eligibility for Certain Supersonic Aero
Gas Turbine Engine Component
Technology
Bureau of Industry and
Security, Commerce.
ACTION: Interim final rule, with request
for comment.
AGENCY:
The Bureau of Industry and
Security (BIS) maintains, as part of its
Export Administration Regulations
(EAR), the Commerce Control List
(CCL), which identifies certain items
subject to Department of Commerce
jurisdiction. During the December 2022
Wassenaar Arrangement on Export
Controls for Conventional Arms and
Dual-Use Goods and Technologies (WA)
Plenary meeting, Participating States of
the WA (Participating States) made
certain decisions affecting the WA dualuse and munitions control lists, which
BIS is now implementing via
amendments to the CCL. BIS seeks
comments on restricting STA eligibility
for countries in EAR Country Group A:5
of certain technology for the
development of supersonic aero gas
turbine engine components controlled
under ECCN 9E003.k, formerly
controlled under ECCN 9E001 as part of
its ongoing assessment of current export
control licensing policy.
DATES: This rule is effective October 18,
2023. Comments specific to ECCN
9E003.k must be received by BIS no
later than December 4, 2023.
ADDRESSES: Comments on this rule may
be submitted to the Federal rulemaking
portal (www.regulations.gov). The
regulations.gov ID for this rule is: BIS–
2023–0025. Please refer to RIN 0694–
AI95 in all comments.
All filers using the portal should use
the name of the person or entity
submitting the comments as the name of
their files, in accordance with the
instructions below. Anyone submitting
business confidential information
should clearly identify the business
confidential portion at the time of
submission, file a statement justifying
nondisclosure and referring to the
specific legal authority claimed, and
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
SUMMARY:
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
provide a non-confidential version of
the submission.
For comments submitted
electronically containing business
confidential information, the file name
of the business confidential version
should begin with the characters ‘‘BC.’’
Any page containing business
confidential information must be clearly
marked ‘‘BUSINESS CONFIDENTIAL’’
on the top of that page. The
corresponding non-confidential version
of those comments must be clearly
marked ‘‘PUBLIC.’’ The file name of the
non-confidential version should begin
with the character ‘‘P.’’ Any
submissions with file names that do not
begin with either a ‘‘BC’’ or a ‘‘P’’ will
be assumed to be public and will be
made publicly available through https://
www.regulations.gov. Commenters
submitting business confidential
information are encouraged to scan a
hard copy of the non-confidential
version to create an image of the file,
rather than submitting a digital copy
with redactions applied, to avoid
inadvertent redaction errors which
could enable the public to read business
confidential information.
FOR FURTHER INFORMATION CONTACT: For
general questions, contact Sharron
Cook, Office of Exporter Services,
Bureau of Industry and Security, U.S.
Department of Commerce at 202–482–
2440 or by email: Sharron.Cook@
bis.doc.gov.
For Technical Questions Contact
Categories 0, 1 & 2: Sean Ghannadian at
202–482–3429 or Sean.Ghannadian@
bis.doc.gov
Category 3: Carlos Monroy at 202–482–
3246 or Carlos.Monroy@bis.doc.gov
Categories 4 & 5: Aaron Amundson or
Aaron.Amundson@bis.doc.gov
Categories 6: John Varesi at 202–482–
1114 or John.Varesi@bis.doc.gov
Categories 7: David Rosenberg at 202–
482–5987, John Varesi at 202–482–
1114 or David.Rosenberg@bis.doc.gov
or John.Varesi@bis.doc.gov
Category 9: David Rosenberg at 202–
482–5987, Jason Chauvin at 202–482–
6462 or David.Rosenberg@bis.doc.gov
or Jason.Chauvin@bis.doc.gov
‘‘600 Series’’ (munitions items): Jeffrey
Leitz at 202–482–7417 or
Jeffrey.Leitz@bis.doc.gov
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION:
Background
The WA (https://www.wassenaar.org/)
is a group of 42 like-minded states
committed to promoting responsibility
and transparency in the global arms
trade and preventing destabilizing
accumulations of conventional
PO 00000
Frm 00002
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
weapons. As a Participating State of the
WA (Participating State), the United
States has committed to controlling for
export all items on the WA’s List of
Dual-Use Goods and Technologies (WA
Dual-Use List) and on the WA
Munitions List (together, WA control
lists). The WA control lists were first
established in 1996 and have been
revised annually thereafter.
Participating States implement changes
to the WA control lists as soon as
possible after the WA Plenary. By doing
so in a timely manner, the United States
demonstrates its decisive support for the
goals of the WA, namely, that transfers
do not contribute to the development or
enhancement of military capabilities or
are not diverted to support such
capabilities. Timely implementation
also ensures that U.S. companies have a
level playing field with their
competitors in other Participating
States.
Revisions to the Commerce Control List
Related to WA 2022 Plenary Meeting
Decisions
Revisions (14) ECCNs: 1B001,
4D001,4E001, 6A005, 6B007, 7A003,
7E004, 8A001, 8A002, 9A001, 9A003,
9E001, 9E002, and 9E003.
Editorial Revision to Technical Notes
in (55) ECCNS: This rule adds the
phrase ‘For the purposes of’ in various
Technical Notes in singular and plural
form in ECCNs 1A004, 1A006, 1A007,
1A008, 1B001, 1C001, 1C002, 1C005,
1C008, 1C010, 1C011, 2A001, 2B004,
2B006, 2B008, 2B009, 2E003, 3A001,
3A002, 3B001, 3D003, 3D006, 3E001,
3E002, 4A004, 4D001, 4E001, 5A001,
5A002, 5A004, 6A001, 6A002, 6A003,
6A004, 6A005, 6A006, 6A007, 6A008,
6B007, 6C002, 6C005, 6D003,
6E003,7A004, 7A005, 7A006, 7B001,
7D002, 7E004, 8A002, 8C001, 8E002,
9A004, 9B005, and 9E003. The intention
of this revision is to ensure consistency
among ECCNs.
1C010 ‘‘Fibrous or Filamentary
Materials’’
This rule makes an editorial revision
by adding a reference to 1C010.e.1.b to
technical note 1 because both
paragraphs e.1.b.1 and e.1.b.2 use terms
referenced in this technical note.
4D001 ‘‘Software’’ and 4E001
‘‘Technology’’
In paragraphs 4D001.b.1 and
4E001.b.1, this rule changes the
parameters of Weighted TeraFLOPS
(WT) from 15 to 24. This change is made
because processors with built-in
hardware memory-coherent
interconnects allow groupings of up to
8 processors without any additional
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
technical know-how, and it is widely
believed that a single processor will
reach Adjusted Peak Performance (APP)
levels of up to 2 WT in the next year,
and up to 2.5 WT by the 2025
timeframe. Thus, companies will soon
be able to build computers that exceed
the current APP levels without any
additional technology. The
corresponding technology and software
levels in License Exception APP
(Section 740.7 of the EAR) were
adjusted in a final rule that
implemented certain changes agreed to
at the December 2021 WA Plenary. See
88 FR 12108 (February 24, 2023). Thus,
BIS is not making any additional
adjustments to those thresholds at this
time.
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
6A005 ‘‘Lasers’’, ‘‘Components’’ and
Optical Equipment
This rule raises the ‘‘average output
power’’ parameter from ‘‘50 W’’ to ‘‘80
W’’ in 6A005.b.3.a.2. For the industrial
applications that use green lasers, the
power level is a key factor in
manufacturing productivity. These
applications require certain pulse
energies for the resultant processes. To
enhance manufacturing productivity,
the repetition frequency for a given
pulse energy must be increased, thereby
requiring an increase in the average
output power. Today, the average
output power requirements for
industrial green lasers exceed the WA
threshold of 50 W, and are expected to
continue an upward trend to more than
80 W. Companies outside of
Participating States compete in the
industrial green laser market, for
example, several Chinese companies
manufacture green lasers with average
output power in the 50–80 W range.
To accommodate increased demand
for single-mode semiconductor laser
diodes, a decision was made during the
WA 2022 Plenary to increase the
technical parameters for semiconductor
lasers. Specifically, adjusting the
wavelength from 1,510 nm to 1,570 nm
in 6A005.d.1.a.1 and d.1.a.2 groups
these lasers with other semiconductor
lasers with lower sensitivity
applications. As a result, the necessary
output power accommodation for
automotive Light Detection and Ranging
(LIDAR) applications is achieved with a
modest output power increase from 1.5
W to 2.0 W in 6A005.d.1.a.1.
Semiconductor lasers that fall within
these parameters, while very useful for
automotive LIDAR, have limited utility
in military applications.
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
6A007 Gravity Meters (Gravimeters)
and Gravity Gradiometers
A technical note to define ‘time-tosteady-state registration’ is added after
paragraph 6A007.b.2, to harmonize this
entry with the entry on the WA DualUse List.
6B007 Equipment To Produce, Align
and Calibrate Land-Based Gravity
Meters
This rule adds the word ‘‘less’’ to the
heading of ECCN 6B007 to clarify that
an ‘‘accuracy’’ better than 0.1 mGal is
less than 0.1 mGal.
7A003 ‘Inertial Measurement
Equipment or Systems’
This rule moves the definition of
‘inertial measurement equipment or
systems’ from Note 1 to a technical note,
so that this entry is consistent with
other CCL entries in which definitions
are set forth in technical notes.
8A001 Submersible Vehicles and
Surface Vessels
In paragraph 8A001.c.1.c, this rule
adds the term ‘wireless’ before the term
‘optical data’ to clarify that the reference
is to communications through water and
to distinguish Remotely Operated
Vehicles (ROVs) having this capability
from those designed to only use a fiber
optic data link.
8A002 Marine Systems, Equipment,
‘‘Parts’’ and ‘‘Components’’
In paragraphs 8A002.o.2.b and
8A002.o.2.c, this rule replaces the term
‘engines’ with ‘motors’ before the term
‘propulsion.’ While the terms ‘‘engines’’
and ‘‘motors’’ are largely
interchangeable, it was determined that
‘‘motor’’ is more commonly used in the
context of 8A002 items. In paragraph
8A002.o.4, this rule adds a new control
for permanent magnet propulsion
systems (PM propulsion systems) to
adequately cover propulsion systems
using permanent magnet motors,
including Rim Driven Propulsion
systems (RDPs).
9A001 Aero Gas Turbine Engines, and
Technology Therefor in 9E001 and
9E002
This rule revises 9A001, 9A003,
9E001, 9E002, and 9E003 to permit the
same civil certification release from
9A001 to 9A991 for supersonic aero gas
turbine engines that is available for
subsonic aero gas turbine engines.
The rule conforms with the decisions
made at WA with regard to 9A001,
specifically to combine 9A001.a and
9A001.b to allow for the same exclusion
when the engine is certified by type
with a civil certified supersonic aircraft.
PO 00000
Frm 00003
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
71933
This rule revises the reference to
9A001.a in Notes 1 and 2 to read as
9A001, as 9A001.a is now the only
subparagraph in 9A001. Note 1 now
excludes from 9A001 aero gas turbine
engines that power an ‘‘aircraft’’ to
Mach 1 or higher for more than 30
minutes if the engines have been
certified by an appropriate civil aviation
authority, and are intended to power an
‘‘aircraft’’ for which a type certificate (or
equivalent document) has been issued,
as these engines are now controlled
under ECCN 9A991 for AT reasons. As
a conforming revision, the reference to
9A001.b is removed from the headings
of ECCNs 9E001 and 9E002, as well as
from the license requirements tables of
these ECCNs. In addition, consistent
with the removal of 9A001.b from the
CCL, as described above, this rule also
removes paragraphs (E) and (F) from
§ 740.20(b)(2)(viii), which had identified
technology associated with 9A001.b that
was ineligible for export, reexport, and
transfer (in-country) under License
Exception STA. Former paragraph (G) is
redesignated as paragraph (E).
9A003 ‘‘Specially Designed’’
Assemblies or ‘‘Components,’’
Incorporating Any of the
‘‘Technologies’’ Controlled by 9E003.a,
9E003.h, 9E003.i, or 9E003.k, for Any of
the Following Aero Gas Turbine
Engines
This rule adds paragraph 9E003.k to
the heading of ECCN 9A003, which
expands the scope of control of
assemblies and components under this
ECCN.
9E003 Other ‘‘Technology’’ as
Specified
This rule makes a simple editorial
change to remove the first comma in
9E003.c after ‘‘cooling holes’’ that
otherwise might bring confusion to the
control text. This rule also redesignates
9E003.k as 9E003.l and adds a new
paragraph 9E003.k to control specific
technologies, formerly controlled by
9E001, that are peculiarly responsible
for the development of an aero gas
turbine engine that can enable an
aircraft to cruise at supersonic speeds
(Mach 1 or greater) for more than 30
minutes. This technology addition to
9E003 addresses the ‘‘development’’ of
systems and components that enable the
engine and aircraft to operate a
supersonic speed. Because 9E003.k
references engine capability (which
does not change with certification) this
important ‘‘development’’ technology
will remain controlled even after the
engine enters civil operation. The
license requirement table is amended to
reflect the redesignation of 9E003.k to
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
71934
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
9E003.l to the SI control paragraph.
Related revisions as a result of this
redesignation are made to §§ 734.4(a)(4),
740.20(b)(2)(viii), 742.14(a), and the
introductory text of 742.14(b).
The new 9E003.k technology for
supersonic engines controls
development technology only. The
associated production technology has
shifted from ECCN 9E002 to ECCN
9E991 and is designated as ‘‘No License
Required’’ (NLR) to all destinations or
countries listed in Country Group A:5
and A:6 (see supplement no. 1 to part
740 of the EAR).
The STA restrictions under 9E003 are
revised by adding an ‘‘or’’ after 9E003.h
and adding Country Group A:5 to
harmonize with 740.20(b)(2) for 9E003.
In addition, this rule adds a new STA
restriction paragraph for 9E003.k for
Country Group A:6 in order to maintain
the STA restriction previously on ECCN
9E001 for ECCN paragraph 9A001.b. As
required by the Export Control Reform
Act (ECRA) (50 U.S.C. 4801–4852), BIS
continually evaluates the control status
of a range of technologies, including
those related to supersonic engines, to
effectively protect U.S. national security
and foreign policy interests. In light of
the amendments to 9E001 and 9E003
implementing the WA revisions, which
identify technologies required for the
development of specific components or
systems specially designed for
supersonic engines, BIS is seeking
comment on whether to retain License
Exception STA eligibility for
destinations specified in Country Group
A:5 of supplement no. 1 to part 740 of
the EAR for the technology specified in
9E003.k. We invite the public to
comment on this issue before the
comment period closes. Information
about how to comment is provided in
the ADDRESS section of this rule.
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
Part 772—Definitions of Terms
This rule revises the definition for
‘‘intrusion software’’ by adding double
quotes around the term ‘‘program’’ in
paragraph (2) to indicate it is a defined
term in § 772.1.
This rule notes the two occurrences of
the term ‘‘program’’ that did not have
double quotation marks indicating it is
a defined term in § 772.1 and corrects
this omission in technical note 1 below
paragraph .g in ECCN 1B001 and in
paragraph (2) in the definition of
‘‘intrusion software’’ in § 772.1. This
rule also amends the term ‘‘program’’ in
§ 772.1 to add category 1 and 7 and
remove category 2 from the categories
where the term is used.
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
Supplement No. 6 to Part 774 Sensitive
List
Paragraph 4 of supplement no. 6 to
part 774 Sensitive List (SL) is amended
by removing paragraphs (ii) 4D001 and
(iii) 4E001. This change is being made
as a consequence of the raising of the
APP thresholds in 4D001 and 4E001.
This rule implements the WA 2022
Plenary determination that high
performance computer technology and
software do not merit the same level of
sensitivity as other items on the SL.
Savings Clause
Shipments of items removed from
license exception eligibility or eligibility
for export, reexport or transfer (incountry) without a license as a result of
this regulatory action that were on dock
for loading, on lighter, laden aboard an
exporting carrier, or en route aboard a
carrier to a port of export, on October
18, 2023, pursuant to actual orders for
exports, reexports and transfers (incountry) to a foreign destination, may
proceed to that destination under the
previous license exception eligibility or
without a license so long as they have
been exported, reexported or transferred
(in-country) before December 18, 2023.
Any such items not actually exported,
reexported or transferred (in-country)
before midnight, on December 18, 2023,
require a license in accordance with this
interim final rule.
Export Control Reform Act of 2018
On August 13, 2018, the President
signed into law the John S. McCain
National Defense Authorization Act for
Fiscal Year 2019, which included the
Export Control Reform Act (ECRA), 50
U.S.C. 4801–4852. ECRA, as amended,
provides the legal basis for BIS’s
principal authorities and serves as the
authority under which BIS issues this
rule.
Rulemaking Requirements
1. Executive Orders 12866, 13563, and
14094 direct agencies to assess all costs
and benefits of available regulatory
alternatives and, if regulation is
necessary, to select regulatory
approaches that maximize net benefits
(including potential economic,
environmental, public health and safety
effects and distributive impacts and
equity). Executive Order 13563
emphasizes the importance of
quantifying both costs and benefits and
of reducing costs, harmonizing rules,
and promoting flexibility.
This interim final rule has been
designated a ‘‘significant regulatory
action’’ under section 3(f) of Executive
Order 12866, as amended by Executive
Order 14094. This rule does not contain
PO 00000
Frm 00004
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
policies with Federalism implications as
that term is defined under Executive
Order 13132.
2. Notwithstanding any other
provision of law, no person is required
to respond to, nor shall any person be
subject to a penalty for failure to comply
with, a collection of information subject
to the requirements of the Paperwork
Reduction Act of 1995 (44 U.S.C. 3501
et seq.) (PRA), unless that collection of
information displays a currently valid
Office of Management and Budget
(OMB) Control Number. Although this
rule makes important changes to the
EAR for items controlled for national
security reasons, BIS believes that the
overall increases in burdens and costs
associated with the following
information collections due to this rule
will be minimal.
• 0694–0088, ‘‘Simplified Network
Application Processing System,’’ which
carries a burden- hour estimate of 29.6
minutes for a manual or electronic
submission;
• 0694–0137 ‘‘License Exceptions and
Exclusions,’’ which carries a burdenhour estimate average of 1.5 hours per
submission (Note: submissions for
License Exceptions are rarely required);
• 0694–0096 ‘‘Five Year Records
Retention Period,’’ which carries a
burden-hour estimate of less than 1
minute; and
• 0607–0152 ‘‘Automated Export
System (AES) Program,’’ which carries a
burden-hour estimate of 3 minutes per
electronic submission.
Additional information regarding
these collections of information—
including all background materials—can
be found at https://www.reginfo.gov/
public/do/PRAMain and using the
search function to enter either the title
of the collection or the OMB Control
Number.
3. Pursuant to Section 1762 of ECRA
(50 U.S.C. 4821), this action is exempt
from the Administrative Procedure Act
(APA) (5 U.S.C. 553) requirements for
notice of proposed rulemaking,
opportunity for public participation and
delay in effective date.
List of Subjects
15 CFR Part 734
Administrative practice and
procedure, Exports, Inventions and
patents, Research, Science and
technology.
15 CFR Part 740
Administrative practice and
procedure, Exports, Reporting and
recordkeeping.
15 CFR Part 742
Exports, Terrorism.
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
15 CFR Part 772
Exports.
15 CFR Part 774
Exports, Reporting and recordkeeping
requirements, Terrorism.
Accordingly, parts 734, 740, 742, 772
and 774 of the Export Administration
Regulations (15 CFR parts 730–774) are
amended as follows:
PART 734—SCOPE OF THE EXPORT
ADMINISTRATION REGULATIONS
1. The authority citation for part 734
continues to read as follows:
■
Authority: 50 U.S.C. 4801–4852; 50 U.S.C.
4601 et seq.; 50 U.S.C. 1701 et seq.; E.O.
12938, 59 FR 59099, 3 CFR, 1994 Comp., p.
950; E.O. 13020, 61 FR 54079, 3 CFR, 1996
Comp., p. 219; E.O. 13026, 61 FR 58767, 3
CFR, 1996 Comp., p. 228; E.O. 13222, 66 FR
44025, 3 CFR, 2001 Comp., p. 783; E.O.
13637, 78 FR 16129, 3 CFR, 2014 Comp., p.
223; Notice of November 8, 2022, 87 FR
68015 (November 10, 2022).
2. Section 734.4 is amended to revise
paragraph (a)(4) to read as follows:
■
§ 734.4
De Minimis U.S. content.
(a) * * *
(4) There is no de minimis level for
U.S.-origin technology controlled by
ECCN 9E003.a.1 through a.6, a.8, .h, .i,
and .l, when redrawn, used, consulted,
or otherwise commingled abroad.
*
*
*
*
*
PART 740—LICENSE EXCEPTIONS
3. The authority citation for part 740
continues to read as follows:
■
Authority: 50 U.S.C. 4801–4852; 50 U.S.C.
4601 et seq.; 50 U.S.C. 1701 et seq.; 22 U.S.C.
7201 et seq.; E.O. 13026, 61 FR 58767, 3 CFR,
1996 Comp., p. 228; E.O. 13222, 66 FR 44025,
3 CFR, 2001 Comp., p. 783.
4. Section 740.20 is amended by
revising paragraph (b)(2)(viii) to read as
follows:
incorporate any of the ‘‘technologies’’
controlled by 9E003.a.1, 9E003.a.2,
9E003.a.3, 9E003.a.4, 9E003.a.5,
9E003.c, 9E003.h, or 9E003.i (other than
technology for fan or power turbines); or
(2) Equipment controlled by 9B001.
(C) License Exception STA may not be
used for 9D001 ‘‘software’’ that is
‘‘specially designed’’ or modified for the
‘‘development’’ of ‘‘technology’’
controlled by 9E003.a.1, 9E003.a.2,
9E003.a.3, 9E003.a.4, 9E003.a.5,
9E003.c, 9E003.h, or 9E003.i (other than
technology for fan or power turbines).
(D) License Exception STA may not
be used for 9D004.f or 9D004.g
‘‘software’’.
(E) License Exception STA may not be
used for ‘‘technology’’ in 9E003.a.1,
9E003.a.2, 9E003.a.3, 9E003.a.4,
9E003.a.5, 9E003.c, 9E003.h, or 9E003.i
(other than technology for fan or power
turbines).
*
*
*
*
*
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
*
*
*
*
*
(b) * * *
(2) * * *
(viii) Commerce Control List Category
9 limitations on use of License
Exception STA.
(A) License Exception STA may not
be used for 9B001 when destined to a
country in Country Group A:6.
(B) License Exception STA may not be
used for 9D001 or 9D002 ‘‘software’’
that is ‘‘specially designed’’ or modified
for the ‘‘development’’ or ‘‘production’’
of:
(1) Components of engines controlled
by ECCN 9A001 if such components
VerDate Sep<11>2014
20:45 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
a.6, a.8, .h, .i, and .l, and related
controls. These controls supplement the
national security controls that apply to
these items. Applications for export and
reexport to all destinations will be
reviewed on a case-by-case basis to
determine whether the export or
reexport is consistent with U.S. national
security and foreign policy interests.
The following factors are among those
that will be considered to determine
what action will be taken on license
applications:
*
*
*
*
*
PART 772—DEFINITIONS OF TERMS
7. The authority citation for part 772
continues to read as follows:
■
Authority: 50 U.S.C. 4801–4852; 50 U.S.C.
4601 et seq.; 50 U.S.C. 1701 et seq.; E.O.
13222, 66 FR 44025, 3 CFR, 2001 Comp., p.
783.
PART 742—CONTROL POLICY—CCL
BASED CONTROLS
8. Section 772.1 is amended by
revising the definitions for ‘‘Intrusion
software’’ and ‘‘Program’’ to read as
follows:
5. The authority citation for part 742
continues to read as follows:
§ 772.1 Definitions of terms as used in the
Export Administration Regulations (EAR).
■
Authority: 50 U.S.C. 4801–4852; 50 U.S.C.
4601 et seq.; 50 U.S.C. 1701 et seq.; 22 U.S.C.
3201 et seq.; 42 U.S.C. 2139a; 22 U.S.C. 7201
et seq.; 22 U.S.C. 7210; Sec. 1503, Pub. L.
108–11, 117 Stat. 559; E.O. 12058, 43 FR
20947, 3 CFR, 1978 Comp., p. 179; E.O.
12851, 58 FR 33181, 3 CFR, 1993 Comp., p.
608; E.O. 12938, 59 FR 59099, 3 CFR, 1994
Comp., p. 950; E.O. 13026, 61 FR 58767, 3
CFR, 1996 Comp., p. 228; E.O. 13222, 66 FR
44025, 3 CFR, 2001 Comp., p. 783;
Presidential Determination 2003–23, 68 FR
26459, 3 CFR, 2004 Comp., p. 320; Notice of
November 8, 2022, 87 FR 68015 (November
10, 2022).
6. Section 742.14 is amended by
revising paragraphs (a) and (b)
introductory text to read as follows:
■
■
§ 740.20 License Exception Strategic
Trade Authorization (STA).
71935
§ 742.14 Significant items: hot section
technology for the development, production
or overhaul of commercial aircraft engines,
components, and systems.
(a) License requirement. Licenses are
required for all destinations, except
Canada, for ECCNs having an ‘‘SI’’
under the ‘‘Reason for Control’’
paragraph. These items include hot
section technology for the development,
production or overhaul of commercial
aircraft engines controlled under ECCN
9E003.a.1 through a.6, a.8, .h, .i, and .l,
and related controls.
(b) Licensing policy. Pursuant to
section 6 of the Export Administration
Act of 1979, as amended, foreign policy
controls apply to technology required
for the development, production or
overhaul of commercial aircraft engines
controlled by ECCN 9E003a.1 through
PO 00000
Frm 00005
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
■
*
*
*
*
*
Intrusion software. (5P2) ‘‘Software’’
specially designed or modified to avoid
detection by ‘monitoring tools’, or to
defeat ‘protective countermeasures’, of a
computer or network-capable device,
and performing any of the following:
(1) The extraction of data or
information, from a computer or
network-capable device, or the
modification of system or user data; or
(2) The modification of the standard
execution path of a ‘‘program’’ or
process in order to allow the execution
of externally provided instructions.
Note 1 to ‘‘Intrusion Software’’
Definition: ‘‘Intrusion software’’ does
not include any of the following:
Hypervisors, debuggers or Software
Reverse Engineering (SRE) tools; Digital
Rights Management (DRM) ‘‘software’’;
or ‘‘Software’’ designed to be installed
by manufacturers, administrators or
users, for the purposes of asset tracking
or recovery.
Note 2 to ‘‘Intrusion Software’’
Definition: Network-capable devices
include mobile devices and smart
meters.
Technical note 1 to ‘‘Intrusion
Software’’ Definition: ‘Monitoring
tools’: ‘‘software’’ or hardware devices,
that monitor system behaviors or
processes running on a device. This
includes antivirus (AV) products, end
point security products, Personal
Security Products (PSP), Intrusion
Detection Systems (IDS), Intrusion
Prevention Systems (IPS) or firewalls.
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
71936
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
Technical note 2 to ‘‘Intrusion
Software’’ Definition: ‘Protective
countermeasures’: techniques designed
to ensure the safe execution of code,
such as Data Execution Prevention
(DEP), Address Space Layout
Randomization (ASLR) or sandboxing.
*
*
*
*
*
Program. (Cat 1, 4, 6, and 7)—A
sequence of instructions to carry out a
process in, or convertible into, a form
executable by an electronic computer.
PART 774—THE COMMERCE
CONTROL LIST
9. The authority citation for part 774
continues to read as follows:
■
Authority: 50 U.S.C. 4801–4852; 50 U.S.C.
4601 et seq.; 50 U.S.C. 1701 et seq.; 10 U.S.C.
8720; 10 U.S.C. 8730(e); 22 U.S.C. 287c, 22
U.S.C. 3201 et seq.; 22 U.S.C. 6004; 42 U.S.C.
2139a; 15 U.S.C. 1824; 50 U.S.C. 4305; 22
U.S.C. 7201 et seq.; 22 U.S.C. 7210; E.O.
13026, 61 FR 58767, 3 CFR, 1996 Comp., p.
228; E.O. 13222, 66 FR 44025, 3 CFR, 2001
Comp., p. 783.
10. In supplement no. 1 to part 774,
ECCNs 1A004, 1A006, 1A007, 1A008,
1B001, 1C001, 1C002, 1C003, 1C005,
1C008, 1C010, 1C011, 2A001, 2B004,
2B006, 2B008, 2B009, 2E003, 3A001,
3A002, 3B001, 3D003, 3D006, 3E001,
3E002, 4A004, 4D001, 4E001, 5A001,
5A002, 5A004, 6A001, 6A002, 6A003,
6A004, 6A005, 6A006, 6A007, 6A008,
6B007, 6C002, 6C005, 6D003, 6E003,
7A003, 7A004, 7A005, 7A006, 7B001,
7D002, 7E004, 8A001, 8A002, 8C001,
8E002, 9A001, 9A003, 9A004, 9A005,
9B005, 9E001, 9E002, and 9E003 are
revised to read as follows:
■
Supplement No. 1 to Part 774—The
Commerce Control List
*
*
*
*
*
1A004 Protective and detection equipment
and ‘‘components’’, not ‘‘specially
designed’’ for military use, as follows
(see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, CB, RS, AT
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
CB applies to chemical detection systems and dedicated
detectors therefor,
in 1A004.c, that
also have the technical characteristic.
RS apply to 1A004.d
AT applies to entire
entry.
VerDate Sep<11>2014
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
NS Column 2
CB Column 2
RS Column 2
AT Column 1
20:45 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: Yes for 1A004.a, .b, and .c.2.
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See ECCNs 1A995,
2B351, and 2B352. (2) See ECCN 1D003 for
‘‘software’’ ‘‘specially designed’’ or
modified to enable equipment to perform
the functions of equipment controlled
under section 1A004.c (Nuclear, biological,
and chemical (NBC) detection systems). (3)
See ECCN 1E002.g for control libraries
(parametric technical databases) ‘‘specially
designed’’ or modified to enable equipment
to perform the functions of equipment
controlled under 1A004.c (Nuclear,
biological, and chemical (NBC) detection
systems). (4) Chemical and biological
protective and detection equipment
specifically designed, developed, modified,
configured, or adapted for military
applications is ‘‘subject to the ITAR’’ (see
22 CFR parts 120 through 130, including
USML Category XIV(f)), as is commercial
equipment that incorporates ‘‘parts’’ or
‘‘components’’ controlled under that
category except for domestic preparedness
devices for individual protection that
integrate ‘‘components’’ and ‘‘parts’’
identified in USML Category XIV(f)(4)
when such ‘‘parts’’ or ‘‘components’’ are:
Integral to the device; inseparable from the
device; and incapable of replacement
without compromising the effectiveness of
the device, in which case the equipment is
subject to the export licensing jurisdiction
of the Department of Commerce under
ECCN 1A004. (5) This entry does not
control radionuclides incorporated in
equipment listed in this entry—such
materials are subject to the licensing
jurisdiction of the Nuclear Regulatory
Commission (See 10 CFR part 110).
Related Definitions: (1) ‘Biological agents’
means: pathogens or toxins, selected or
modified (such as altering purity, shelf life,
virulence, dissemination characteristics, or
resistance to UV radiation) to produce
casualties in humans or animals, degrade
equipment or damage crops or the
environment. (2) ‘Riot control agents’ are
substances which, under the expected
conditions of use for riot control purposes,
produce rapidly in humans sensory
irritation or disabling physical effects
which disappear within a short time
following termination of exposure. (Tear
gases are a subset of ‘riot control agents.’)
Items:
a. Full face masks, filter canisters and
decontamination equipment therefor,
designed or modified for defense against any
of the following, and ‘‘specially designed’’
‘‘components’’ therefor:
Note: 1A004.a includes Powered Air
Purifying Respirators (PAPR) that are
designed or modified for defense against
agents or materials, listed in 1A004.a.
Technical Notes: For the purposes of
1A004.a:
1. Full face masks are also known as gas
masks.
2. Filter canisters include filter cartridges.
a.1. ‘Biological agents’;
PO 00000
Frm 00006
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
a.2. ‘Radioactive materials’;
a.3. Chemical warfare (CW) agents; or
a.4. ‘Riot control agents’, as follows:
a.4.a. a-Bromobenzeneacetonitrile,
(Bromobenzyl cyanide) (CA) (CAS 5798–79–
8);
a.4.b. [(2-chlorophenyl) methylene]
propanedinitrile, (oChlorobenzylidenemalononitrile) (CS) (CAS
2698–41–1);
a.4.c. 2-Chloro-1-phenylethanone,
Phenylacyl chloride (w-chloroacetophenone)
(CN) (CAS 532–27–4);
a.4.d. Dibenz-(b,f)-1,4-oxazephine, (CR)
(CAS 257–07–8);
a.4.e. 10-Chloro-5, 10dihydrophenarsazine, (Phenarsazine
chloride), (Adamsite), (DM) (CAS 578–94–9);
a.4.f. N-Nonanoylmorpholine, (MPA) (CAS
5299–64–9);
b. Protective suits, gloves and shoes,
‘‘specially designed’’ or modified for defense
against any of the following:
b.1. ‘Biological agents’;
b.2. ‘Radioactive materials’; or
b.3. Chemical warfare (CW) agents;
c. Detection systems, ‘‘specially designed’’
or modified for detection or identification of
any of the following, and ‘‘specially
designed’’ ‘‘components’’ therefor:
c.1. ‘Biological agents’;
c.2. ‘Radioactive materials’; or
c.3. Chemical warfare (CW) agents;
d. Electronic equipment designed for
automatically detecting or identifying the
presence of ‘‘explosives’’ (as listed in the
annex at the end of Category 1) residues and
utilizing ‘trace detection’ techniques (e.g.,
surface acoustic wave, ion mobility
spectrometry, differential mobility
spectrometry, mass spectrometry).
Technical Note: For the purposes of
1A004.d, ‘trace detection’ is defined as the
capability to detect less than 1 ppm vapor,
or 1 mg solid or liquid.
Note 1: 1A004.d does not apply to
equipment ‘‘specially designed’’ for
laboratory use.
Note 2: 1A004.d does not apply to noncontact walk-through security portals.
Note: 1A004 does not control:
a. Personal radiation monitoring
dosimeters;
b. Occupational health or safety equipment
limited by design or function to protect
against hazards specific to residential safety
or civil industries, including:
1. Mining;
2. Quarrying;
3. Agriculture;
4. Pharmaceutical;
5. Medical;
6. Veterinary;
7. Environmental;
8. Waste management;
9. Food industry.
Technical Notes:
1. 1A004 includes equipment,
‘‘components’’ that have been ‘identified,’
successfully tested to national standards or
otherwise proven effective, for the detection
of or defense against ‘radioactive materials’
‘biological agents,’ chemical warfare agents,
‘simulants’ or ‘‘riot control agents,’’ even if
such equipment or ‘‘components’’ are used in
civil industries such as mining, quarrying,
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
agriculture, pharmaceuticals, medical,
veterinary, environmental, waste
management, or the food industry.
2. ‘Simulant’: A substance or material that
is used in place of toxic agent (chemical or
biological) in training, research, testing or
evaluation.
3. For the purposes of 1A004, ‘radioactive
materials’ are those selected or modified to
increase their effectiveness in producing
casualties in humans or animals, degrading
equipment or damaging crops or the
environment.
*
*
*
*
*
1A006 Equipment, ‘‘specially designed’’ or
modified for the disposal of Improvised
Explosive Devices (IEDs), as follows (see
List of Items Controlled), and ‘‘specially
designed’’ ‘‘components’’ and
‘‘accessories’’ therefor.
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
AT applies to entire
entry.
Country chart
(see supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
NS Column 2
AT Column 1
License Requirement Note: 1A006 does
not apply to equipment when accompanying
its operator.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
Related Controls: Equipment ‘‘specially
designed’’ for military use for the disposal
of IEDs is ‘‘subject to the ITAR’’ (see 22
CFR parts 120 through 130, including
USML Category IV).
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Remotely operated vehicles;
b. ‘Disruptors’.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
1A006.b ‘disruptors’ are devices ‘‘specially
designed’’ for the purpose of preventing the
operation of an explosive device by
projecting a liquid, solid or frangible
projectile.
Note: 1A006 does not apply to equipment
when accompanying its operator.
1A007 Equipment and devices, ‘‘specially
designed’’ to initiate charges and
devices containing ‘‘energetic
materials,’’ by electrical means, as
follows (see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
NS applies to entire
entry.
VerDate Sep<11>2014
NP applies to
1A007.b, as well as
1A007.a when the
detonator firing set
meets or exceeds
the parameters of
3A229.
AT applies to entire
entry.
NP Column 1
AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: High explosives and related
equipment ‘‘specially designed’’ for
military use are ‘‘subject to the ITAR’’ (see
22 CFR parts 120 through 130). This entry
does not control detonators using only
primary explosives, such as lead azide. See
also ECCNs 0A604, 3A229, and 3A232. See
1E001 for ‘‘development’’ and
‘‘production’’ technology controls, and
1E201 for ‘‘use’’ technology controls.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Explosive detonator firing sets designed
to drive explosive detonators specified by
1A007.b;
b. Electrically driven explosive detonators
as follows:
b.1. Exploding bridge (EB);
b.2. Exploding bridge wire (EBW);
b.3. Slapper;
b.4. Exploding foil initiators (EFI).
Technical Notes:
1. The word initiator or igniter is
sometimes used in place of the word
detonator.
2. For the purposes of 1A007.b, the
detonators of concern all utilize a small
electrical conductor (bridge, bridge wire, or
foil) that explosively vaporizes when a fast,
high-current electrical pulse is passed
through it. In non slapper types, the
exploding conductor starts a chemical
detonation in a contacting high explosive
material such as PETN
(pentaerythritoltetranitrate). In slapper
detonators, the explosive vaporization of the
electrical conductor drives a flyer or slapper
across a gap, and the impact of the slapper
on an explosive starts a chemical detonation.
The slapper in some designs is driven by
magnetic force. The term exploding foil
detonator may refer to either an EB or a
slapper-type detonator.
1A008 Charges, devices and
‘‘components’’, as follows (see List of
Items Controlled).
Country chart
(see supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
NS Column 2
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Country chart
(see supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, UN, AT
Reason for Control: NS, NP, AT
Control(s)
Control(s)
Jkt 262001
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
PO 00000
Frm 00007
Fmt 4701
Country chart
(see supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
NS Column 2
Sfmt 4700
Control(s)
AT applies to entire
entry.
UN applies to entire
entry.
71937
Country chart
(see supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
AT Column 1
See § 746.1(b) for UN
controls.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: $3,000 for .a through .c; $6,000 for .d.
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) All of the following are
‘‘subject to the ITAR’’ (see 22 CFR parts
120 through 130):
a. High explosives and related equipment
‘‘specially designed’’ for military use;
b. Explosive devices or charges in this
entry that utilize USML controlled energetic
materials (See 22 CFR 121.1 Category V), if
they have been specifically designed,
developed, configured, adapted, or modified
for a military application;
c. Shaped charges that have all of the
following a uniform shaped conical liner
with an included angle of 90 degrees or less,
more than 2.0 kg of controlled materials, and
a diameter exceeding 4.5 inches;
d. Detonating cord containing greater than
0.1 kg per meter (470 grains per foot) of
controlled materials;
e. Cutters and severing tools containing
greater than 10 kg of controlled materials;
f. With the exception of cutters and
severing tools, devices or charges controlled
by this entry where the USML controlled
materials can be easily extracted without
destroying the device or charge; and
g. Individual USML controlled energetic
materials in this entry, even when
compounded with other materials, when not
incorporated into explosive devices or
charges controlled by this entry or 1C992.
(2) See also ECCNs 1C011, 1C018, 1C111,
1C239, and 1C608 for additional controlled
energetic materials. See ECCN 1E001 for
the ‘‘development’’ or ‘‘production’’
‘‘technology’’ for the commodities
controlled by ECCN 1A008, but not for
explosives or commodities that are
‘‘subject to the ITAR’’ (see 22 CFR parts
120 through 130).
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. ‘Shaped charges’ having all of the
following:
a.1. Net Explosive Quantity (NEQ) greater
than 90 g; and
a.2. Outer casing diameter equal to or
greater than 75 mm;
b. Linear shaped cutting charges having all
of the following, and ‘‘specially designed’’
‘‘components’’ therefor:
b.1. An explosive load greater than 40 g/
m; and
b.2. A width of 10 mm or more;
c. Detonating cord with explosive core load
greater than 64 g/m;
d. Cutters, not specified by 1A008.b, and
severing tools, having a NEQ greater than 3.5
kg.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
1A008.a, ‘shaped charges’ are explosive
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
71938
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
charges shaped to focus the effects of the
explosive blast.
Note: The only charges and devices
specified in 1A008 are those containing
‘‘explosives’’ (see list of explosives in the
Annex at the end of Category 1) and mixtures
thereof.
*
*
*
*
*
1B001 Equipment for the production or
inspection of ‘‘composite’’ structures or
laminates controlled by 1A002 or
‘‘fibrous or filamentary materials’’
controlled by 1C010, as follows (see List
of Items Controlled), and ‘‘specially
designed’’ ‘‘components’’ and
‘‘accessories’’ therefor.
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, NP, AT
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
MT applies to entire
entry, except
1B001.d.4, e and f.
Note: MT applies
to equipment in
1B001.d that meet
or exceed the parameters of 1B101.
NP applies to filament winding machines described in
1B001.a that are
capable of winding
cylindrical rotors
having a diameter
between 75 mm (3
in) and 400 mm
(16 in) and lengths
of 600 mm (24 in)
or greater; AND coordinating and programming controls
and precision
mandrels for these
filament winding
machines.
AT applies to entire
entry.
Country chart
(see supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
NS Column 2
MT Column 1
NP Column 1.
AT Column 1.
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A for MT and for 1B001.a; $5000 for
all other items
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See ECCN 1D001 for
software for items controlled by this entry
and see ECCNs 1E001 (‘‘development’’ and
‘‘production’’) and 1E101 (‘‘use’’) for
technology for items controlled by this
entry. (2) Also see ECCNs 1B101 and
1B201.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Filament winding machines, of which
the motions for positioning, wrapping and
winding fibers are coordinated and
programmed in three or more ‘primary servo
positioning’ axes, ‘‘specially designed’’ for
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
the manufacture of ‘‘composite’’ structures or
laminates, from ‘‘fibrous or filamentary
materials’’;
b. ‘Tape laying machines’, of which the
motions for positioning and laying tape are
coordinated and programmed in five or more
‘primary servo positioning’ axes, ‘‘specially
designed’’ for the manufacture of
‘‘composite’’ airframe or missile structures;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
1B001.b, ‘tape-laying machines’ have the
ability to lay one or more ‘filament bands’
limited to widths greater than 25.4 mm and
less than or equal to 304.8 mm, and to cut
and restart individual ‘filament band’
courses during the laying process.
c. Multidirectional, multidimensional
weaving machines or interlacing machines,
including adapters and modification kits,
‘‘specially designed’’ or modified for
weaving, interlacing or braiding fibers for
‘‘composite’’ structures;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
1B001.c the technique of interlacing includes
knitting.
d. Equipment ‘‘specially designed’’ or
adapted for the production of reinforcement
fibers, as follows:
d.1. Equipment for converting polymeric
fibers (such as polyacrylonitrile, rayon, pitch
or polycarbosilane) into carbon fibers or
silicon carbide fibers, including special
equipment to strain the fiber during heating;
d.2. Equipment for the chemical vapor
deposition of elements or compounds, on
heated filamentary substrates, to manufacture
silicon carbide fibers;
d.3. Equipment for the wet-spinning of
refractory ceramics (such as aluminum
oxide);
d.4. Equipment for converting aluminum
containing precursor fibers into alumina
fibers by heat treatment;
e. Equipment for producing prepregs
controlled by 1C010.e by the hot melt
method;
f. Non-destructive inspection equipment
‘‘specially designed’’ for ‘‘composite’’
materials, as follows:
f.1. X-ray tomography systems for three
dimensional defect inspection;
f.2. Numerically controlled ultrasonic
testing machines of which the motions for
positioning transmitters or receivers are
simultaneously coordinated and programmed
in four or more axes to follow the three
dimensional contours of the ‘‘part’’ or
‘‘component’’ under inspection;
g. Tow-placement machines, of which the
motions for positioning and laying tows are
coordinated and programmed in two or more
‘primary servo positioning’ axes, ‘‘specially
designed’’ for the manufacture of
‘‘composite’’ airframe or missile structures.
Technical Note to 1B001.g: For the
purposes of 1B001.g, ‘tow-placement
machines’ have the ability to place one or
more ‘filament bands’ having widths less
than or equal to 25.4 mm, and to cut and
restart individual ‘filament band’ courses
during the placement process.
Technical Notes for 1B001:
1. For the purposes of 1B001, ‘primary
servo positioning’ axes control, under
computer ‘‘program’’ direction, the position
of the end effector (i.e., head) in space
PO 00000
Frm 00008
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
relative to the work piece at the correct
orientation and direction to achieve the
desired process.
2. For the purposes of 1B001, a ‘filament
band’ is a single continuous width of fully or
partially resin-impregnated tape, tow or fiber.
Fully or partially resin-impregnated ‘filament
bands’ include those coated with dry powder
that tacks upon heating.
*
*
*
*
*
1C001 Materials ‘‘specially designed’’ for
absorbing electromagnetic radiation, or
intrinsically conductive polymers, as
follows (see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, AT
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
MT applies to items
that meet or exceed the parameters of ECCN
1C101.
AT applies to entire
entry.
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
NS Column 1
MT Column 1
AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements
See § 743.1 of the EAR for reporting
requirements for exports under License
Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be
used to ship any item in this entry to any
of the destinations listed in Country Group
A:6 (See Supplement No.1 to part 740 of
the EAR).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: See also 1C101.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Materials for absorbing frequencies
exceeding 2 × 108 Hz but less than 3 × 1012
Hz.
Note 1: 1C001.a does not control:
a. Hair type absorbers, constructed of
natural or synthetic fibers, with non-magnetic
loading to provide absorption;
b. Absorbers having no magnetic loss and
whose incident surface is non-planar in
shape, including pyramids, cones, wedges
and convoluted surfaces;
c. Planar absorbers, having all of the
following:
1. Made from any of the following:
a. Plastic foam materials (flexible or nonflexible) with carbon-loading, or organic
materials, including binders, providing more
than 5% echo compared with metal over a
bandwidth exceeding ±15% of the center
frequency of the incident energy, and not
capable of withstanding temperatures
exceeding 450 K (177 °C); or
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
b. Ceramic materials providing more than
20% echo compared with metal over a
bandwidth exceeding ±15% of the center
frequency of the incident energy, and not
capable of withstanding temperatures
exceeding 800 K (527 °C);
Technical Note: For the purposes of
1C001.a Note 1.c.1, absorption test samples
should be a square at least 5 wavelengths of
the center frequency on a side and positioned
in the far field of the radiating element.
2. Tensile strength less than 7 × 106 N/m2;
and
3. Compressive strength less than 14 × 106
N/m2;
d. Planar absorbers made of sintered
ferrite, having all of the following:
1. A specific gravity exceeding 4.4; and
2. A maximum operating temperature of
548 K (275 °C) or less;
e. Planar absorbers having no magnetic
loss and fabricated from ‘open-cell foams’
plastic material with a density of 0.15 grams/
cm3 or less.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
1C001.a Note e., ‘open-cell foams’ are
flexible and porous materials, having an
inner structure open to the atmosphere.
‘Open-cell foams’ are also known as
reticulated foams.
Note 2: Nothing in Note 1 releases
magnetic materials to provide absorption
when contained in paint.
b. Materials not transparent to visible light
and ‘‘specially designed’’ for absorbing nearinfrared radiation having a wavelength
exceeding 810 nm but less than 2,000 nm
(frequencies exceeding 150 THz but less than
370 THz);
Note: 1C001.b does not apply to materials,
‘‘specially designed’’ or formulated for any of
the following applications:
a. ‘‘Laser’’ marking of polymers; or
b. ‘‘Laser’’ welding of polymers.
c. Intrinsically conductive polymeric
materials with a ‘bulk electrical conductivity’
exceeding 10,000 S/m (Siemens per meter) or
a ‘sheet (surface) resistivity’ of less than 100
ohms/square, based on any of the following
polymers:
c.1. Polyaniline;
c.2. Polypyrrole;
c.3. Polythiophene;
c.4. Poly phenylene-vinylene; or
c.5. Poly thienylene-vinylene.
Note: 1C001.c does not apply to materials
in a liquid form.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
1C001.c, ‘bulk electrical conductivity’ and
‘sheet (surface) resistivity’ should be
determined using ASTM D–257 or national
equivalents.
1C002 Metal alloys, metal alloy powder
and alloyed materials, as follows (see
List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, NP, AT
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
VerDate Sep<11>2014
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
NS Column 2
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
Control(s)
NP applies to
1C002.b.3 or b.4 if
they exceed the
parameters stated
in 1C202.
AT applies to entire
entry.
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
NP Column 1
AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: $3000; N/A for NP
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See ECCNs 1E001
(‘‘development’’ and ‘‘production’’) and
1E201 (‘‘use’’) for technology for items
controlled by this entry. (2) Also see ECCN
1C202. (3) Aluminum alloys and titanium
alloys in physical forms and finished
products ‘‘especially designed’’ or
prepared for use in separating uranium
isotopes are subject to the export licensing
authority of the Nuclear Regulatory
Commission (see 10 CFR part 110).
Related Definition: N/A
Items:
Note: 1C002 does not control metal alloys,
metal alloy powder and alloyed materials,
specially formulated for coating purposes.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
1C002, metal alloys are those containing a
higher percentage by weight of the stated
metal than of any other element.
a. Aluminides, as follows:
a.1. Nickel aluminides containing a
minimum of 15% by weight aluminum, a
maximum of 38% by weight aluminum and
at least one additional alloying element;
a.2. Titanium aluminides containing 10%
by weight or more aluminum and at least one
additional alloying element;
b. Metal alloys, as follows, made from the
powder or particulate material controlled by
1C002.c:
b.1. Nickel alloys having any of the
following:
b.1.a. A ‘stress-rupture life’ of 10,000 hours
or longer at 923 K (650 °C) at a stress of 676
MPa; or
b.1.b. A ‘low cycle fatigue life’ of 10,000
cycles or more at 823 K (550 °C) at a
maximum stress of 1,095 MPa;
b.2. Niobium alloys having any of the
following:
b.2.a. A ‘stress-rupture life’ of 10,000 hours
or longer at 1,073 K (800 °C) at a stress of 400
MPa; or
b.2.b. A ‘low cycle fatigue life’ of 10,000
cycles or more at 973 K (700 °C) at a
maximum stress of 700 MPa;
b.3. Titanium alloys having any of the
following:
b.3.a. A ‘stress-rupture life’ of 10,000 hours
or longer at 723 K (450 °C) at a stress of 200
MPa; or
b.3.b. A ‘low cycle fatigue life’ of 10,000
cycles or more at 723 K (450 °C) at a
maximum stress of 400 MPa;
b.4 Aluminum alloys having any of the
following:
b.4.a. A tensile strength of 240 MPa or
more at 473 K (200 °C); or
PO 00000
Frm 00009
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
71939
b.4.b. A tensile strength of 415 MPa or
more at 298 K (25 °C);
b.5. Magnesium alloys having all the
following:
b.5.a. A tensile strength of 345 MPa or
more; and
b.5.b. A corrosion rate of less than 1 mm/
year in 3% sodium chloride aqueous solution
measured in accordance with ASTM
standard G–31 or national equivalents;
Technical Notes: For the purposes of
1C002.b:
1. ‘Stress-rupture life’ should be measured
in accordance with ASTM standard E–139 or
national equivalents.
2. ‘Low cycle fatigue life’ should be
measured in accordance with ASTM
Standard E–606 ‘Recommended Practice for
Constant-Amplitude Low-Cycle Fatigue
Testing’ or national equivalents. Testing
should be axial with an average stress ratio
equal to 1 and a stress-concentration factor
(Kt) equal to 1. The average stress ratio is
defined as maximum stress minus minimum
stress divided by maximum stress.
c. Metal alloy powder or particulate
material, having all of the following:
c.1. Made from any of the following
composition systems:
Technical Note: For the purposes of
1C002.c.1, X equals one or more alloying
elements.
c.1.a. Nickel alloys (Ni-Al-X, Ni-X-Al)
qualified for turbine engine ‘‘parts’’ or
‘‘components,’’ i.e., with less than 3 nonmetallic particles (introduced during the
manufacturing process) larger than 100 mm in
109 alloy particles;
c.1.b. Niobium alloys (Nb-Al-X or Nb-X-Al,
Nb-Si-X or Nb-X-Si, Nb-Ti-X or Nb-X-Ti);
c.1.c. Titanium alloys (Ti-Al-X or Ti-X-Al);
c.1.d. Aluminum alloys (Al-Mg-X or Al-XMg, Al-Zn-X or Al-X-Zn, Al-Fe-X or Al-X-Fe);
or
c.1.e. Magnesium alloys (Mg-Al-X or Mg-XAl);
c.2. Made in a controlled environment by
any of the following processes:
c.2.a. ‘Vacuum atomization’;
c.2.b. ‘Gas atomization’;
c.2.c. ‘Rotary atomization’;
c.2.d. ‘Splat quenching’;
c.2.e. ‘Melt spinning’ and ‘comminution’;
c.2.f. ‘Melt extraction’ and ‘comminution’;
c.2.g. ‘Mechanical alloying’; or
c.2.h. ‘Plasma atomization’; and
c.3. Capable of forming materials
controlled by 1C002.a or 1C002.b;
d. Alloyed materials, having all the
following:
d.1. Made from any of the composition
systems specified by 1C002.c.1;
d.2. In the form of uncomminuted flakes,
ribbons or thin rods; and
d.3. Produced in a controlled environment
by any of the following:
d.3.a. ‘Splat quenching’;
d.3.b. ‘Melt spinning’; or
d.3.c. ‘Melt extraction’.
Technical Notes: For the purposes of
1C002:
1. ‘Vacuum atomization’ is a process to
reduce a molten stream of metal to droplets
of a diameter of 500 mm or less by the rapid
evolution of a dissolved gas upon exposure
to a vacuum.
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
71940
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
2. ‘Gas atomization’ is a process to reduce
a molten stream of metal alloy to droplets of
500 mm diameter or less by a high pressure
gas stream.
3. ‘Rotary atomization’ is a process to
reduce a stream or pool of molten metal to
droplets of a diameter of 500 mm or less by
centrifugal force.
4. ‘Splat quenching’ is a process to ‘solidify
rapidly’ a molten metal stream impinging
upon a chilled block, forming a flake-like
product.
5. ‘Melt spinning’ is a process to ‘solidify
rapidly’ a molten metal stream impinging
upon a rotating chilled block, forming a
flake, ribbon or rod-like product.
6. ‘Comminution’ is a process to reduce a
material to particles by crushing or grinding.
7. ‘Melt extraction’ is a process to ‘solidify
rapidly’ and extract a ribbon-like alloy
product by the insertion of a short segment
of a rotating chilled block into a bath of a
molten metal alloy.
8. ‘Mechanical alloying’ is an alloying
process resulting from the bonding,
fracturing and rebonding of elemental and
master alloy powders by mechanical impact.
Non-metallic particles may be incorporated
in the alloy by addition of the appropriate
powders.
9. ‘Plasma atomization’ is a process to
reduce a molten stream or solid metal to
droplets of 500 mm diameter or less, using
plasma torches in an inert gas environment.
10. For the purposes of 1C002 Technical
Notes, ‘solidify rapidly’ is a process involving
the solidification of molten material at
cooling rates exceeding 1000 K/sec.
1C003 Magnetic metals, of all types and of
whatever form, having any of the
following (see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
AT applies to entire
entry.
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
NS Column 2
AT Column 1
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: $3000
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: N/A
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Initial relative permeability of 120,000 or
more and a thickness of 0.05 mm or less;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
1C003.a, measurement of initial relative
permeability must be performed on fully
annealed materials.
b. Magnetostrictive alloys having any of the
following:
b.1. A saturation magnetostriction of more
than 5 × 104¥4; or
b.2. A magnetomechanical coupling factor
(k) of more than 0.8; or
c. Amorphous or ‘nanocrystalline’ alloy
strips, having all of the following:
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
c.1. A composition having a minimum of
75% by weight of iron, cobalt or nickel;
c.2. A saturation magnetic induction (Bs) of
1.6 T or more; and
c.3. Any of the following:
c.3.a. A strip thickness of 0.02 mm or less;
or
c.3.b. An electrical resistivity of 2 × 10¥4
ohm cm or more.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
1C003.c, ‘nanocrystalline’ materials are those
materials having a crystal grain size of 50 nm
or less, as determined by X-ray diffraction.
*
*
*
*
*
1C005 ‘‘Superconductive’’ ‘‘composite’’
conductors in lengths exceeding 100 m
or with a mass exceeding 100 g, as
follows (see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
NS applies to entire
entry.
AT applies to entire
entry.
NS Column 2
AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: $1500
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: N/A
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. ‘‘Superconductive’’ ‘‘composite’’
conductors containing one or more niobiumtitanium ‘filaments’, having all of the
following:
a.1. Embedded in a ‘‘matrix’’ other than a
copper or copper-based mixed ‘‘matrix’’; and
a.2. Having a cross-section area less than
0.28 × 10¥4 mm2 (6 mm in diameter for
circular ‘filaments’);
b. ‘‘Superconductive’’ ‘‘composite’’
conductors consisting of one or more
‘‘superconductive’’ ‘filaments’ other than
niobium-titanium, having all of the
following:
b.1. A ‘‘critical temperature’’ at zero
magnetic induction exceeding 9.85 K
(¥263.31 °C); and
b.2. Remaining in the ‘‘superconductive’’
state at a temperature of 4.2 K (¥268.96 °C)
when exposed to a magnetic field oriented in
any direction perpendicular to the
longitudinal axis of conductor and
corresponding to a magnetic induction of 12
T with critical current density exceeding
1750 A/mm2 on overall cross-section of the
conductor.
c. ‘‘Superconductive’’ ‘‘composite’’
conductors consisting of one or more
‘‘superconductive’’ ‘filaments’ which remain
‘‘superconductive’’ above 115 K (¥158.16
°C).
Technical Note: For the purposes of
1C005, ‘filaments’ may be in wire, cylinder,
film, tape or ribbon form.
*
PO 00000
*
*
Frm 00010
*
Fmt 4701
*
Sfmt 4700
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Country chart (see
supp. No. 1 to part
738)
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
AT applies to entire
entry.
NS Column 2
AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: $200
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Control(s)
1C008 Non-fluorinated polymeric
substances as follows (see List of Items
Controlled).
Related Controls: See also 1A003.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Imides as follows:
a.1. Bismaleimides;
a.2. Aromatic polyamide-imides (PAI)
having a ‘glass transition temperature (Tg)’
exceeding 563 K (290 °C);
a.3. Aromatic polyimides having a ‘glass
transition temperature (Tg)’ exceeding 505 K
(232 °C);
a.4. Aromatic polyetherimides having a
‘glass transition temperature (Tg)’ exceeding
563 K (290 °C);
Note: 1C008.a controls the substances in
liquid or solid ‘‘fusible’’ form, including
resin, powder, pellet, film, sheet, tape, or
ribbon.
N.B.: For non-‘‘fusible’’ aromatic
polyimides in film, sheet, tape, or ribbon
form, see ECCN 1A003.
b. [Reserved]
c. [Reserved]
d. Polyarylene ketones;
e. Polyarylene sulfides, where the arylene
group is biphenylene, triphenylene or
combinations thereof;
f. Polybiphenylenethersulphone having a
‘glass transition temperature (Tg)’ exceeding
563 K (290 °C).
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 1C008.a.2
thermoplastic materials, 1C008.a.4 materials,
and 1C008.f materials, the ‘glass transition
temperature (Tg)’ is determined using the
method described in ISO 11357–2 (1999) or
national equivalents.
2. For the purposes of 1C008.a.2
thermosetting materials and 1C008.a.3
materials, the ‘glass transition temperature
(Tg)’ is determined using the 3-point bend
method described in ASTM D 7028–07 or
equivalent national standard. The test is to
be performed using a dry test specimen
which has attained a minimum of 90%
degree of cure as specified by ASTM E 2160–
04 or equivalent national standard, and was
cured using the combination of standardand post-cure processes that yield the highest
Tg.
*
*
*
*
*
1C010 ‘‘Fibrous or filamentary materials’’
as follows (see List of Items Controlled).
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, NP, AT
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
NP applies to
1C010.a (aramid
‘‘fibrous or filamentary materials’’, b
(carbon ‘‘fibrous
and filamentary
materials’’), and e.1
for ‘‘fibrous and
filamentary materials’’ that meet or
exceed the control
criteria of ECCN
1C210.
AT applies to entire
entry.
Country chart (see
supp. No. 1 to part
738)
NS Column 2
NP Column 1
AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements
See § 743.1 of the EAR for reporting
requirements for exports under License
Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: $1500, N/A for NP
GBS: N/A
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be
used to ship any item in 1C010.c to any of
the destinations listed in Country Group
A:6 (See Supplement No.1 to part 740 of
the EAR).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See ECCNs 1E001
(‘‘development’’ and ‘‘production’’) and
1E201 (‘‘use’’) for technology for items
controlled by this entry. (2) Also see
ECCNs 1C210 and 1C990. (3) See also
9C110 for material not controlled by
1C010.e, as defined by notes 1 or 2.
Related Definitions: (1) ‘‘Specific modulus’’:
Young’s modulus in pascals, equivalent to
N/m2 divided by specific weight in N/m3,
measured at a temperature of (296+2) K
((23+2) °C) and a relative humidity of
(50+5) %. (2) ‘‘Specific tensile strength’’:
ultimate tensile strength in pascals,
equivalent to N/m2 divided by specific
weight in N/m3, measured at a temperature
of (296+2) K ((23+2) °C) and a relative
humidity of (50+5) %.
Items:
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of calculating ‘‘specific
tensile strength’’, ‘‘specific modulus’’ or
specific weight of ‘‘fibrous or filamentary
materials’’ in 1C010.a, 1C010.b, 1C010.c, or
1C010.e.1.b the tensile strength and modulus
should be determined by using Method A
described in ISO 10618 (2004) or national
equivalents.
2. For the purposes of assessing the
‘‘specific tensile strength’’, ‘‘specific
modulus’’ or specific weight of nonunidirectional ‘‘fibrous or filamentary
materials’’ (e.g., fabrics, random mats or
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
braids) in 1C010, this is to be based on the
mechanical properties of the constituent
unidirectional monofilaments (e.g.,
monofilaments, yarns, rovings or tows) prior
to processing into the non-unidirectional
‘‘fibrous or filamentary materials’’.
a. Organic ‘‘fibrous or filamentary
materials’’, having all of the following:
a.1. ‘‘Specific modulus’’ exceeding 12.7 ×
106 m; and
a.2. ‘‘Specific tensile strength’’ exceeding
23.5 × 104 m;
Note: 1C010.a does not control
polyethylene.
b. Carbon ‘‘fibrous or filamentary
materials’’, having all of the following:
b.1. ‘‘Specific modulus’’ exceeding 14.65 ×
106 m; and
b.2. ‘‘Specific tensile strength’’ exceeding
26.82 × 104 m;
Note: 1C010.b does not control:
a. ‘‘Fibrous or filamentary materials’’, for
the repair of ‘‘civil aircraft’’ structures or
laminates, having all of the following:
1. An area not exceeding 1 m2;
2. A length not exceeding 2.5 m; and
3. A width exceeding 15 mm.
b. Mechanically chopped, milled or cut
carbon ‘‘fibrous or filamentary materials’’
25.0 mm or less in length.
c. Inorganic ‘‘fibrous or filamentary
materials’’, having all of the following:
c.1. Having any of the following:
c.1.a. Composed of 50% or more by weight
silicon dioxide (SiO2) and having a ‘‘specific
modulus’’ exceeding 2.54 × 106 m; or
c.1.b. Not specified in 1C010.c.1.a and
having a ‘‘specific modulus’’ exceeding 5.6 ×
106 m; and
c.2. Melting, softening, decomposition or
sublimation point exceeding 1,922 K (1,649
°C) in an inert environment;
Note: 1C010.c does not control:
a. Discontinuous, multiphase,
polycrystalline alumina fibers in chopped
fiber or random mat form, containing 3% by
weight or more silica, with a ‘‘specific
modulus’’ of less than 10 × 106 m;
b. Molybdenum and molybdenum alloy
fibers;
c. Boron fibers;
d. Discontinuous ceramic fibers with a
melting, softening, decomposition or
sublimation point lower than 2,043 K (1,770
°C) in an inert environment.
d. ‘‘Fibrous or filamentary materials’’,
having any of the following:
d.1. Composed of any of the following:
d.1.a. Polyetherimides controlled by
1C008.a; or
d.1.b. Materials controlled by 1C008.b to
1C008.f; or
d.2. Composed of materials controlled by
1C010.d.1.a or 1C010.d.1.b and ‘commingled’
with other fibers controlled by 1C010.a,
1C010.b or 1C010.c;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
1C010.d.2, ‘commingled’ is filament to
filament blending of thermoplastic fibers and
reinforcement fibers in order to produce a
fiber reinforcement ‘‘matrix’’ mix in total
fiber form.
e. Fully or partially resin impregnated or
pitch impregnated ‘‘fibrous or filamentary
materials’’ (prepregs), metal or carbon coated
‘‘fibrous or filamentary materials’’ (preforms)
PO 00000
Frm 00011
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
71941
or ‘carbon fiber preforms’, having all of the
following:
e.1. Having any of the following:
e.1.a. Inorganic ‘‘fibrous or filamentary
materials’’ controlled by 1C010.c; or
e.1.b. Organic or carbon ‘‘fibrous or
filamentary materials’’, having all of the
following:
e.1.b.1. ‘‘Specific modulus’’ exceeding
10.15 × 106 m; and
e.1.b.2 ‘‘Specific tensile strength’’
exceeding 17.7 × 104m; and
e.2. Having any of the following:
e.2.a. Resin or pitch, controlled by 1C008
or 1C009.b;
e.2.b. ‘Dynamic Mechanical Analysis glass
transition temperature (DMA Tg)’ equal to or
exceeding 453 K (180°C) and having a
phenolic resin; or
e.2.c. ‘Dynamic Mechanical Analysis glass
transition temperature (DMA Tg)’ equal to or
exceeding 505 K (232°C) and having a resin
or pitch, not specified by 1C008 or 1C009.b,
and not being a phenolic resin;
Note 1: Metal or carbon coated ‘‘fibrous or
filamentary materials’’ (preforms) or ‘carbon
fiber preforms’, not impregnated with resin or
pitch, are specified by ‘‘fibrous or filamentary
materials’’ in 1C010.a, 1C010.b or 1C010.c.
Note 2: 1C010.e does not apply to:
a. Epoxy resin ‘‘matrix’’ impregnated
carbon ‘‘fibrous or filamentary materials’’
(prepregs) for the repair of ‘‘civil aircraft’’
structures or laminates, having all of the
following:
1. An area not exceeding 1 m2
2. A length not exceeding 2.5 m; and
3. A width exceeding 15 mm;
b. Fully or partially resin-impregnated or
pitch-impregnated mechanically chopped,
milled or cut carbon ‘‘fibrous or filamentary
materials’’ 25.0 mm or less in length when
using a resin or pitch other than those
specified by 1C008 or 1C009.b.
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 1C010.e and Note 1,
‘carbon fiber preforms’ are an ordered
arrangement of uncoated or coated fibers
intended to constitute a framework of a part
before the ‘‘matrix’’ is introduced to form a
‘‘composite’’.
2. For the purposes of 1C010.e.2, ‘Dynamic
Mechanical Analysis glass transition
temperature (DMA Tg)’ is determined using
the method described in ASTM D 7028 –07,
or equivalent national standard, on a dry test
specimen. In the case of thermoset materials,
degree of cure of a dry test specimen shall
be a minimum of 90% as defined by ASTM
E 2160 04 or equivalent national standard.
1C011 Metals and compounds, as follows
(see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, AT
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
MT applies to
1C011.a and .b for
items that meet or
exceed the parameters in 1C111..
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
Country chart (see
supp. No. 1 to part
738)
NS Column 2
MT Column 1
71942
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
Country chart (see
supp. No. 1 to part
738)
Control(s)
AT applies to entire
entry.
AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See also ECCNs 1C111
and 1C608. (2) All of the following are
‘‘subject to the ITAR’’ (see 22 CFR parts
120 through 130): (a) Materials controlled
by 1C011.a, and metal fuels in particle
form, whether spherical, atomized,
spheroidal, flaked or ground, manufactured
from material consisting of 99 percent or
more of items controlled by 1C011.b; and
(b) Metal powders mixed with other
substances to form a mixture formulated
for military purposes.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Metals in particle sizes of less than 60
mm whether spherical, atomized, spheroidal,
flaked or ground, manufactured from
material consisting of 99% or more of
zirconium, magnesium and alloys thereof;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
1C011.a, the natural content of hafnium in
the zirconium (typically 2% to 7%) is
counted with the zirconium.
Note: The metals or alloys specified by
1C011.a also refer to metals or alloys
encapsulated in aluminum, magnesium,
zirconium or beryllium.
b. Boron or boron alloys, with a particle
size of 60 mm or less, as follows:
b.1. Boron with a purity of 85% by weight
or more;
b.2. Boron alloys with a boron content of
85% by weight or more;
Note: The metals or alloys specified by
1C011.b also refer to metals or alloys
encapsulated in aluminum, magnesium,
zirconium or beryllium.
c. Guanidine nitrate (CAS 506–93–4);
d. Nitroguanidine (NQ) (CAS 556–88–7).
*
*
*
*
*
2A001 Anti-friction bearings, bearing
systems and ‘‘components,’’ as follows,
(see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, AT
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
Country chart (see
supp. No. 1 to part
738)
NS Column 2
MT applies to radial
ball bearings having all tolerances
specified in accordance with ISO 492
Tolerance Class 2
(or ANSI/ABMA Std
20 Tolerance Class
ABEC–9, or other
national equivalents) or better and
having all the following characteristics: an inner ring
bore diameter between 12 and 50
mm; an outer ring
outside diameter
between 25 and
100 mm; and a
width between 10
and 20 mm..
AT applies to entire
entry.
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
MT Column 1
AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: $3000, N/A for MT
GBS: Yes, for 2A001.a,
N/A for MT
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See also 2A991. (2)
Quiet running bearings are ‘‘subject to the
ITAR’’ (see 22 CFR parts 120 through 130.)
Related Definitions: Annular Bearing
Engineers Committee (ABEC).
Items:
Note: 2A001.a includes ball bearing and
roller elements ‘‘specially designed’’ for the
items specified therein.
a. Ball bearings and solid roller bearings,
having all tolerances specified by the
manufacturer in accordance with ISO 492
Tolerance Class 2 or Class 4 (or national
equivalents), or better, and having both
‘rings’ and ‘rolling elements’, made from
monel or beryllium;
Note: 2A001.a does not control tapered
roller bearings.
Technical Notes: For the purposes of
2A001.a:
1. ‘Ring’—is an annular part of a radial
rolling bearing incorporating one or more
raceways (ISO 5593:1997).
2. ‘Rolling element’—is a ball or roller
which rolls between raceways (ISO
5593:1997).
b. [Reserved]
c. Active magnetic bearing systems using
any of the following, and ‘‘specially
designed’’ components therefor:
c.1. Materials with flux densities of 2.0 T
or greater and yield strengths greater than
414 MPa;
c.2. All-electromagnetic 3D homopolar bias
designs for actuators; or
c.3. High temperature (450 K (177 °C) and
above) position sensors.
*
VerDate Sep<11>2014
Country chart (see
supp. No. 1 to part
738)
Control(s)
PO 00000
*
*
Frm 00012
*
Fmt 4701
*
Sfmt 4700
B. ‘‘Test,’’ ‘‘Inspection’’ and ‘‘Production
Equipment’’
Technical Notes for 2B001 to 2B009,
2B201, and 2B991 to 2B999:
1. For the purposes of 2B, secondary
parallel contouring axes, (e.g., the w-axis on
horizontal boring mills or a secondary rotary
axis the center line of which is parallel to the
primary rotary axis) are not counted in the
total number of contouring axes. Rotary axes
need not rotate over 360 °. A rotary axis can
be driven by a linear device (e.g., a screw or
a rack-and-pinion).
2. For the purposes of 2B, the number of
axes which can be coordinated
simultaneously for ‘‘contouring control’’ is
the number of axes along or around which,
during processing of the workpiece,
simultaneous and interrelated motions are
performed between the workpiece and a tool.
This does not include any additional axes
along or around which other relative motions
within the machine are performed, such as:
2.a. Wheel-dressing systems in grinding
machines;
2.b. Parallel rotary axes designed for
mounting of separate workpieces;
2.c. Co-linear rotary axes designed for
manipulating the same workpiece by holding
it in a chuck from different ends.
3. For the purposes of 2B, axis
nomenclature shall be in accordance with
International Standard ISO 841:2001,
Industrial automation systems and
integration—Numerical control of
machines—Coordinate system and motion
nomenclature.
4. For the purposes of this Category, a
‘‘tilting spindle’’ is counted as a rotary axis.
5. For the purposes of 2B, ‘stated
‘‘unidirectional positioning repeatability’’’
may be used for each specific machine model
as an alternative to individual machine tests,
and is determined as follows:
5.a. Select five machines of a model to be
evaluated;
5.b. Measure the linear axis repeatability
(R↑,R↓) according to ISO 230–2:2014 and
evaluate ‘‘unidirectional positioning
repeatability’’ for each axis of each of the five
machines;
5.c. Determine the arithmetic mean value
of the ‘‘unidirectional positioning
repeatability’’-values for each axis of all five
machines together. These arithmetic mean
values ‘‘unidirectional positioning
repeatability’’ (UPR) become the stated value
of each axis for the model. . .)(UPRx, UPRy,
. . .);
5.d. Since the Category 2 list refers to each
linear axis there will be as many ‘stated
‘‘unidirectional positioning repeatability’’’
values as there are linear axes;
5.e. If any axis of a machine model not
controlled by 2B001.a. to 2B001.c. has a
‘stated ‘‘unidirectional positioning
repeatability’’’ equal to or less than the
specified ‘‘unidirectional positioning
repeatability’’ of each machine tool model
plus 0.7 mm, the builder should be required
to reaffirm the accuracy level once every
eighteen months.
6. For the purposes of 2B, measurement
uncertainty for the ‘‘unidirectional
positioning repeatability’’ of machine tools,
as defined in the International Standard ISO
230–2:2014, shall not be considered.
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
7. For the purposes of 2B, the measurement
of axes shall be made according to test
procedures in 5.3.2. of ISO 230–2:2014. Tests
for axes longer than 2 meters shall be made
over 2 m segments. Axes longer than 4 m
require multiple tests (e.g., two tests for axes
longer than 4 m and up to 8 m, three tests
for axes longer than 8 m and up to 12 m),
each over 2 m segments and distributed in
equal intervals over the axis length. Test
segments are equally spaced along the full
axis length, with any excess length equally
divided at the beginning, in between, and at
the end of the test segments. The smallest
‘‘unidirectional positioning repeatability’’value of all test segments is to be reported.
*
*
*
*
*
2B004 Hot ‘‘isostatic presses’’ having all of
the characteristics described in the List
of Items Controlled, and ‘‘specially
designed’’ ‘‘components’’ and
‘‘accessories’’ therefor.
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT NP, AT
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
MT applies to entire
entry.
NP applies to entire
entry, except
2B004.b.3 and
presses with maximum working pressures below 69
MPa.
AT applies to entire
entry.
Country chart (see
supp. No. 1 to part
738)
NS Column 2
MT Column 1
NP Column 1
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
*
*
*
*
*
2B006 Dimensional inspection or
measuring systems, equipment, position
feedback units and ‘‘electronic
assemblies’’, as follows (see List of Items
Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, NP, AT
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
NP applies to those
items in 2B006.a,
b.1, b.3, and .c
(angular displacement measuring instruments) that
meet or exceed the
technical parameters in 2B206..
AT applies to entire
entry.
Country chart (see
supp. no. 1 to part
738)
NS Column 2
NP Column 1
AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See ECCN 2D001 for
software for items controlled under this
entry. (2) See ECCNs 2E001
(‘‘development’’), 2E002 (‘‘production’’),
and 2E101 (‘‘use’’) for technology for items
controlled under this entry. (3) For
‘‘specially designed’’ dies, molds and
tooling, see ECCNs 0B501, 0B602, 0B606,
1B003, 9B004, and 9B009. (4) For
additional controls on dies, molds and
tooling, see ECCNs 1B101.d, 2B104 and
2B204. (5) Also see ECCNs 2B117 and
2B999.a.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. A controlled thermal environment
within the closed cavity and possessing a
chamber cavity with an inside diameter of
406 mm or more; and
b. Having any of the following:
b.1. A maximum working pressure
exceeding 207 MPa;
b.2. A controlled thermal environment
exceeding 1,773 K (1,500 °C); or
b.3. A facility for hydrocarbon
impregnation and removal of resultant
gaseous degradation products.
VerDate Sep<11>2014
Technical Note: For the purposes of
2B004, the inside chamber dimension is that
of the chamber in which both the working
temperature and the working pressure are
achieved and does not include fixtures. That
dimension will be the smaller of either the
inside diameter of the pressure chamber or
the inside diameter of the insulated furnace
chamber, depending on which of the two
chambers is located inside the other.
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See ECCNs 2D001 and
2D002 for ‘‘software’’ for items controlled
under this entry. (2) See ECCNs 2E001
(‘‘development’’), 2E002 (‘‘production’’),
and 2E201 (‘‘use’’) for technology for items
controlled under this entry. (3) Also see
ECCNs 2B206 and 2B996.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Computer controlled or ‘‘numerically
controlled’’ Coordinate Measuring Machines
(CMM), having a three dimensional length
(volumetric) maximum permissible error of
length measurement (E0,MPE) at any point
within the operating range of the machine
(i.e., within the length of axes) equal to or
less (better) than (1.7 + L/1,000) mm (L is the
measured length in mm) according to ISO
10360–2 (2009);
Technical Note: For the purposes of
2B006.a, E0,MPE of the most accurate
configuration of the CMM specified by the
manufacturer (e.g.,best of the following:
Probe, stylus length, motion parameters,
environment) and with ‘‘all compensations
available’’ shall be compared to the 1.7 + L/
1,000 mm threshold.
b. Linear displacement measuring
instruments or systems, linear position
feedback units, and ‘‘electronic assemblies’’,
as follows:
PO 00000
Frm 00013
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
71943
Note: Interferometer and optical-encoder
measuring systems containing a ‘‘laser’’ are
only specified by 2B006.b.3.
b.1. ‘Non-contact type measuring systems’
with a ‘resolution’ equal to or less (better)
than 0.2 mm within 0 to 0.2 mm of the
’measuring range’;
Technical Notes: For the purposes of
2B006.b.1:
1. ‘Non-contact type measuring systems’
are designed to measure the distance
between the probe and measured object along
a single vector, where the probe or measured
object is in motion.
2. ‘Measuring range’ means the distance
between the minimum and maximum
working distance.
b.2. Linear position feedback units
‘‘specially designed’’ for machine tools and
having an overall ‘‘accuracy’’ less (better)
than (800 + (600 × L/1,000)) nm (L equals
effective length in mm);
b.3. Measuring systems having all of the
following:
b.3.a. Containing a ‘‘laser’’;
b.3.b. A ‘resolution’ over their full scale of
0.200 nm or less (better); and
b.3.c. Capable of achieving a
‘‘measurement uncertainty’’ equal to or less
(better) than (1.6 + L/2,000) nm (L is the
measured length in mm) at any point within
a measuring range, when compensated for
the refractive index of air and measured over
a period of 30 seconds at a temperature of
20±0.01°C;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
2B006.b, ‘resolution’ is the least increment of
a measuring device; on digital instruments,
the least significant bit.
b.4. ‘‘Electronic assemblies’’ ‘‘specially
designed’’ to provide feedback capability in
systems controlled by 2B006.b.3;
c. Rotary position feedback units ‘‘specially
designed’’ for machine tools or angular
displacement measuring instruments, having
an angular position ‘‘accuracy’’ equal to or
less (better) than 0.9 second of arc;
Note: 2B006.c does not control optical
instruments, such as autocollimators, using
collimated light (e.g., ‘‘laser’’ light) to detect
angular displacement of a mirror.
d. Equipment for measuring surface
roughness (including surface defects), by
measuring optical scatter with a sensitivity of
0.5 nm or less (better).
Note: 2B006 includes machine tools, other
than those specified by 2B001, that can be
used as measuring machines, if they meet or
exceed the criteria specified for the
measuring machine function.
*
*
*
*
*
2B008 ‘Compound rotary tables’ and
‘‘tilting spindles’’, ‘‘specially designed’’
for machine tools, as follows (see List of
Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
AT applies to entire
entry.
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
Country chart (see
supp. no. 1 to part
738)
NS Column 2
AT Column 1
71944
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: See also 2B998.
Related Definition: N/A
Items:
a. [Reserved]
b. [Reserved]
c. ‘Compound rotary tables’ having all of
the following:
c.1. Designed for machine tools for turning,
milling or grinding; and
c.2. Two rotary axes designed to be
coordinated simultaneously for ‘‘contouring
control’’.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
2B008.c, a ‘compound rotary table’ is a table
allowing the workpiece to rotate and tilt
about two non-parallel axes.
d. ‘‘Tilting spindles’’ having all of the
following:
d.1. Designed for machine tools for turning,
milling or grinding; and
d.2. Designed to be coordinated
simultaneously for ‘‘contouring control’’.
*
*
*
*
*
2B009 Spin-forming machines and flowforming machines, which, according to
the manufacturer’s technical
specifications, can be equipped with
‘‘numerical control’’ units or a computer
control and having all of the following
characteristics (see List of Items
Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, NP, AT
Control(s)
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
NS applies to entire
entry.
MT applies to: spinforming.
machines combining
the functions of
spin-forming and
flow-forming; and
flow-forming machines that meet or
exceed the parameters of 2B009.a
and 2B109.
Country chart (see
supp. no. 1 to part
738)
Country chart (see
supp. no. 1 to part
738)
Control(s)
NP applies to flowforming machines,
and spin-forming
machines capable
of flow-forming
functions, that meet
or exceed the parameters of 2B209.
AT applies to entire
entry.
AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See ECCN 2D001 for
‘‘software’’ for items controlled under this
entry. (2) See ECCNs 2E001
(‘‘development’’), 2E002 (‘‘production’’),
and 2E101 (‘‘use’’) for technology for items
controlled under this entry. (3) Also see
ECCNs 2B109 and 2B209 for additional
flow-forming machines for MT and NP
reasons.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Three or more axes which can be
coordinated simultaneously for ‘‘contouring
control’’; and
b. A roller force more than 60 kN.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
2B009, machines combining the function of
spin-forming and flow-forming are regarded
as flow-forming machines.
*
*
*
*
*
2E003 Other ‘‘technology’’, as follows (see
List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Country chart (see
Supp. No. 1 to part
738)
Control(s)
NS Column 2
NS applies to entire
entry.
AT applies to entire
entry.
MT Column 1
NP Column 1
NS Column 1
AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
TSR: Yes, except 2E003.b, .e and .f
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: See 2E001, 2E002, and
2E101 for ‘‘development’’ and ‘‘use’’
technology for equipment that are designed
or modified for densification of carbon-
1. Coating process (1) 1
2. Substrate
A. Chemical Vapor Deposition (CVD) ...............
‘‘Superalloys’’ ....................................................
Ceramics (19) and Low-expansion glasses(14)
carbon composites, structural composite
rocket nozzles and reentry vehicle nose
tips.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. [Reserved]
b. ‘‘Technology’’ for metal-working
manufacturing processes, as follows:
b.1. ‘‘Technology’’ for the design of tools,
dies or fixtures ‘‘specially designed’’ for any
of the following processes:
b.1.a. ‘‘Superplastic forming’’;
b.1.b. ‘‘Diffusion bonding’’; or
b.1.c. ‘Direct-acting hydraulic pressing’;
b.2. [Reserved]
N.B.: For ‘‘technology’’ for metal-working
manufacturing processes for gas turbine
engines and components, see 9E003 and
USML Category XIX
Technical Note: For the purposes of
2E003.b.1.c, ‘direct-acting hydraulic pressing’
is a deformation process which uses a fluidfilled flexible bladder in direct contact with
the workpiece.
c. ‘‘Technology’’ for the ‘‘development’’ or
‘‘production’’ of hydraulic stretch-forming
machines and dies therefor, for the
manufacture of airframe structures;
d. [Reserved]
e. ‘‘Technology’’ for the ‘‘development’’ of
integration ‘‘software’’ for incorporation of
expert systems for advanced decision support
of shop floor operations into ‘‘numerical
control’’ units;
f. ‘‘Technology’’ for the application of
inorganic overlay coatings or inorganic
surface modification coatings (specified in
column 3 of the following table) to nonelectronic substrates (specified in column 2
of the following table), by processes specified
in column 1 of the following table and
defined in the Technical Note.
N.B. This table should be read to control
the technology of a particular ‘Coating
Process’ only when the resultant coating in
column 3 is in a paragraph directly across
from the relevant ‘Substrate’ under column 2.
For example, Chemical Vapor Deposition
(CVD) ‘coating process’ control the
‘‘technology’’ for a particular application of
‘silicides’ to ‘Carbon-carbon, Ceramic and
Metal ‘‘matrix’’ ‘‘composites’’ substrates, but
are not controlled for the application of
‘silicides’ to ‘Cemented tungsten carbide (16),
Silicon carbide (18)’ substrates. In the second
case, the resultant coating is not listed in the
paragraph under column 3 directly across
from the paragraph under column 2 listing
‘Cemented tungsten carbide (16), Silicon
carbide (18)’.
Category 2E—Materials Processing Table;
Deposition Techniques
3. Resultant coating
Aluminides for internal passages
Silicides
Carbides
Dielectric layers (15)
Diamond
Diamond-like carbon (17)
1 The numbers in parenthesis refer to the Notes
following this Table.
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
PO 00000
Frm 00014
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
1. Coating process (1) 1
2. Substrate
3. Resultant coating
Carbon-carbon, Ceramic, and Metal ‘‘matrix’’
‘‘composites‘‘.
Cemented tungsten ..........................................
carbide (16),
Silicon carbide (18)
Molybdenum and Molybdenum alloys ..............
Beryllium and Beryllium alloys .........................
Sensor window materials (9) ............................
B. Thermal-Evaporation Physical Vapor:
1. Physical Vapor Deposition (PVD): Deposition (TE–PVD) Electron-Beam (EB–
PVD).
‘‘Superalloys’’ ....................................................
Ceramics (19) and Low-expansion glasses
(14).
Corrosion resistant steel (7) .............................
Carbon-carbon, Ceramic and Metal ‘‘matrix’’
‘‘composites’’.
Cemented tungsten carbide (16), Silicon carbide (18).
Molybdenum and Molybdenum alloys ..............
Beryllium and Beryllium alloys .........................
Sensor window materials (9) ............................
Titanium alloys (13) ..........................................
2. Ion assisted resistive heating Physical
Vapor Deposition (PVD)(Ion Plating).
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
3.
Physical Vapor Deposition
‘‘Laser’’ Vaporization.
(PVD):
Ceramics (19) and Low-expansion glasses
(14).
Carbon-carbon, Ceramic and Metal ‘‘matrix’’
‘‘composites’’.
Cemented tungsten carbide (16) .....................
Silicon carbide
Molybdenum and Molybdenum alloys ..............
Beryllium and Beryllium alloys .........................
Sensor window materials (9) ............................
Ceramics (19) and Low-expansion glasses
(14).
Carbon-carbon, Ceramic and Metal ‘‘matrix’’
‘‘composites’’.
Cemented tungsten carbide (16), Silicon carbide.
Molybdenum and Molybdenum alloys ..............
Beryllium and Beryllium alloys .........................
Sensor window materials (9) ............................
4. Physical Vapor Deposition (PVD): Cathodic Arc Discharge.
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
‘‘Superalloys’’ ....................................................
PO 00000
Frm 00015
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
Silicides
Carbides
Refractory metals
Mixtures thereof (4)
Dielectric layers (15)
Aluminides
Alloyed aluminides (2)
Boron nitride
Carbides
Tungsten
Mixtures thereof (4)
Dielectric layers (15)
Dielectric layers (15)
Dielectric layers (15)
Diamond
Diamond-like carbon (17)
Dielectric layers (15)
Diamond
Diamond-like carbon (17)
Alloyed silicides
Alloyed aluminides (2)
MCrAlX (5)
Modified zirconia (12)
Silicides
Aluminides
Mixtures thereof (4)
Dielectric layers (15)
MCrAlX (5)
Modified zirconia (12)
Mixtures thereof (4)
Silicides
Carbides
Refractory metals
Mixtures thereof (4)
Dielectric layers (15)
Boron nitride
Carbides
Tungsten
Mixtures thereof (4)
Dielectric layers (15)
Dielectric layers (15)
Dielectric layers (15)
Borides
Beryllium
Dielectric layers (15)
Borides
Nitrides
Dielectric layers (15)
Diamond-like carbon (17)
Dielectric layers (15)
Dielectric layers (15)
Dielectric layers (15)
Dielectric layers (15)
Dielectric Layers (15)
Diamond-like carbon (17)
Silicides
Dielectric layers (15)
Diamond-like carbon (17)
Dielectric layers (15)
Dielectric Layers (15)
Dielectric layers (15)
Dielectric layers (15)
Dielectric layers (15)
Diamond-like carbon
Alloyed silicides
Alloyed Aluminides (2)
MCrA1X (5)
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
71945
71946
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
1. Coating process (1) 1
C. Pack cementation (see A above for out-ofpack cementation) (10).
2. Substrate
3. Resultant coating
Polymers (11) and Organic ‘‘matrix’’ ‘‘composites’’.
Borides
Carbides
Nitrides
Diamond-like carbon (17)
Silicides
Carbides
Mixtures thereof (4)
Silicides
Aluminides
Alloyed aluminides (2)
Silicides
Oxides
MCrAlX (5)
Modified zirconia (12)
Mixtures thereof (4)
Abradable Nickel-Graphite
Abradable materials containing
Ni-Cr-Al Abradable
Al-Si-Polyester Alloyed aluminides (2)
MCrAlX (5)
Modified zirconia (12)
Silicides
Mixtures thereof (4)
Aluminides
Silicides
MCrAlX (5)
Modified zirconia (12)
Mixtures thereof (4)
Carbides
Aluminides
Silicides
Alloyed aluminides (2)
Abradable materials containing
Ni-Cr-Al
Abradable Al-Si-Polyester
Fused silicides
Fused aluminides except for resistance heating elements
Silicides
Carbides
Mixtures thereof (4)
Alloyed silicides
Alloyed aluminides (2)
Noble metal modified aluminides (3)
MCrAlX (5)
Modified zirconia (12)
Platinum
Mixtures thereof (4)
Silicides
Platinum
Mixtures thereof (4)
Dielectric layers (15)
Diamond-like carbon (17)
Borides
Nitrides
Oxides
Silicides
Aluminides
Alloyed aluminides (2)
Carbides
Silicides
Carbides
Refractory metals
Mixtures thereof (4)
Dielectric layers (15)
Boron nitride
Carbides
Tungsten
Mixtures thereof (4)
Dielectric layers (15)
Boron nitride
Dielectric layers (15)
Carbon-carbon, Ceramic and Metal ‘‘matrix’’
‘‘composites’’.
Titanium alloys (13) ..........................................
Refractory metals and alloys (8) ......................
D. Plasma spraying ...........................................
‘‘Superalloys’’ ....................................................
Aluminum alloys (6) ..........................................
Refractory metals and alloys (8), Carbides,
Corrosion resistant steel (7).
D. Plasma spraying (continued) ........................
Titanium alloys (13) ..........................................
Abradable Nickel Graphite ...............................
E. Slurry Deposition ...........................................
Refractory metals and alloys (8) ......................
Carbon-carbon, Ceramic and Metal ‘‘matrix’’
‘‘composites’’.
F. Sputter Deposition .........................................
‘‘Superalloys’’ ....................................................
Ceramics and Low-expansion glasses (14) .....
Titanium alloys (13) ..........................................
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
F. Sputter Deposition (continued) .....................
Carbon-carbon, Ceramic and Metal ‘‘matrix’’
‘‘Composites’’.
Cemented tungsten carbide (16), Silicon carbide (18).
Molybdenum and Molybdenum alloys ..............
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
PO 00000
Frm 00016
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
1. Coating process (1) 1
2. Substrate
3. Resultant coating
Beryllium and Beryllium alloys .........................
Borides
Dielectric layers (15)
Beryllium
Dielectric layers (15)
Diamond-like carbon (17)
Aluminides
Silicides
Oxides
Carbides
Additions of Chromium,Tantalum, or Niobium
(Columbium)
Borides
Nitrides
Borides
Carbides
Nitrides
Sensor window materials (9) ............................
Refractory metals and alloys (8) ......................
G. Ion Implantation ............................................
High temperature bearing steels ......................
Titanium alloys (13) ..........................................
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
Beryllium and Beryllium alloys .........................
Cemented tungsten carbide (16) .....................
Notes to Table on Deposition
Techniques:
1. The term ‘‘coating process’’ includes
coating repair and refurbishing as well as
original coating.
2. The term ‘‘alloyed aluminide coating’’
includes single or multiple-step coatings in
which an element or elements are deposited
prior to or during application of the
aluminide coating, even if these elements are
deposited by another coating process. It does
not, however, include the multiple use of
single-step pack cementation processes to
achieve alloyed aluminides.
3. The term ‘‘noble metal modified
aluminide’’ coating includes multiple-step
coatings in which the noble metal or noble
metals are laid down by some other coating
process prior to application of the aluminide
coating.
4. The term ‘‘mixtures thereof’’ includes
infiltrated material, graded compositions, codeposits and multilayer deposits and are
obtained by one or more of the coating
processes specified in the Table.
5. MCrAlX refers to a coating alloy where
M equals cobalt, iron, nickel or combinations
thereof and X equals hafnium, yttrium,
silicon, tantalum in any amount or other
intentional additions over 0.01% by weight in
various proportions and combinations,
except:
a. CoCrAlY coatings which contain less
than 22% by weight of chromium, less than
7% by weight of aluminum and less than 2%
by weight of yttrium;
b. CoCrAlY coatings which contain 22 to
24% by weight of chromium, 10 to 12% by
weight of aluminum and 0.5 to 0.7% by
weight of yttrium; or
c. NiCrAlY coatings which contain 21 to
23% by weight of chromium, 10 to 12% by
weight of aluminum and 0.9 to 1.1% by
weight of yttrium.
6. The term ‘‘aluminum alloys’’ refers to
alloys having an ultimate tensile strength of
190 MPa or more measured at 293 K (20 °C).
7. The term ‘‘corrosion resistant steel’’
refers to AISI (American Iron and Steel
Institute) 300 series or equivalent national
standard steels.
8. ‘‘Refractory metals and alloys’’ include
the following metals and their alloys:
niobium (columbium), molybdenum,
tungsten and tantalum.
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
71947
9. ‘‘Sensor window materials’’, as follows:
alumina, silicon, germanium, zinc sulphide,
zinc selenide, gallium arsenide, diamond,
gallium phosphide, sapphire and the
following metal halides: sensor window
materials of more than 40 mm diameter for
zirconium fluoride and hafnium fluoride.
10. Category 2 does not include
‘‘technology’’ for single-step pack
cementation of solid airfoils.
11. ‘‘Polymers’’, as follows: polyimide,
polyester, polysulfide, polycarbonates and
polyurethanes.
12. ‘‘Modified zirconia’’ refers to additions
of other metal oxides, (e.g., calcia, magnesia,
yttria, hafnia, rare earth oxides) to zirconia
in order to stabilize certain crystallographic
phases and phase compositions. Thermal
barrier coatings made of zirconia, modified
with calcia or magnesia by mixing or fusion,
are not controlled.
13. ‘‘Titanium alloys’’ refers only to
aerospace alloys having an ultimate tensile
strength of 900 MPa or more measured at 293
K (20 °C).
14. ‘‘Low-expansion glasses’’ refers to
glasses which have a coefficient of thermal
expansion of 1 x 10¥7 K¥1 or less measured
at 293 K (20 °C).
15. ‘‘Dielectric layers’’ are coatings
constructed of multi-layers of insulator
materials in which the interference properties
of a design composed of materials of various
refractive indices are used to reflect, transmit
or absorb various wavelength bands.
Dielectric layers refers to more than four
dielectric layers or dielectric/metal
‘‘composite’’ layers.
16. ‘‘Cemented tungsten carbide’’ does not
include cutting and forming tool materials
consisting of tungsten carbide/(cobalt,
nickel), titanium carbide/(cobalt, nickel),
chromium carbide/nickel-chromium and
chromium carbide/nickel.
17. ‘‘Technology’’ for depositing diamondlike carbon on any of the following is not
controlled: magnetic disk drives and heads,
equipment for the manufacture of
disposables, valves for faucets, acoustic
diaphragms for speakers, engine parts for
automobiles, cutting tools, punching-pressing
dies, office automation equipment,
microphones, medical devices or molds, for
casting or molding of plastics, manufactured
from alloys containing less than 5%
beryllium.
PO 00000
Frm 00017
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
18. ‘‘Silicon carbide’’ does not include
cutting and forming tool materials.
19. Ceramic substrates, as used in this
entry, does not include ceramic materials
containing 5% by weight, or greater, clay or
cement content, either as separate
constituents or in combination.
Technical Note to Table on Deposition
Techniques: Processes specified in Column
1 of the Table are defined as follows:
a. Chemical Vapor Deposition (CVD) is an
overlay coating or surface modification
coating process wherein a metal, alloy,
‘‘composite’’, dielectric or ceramic is
deposited upon a heated substrate. Gaseous
reactants are decomposed or combined in the
vicinity of a substrate resulting in the
deposition of the desired elemental, alloy or
compound material on the substrate. Energy
for this decomposition or chemical reaction
process may be provided by the heat of the
substrate, a glow discharge plasma, or
‘‘laser’’ irradiation.
Note 1: CVD includes the following
processes: directed gas flow out-of-pack
deposition, pulsating CVD, controlled
nucleation thermal decomposition (CNTD),
plasma enhanced or plasma assisted CVD
processes.
Note 2: Pack denotes a substrate immersed
in a powder mixture.
Note 3: The gaseous reactants used in the
out-of-pack process are produced using the
same basic reactions and parameters as the
pack cementation process, except that the
substrate to be coated is not in contact with
the powder mixture.
b. Thermal Evaporation-Physical Vapor
Deposition (TE–PVD) is an overlay coating
process conducted in a vacuum with a
pressure less than 0.1 Pa wherein a source of
thermal energy is used to vaporize the
coating material. This process results in the
condensation, or deposition, of the
evaporated species onto appropriately
positioned substrates. The addition of gases
to the vacuum chamber during the coating
process to synthesize compound coatings is
an ordinary modification of the process. The
use of ion or electron beams, or plasma, to
activate or assist the coating’s deposition is
also a common modification in this
technique. The use of monitors to provide inprocess measurement of optical
characteristics and thickness of coatings can
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
71948
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
be a feature of these processes. Specific TE–
PVD processes are as follows:
1. Electron Beam PVD uses an electron
beam to heat and evaporate the material
which forms the coating;
2. Ion Assisted Resistive Heating PVD
employs electrically resistive heating sources
in combination with impinging ion beam(s)
to produce a controlled and uniform flux of
evaporated coating species;
3. ‘‘Laser’’ Vaporization uses either pulsed
or continuous wave ‘‘laser’’ beams to
vaporize the material which forms the
coating;
4. Cathodic Arc Deposition employs a
consumable cathode of the material which
forms the coating and has an arc discharge
established on the surface by a momentary
contact of a ground trigger. Controlled
motion of arcing erodes the cathode surface
creating a highly ionized plasma. The anode
can be either a cone attached to the
periphery of the cathode, through an
insulator, or the chamber. Substrate biasing
is used for non line-of-sight deposition;
Note: This definition does not include
random cathodic arc deposition with nonbiased substrates.
5. Ion Plating is a special modification of
a general TE–PVD process in which a plasma
or an ion source is used to ionize the species
to be deposited, and a negative bias is
applied to the substrate in order to facilitate
the extraction of the species from the plasma.
The introduction of reactive species,
evaporation of solids within the process
chamber, and the use of monitors to provide
in-process measurement of optical
characteristics and thicknesses of coatings
are ordinary modifications of the process.
c. Pack Cementation is a surface
modification coating or overlay coating
process wherein a substrate is immersed in
a powder mixture (a pack), that consists of:
1. The metallic powders that are to be
deposited (usually aluminum, chromium,
silicon or combinations thereof);
2. An activator (normally a halide salt);
and
3. An inert powder, most frequently
alumina.
Note: The substrate and powder mixture is
contained within a retort which is heated to
between 1,030 K (757 °C) to 1,375 K (1,102 °C)
for sufficient time to deposit the coating.
d. Plasma Spraying is an overlay coating
process wherein a gun (spray torch) which
produces and controls a plasma accepts
powder or wire coating materials, melts them
and propels them towards a substrate,
whereon an integrally bonded coating is
formed. Plasma spraying constitutes either
low pressure plasma spraying or high
velocity plasma spraying.
Note 1: Low pressure means less than
ambient atmospheric pressure.
Note 2: High velocity refers to nozzle-exit
gas velocity exceeding 750 m/s calculated at
293 K (20 °C) at 0.1 MPa.
e. Slurry Deposition is a surface
modification coating or overlay coating
process wherein a metallic or ceramic
powder with an organic binder is suspended
in a liquid and is applied to a substrate by
either spraying, dipping or painting,
subsequent air or oven drying, and heat
treatment to obtain the desired coating.
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
f. Sputter Deposition is an overlay coating
process based on a momentum transfer
phenomenon, wherein positive ions are
accelerated by an electric field towards the
surface of a target (coating material). The
kinetic energy of the impacting ions is
sufficient to cause target surface atoms to be
released and deposited on an appropriately
positioned substrate.
Note 1: The Table refers only to triode,
magnetron or reactive sputter deposition
which is used to increase adhesion of the
coating and rate of deposition and to radio
frequency (RF) augmented sputter deposition
used to permit vaporization of non-metallic
coating materials.
Note 2: Low-energy ion beams (less than 5
keV) can be used to activate the deposition.
g. Ion Implantation is a surface
modification coating process in which the
element to be alloyed is ionized, accelerated
through a potential gradient and implanted
into the surface region of the substrate. This
includes processes in which ion implantation
is performed simultaneously with electron
beam physical vapor deposition or sputter
deposition.
Accompanying Technical Information
to Table on Deposition Techniques:
1. Technical information for pretreatments
of the substrates listed in the Table, as
follows:
a. Chemical stripping and cleaning bath
cycle parameters, as follows:
1. Bath composition;
a. For the removal of old or defective
coatings corrosion product or foreign
deposits;
b. For preparation of virgin substrates;
2. Time in bath;
3. Temperature of bath;
4. Number and sequences of wash cycles;
b. Visual and macroscopic criteria for
acceptance of the cleaned part;
c. Heat treatment cycle parameters, as
follows:
1. Atmosphere parameters, as follows:
a. Composition of the atmosphere;
b. Pressure of the atmosphere;
2. Temperature for heat treatment;
3. Time of heat treatment;
d. Substrate surface preparation
parameters, as follows:
1. Grit blasting parameters, as follows:
a. Grit composition;
b. Grit size and shape;
c. Grit velocity;
2. Time and sequence of cleaning cycle
after grit blast;
3. Surface finish parameters;
4. Application of binders to promote
adhesion;
e. Masking technique parameters, as
follows:
1. Material of mask;
2. Location of mask;
2. Technical information for in situ quality
assurance techniques for evaluation of the
coating processes listed in the Table, as
follows:
a. Atmosphere parameters, as follows:
1. Composition of the atmosphere;
2. Pressure of the atmosphere;
b. Time parameters;
c. Temperature parameters;
d. Thickness parameters;
PO 00000
Frm 00018
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
e. Index of refraction parameters;
f. Control of composition;
3. Technical information for post
deposition treatments of the coated
substrates listed in the Table, as follows:
a. Shot peening parameters, as follows:
1. Shot composition;
2. Shot size;
3. Shot velocity;
b. Post shot peening cleaning parameters;
c. Heat treatment cycle parameters, as
follows:
1. Atmosphere parameters, as follows:
a. Composition of the atmosphere;
b. Pressure of the atmosphere;
2. Time-temperature cycles;
d. Post heat treatment visual and
macroscopic criteria for acceptance of the
coated substrates;
4. Technical information for quality
assurance techniques for the evaluation of
the coated substrates listed in the Table, as
follows:
a. Statistical sampling criteria;
b. Microscopic criteria for:
1. Magnification;
2. Coating thickness, uniformity;
3. Coating integrity;
4. Coating composition;
5. Coating and substrates bonding;
6. Microstructural uniformity.
c. Criteria for optical properties assessment
(measured as a function of wavelength):
1. Reflectance;
2. Transmission;
3. Absorption;
4. Scatter;
5. Technical information and parameters
related to specific coating and surface
modification processes listed in the Table, as
follows:
a. For Chemical Vapor Deposition (CVD):
1. Coating source composition and
formulation;
2. Carrier gas composition;
3. Substrate temperature;
4. Time-temperature-pressure cycles;
5. Gas control and part manipulation;
b. For Thermal Evaporation-Physical
Vapor Deposition (PVD):
1. Ingot or coating material source
composition;
2. Substrate temperature;
3. Reactive gas composition;
4. Ingot feed rate or material vaporization
rate;
5. Time-temperature-pressure cycles;
6. Beam and part manipulation;
7. ‘‘Laser’’ parameters, as follows:
a. Wave length;
b. Power density;
c. Pulse length;
d. Repetition ratio;
e. Source;
c. For Pack Cementation:
1. Pack composition and formulation;
2. Carrier gas composition;
3. Time-temperature-pressure cycles;
d. For Plasma Spraying:
1. Powder composition, preparation and
size distributions;
2. Feed gas composition and parameters;
3. Substrate temperature;
4. Gun power parameters;
5. Spray distance;
6. Spray angle;
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
7. Cover gas composition, pressure and
flow rates;
8. Gun control and part manipulation;
e. For Sputter Deposition:
1. Target composition and fabrication;
2. Geometrical positioning of part and
target;
3. Reactive gas composition;
4. Electrical bias;
5. Time-temperature-pressure cycles;
6. Triode power;
7. Part manipulation;
f. For Ion Implantation:
1. Beam control and part manipulation;
2. Ion source design details;
3. Control techniques for ion beam and
deposition rate parameters;
4. Time-temperature-pressure cycles.
g. For Ion Plating:
1. Beam control and part manipulation;
2. Ion source design details;
3. Control techniques for ion beam and
deposition rate parameters;
4. Time-temperature-pressure cycles;
5. Coating material feed rate and
vaporization rate;
6. Substrate temperature;
7. Substrate bias parameters.
*
*
*
*
Control(s)
MT applies to
3A001.a.1.a when
usable in ‘‘missiles’’; and to
3A001.a.5.a when
‘‘designed or modified’’ for military
use, hermetically
sealed and rated
for operation in the
temperature range
from below ¥54 °C
to above +125 °C.
NP applies to pulse
discharge capacitors in 3A001.e.2
and superconducting solenoidal
electromagnets in
3A001.e.3 that
meet or exceed the
technical parameters in 3A201.a
and 3A201.b, respectively.
AT applies to entire
entry.
*
3A001 Electronic items as follows (see List
of Items Controlled).
Reason for Control: NS, RS, MT, NP, AT
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
Control(s)
NS applies to ‘‘Monolithic Microwave
Integrated Circuit’’
(‘‘MMIC’’) amplifiers
in 3A001.b.2 and
discrete microwave
transistors in
3A001.b.3, except
those 3A001.b.2
and b.3 items
being exported or
reexported for use
in civil telecommunications
applications.
NS applies to entire
entry.
RS applies ‘‘Monolithic Microwave Integrated Circuit’’
(‘‘MMIC’’) amplifiers
in 3A001.b.2 and
discrete microwave
transistors in
3A001.b.3, except
those 3A001.b.2
and b.3 items
being exported or
reexported for use
in civil telecommunications
applications.
VerDate Sep<11>2014
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
NS Column 1
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
MT Column 1
NP Column 1
AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements: See § 743.1 of the
EAR for reporting requirements for exports
under 3A001.b.2 or b.3 under License
Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
License Requirements Note: See
§ 744.17 of the EAR for additional license
requirements for microprocessors having a
processing speed of 5 GFLOPS or more and
an arithmetic logic unit with an access width
of 32 bit or more, including those
incorporating ‘‘information security’’
functionality, and associated ‘‘software’’ and
‘‘technology’’ for the ‘‘production’’ or
‘‘development’’ of such microprocessors.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
NS Column 2
RS Column 1
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
LVS: N/A for MT or NP; N/A for ‘‘Monolithic
Microwave Integrated Circuit’’ (‘‘MMIC’’)
amplifiers in 3A001.b.2 and discrete
microwave transistors in 3A001.b.3, except
those that are being exported or reexported
for use in civil telecommunications
applications.
Yes for:
$1500: 3A001.c
$3000: 3A001.b.1, b.2 (exported or
reexported for use in civil
telecommunications applications), b.3
(exported or reexported for use in civil
telecommunications applications), b.9, .d,
.e, .f, and .g.
$5000: 3A001.a (except a.1.a and a.5.a when
controlled for MT), .b.4 to b.7, and b.12.
GBS: Yes for 3A001.a.1.b, a.2 to a.14 (except
.a.5.a when controlled for MT), b.2
(exported or reexported for use in civil
telecommunications applications), b.8
(except for ‘‘vacuum electronic devices’’
exceeding 18 GHz), b.9., b.10, .g, and .h,
and .i.
PO 00000
Frm 00019
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
71949
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be
used to ship any item in 3A001.b.2 or b.3,
except those that are being exported or
reexported for use in civil
telecommunications applications, to any of
the destinations listed in Country Group
A:5 or A:6 (See Supplement No. 1 to part
740 of the EAR).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See Category XV of the
USML for certain ‘‘space-qualified’’
electronics and Category XI of the USML
for certain ASICs, ‘transmit/receive
modules,’ or ‘transmit modules’ ‘‘subject to
the ITAR’’ (see 22 CFR parts 120 through
130). (2) See also 3A101, 3A201, 3A611,
3A991, and 9A515.
Related Definitions: ‘Microcircuit’ means a
device in which a number of passive or
active elements are considered as
indivisibly associated on or within a
continuous structure to perform the
function of a circuit. For the purposes of
integrated circuits in 3A001.a.1, 5 × 103
Gy(Si) = 5 × 105 Rads (Si); 5 × 106 Gy (Si)/
s = 5 × 108 Rads (Si)/s.
Items:
a. General purpose integrated circuits, as
follows:
Note 1: Integrated circuits include the
following types:
—‘‘Monolithic integrated circuits’’;
—‘‘Hybrid integrated circuits’’;
—‘‘Multichip integrated circuits’’;
—Film type integrated circuits, including
silicon-on-sapphire integrated circuits’’;
—‘‘Optical integrated circuits’’;
—‘‘Three dimensional integrated circuits’’;
—‘‘Monolithic Microwave Integrated
Circuits’’ (‘‘MMICs’’).
a.1. Integrated circuits designed or rated as
radiation hardened to withstand any of the
following:
a.1.a. A total dose of 5 × 103 Gy (Si), or
higher;
a.1.b. A dose rate upset of 5 × 106 Gy (Si)/
s, or higher; or
a.1.c. A fluence (integrated flux) of
neutrons (1 MeV equivalent) of 5 × 1013 n/
cm2 or higher on silicon, or its equivalent for
other materials;
Note: 3A001.a.1.c does not apply to Metal
Insulator Semiconductors (MIS).
a.2. ‘‘Microprocessor microcircuits,’’
‘‘microcomputer microcircuits,’’
microcontroller microcircuits, storage
integrated circuits manufactured from a
compound semiconductor, analog-to-digital
converters, integrated circuits that contain
analog-to-digital converters and store or
process the digitized data, digital-to-analog
converters, electro-optical or ‘‘optical
integrated circuits’’ designed for ‘‘signal
processing’’, field programmable logic
devices, custom integrated circuits for which
either the function is unknown or the control
status of the equipment in which the
integrated circuit will be used in unknown,
Fast Fourier Transform (FFT) processors,
Static Random-Access Memories (SRAMs), or
‘non-volatile memories,’ having any of the
following:
Technical Note: For the purposes of
3A001.a.2, ‘non-volatile memories’ are
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
71950
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
memories with data retention over a period
of time after a power shutdown.
a.2.a. Rated for operation at an ambient
temperature above 398 K (+125 °C);
a.2.b. Rated for operation at an ambient
temperature below 218 K (¥55 °C); or
a.2.c. Rated for operation over the entire
ambient temperature range from 218 K
(¥55 °C) to 398 K (+125 °C);
Note: 3A001.a.2 does not apply to
integrated circuits designed for civil
automobile or railway train applications.
a.3. ‘‘Microprocessor microcircuits’’,
‘‘microcomputer microcircuits’’ and
microcontroller microcircuits, manufactured
from a compound semiconductor and
operating at a clock frequency exceeding 40
MHz;
Note: 3A001.a.3 includes digital signal
processors, digital array processors and
digital coprocessors.
a.4. [Reserved]
a.5. Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) and
Digital-to-Analog Converter (DAC) integrated
circuits, as follows:
a.5.a. ADCs having any of the following:
a.5.a.1. A resolution of 8 bit or more, but
less than 10 bit, with a ‘‘sample rate’’ greater
than 1.3 Giga Samples Per Second (GSPS);
a.5.a.2. A resolution of 10 bit or more, but
less than 12 bit, with a ‘‘sample rate’’ greater
than 600 Mega Samples Per Second (MSPS);
a.5.a.3. A resolution of 12 bit or more, but
less than 14 bit, with a ‘‘sample rate’’ greater
than 400 MSPS;
a.5.a.4. A resolution of 14 bit or more, but
less than 16 bit, with a ‘‘sample rate’’ greater
than 250 MSPS; or
a.5.a.5. A resolution of 16 bit or more with
a ‘‘sample rate’’ greater than 65 MSPS;
N.B.: For integrated circuits that contain
analog-to-digital converters and store or
process the digitized data see 3A001.a.14.
Technical Notes: For the purposes of
3A001.a.5.a:
1. A resolution of n bit corresponds to a
quantization of 2n levels.
2. The resolution of the ADC is the number
of bits of the digital output that represents
the measured analog input. Effective Number
of Bits (ENOB) is not used to determine the
resolution of the ADC.
3. For ‘‘multiple channel ADCs’’, the
‘‘sample rate’’ is not aggregated and the
‘‘sample rate’’ is the maximum rate of any
single channel.
4. For ‘‘interleaved ADCs’’ or for ‘‘multiple
channel ADCs’’ that are specified to have an
interleaved mode of operation, the ‘‘sample
rates’’ are aggregated and the ‘‘sample rate’’
is the maximum combined total rate of all of
the interleaved channels.
a.5.b. Digital-to-Analog Converters (DAC)
having any of the following:
a.5.b.1. A resolution of 10-bit or more but
less than 12-bit,with an ‘adjusted update rate’
of exceeding 3,500 MSPS; or
a.5.b.2. A resolution of 12-bit or more and
having any of the following:
a.5.b.2.a. An ‘adjusted update rate’
exceeding 1,250 MSPS but not exceeding
3,500 MSPS, and having any of the following:
a.5.b.2.a.1. A settling time less than 9 ns to
arrive at or within 0.024% of full scale from
a full scale step; or
a.5.b.2.a.2. A ‘Spurious Free Dynamic
Range’ (SFDR) greater than 68 dBc (carrier)
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
when synthesizing a full scale analog signal
of 100 MHz or the highest full scale analog
signal frequency specified below 100 MHz; or
a.5.b.2.b. An ‘adjusted update rate’
exceeding 3,500 MSPS;
Technical Notes: For the purposes of
3A001.a.5.b:
1. ‘Spurious Free Dynamic Range’ (SFDR)
is defined as the ratio of the RMS value of
the carrier frequency (maximum signal
component) at the input of the DAC to the
RMS value of the next largest noise or
harmonic distortion component at its output.
2. SFDR is determined directly from the
specification table or from the
characterization plots of SFDR versus
frequency.
3. A signal is defined to be full scale when
its amplitude is greater than ¥3 dBfs (full
scale).
4. ‘Adjusted update rate’ for DACs is:
a. For conventional (non-interpolating)
DACs, the ‘adjusted update rate’ is the rate
at which the digital signal is converted to an
analog signal and the output analog values
are changed by the DAC. For DACs where the
interpolation mode may be bypassed
(interpolation factor of one), the DAC should
be considered as a conventional (noninterpolating) DAC.
b. For interpolating DACs (oversampling
DACs), the ‘adjusted update rate’ is defined
as the DAC update rate divided by the
smallest interpolating factor. For
interpolating DACs, the ‘adjusted update
rate’ may be referred to by different terms
including:
• input data rate
• input word rate
• input sample rate
• maximum total input bus rate
• maximum DAC clock rate for DAC clock
input.
a.6. Electro-optical and ‘‘optical integrated
circuits’’, designed for ‘‘signal processing’’
and having all of the following:
a.6.a. One or more than one internal
‘‘laser’’ diode;
a.6.b. One or more than one internal light
detecting element; and
a.6.c. Optical waveguides;
a.7. ‘Field programmable logic devices’
having any of the following:
a.7.a. A maximum number of single-ended
digital input/outputs of greater than 700; or
a.7.b. An ‘aggregate one-way peak serial
transceiver data rate’ of 500 Gb/s or greater;
Note: 3A001.a.7 includes:
—Complex Programmable Logic Devices
(CPLDs);
—Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs);
—Field Programmable Logic Arrays (FPLAs);
—Field Programmable Interconnects (FPICs).
N.B.: For integrated circuits having field
programmable logic devices that are
combined with an analog-to-digital converter,
see 3A001.a.14.
Technical Notes: For the purposes of
3A001.a.7:
1. Maximum number of digital input/
outputs in 3A001.a.7.a is also referred to as
maximum user input/outputs or maximum
available input/outputs, whether the
integrated circuit is packaged or bare die.
2. ‘Aggregate one-way peak serial
transceiver data rate’ is the product of the
PO 00000
Frm 00020
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
peak serial one-way transceiver data rate
times the number of transceivers on the
FPGA.
a.8. [Reserved]
a.9. Neural network integrated circuits;
a.10. Custom integrated circuits for which
the function is unknown, or the control
status of the equipment in which the
integrated circuits will be used is unknown
to the manufacturer, having any of the
following:
a.10.a. More than 1,500 terminals;
a.10.b. A typical ‘‘basic gate propagation
delay time’’ of less than 0.02 ns; or
a.10.c. An operating frequency exceeding 3
GHz;
a.11. Digital integrated circuits, other than
those described in 3A001.a.3 to 3A001.a.10
and 3A001.a.12, based upon any compound
semiconductor and having any of the
following:
a.11.a. An equivalent gate count of more
than 3,000 (2 input gates); or
a.11.b. A toggle frequency exceeding 1.2
GHz;
a.12. Fast Fourier Transform (FFT)
processors having a rated execution time for
an N-point complex FFT of less than (N log2
N)/20,480 ms, where N is the number of
points;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
3A001.a.12, when N is equal to 1,024 points,
the formula in 3A001.a.12 gives an execution
time of 500 ms.
a.13. Direct Digital Synthesizer (DDS)
integrated circuits having any of the
following:
a.13.a. A Digital-to-Analog Converter
(DAC) clock frequency of 3.5 GHz or more
and a DAC resolution of 10 bit or more, but
less than 12 bit; or
a.13.b. A DAC clock frequency of 1.25 GHz
or more and a DAC resolution of 12 bit or
more;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
3A001.a.13, the DAC clock frequency may be
specified as the master clock frequency or the
input clock frequency.
a.14. Integrated circuits that perform or are
programmable to perform all of the following:
a.14.a. Analog-to-digital conversions
meeting any of the following:
a.14.a.1. A resolution of 8 bit or more, but
less than 10 bit, with a ‘‘sample rate’’ greater
than 1.3 Giga Samples Per Second (GSPS);
a.14.a.2. A resolution of 10 bit or more, but
less than 12 bit, with a ‘‘sample rate’’ greater
than 1.0 GSPS;
a.14.a.3. A resolution of 12 bit or more, but
less than 14 bit, with a ‘‘sample rate’’ greater
than 1.0 GSPS;
a.14.a.4. A resolution of 14 bit or more, but
less than 16 bit, with a ‘‘sample rate’’ greater
than 400 Mega Samples Per Second (MSPS);
or
a.14.a.5. A resolution of 16 bit or more
with a ‘‘sample rate’’ greater than 180 MSPS;
and
a.14.b. Any of the following:
a.14.b.1. Storage of digitized data; or
a.14.b.2. Processing of digitized data;
N.B. 1: For analog-to-digital converter
integrated circuits see 3A001.a.5.a.
N.B. 2: For field programmable logic
devices see 3A001.a.7.
Technical Notes: For the purposes of
3A001.a.14:
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
1. A resolution of n bit corresponds to a
quantization of 2n levels.
2. The resolution of the ADC is the number
of bits of the digital output of the ADC that
represents the measured analog input.
Effective Number of Bits (ENOB) is not used
to determine the resolution of the ADC.
3. For integrated circuits with noninterleaving ‘‘multiple channel ADCs’’, the
‘‘sample rate’’ is not aggregated and the
‘‘sample rate’’ is the maximum rate of any
single channel.
4. For integrated circuits with ‘‘interleaved
ADCs’’ or with ‘‘multiple channel ADCs’’ that
are specified to have an interleaved mode of
operation, the ‘‘sample rates’’ are aggregated
and the ‘‘sample rate’’ is the maximum
combined total rate of all of the interleaved
channels.
b. Microwave or millimeter wave items, as
follows:
Technical Note: For the purposes of
3A001.b, the parameter peak saturated
power output may also be referred to on
product data sheets as output power,
saturated power output, maximum power
output, peak power output, or peak envelope
power output.
b.1. ‘‘Vacuum electronic devices’’ and
cathodes, as follows:
Note 1: 3A001.b.1 does not control
‘‘vacuum electronic devices’’ designed or
rated for operation in any frequency band
and having all of the following:
a. Does not exceed 31.8 GHz; and
b. Is ‘‘allocated by the ITU’’ for radiocommunications services, but not for radiodetermination.
Note 2: 3A001.b.1 does not control non‘‘space-qualified’’ ‘‘vacuum electronic
devices’’ having all the following:
a. An average output power equal to or less
than 50 W; and
b. Designed or rated for operation in any
frequency band and having all of the
following:
1. Exceeds 31.8 GHz but does not exceed
43.5 GHz; and
2. Is ‘‘allocated by the ITU’’ for radiocommunications services, but not for radiodetermination.
b.1.a. Traveling-wave ‘‘vacuum electronic
devices,’’ pulsed or continuous wave, as
follows:
b.1.a.1. Devices operating at frequencies
exceeding 31.8 GHz;
b.1.a.2. Devices having a cathode heater
with a turn on time to rated RF power of less
than 3 seconds;
b.1.a.3. Coupled cavity devices, or
derivatives thereof, with a ‘‘fractional
bandwidth’’ of more than 7% or a peak
power exceeding 2.5 kW;
b.1.a.4. Devices based on helix, folded
waveguide, or serpentine waveguide circuits,
or derivatives thereof, having any of the
following:
b.1.a.4.a. An ‘‘instantaneous bandwidth’’ of
more than one octave, and average power
(expressed in kW) times frequency
(expressed in GHz) of more than 0.5;
b.1.a.4.b. An ‘‘instantaneous bandwidth’’ of
one octave or less, and average power
(expressed in kW) times frequency
(expressed in GHz) of more than 1;
b.1.a.4.c. Being ‘‘space-qualified’’; or
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
b.1.a.4.d. Having a gridded electron gun;
b.1.a.5. Devices with a ‘‘fractional
bandwidth’’ greater than or equal to 10%,
with any of the following:
b.1.a.5.a. An annular electron beam;
b.1.a.5.b. A non-axisymmetric electron
beam; or
b.1.a.5.c. Multiple electron beams;
b.1.b. Crossed-field amplifier ‘‘vacuum
electronic devices’’ with a gain of more than
17 dB;
b.1.c. Thermionic cathodes, designed for
‘‘vacuum electronic devices,’’ producing an
emission current density at rated operating
conditions exceeding 5 A/cm2 or a pulsed
(non-continuous) current density at rated
operating conditions exceeding 10 A/cm2;
b.1.d. ‘‘Vacuum electronic devices’’ with
the capability to operate in a ‘dual mode.’
Technical Note: For the purposes of
3A001.b.1.d, ‘dual mode’ means the
‘‘vacuum electronic device’’ beam current
can be intentionally changed between
continuous-wave and pulsed mode operation
by use of a grid and produces a peak pulse
output power greater than the continuouswave output power.
b.2. ‘‘Monolithic Microwave Integrated
Circuit’’ (‘‘MMIC’’) amplifiers that are any of
the following:
N.B.: For ‘‘MMIC’’ amplifiers that have an
integrated phase shifter see 3A001.b.12.
b.2.a. Rated for operation at frequencies
exceeding 2.7 GHz up to and including 6.8
GHz with a ‘‘fractional bandwidth’’ greater
than 15%, and having any of the following:
b.2.a.1. A peak saturated power output
greater than 75 W (48.75 dBm) at any
frequency exceeding 2.7 GHz up to and
including 2.9 GHz;
b.2.a.2. A peak saturated power output
greater than 55 W (47.4 dBm) at any
frequency exceeding 2.9 GHz up to and
including 3.2 GHz;
b.2.a.3. A peak saturated power output
greater than 40 W (46 dBm) at any frequency
exceeding 3.2 GHz up to and including 3.7
GHz; or
b.2.a.4. A peak saturated power output
greater than 20 W (43 dBm) at any frequency
exceeding 3.7 GHz up to and including 6.8
GHz;
b.2.b. Rated for operation at frequencies
exceeding 6.8 GHz up to and including 16
GHz with a ‘‘fractional bandwidth’’ greater
than 10%, and having any of the following:
b.2.b.1. A peak saturated power output
greater than 10 W (40 dBm) at any frequency
exceeding 6.8 GHz up to and including 8.5
GHz; or
b.2.b.2. A peak saturated power output
greater than 5 W (37 dBm) at any frequency
exceeding 8.5 GHz up to and including 16
GHz;
b.2.c. Rated for operation with a peak
saturated power output greater than 3 W
(34.77 dBm) at any frequency exceeding 16
GHz up to and including 31.8 GHz, and with
a ‘‘fractional bandwidth’’ of greater than
10%;
b.2.d. Rated for operation with a peak
saturated power output greater than 0.1 nW
(¥70 dBm) at any frequency exceeding 31.8
GHz up to and including 37 GHz;
b.2.e. Rated for operation with a peak
saturated power output greater than 1 W (30
PO 00000
Frm 00021
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
71951
dBm) at any frequency exceeding 37 GHz up
to and including 43.5 GHz, and with a
‘‘fractional bandwidth’’ of greater than 10%;
b.2.f. Rated for operation with a peak
saturated power output greater than 31.62
mW (15 dBm) at any frequency exceeding
43.5 GHz up to and including 75 GHz, and
with a ‘‘fractional bandwidth’’ of greater than
10%;
b.2.g. Rated for operation with a peak
saturated power output greater than 10 mW
(10 dBm) at any frequency exceeding 75 GHz
up to and including 90 GHz, and with a
‘‘fractional bandwidth’’ of greater than 5%; or
b.2.h. Rated for operation with a peak
saturated power output greater than 0.1 nW
(¥70 dBm) at any frequency exceeding 90
GHz;
Note 1: [Reserved]
Note 2: The control status of the ‘‘MMIC’’
whose rated operating frequency includes
frequencies listed in more than one frequency
range, as defined by 3A001.b.2.a through
3A001.b.2.h, is determined by the lowest
peak saturated power output control
threshold.
Note 3: Notes 1 and 2 following the
Category 3 heading for product group A.
Systems, Equipment, and Components mean
that 3A001.b.2 does not control ‘‘MMICs’’ if
they are ‘‘specially designed’’ for other
applications, e.g., telecommunications,
radar, automobiles.
b.3. Discrete microwave transistors that are
any of the following:
b.3.a. Rated for operation at frequencies
exceeding 2.7 GHz up to and including 6.8
GHz and having any of the following:
b.3.a.1. A peak saturated power output
greater than 400 W (56 dBm) at any
frequency exceeding 2.7 GHz up to and
including 2.9 GHz;
b.3.a.2. A peak saturated power output
greater than 205 W (53.12 dBm) at any
frequency exceeding 2.9 GHz up to and
including 3.2 GHz;
b.3.a.3. A peak saturated power output
greater than 115 W (50.61 dBm) at any
frequency exceeding 3.2 GHz up to and
including 3.7 GHz; or
b.3.a.4. A peak saturated power output
greater than 60 W (47.78 dBm) at any
frequency exceeding 3.7 GHz up to and
including 6.8 GHz;
b.3.b. Rated for operation at frequencies
exceeding 6.8 GHz up to and including 31.8
GHz and having any of the following:
b.3.b.1. A peak saturated power output
greater than 50 W (47 dBm) at any frequency
exceeding 6.8 GHz up to and including 8.5
GHz;
b.3.b.2. A peak saturated power output
greater than 15 W (41.76 dBm) at any
frequency exceeding 8.5 GHz up to and
including 12 GHz;
b.3.b.3. A peak saturated power output
greater than 40 W (46 dBm) at any frequency
exceeding 12 GHz up to and including 16
GHz; or
b.3.b.4. A peak saturated power output
greater than 7 W (38.45 dBm) at any
frequency exceeding 16 GHz up to and
including 31.8 GHz;
b.3.c. Rated for operation with a peak
saturated power output greater than 0.5 W
(27 dBm) at any frequency exceeding 31.8
GHz up to and including 37 GHz;
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
71952
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
b.3.d. Rated for operation with a peak
saturated power output greater than 1 W (30
dBm) at any frequency exceeding 37 GHz up
to and including 43.5 GHz;
b.3.e. Rated for operation with a peak
saturated power output greater than 0.1 nW
(¥70 dBm) at any frequency exceeding 43.5
GHz; or
b.3.f. Other than those specified by
3A001.b.3.a to 3A001.b.3.e and rated for
operation with a peak saturated power output
greater than 5 W (37.0 dBm) at all frequencies
exceeding 8.5 GHz up to and including 31.8
GHz;
Note 1: The control status of a transistor
in 3A001.b.3.a through 3A001.b.3.e, whose
rated operating frequency includes
frequencies listed in more than one frequency
range, as defined by 3A001.b.3.a through
3A001.b.3.e, is determined by the lowest
peak saturated power output control
threshold.
Note 2: 3A001.b.3 includes bare dice, dice
mounted on carriers, or dice mounted in
packages. Some discrete transistors may also
be referred to as power amplifiers, but the
status of these discrete transistors is
determined by 3A001.b.3.
b.4. Microwave solid state amplifiers and
microwave assemblies/modules containing
microwave solid state amplifiers, that are any
of the following:
b.4.a. Rated for operation at frequencies
exceeding 2.7 GHz up to and including 6.8
GHz with a ‘‘fractional bandwidth’’ greater
than 15%, and having any of the following:
b.4.a.1. A peak saturated power output
greater than 500 W (57 dBm) at any
frequency exceeding 2.7 GHz up to and
including 2.9 GHz;
b.4.a.2. A peak saturated power output
greater than 270 W (54.3 dBm) at any
frequency exceeding 2.9 GHz up to and
including 3.2 GHz;
b.4.a.3. A peak saturated power output
greater than 200 W (53 dBm) at any
frequency exceeding 3.2 GHz up to and
including 3.7 GHz; or
b.4.a.4. A peak saturated power output
greater than 90 W (49.54 dBm) at any
frequency exceeding 3.7 GHz up to and
including 6.8 GHz;
b.4.b. Rated for operation at frequencies
exceeding 6.8 GHz up to and including 31.8
GHz with a ‘‘fractional bandwidth’’ greater
than 10%, and having any of the following:
b.4.b.1. A peak saturated power output
greater than 70 W (48.45 dBm) at any
frequency exceeding 6.8 GHz up to and
including 8.5 GHz;
b.4.b.2. A peak saturated power output
greater than 50 W (47 dBm) at any frequency
exceeding 8.5 GHz up to and including 12
GHz;
b.4.b.3. A peak saturated power output
greater than 30 W (44.77 dBm) at any
frequency exceeding 12 GHz up to and
including 16 GHz; or
b.4.b.4. A peak saturated power output
greater than 20 W (43 dBm) at any frequency
exceeding 16 GHz up to and including 31.8
GHz;
b.4.c. Rated for operation with a peak
saturated power output greater than 0.5 W
(27 dBm) at any frequency exceeding 31.8
GHz up to and including 37 GHz;
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
b.4.d. Rated for operation with a peak
saturated power output greater than 2 W (33
dBm) at any frequency exceeding 37 GHz up
to and including 43.5 GHz, and with a
‘‘fractional bandwidth’’ of greater than 10%;
b.4.e. Rated for operation at frequencies
exceeding 43.5 GHz and having any of the
following:
b.4.e.1. A peak saturated power output
greater than 0.2 W (23 dBm) at any frequency
exceeding 43.5 GHz up to and including 75
GHz, and with a ‘‘fractional bandwidth’’ of
greater than 10%;
b.4.e.2. A peak saturated power output
greater than 20 mW (13 dBm) at any
frequency exceeding 75 GHz up to and
including 90 GHz, and with a ‘‘fractional
bandwidth’’ of greater than 5%; or
b.4.e.3. A peak saturated power output
greater than 0.1 nW (¥70 dBm) at any
frequency exceeding 90 GHz; or
b.4.f. [Reserved]
N.B.:
1. For ‘‘MMIC’’ amplifiers see 3A001.b.2.
2. For ‘transmit/receive modules’ and
‘transmit modules’ see 3A001.b.12.
3. For converters and harmonic mixers,
designed to extend the operating or
frequency range of signal analyzers, signal
generators, network analyzers or microwave
test receivers, see 3A001.b.7.
Note 1: [Reserved]
Note 2: The control status of an item
whose rated operating frequency includes
frequencies listed in more than one frequency
range, as defined by 3A001.b.4.a through
3A001.b.4.e, is determined by the lowest
peak saturated power output control
threshold.
b.5. Electronically or magnetically tunable
band-pass or band-stop filters, having more
than 5 tunable resonators capable of tuning
across a 1.5:1 frequency band (fmax/fmin) in
less than 10 ms and having any of the
following:
b.5.a. A band-pass bandwidth of more than
0.5% of center frequency; or
b.5.b. A band-stop bandwidth of less than
0.5% of center frequency;
b.6. [Reserved]
b.7. Converters and harmonic mixers, that
are any of the following:
b.7.a. Designed to extend the frequency
range of ‘‘signal analyzers’’ beyond 90 GHz;
b.7.b. Designed to extend the operating
range of signal generators as follows:
b.7.b.1. Beyond 90 GHz;
b.7.b.2. To an output power greater than
100 mW (20 dBm) anywhere within the
frequency range exceeding 43.5 GHz but not
exceeding 90 GHz;
b.7.c. Designed to extend the operating
range of network analyzers as follows:
b.7.c.1. Beyond 110 GHz;
b.7.c.2. To an output power greater than
31.62 mW (15 dBm) anywhere within the
frequency range exceeding 43.5 GHz but not
exceeding 90 GHz;
b.7.c.3. To an output power greater than 1
mW (0 dBm) anywhere within the frequency
range exceeding 90 GHz but not exceeding
110 GHz; or
b.7.d. Designed to extend the frequency
range of microwave test receivers beyond 110
GHz;
b.8. Microwave power amplifiers
containing ‘‘vacuum electronic devices’’
PO 00000
Frm 00022
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
controlled by 3A001.b.1 and having all of the
following:
b.8.a. Operating frequencies above 3 GHz;
b.8.b. An average output power to mass
ratio exceeding 80 W/kg; and
b.8.c. A volume of less than 400 cm3;
Note: 3A001.b.8 does not control
equipment designed or rated for operation in
any frequency band which is ‘‘allocated by
the ITU’’ for radio-communications services,
but not for radio-determination.
b.9. Microwave Power Modules (MPM)
consisting of, at least, a traveling-wave
‘‘vacuum electronic device,’’ a ‘‘Monolithic
Microwave Integrated Circuit’’ (‘‘MMIC’’) and
an integrated electronic power conditioner
and having all of the following:
b.9.a. A ‘turn-on time’ from off to fully
operational in less than 10 seconds;
b.9.b. A volume less than the maximum
rated power in Watts multiplied by 10 cm3/
W; and
b.9.c. An ‘‘instantaneous bandwidth’’
greater than 1 octave (fmax > 2fmin) and having
any of the following:
b.9.c.1. For frequencies equal to or less
than 18 GHz, an RF output power greater
than 100 W; or
b.9.c.2. A frequency greater than 18 GHz;
Technical Notes: For the purposes of
3A001.b.9:
1. To calculate the volume in 3A001.b.9.b,
the following example is provided: for a
maximum rated power of 20 W, the volume
would be: 20 W X 10 cm3/W = 200 cm3.
2. The ‘turn-on time’ in 3A001.b.9.a refers
to the time from fully-off to fully operational,
i.e., it includes the warm-up time of the
MPM.
b.10. Oscillators or oscillator assemblies,
specified to operate with a single sideband
(SSB) phase noise, in dBc/Hz, less (better)
than ¥(126 + 20log10F¥20log10f) anywhere
within the range of 10 Hz ≤ F ≤ 10 kHz;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
3A001.b.10, F is the offset from the operating
frequency in Hz and f is the operating
frequency in MHz.
b.11. ‘Frequency synthesizer’ ‘‘electronic
assemblies’’ having a ‘‘frequency switching
time’’ as specified by any of the following:
b.11.a. Less than 143 ps;
b.11.b. Less than 100 ms for any frequency
change exceeding 2.2 GHz within the
synthesized frequency range exceeding 4.8
GHz but not exceeding 31.8 GHz;
b.11.c. [Reserved]
b.11.d. Less than 500 ms for any frequency
change exceeding 550 MHz within the
synthesized frequency range exceeding 31.8
GHz but not exceeding 37 GHz;
b.11.e. Less than 100 ms for any frequency
change exceeding 2.2 GHz within the
synthesized frequency range exceeding 37
GHz but not exceeding 75 GHz;
b.11.f. Less than 100 ms for any frequency
change exceeding 5.0 GHz within the
synthesized frequency range exceeding 75
GHz but not exceeding 90 GHz; or
b.11.g. Less than 1 ms within the
synthesized frequency range exceeding 90
GHz;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
3A001.b.11, a ‘frequency synthesizer’ is any
kind of frequency source, regardless of the
actual technique used, providing a
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
multiplicity of simultaneous or alternative
output frequencies, from one or more
outputs, controlled by, derived from or
disciplined by a lesser number of standard
(or master) frequencies.
N.B.: For general purpose ‘‘signal
analyzers’’, signal generators, network
analyzers and microwave test receivers, see
3A002.c, 3A002.d, 3A002.e and 3A002.f,
respectively.
b.12. ‘Transmit/receive modules,’
‘transmit/receive MMICs,’ ‘transmit
modules,’ and ‘transmit MMICs,’ rated for
operation at frequencies above 2.7 GHz and
having all of the following:
b.12.a. A peak saturated power output (in
watts), Psat, greater than 505.62 divided by
the maximum operating frequency (in GHz)
squared [Psat>505.62 W*GHz2/fGHz2] for any
channel;
b.12.b. A ‘‘fractional bandwidth’’ of 5% or
greater for any channel;
b.12.c. Any planar side with length d (in
cm) equal to or less than 15 divided by the
lowest operating frequency in GHz [d ≤
15cm*GHz*N/fGHz] where N is the number of
transmit or transmit/receive channels; and
b.12.d. An electronically variable phase
shifter per channel.
Technical Notes: For the purposes of
3A001.b.12:
1. A ‘transmit/receive module’ is a
multifunction ‘‘electronic assembly’’ that
provides bi-directional amplitude and phase
control for transmission and reception of
signals.
2. A ‘transmit module’ is an ‘‘electronic
assembly’’ that provides amplitude and
phase control for transmission of signals.
3. A ‘transmit/receive MMIC’ is a
multifunction ‘‘MMIC’’ that provides bidirectional amplitude and phase control for
transmission and reception of signals.
4. A ‘transmit MMIC’ is a ‘‘MMIC’’ that
provides amplitude and phase control for
transmission of signals.
5. 2.7 GHz should be used as the lowest
operating frequency (fGHz) in the formula in
3A001.b.12.c for transmit/receive or transmit
modules that have a rated operation range
extending downward to 2.7 GHz and below
[d≤15cm*GHz*N/2.7 GHz].
6. 3A001.b.12 applies to ‘transmit/receive
modules’ or ‘transmit modules’ with or
without a heat sink. The value of d in
3A001.b.12.c does not include any portion of
the ‘transmit/receive module’ or ‘transmit
module’ that functions as a heat sink.
7. ‘Transmit/receive modules’ or ‘transmit
modules,’ ‘transmit/receive MMICs’ or
‘transmit MMICs’ may or may not have N
integrated radiating antenna elements where
N is the number of transmit or transmit/
receive channels.
c. Acoustic wave devices as follows and
‘‘specially designed’’ ‘‘components’’ therefor:
c.1. Surface acoustic wave and surface
skimming (shallow bulk) acoustic wave
devices, having any of the following:
c.1.a. A carrier frequency exceeding 6 GHz;
c.1.b. A carrier frequency exceeding 1 GHz,
but not exceeding 6 GHz and having any of
the following:
c.1.b.1. A ‘frequency side-lobe rejection’
exceeding 65 dB;
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
c.1.b.2. A product of the maximum delay
time and the bandwidth (time in ms and
bandwidth in MHz) of more than 100;
c.1.b.3. A bandwidth greater than 250
MHz; or
c.1.b.4. A dispersive delay of more than 10
ms; or
c.1.c. A carrier frequency of 1 GHz or less
and having any of the following:
c.1.c.1. A product of the maximum delay
time and the bandwidth (time in ms and
bandwidth in MHz) of more than 100;
c.1.c.2. A dispersive delay of more than 10
ms; or
c.1.c.3. A ‘frequency side-lobe rejection’
exceeding 65 dB and a bandwidth greater
than 100 MHz;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
3A001.c.1, ‘frequency side-lobe rejection’ is
the maximum rejection value specified in
data sheet.
c.2. Bulk (volume) acoustic wave devices
that permit the direct processing of signals at
frequencies exceeding 6 GHz;
c.3. Acoustic-optic ‘‘signal processing’’
devices employing interaction between
acoustic waves (bulk wave or surface wave)
and light waves that permit the direct
processing of signals or images, including
spectral analysis, correlation or convolution;
Note: 3A001.c does not control acoustic
wave devices that are limited to a single band
pass, low pass, high pass or notch filtering,
or resonating function.
d. Electronic devices and circuits
containing ‘‘components,’’ manufactured
from ‘‘superconductive’’ materials, ‘‘specially
designed’’ for operation at temperatures
below the ‘‘critical temperature’’ of at least
one of the ‘‘superconductive’’ constituents
and having any of the following:
d.1. Current switching for digital circuits
using ‘‘superconductive’’ gates with a
product of delay time per gate (in seconds)
and power dissipation per gate (in watts) of
less than 10¥14 J; or
d.2. Frequency selection at all frequencies
using resonant circuits with Q-values
exceeding 10,000;
e. High energy devices as follows:
e.1. ‘Cells’ as follows:
e.1.a ‘Primary cells’ having any of the
following at 20°C:
e.1.a.1. ‘Energy density’ exceeding 550 Wh/
kg and a ‘continuous power density’
exceeding 50 W/kg; or
e.1.a.2. ‘Energy density’ exceeding 50 Wh/
kg and a ‘continuous power density’
exceeding 350 W/kg;
e.1.b. ‘Secondary cells’ having an ‘energy
density’ exceeding 350 Wh/kg at 20°C;
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 3A001.e.1, ‘energy
density’ (Wh/kg) is calculated from the
nominal voltage multiplied by the nominal
capacity in ampere-hours (Ah) divided by the
mass in kilograms. If the nominal capacity is
not stated, energy density is calculated from
the nominal voltage squared then multiplied
by the discharge duration in hours divided by
the discharge load in Ohms and the mass in
kilograms.
2. For the purposes of 3A001.e.1, a ‘cell’ is
defined as an electrochemical device, which
has positive and negative electrodes, an
electrolyte, and is a source of electrical
PO 00000
Frm 00023
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
71953
energy. It is the basic building block of a
battery.
3. For the purposes of 3A001.e.1.a, a
‘primary cell’ is a ‘cell’ that is not designed
to be charged by any other source.
4. For the purposes of 3A001.e.1.b, a
‘secondary cell’ is a ‘cell’ that is designed to
be charged by an external electrical source.
5. For the purposes of 3A001.e.1.a,
‘continuous power density’ (W/kg) is
calculated from the nominal voltage
multiplied by the specified maximum
continuous discharge current in amperes (A)
divided by the mass in kilograms.
‘Continuous power density’ is also referred to
as specific power.
Note: 3A001.e does not control batteries,
including single-cell batteries.
e.2. High energy storage capacitors as
follows:
e.2.a. Capacitors with a repetition rate of
less than 10 Hz (single shot capacitors) and
having all of the following:
e.2.a.1. A voltage rating equal to or more
than 5 kV;
e.2.a.2. An energy density equal to or more
than 250 J/kg; and
e.2.a.3. A total energy equal to or more
than 25 kJ;
e.2.b. Capacitors with a repetition rate of
10 Hz or more (repetition rated capacitors)
and having all of the following:
e.2.b.1. A voltage rating equal to or more
than 5 kV;
e.2.b.2. An energy density equal to or more
than 50 J/kg;
e.2.b.3. A total energy equal to or more
than 100 J; and
e.2.b.4. A charge/discharge cycle life equal
to or more than 10,000;
e.3. ‘‘Superconductive’’ electromagnets and
solenoids, ‘‘specially designed’’ to be fully
charged or discharged in less than one
second and having all of the following:
Note: 3A001.e.3 does not control
‘‘superconductive’’ electromagnets or
solenoids ‘‘specially designed’’ for Magnetic
Resonance Imaging (MRI) medical
equipment.
e.3.a. Energy delivered during the
discharge exceeding 10 kJ in the first second;
e.3.b. Inner diameter of the current
carrying windings of more than 250 mm; and
e.3.c. Rated for a magnetic induction of
more than 8 T or ‘‘overall current density’’
in the winding of more than 300 A/mm2;
e.4. Solar cells, cell-interconnectcoverglass (CIC) assemblies, solar panels, and
solar arrays, which are ‘‘space-qualified,’’
having a minimum average efficiency
exceeding 20% at an operating temperature
of 301 K (28 °C) under simulated ‘AM0’
illumination with an irradiance of 1,367
Watts per square meter (W/m2);
Technical Note: For the purposes of
3A001.e.4, ‘AM0’, or ‘Air Mass Zero’, refers
to the spectral irradiance of sun light in the
earth’s outer atmosphere when the distance
between the earth and sun is one
astronomical unit (AU).
f. Rotary input type absolute position
encoders having an ‘‘accuracy’’ equal to or
less (better) than 1.0 second of arc and
‘‘specially designed’’ encoder rings, discs or
scales therefor;
g. Solid-state pulsed power switching
thyristor devices and ‘thyristor modules’,
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
71954
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
using either electrically, optically, or electron
radiation controlled switch methods and
having any of the following:
g.1. A maximum turn-on current rate of
rise (di/dt) greater than 30,000 A/ms and offstate voltage greater than 1,100 V; or
g.2. A maximum turn-on current rate of
rise (di/dt) greater than 2,000 A/ms and
having all of the following:
g.2.a. An off-state peak voltage equal to or
greater than 3,000 V; and
g.2.b. A peak (surge) current equal to or
greater than 3,000 A;
Note 1: 3A001.g. includes:
—Silicon Controlled Rectifiers (SCRs)
—Electrical Triggering Thyristors (ETTs)
—Light Triggering Thyristors (LTTs)
—Integrated Gate Commutated Thyristors
(IGCTs)
—Gate Turn-off Thyristors (GTOs)
—MOS Controlled Thyristors (MCTs)
—Solidtrons
Note 2: 3A001.g does not control thyristor
devices and ‘thyristor modules’ incorporated
into equipment designed for civil railway or
‘‘civil aircraft’’ applications.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
3A001.g, a ‘thyristor module’ contains one or
more thyristor devices.
h. Solid-state power semiconductor
switches, diodes, or ‘modules’, having all of
the following:
h.1. Rated for a maximum operating
junction temperature greater than 488 K
(215°C);
h.2. Repetitive peak off-state voltage
(blocking voltage) exceeding 300 V; and
h.3. Continuous current greater than 1 A.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
3A001.h, ‘modules’ contain one or more
solid-state power semiconductor switches or
diodes.
Note 1: Repetitive peak off-state voltage in
3A001.h includes drain to source voltage,
collector to emitter voltage, repetitive peak
reverse voltage and peak repetitive off-state
blocking voltage.
Note 2: 3A001.h includes:
—Junction Field Effect Transistors (JFETs)
—Vertical Junction Field Effect Transistors
(VJFETs)
—Metal Oxide Semiconductor Field Effect
Transistors (MOSFETs)
—Double Diffused Metal Oxide
Semiconductor Field Effect Transistor
(DMOSFET)
—Insulated Gate Bipolar Transistor (IGBT)
—High Electron Mobility Transistors
(HEMTs)
—Bipolar Junction Transistors (BJTs)
—Thyristors and Silicon Controlled
Rectifiers (SCRs)
—Gate Turn-Off Thyristors (GTOs)
—Emitter Turn-Off Thyristors (ETOs)
—PiN Diodes
—Schottky Diodes
Note 3: 3A001.h does not apply to
switches, diodes, or ‘modules’, incorporated
into equipment designed for civil automobile,
civil railway, or ‘‘civil aircraft’’ applications.
i. Intensity, amplitude, or phase electrooptic modulators, designed for analog signals
and having any of the following:
i.1. A maximum operating frequency of
more than 10 GHz but less than 20 GHz, an
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
optical insertion loss equal to or less than 3
dB and having any of the following:
i.1.a. A ‘half-wave voltage’ (‘Vp’) less than
2.7 V when measured at a frequency of 1 GHz
or below; or
i.1.b. A ‘Vp’ of less than 4 V when
measured at a frequency of more than 1 GHz;
or
i.2. A maximum operating frequency equal
to or greater than 20 GHz, an optical insertion
loss equal to or less than 3 dB and having
any of the following:
i.2.a. A ‘Vp’ less than 3.3 V when measured
at a frequency of 1 GHz or below; or
i.2.b. A ‘Vp’ less than 5 V when measured
at a frequency of more than 1 GHz.
Note: 3A001.i includes electro-optic
modulators having optical input and output
connectors (e.g., fiber-optic pigtails).
Technical Note: For the purposes of
3A001.i, a ‘half-wave voltage’ (‘Vp’) is the
applied voltage necessary to make a phase
change of 180 degrees in the wavelength of
light propagating through the optical
modulator.
*
*
*
*
*
3A002 General purpose ‘‘electronic
assemblies,’’ modules and equipment, as
follows (see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, AT
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
MT applies to
3A002.h when the
parameters in
3A101.a.2.b are
met or exceeded.
AT applies to entire
entry.
Country chart (see
Supp. No. 1 to part
738)
NS Column 2
MT Column 1
AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements: See § 743.1 of
the EAR for reporting requirements for
exports under License Exceptions, and
Validated End-User authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: $3000: 3A002.a, .e, .f, and .g
$5000: 3A002.c to .d, and .h (unless
controlled for MT);
GBS: Yes, for 3A002.h (unless controlled for
MT)
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be
used to ship any item in 3A002.g.1 to any
of the destinations listed in Country Group
A:6 (See Supplement No. 1 to part 740 of
the EAR).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: See Category XV(e)(9) of
the USML for certain ‘‘space-qualified’’
atomic frequency standards ‘‘subject to the
ITAR’’ (see 22 CFR parts 120 through 130).
See also 3A101, 3A992 and 9A515.x.
Related Definitions: Constant percentage
bandwidth filters are also known as octave
or fractional octave filters.
Items:
PO 00000
Frm 00024
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
a. Recording equipment and oscilloscopes,
as follows:
a.1. to a.5. [Reserved]
N.B.: For waveform digitizers and transient
recorders, see 3A002.h.
a.6. Digital data recorders having all of the
following:
a.6.a. A sustained ‘continuous throughput’
of more than 6.4 Gbit/s to disk or solid-state
drive memory; and
a.6.b. ‘‘Signal processing’’ of the radio
frequency signal data while it is being
recorded;
Technical Notes: For the purposes of
3A002.a.6:
1. For recorders with a parallel bus
architecture, the ‘continuous throughput’
rate is the highest word rate multiplied by the
number of bits in a word.
2. ‘Continuous throughput’ is the fastest
data rate the instrument can record to disk
or solid-state drive memory without the loss
of any information while sustaining the input
digital data rate or digitizer conversion rate.
a.7. Real-time oscilloscopes having a
vertical root-mean-square (rms) noise voltage
of less than 2% of full-scale at the vertical
scale setting that provides the lowest noise
value for any input 3dB bandwidth of 60 GHz
or greater per channel;
Note: 3A002.a.7 does not apply to
equivalent-time sampling oscilloscopes.
b. [Reserved]
c. ‘‘Signal analyzers’’ as follows:
c.1. ‘‘Signal analyzers’’ having a 3 dB
resolution bandwidth (RBW) exceeding 40
MHz anywhere within the frequency range
exceeding 31.8 GHz but not exceeding 37
GHz;
c.2. ‘‘Signal analyzers’’ having a Displayed
Average Noise Level (DANL) less (better)
than ¥150 dBm/Hz anywhere within the
frequency range exceeding 43.5 GHz but not
exceeding 90 GHz;
c.3. ‘‘Signal analyzers’’ having a frequency
exceeding 90 GHz;
c.4. ‘‘Signal analyzers’’ having all of the
following:
c.4.a. ‘Real-time bandwidth’ exceeding 170
MHz; and
c.4.b. Having any of the following:
c.4.b.1. 100% probability of discovery,
with less than a 3 dB reduction from full
amplitude due to gaps or windowing effects,
of signals having a duration of 15 ms or less;
or
c.4.b.2. A ‘frequency mask trigger’
function, with 100% probability of trigger
(capture) for signals having a duration of 15
ms or less;
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 3A002.c.4.a, ‘realtime bandwidth’ is the widest frequency
range for which the analyzer can
continuously transform time-domain data
entirely into frequency-domain results, using
a Fourier or other discrete time transform
that processes every incoming time point,
without a reduction of measured amplitude
of more than 3 dB below the actual signal
amplitude caused by gaps or windowing
effects, while outputting or displaying the
transformed data.
2. For the purposes of 3A002.c.4.b.1.,
probability of discovery is also referred to as
probability of intercept or probability of
capture.
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
3. For the purposes of 3A002.c.4.b.1, the
duration for 100% probability of discovery is
equivalent to the minimum signal duration
necessary for the specified level
measurement uncertainty.
4. For the purposes of 3A002.c.4.b.2, a
‘frequency mask trigger’ is a mechanism
where the trigger function is able to select a
frequency range to be triggered on as a subset
of the acquisition bandwidth while ignoring
other signals that may also be present within
the same acquisition bandwidth. A
‘frequency mask trigger’ may contain more
than one independent set of limits.
Note: 3A002.c.4 does not apply to those
‘‘signal analyzers’’ using only constant
percentage bandwidth filters (also known as
octave or fractional octave filters).
c.5. [Reserved]
d. Signal generators having any of the
following:
d.1. Specified to generate pulse-modulated
signals having all of the following, anywhere
within the frequency range exceeding 31.8
GHz but not exceeding 37 GHz:
d.1.a. ‘Pulse duration’ of less than 25 ns;
and
d.1.b. On/off ratio equal to or exceeding 65
dB;
d.2. An output power exceeding 100 mW
(20 dBm) anywhere within the frequency
range exceeding 43.5 GHz but not exceeding
90 GHz;
d.3. A ‘‘frequency switching time’’ as
specified by any of the following:
d.3.a. [Reserved]
d.3.b. Less than 100 ms for any frequency
change exceeding 2.2 GHz within the
frequency range exceeding 4.8 GHz but not
exceeding 31.8 GHz;
d.3.c. [Reserved]
d.3.d. Less than 500 ms for any frequency
change exceeding 550 MHz within the
frequency range exceeding 31.8 GHz but not
exceeding 37 GHz;
d.3.e. Less than 100 ms for any frequency
change exceeding 2.2 GHz within the
frequency range exceeding 37 GHz but not
exceeding 75 GHz; or
d.3.f. [Reserved]
d.3.g. Less than 100 ms for any frequency
change exceeding 5.0 GHz within the
frequency range exceeding 75 GHz but not
exceeding 90 GHz.
d.4. A single sideband (SSB) phase noise,
in dBc/Hz, specified as being any of the
following:
d.4.a. Less (better) than ¥(126 + 20 log10
F¥20log10f) for anywhere within the range of
10 Hz ≤ F ≤ 10 kHz anywhere within the
frequency range exceeding 3.2 GHz but not
exceeding 90 GHz; or
d.4.b. Less (better) than ¥(206¥20log10f)
for anywhere within the range of 10 kHz <
F ≤ 100 kHz anywhere within the frequency
range exceeding 3.2 GHz but not exceeding
90 GHz;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
3A002.d.4, F is the offset from the operating
frequency in Hz and f is the operating
frequency in MHz.
d.5. An ‘RF modulation bandwidth’ of
digital baseband signals as specified by any
of the following:
d.5.a. Exceeding 2.2 GHz within the
frequency range exceeding 4.8 GHz but not
exceeding 31.8 GHz;
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
d.5.b. Exceeding 550 MHz within the
frequency range exceeding 31.8 GHz but not
exceeding 37 GHz;
d.5.c. Exceeding 2.2 GHz within the
frequency range exceeding 37 GHz but not
exceeding 75 GHz;
d.5.d. Exceeding 5.0 GHz within the
frequency range exceeding 75 GHz but not
exceeding 90 GHz; or
Technical Note: For the purposes of
3A002.d.5, ‘RF modulation bandwidth’ is the
Radio Frequency (RF) bandwidth occupied
by a digitally encoded baseband signal
modulated onto an RF signal. It is also
referred to as information bandwidth or
vector modulation bandwidth. I/Q digital
modulation is the technical method for
producing a vector-modulated RF output
signal, and that output signal is typically
specified as having an ‘RF modulation
bandwidth’.
d.6. A maximum frequency exceeding 90
GHz;
Note 1: For the purposes of 3A002.d,
signal generators include arbitrary waveform
and function generators.
Note 2: 3A002.d does not control
equipment in which the output frequency is
either produced by the addition or
subtraction of two or more crystal oscillator
frequencies, or by an addition or subtraction
followed by a multiplication of the result.
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 3A002.d, the
maximum frequency of an arbitrary
waveform or function generator is calculated
by dividing the sample rate, in samples/
second, by a factor of 2.5.
2. For the purposes of 3A002.d.1.a, ‘pulse
duration’ is defined as the time interval from
the point on the leading edge that is 50% of
the pulse amplitude to the point on the
trailing edge that is 50% of the pulse
amplitude.
e. Network analyzers having any of the
following:
e.1. An output power exceeding 31.62 mW
(15 dBm) anywhere within the operating
frequency range exceeding 43.5 GHz but not
exceeding 90 GHz;
e.2. An output power exceeding 1 mW (0
dBm) anywhere within the operating
frequency range exceeding 90 GHz but not
exceeding 110 GHz;
e.3. ‘Nonlinear vector measurement
functionality’ at frequencies exceeding 50
GHz but not exceeding 110 GHz; or
Technical Note: For the purposes of
3A002.e.3, ‘nonlinear vector measurement
functionality’ is an instrument’s ability to
analyze the test results of devices driven into
the large-signal domain or the non-linear
distortion range.
e.4. A maximum operating frequency
exceeding 110 GHz;
f. Microwave test receivers having all of the
following:
f.1. Maximum operating frequency
exceeding 110 GHz; and
f.2. Being capable of measuring amplitude
and phase simultaneously;
g. Atomic frequency standards being any of
the following:
g.1. ‘‘Space-qualified’’;
g.2. Non-rubidium and having a long-term
stability less (better) than 1 × 10¥11/month;
or
PO 00000
Frm 00025
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
71955
g.3. Non-‘‘space-qualified’’ and having all
of the following:
g.3.a. Being a rubidium standard;
g.3.b. Long-term stability less (better) than
1 × 10¥11/month; and
g.3.c. Total power consumption of less
than 1 Watt.
h. ‘‘Electronic assemblies,’’ modules or
equipment, specified to perform all of the
following:
h.1. Analog-to-digital conversions meeting
any of the following:
h.1.a. A resolution of 8 bit or more, but less
than 10 bit, with a ‘‘sample rate’’ greater than
1.3 Giga Samples Per Second (GSPS);
h.1.b. A resolution of 10 bit or more, but
less than 12 bit, with a ‘‘sample rate’’ greater
than 1.0 GSPS;
h.1.c. A resolution of 12 bit or more, but
less than 14 bit, with a ‘‘sample rate’’ greater
than 1.0 GSPS;
h.1.d. A resolution of 14 bit or more but
less than 16 bit, with a ‘‘sample rate’’ greater
than 400 Mega Samples Per Second (MSPS);
or
h.1.e. A resolution of 16 bit or more with
a ‘‘sample rate’’ greater than 180 MSPS; and
h.2. Any of the following:
h.2.a. Output of digitized data;
h.2.b. Storage of digitized data; or
h.2.c. Processing of digitized data;
N.B.: Digital data recorders, oscilloscopes,
‘‘signal analyzers,’’ signal generators,
network analyzers and microwave test
receivers, are specified by 3A002.a.6,
3A002.a.7, 3A002.c, 3A002.d, 3A002.e and
3A002.f, respectively.
Technical Notes: For the purposes of
3A002.h:
1. A resolution of n bit corresponds to a
quantization of 2n levels.
2. The resolution of the ADC is the number
of bits of the digital output of the ADC that
represents the measured analog input word.
Effective Number of Bits (ENOB) is not used
to determine the resolution of the ADC.
3. For non-interleaved multiple-channel
‘‘electronic assemblies’’, modules, or
equipment, the ‘‘sample rate’’ is not
aggregated and the ‘‘sample rate’’ is the
maximum rate of any single channel.
4. For interleaved channels on multiplechannel ‘‘electronic assemblies’’, modules, or
equipment, the ‘‘sample rates’’ are
aggregated and the ‘‘sample rate’’ is the
maximum combined total rate of all the
interleaved channels.
Note: 3A002.h includes ADC cards,
waveform digitizers, data acquisition cards,
signal acquisition boards and transient
recorders.
*
*
*
*
*
3B001 Equipment for the manufacturing of
semiconductor devices or materials, as
follows (see List of Items Controlled)
and ‘‘specially designed’’ ‘‘components’’
and ‘‘accessories’’ therefor.
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
NS Column 2
71956
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
Control(s)
AT applies to entire
entry.
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
AT Column 1
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: $500
GBS: Yes, except a.3 (molecular beam
epitaxial growth equipment using gas
sources), .e (automatic loading multichamber central wafer handling systems
only if connected to equipment controlled
by 3B001. a.3, or .f), and .f (lithography
equipment).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: See also 3B991.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Equipment designed for epitaxial growth
as follows:
a.1. Equipment designed or modified to
produce a layer of any material other than
silicon with a thickness uniform to less than
±2.5% across a distance of 75 mm or more;
Note: 3B001.a.1 includes atomic layer
epitaxy (ALE) equipment.
a.2. Metal Organic Chemical Vapor
Deposition (MOCVD) reactors designed for
compound semiconductor epitaxial growth of
material having two or more of the following
elements: aluminum, gallium, indium,
arsenic, phosphorus, antimony, or nitrogen;
a.3. Molecular beam epitaxial growth
equipment using gas or solid sources;
b. Equipment designed for ion
implantation and having any of the
following:
b.1. [Reserved]
b.2. Being designed and optimized to
operate at a beam energy of 20 keV or more
and a beam current of 10 mA or more for
hydrogen, deuterium, or helium implant;
b.3. Direct write capability;
b.4. A beam energy of 65 keV or more and
a beam current of 45 mA or more for high
energy oxygen implant into a heated
semiconductor material ‘‘substrate’’; or
b.5. Being designed and optimized to
operate at beam energy of 20 keV or more and
a beam current of 10mA or more for silicon
implant into a semiconductor material
‘‘substrate’’ heated to 600 °C or greater;
c. [Reserved]
d. [Reserved]
e. Automatic loading multi-chamber
central wafer handling systems having all of
the following:
e.1. Interfaces for wafer input and output,
to which more than two functionally
different ‘semiconductor process tools’
controlled by 3B001.a.1, 3B001.a.2, 3B001.a.3
or 3B001.b are designed to be connected; and
e.2. Designed to form an integrated system
in a vacuum environment for ‘sequential
multiple wafer processing’;
Note: 3B001.e does not control automatic
robotic wafer handling systems ‘‘specially
designed’’ for parallel wafer processing.
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 3B001.e.1,
‘semiconductor process tools’ refers to
modular tools that provide physical
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
processes for semiconductor production that
are functionally different, such as deposition,
implant or thermal processing.
2. For the purposes of 3B001.e.2,
‘sequential multiple wafer processing’ means
the capability to process each wafer in
different ‘semiconductor process tools’, such
as by transferring each wafer from one tool
to a second tool and on to a third tool with
the automatic loading multi-chamber central
wafer handling systems.
f. Lithography equipment as follows:
f.1. Align and expose step and repeat
(direct step on wafer) or step and scan
(scanner) equipment for wafer processing
using photo-optical or X-ray methods and
having any of the following:
f.1.a. A light source wavelength shorter
than 193 nm; or
f.1.b. Capable of producing a pattern with
a ‘‘Minimum Resolvable Feature size’’ (MRF)
of 45 nm or less;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
3B001.f.1.b, the ‘Minimum Resolvable
Feature size’ (MRF) is calculated by the
following formula:
MRF = (an exposure light source wavelength
in nm) × (K factor)/numerical aperture
where the K factor = 0.35
f.2 Imprint lithography equipment capable
of production features of 45 nm or less;
Note: 3B001.f.2 includes:
—Micro contact printing tools
—Hot embossing tools
—Nano-imprint lithography tools
—Step and flash imprint lithography (S–FIL)
tools
f.3. Equipment ‘‘specially designed’’ for
mask making having all of the following:
f.3.a. A deflected focused electron beam,
ion beam or ‘‘laser’’ beam; and
f.3.b. Having any of the following:
f.3.b.1. A Full-Width Half-Maximum
(FWHM) spot size smaller than 65 nm and an
image placement less than 17 nm (mean + 3
sigma); or
f.3.b.2. [Reserved]
f.3.b.3. A second-layer overlay error of less
than 23 nm (mean + 3 sigma) on the mask;
f.4. Equipment designed for device
processing using direct writing methods,
having all of the following:
f.4.a. A deflected focused electron beam;
and
f.4.b. Having any of the following:
f.4.b.1. A minimum beam size equal to or
smaller than 15 nm; or
f.4.b.2. An overlay error less than 27 nm
(mean + 3 sigma);
g. Masks and reticles, designed for
integrated circuits controlled by 3A001;
h. Multi-layer masks with a phase shift
layer not specified by 3B001.g and designed
to be used by lithography equipment having
a light source wavelength less than 245 nm;
Note: 3B001.h. does not control multi-layer
masks with a phase shift layer designed for
the fabrication of memory devices not
controlled by 3A001.
N.B.: For masks and reticles, ‘‘specially
designed’’ for optical sensors, see 6B002.
i. Imprint lithography templates designed
for integrated circuits by 3A001;
j. Mask ‘‘substrate blanks’’ with multilayer
reflector structure consisting of molybdenum
and silicon, and having all of the following:
PO 00000
Frm 00026
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
j.1. ‘‘Specially designed’’ for ‘Extreme
Ultraviolet (EUV)’ lithography; and
j.2. Compliant with SEMI Standard P37.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
3B001.j, ‘Extreme Ultraviolet (EUV)’ refers to
electromagnetic spectrum wavelengths
greater than 5 nm and less than 124 nm.
*
*
*
*
*
3D003 ‘Computational lithography’
‘‘software’’ ‘‘specially designed’’for the
‘‘development’’ of patterns on EUVlithography masks or reticles.
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Country chart (see
supp. No. 1 to part
738)
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
AT applies to entire
entry.
NS Column 1
AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
TSR: Yes
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: N/A
Related Definitions: For the purposes of
3D003, ‘computational lithography’ is the
use of computer modelling to predict,
correct, optimize and verify imaging
performance of the lithography process
over a range of patterns, processes, and
system conditions.
Items:
The list of items controlled is contained in
the ECCN heading.
*
*
*
*
*
3D006 ‘Electronic Computer-Aided Design’
(‘ECAD’) ‘‘software’’ ‘‘specially
designed’’ for the ‘‘development’’ of
integrated circuits having any ‘‘GateAll-Around Field-Effect Transistor’’
(‘‘GAAFET’’) structure, and having any
of the following (see List of Items
Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
AT applies to entire
entry.
Country chart (see
supp. no. 1 to part
738)
NS Column 2
AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for Description of All License Exceptions)
TSR: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: N/A
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. ‘‘Specially designed’’ for implementing
‘Register Transfer Level’ (‘RTL’) to
‘Geometrical Database Standard II’ (‘GDSII’)
or equivalent standard; or
b. ‘‘Specially designed’’ for optimization of
power or timing rules.
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
Technical Notes: For the purposes of
3D006:
1. ‘Electronic Computer-Aided Design’
(‘ECAD’) is a category of ‘‘software’’ tools
used for designing, analyzing, optimizing,
and validating the performance of an
integrated circuit or printed circuit board.
2. ‘Register Transfer Level’ (‘RTL’) is a
design abstraction which models a
synchronous digital circuit in terms of the
flow of digital signals between hardware
registers and the logical operations
performed on those signals.
3. ‘Geometrical Database Standard II’
(‘GDSII’) is a database file format for data
exchange of integrated circuit or integrated
circuit layout artwork.
*
*
*
*
*
3E001 ‘‘Technology’’ according to the
General Technology Note for the
‘‘development’’ or ‘‘production’’ of
commodities controlled by 3A (except
3A980, 3A981, 3A991, 3A992, or
3A999), 3B (except 3B991 or 3B992) or
3C (except 3C992).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, NP, RS, AT
Control(s)
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
NS applies to ‘‘technology’’ for commodities controlled
by 3A001, 3A002,
3A003, 3B001,
3B002, or 3C001 to
3C006.
MT applies to ‘‘technology’’ for commodities controlled
by 3A001 or 3A101
for MT reasons.
NP applies to ‘‘technology’’ for commodities controlled
by 3A001, 3A201,
or 3A225 to 3A234
for NP reasons.
RS applies to ‘‘technology’’ for commodities controlled
by 3A090 or 3B090.
RS applies to ‘‘technology’’ for commodities controlled
in 3A090, when exported from China
or Macau.
AT applies to entire
entry.
Country chart (see
supp. no. 1 to part
738)
NS Column 1
MT Column 1
NP Column 1
China and Macau
(See § 742.6(a)(6))
Worldwide (See
§ 742.6(a)(6))
AT Column 1
License Requirements Note: See § 744.17 of
the EAR for additional license
requirements for microprocessors having a
processing speed of 5 GFLOPS or more and
an arithmetic logic unit with an access
width of 32 bit or more, including those
incorporating ‘‘information security’’
functionality, and associated ‘‘software’’
and ‘‘technology’’ for the ‘‘production’’ or
‘‘development’’ of such microprocessors.
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
Reporting Requirements
See § 743.1 of the EAR for reporting
requirements for exports under License
Exceptions, Special Comprehensive Licenses,
and Validated End-User authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
TSR: Yes, except N/A for MT, and
‘‘technology’’ for the ‘‘development’’ or
‘‘production’’ of: (a) vacuum electronic
device amplifiers described in 3A001.b.8,
having operating frequencies exceeding 19
GHz; (b) solar cells, coverglassinterconnect-cells or covered-interconnectcells (CIC) ‘‘assemblies’’, solar arrays and/
or solar panels described in 3A001.e.4; (c)
‘‘Monolithic Microwave Integrated Circuit’’
(‘‘MMIC’’) amplifiers in 3A001.b.2; and (d)
discrete microwave transistors in
3A001.b.3.
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be
used to ship or transmit ‘‘technology’’
according to the General Technology Note
for the ‘‘development’’ or ‘‘production’’ of
equipment specified by ECCNs 3A002.g.1
or 3B001.a.2 to any of the destinations
listed in Country Group A:6 (See
Supplement No.1 to part 740 of the EAR).
License Exception STA may not be used to
ship or transmit ‘‘technology’’ according to
the General Technology Note for the
‘‘development’’ or ‘‘production’’ of
components specified by ECCN 3A001.b.2
or b.3 to any of the destinations listed in
Country Group A:5 or A:6 (See Supplement
No.1 to part 740 of the EAR).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) ‘‘Technology’’ according
to the General Technology Note for the
‘‘development’’ or ‘‘production’’ of certain
‘‘space-qualified’’ atomic frequency
standards described in Category XV(e)(9),
MMICs described in Category XV(e)(14),
and oscillators described in Category
XV(e)(15) of the USML are ‘‘subject to the
ITAR’’ (see 22 CFR parts 120 through 130).
See also 3E101, 3E201 and 9E515. (2)
‘‘Technology’’ for ‘‘development’’ or
‘‘production’’ of ‘‘Microwave Monolithic
Integrated Circuits’’ (‘‘MMIC’’) amplifiers
in 3A001.b.2 is controlled in this ECCN
3E001; 5E001.d refers only to that
additional ‘‘technology’’ ‘‘required’’ for
telecommunications.
Related Definition: N/A
Items:
The list of items controlled is contained in
the ECCN heading.
Note 1: 3E001 does not control
‘‘technology’’ for equipment or
‘‘components’’ controlled by 3A003.
Note 2: 3E001 does not control
‘‘technology’’ for integrated circuits
controlled by 3A001.a.3 to a.14, having all of
the following:
(a) Using ‘‘technology’’ at or above 0.130
μm; and
(b) Incorporating multi-layer structures
with three or fewer metal layers.
Note 3: 3E001 does not apply to ‘Process
Design Kits’ (‘PDKs’) unless they include
libraries implementing functions or
PO 00000
Frm 00027
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
71957
technologies for items specified by 3A001 or
3A090.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
3E001 Note 3, a ‘Process Design Kit’ (‘PDK’)
is a software tool provided by a
semiconductor manufacturer to ensure that
the required design practices and rules are
taken into account in order to successfully
produce a specific integrated circuit design
in a specific semiconductor process, in
accordance with technological and
manufacturing constraints (each
semiconductor manufacturing process has its
particular ‘PDK’).
3E002 ‘‘Technology’’ according to the
General Technology Note other than
that controlled in 3E001 for the
‘‘development’’ or ‘‘production’’ of a
‘‘microprocessor microcircuit’’, ‘‘microcomputer microcircuit’’ and
microcontroller microcircuit core,
having an arithmetic logic unit with an
access width of 32 bits or more and any
of the following features or
characteristics (see List of Items
Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
AT applies to entire
entry.
Country Chart (See
Supp. No. 1 to part
738)
NS Column 1
AT Column 1
LICENSE REQUIREMENTS NOTE: See
§ 744.17 of the EAR for additional license
requirements for microprocessors having a
processing speed of 5 GFLOPS or more and
an arithmetic logic unit with an access width
of 32 bit or more, including those
incorporating ‘‘information security’’
functionality, and associated ‘‘software’’ and
‘‘technology’’ for the ‘‘production’’ or
‘‘development’’ of such microprocessors.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
TSR: Yes
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: N/A
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. A ‘vector processor unit’ designed to
perform more than two calculations on
‘floating-point’ vectors (one-dimensional
arrays of 32-bit or larger numbers)
simultaneously;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
3E002.a, a ‘vector processor unit’ is a
processor element with built-in instructions
that perform multiple calculations on
‘floating-point’ vectors (one-dimensional
arrays of 32-bit or larger numbers)
simultaneously, having at least one vector
arithmetic logic unit and vector registers of
at least 32 elements each.
b. Designed to perform more than four 64bit or larger ‘floating-point’ operation results
per cycle; or
c. Designed to perform more than eight 16bit ‘fixed-point’ multiply-accumulate results
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
71958
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
per cycle (e.g., digital manipulation of analog
information that has been previously
converted into digital form, also known as
digital ‘‘signal processing’’).
Note 1: 3E002 does not control
‘‘technology’’ for multimedia extensions.
Note 2: 3E002 does not control
‘‘technology’’ for microprocessor cores,
having all of the following:
a. Using ‘‘technology’’ at or above 0.130
μm; and
b. Incorporating multi-layer structures with
five or fewer metal layers.
Note 3: 3E002 includes ‘‘technology’’ for
the ‘‘development’’ or ‘‘production’’ of digital
signal processors and digital array
processors.
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 3E002.a and
3E002.b, ‘floating-point’ is defined by IEEE–
754.
2. For the purposes of 3E002.c, ‘fixedpoint’ refers to a fixed-width real number
with both an integer component and a
fractional component, and which does not
include integer-only formats.
*
*
*
*
*
Category 4—Computers
*
*
*
*
*
Technical Note: For the purposes of Note
2, ‘main storage’ is the primary storage for
data or instructions for rapid access by a
central processing unit. It consists of the
internal storage of a ‘‘digital computer’’ and
any hierarchical extension thereto, such as
cache storage or non-sequentially accessed
extended storage.
*
*
*
*
*
4A004 Computers as follows (see List of
Items Controlled) and ‘‘specially
designed’’ related equipment,
‘‘electronic assemblies’’ and
‘‘components’’therefor.
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
AT applies to entire
entry.
Country Chart (See
Supp. No. 1 to part
738)
NS Column 2
AT Column 1
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: $5000
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: N/A
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. ‘Systolic array computers’;
b. ‘Neural computers’;
c. ‘Optical computers’.
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 4A004.a, ‘systolic
array computers’ are computers where the
flow and modification of the data is
dynamically controllable at the logic gate
level by the user.
2. For the purposes of 4A004.b, ‘neural
computers’ are computational devices
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
designed or modified to mimic the behaviour
of a neuron or a collection of neurons, i.e.,
computational devices which are
distinguished by their hardware capability to
modulate the weights and numbers of the
interconnections of a multiplicity of
computational components based on
previous data.
3. For the purposes of 4A004.c, ‘optical
computers’ are computers designed or
modified to use light to represent data and
whose computational logic elements are
based on directly coupled optical devices.
*
*
*
*
*
4D001 ‘‘Software’’ as follows (see List of
Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, CC, AT
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
CC applies to ‘‘software’’ for computerized finger-print
equipment controlled by 4A003 for
CC reasons.
AT applies to entire
entry.
Country Chart (See
Supp. No. 1 to part
738)
NS Column 1
CC Column 1
*
*
*
AT Column 1
Control(s)
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be
used to ship or transmit ‘‘software’’
‘‘specially designed’’ or modified for the
‘‘development’’ or ‘‘production’’ of
equipment specified by ECCN 4A001.a.2 or
for the ‘‘development’’ or ‘‘production’’ of
‘‘digital computers’’ having an ‘Adjusted
Peak Performance’ (‘APP’) exceeding 70
Weighted TeraFLOPS (WT) to any of the
destinations listed in Country Group A:6
(See Supplement No. 1 to part 740 of the
EAR); and may not be used to ship or
transmit ’’software’’ specified in 4D001.a
’’specially designed’’ for the
’’development’’ or ’’production’’ of
equipment specified by ECCN 4A005 to
Fmt 4701
*
*
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, RS, CC, AT
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
TSR: Yes, except for ‘‘software’’ for the
‘‘development’’ or ‘‘production’’ of the
following:
(1) Commodities with an ‘‘Adjusted Peak
Performance’’ (‘‘APP’’) exceeding 70 WT;
or
(2) Commodities controlled by 4A005 or
’’software’’ controlled by 4D004.
APP: Yes to specific countries (see § 740.7 of
the EAR for eligibility criteria)
ACE: Yes for 4D001.a (for the
‘‘development’’, ‘‘production’’ or ‘‘use’’ of
equipment or ‘‘software’’ specified in
ECCN 4A005 or 4D004), except to Country
Group E:1 or E:2. See § 740.22 of the EAR
for eligibility criteria.
Frm 00028
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: N/A
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. ‘‘Software’’ ‘‘specially designed’’ or
modified for the ‘‘development’’ or
‘‘production’’, of equipment or ‘‘software’’
controlled by 4A001, 4A003, 4A004, 4A005
or 4D (except 4D090, 4D980, 4D993 or
4D994).
b. ‘‘Software’’, other than that controlled by
4D001.a, ‘‘specially designed’’ or modified
for the ‘‘development’’ or ‘‘production’’ of
equipment as follows:
b.1. ‘‘Digital computers’’ having an
‘‘Adjusted Peak Performance’’ (‘‘APP’’)
exceeding 24 Weighted TeraFLOPS (WT);
b.2. ‘‘Electronic assemblies’’ ‘‘specially
designed’’ or modified for enhancing
performance by aggregation of processors so
that the ‘‘APP’’ of the aggregation exceeds the
limit in 4D001.b.1.
4E001 ‘‘Technology’’ as follows (see List of
Items Controlled).
Reporting Requirements
See § 743.1 of the EAR for reporting
requirements for exports under License
Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
PO 00000
any of the destinations listed in Country
Group A:5 or A:6.
Sfmt 4700
NS applies to entire
entry, except
4A090 or ‘‘software’’ specified by
4D090.
MT applies to ‘‘technology’’ for items
controlled by
4A001.a and
4A101 for MT reasons.
RS applies to ‘‘technology’’ for commodities controlled
by 4A090 or ‘‘software’’ specified by
4D090.
CC applies to ‘‘software’’ for computerized finger-print
equipment controlled by 4A003 for
CC reasons.
AT applies to entire
entry.
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
NS Column 1
MT Column 1
China and Macau
(See § 742.6(a)(6))
CC Column 1
AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements
See § 743.1 of the EAR for reporting
requirements for exports under License
Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
TSR: Yes, except for the following:
(1) ‘‘Technology’’ for the ‘‘development’’ or
‘‘production’’ of commodities with an
‘‘Adjusted Peak Performance’’ (‘‘APP’’)
exceeding 70 WT or for the ’’development’’
or ’’production’’ of commodities controlled
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
by 4A005 or ’’software’’ controlled by
4D004; or
(2) ‘‘Technology’’ for the ’’development’’ of
’’intrusion software’’.
APP: Yes to specific countries (see § 740.7 of
the EAR for eligibility criteria).
ACE: Yes for 4E001.a (for the ‘‘development’’,
‘‘production’’ or ‘‘use’’ of equipment or
‘‘software’’ specified in ECCN 4A005 or
4D004) and for 4E001.c, except to Country
Group E:1 or E:2. See § 740.22 of the EAR
for eligibility criteria.
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be
used to ship or transmit ‘‘technology’’
according to the General Technology Note
for the ‘‘development’’ or ‘‘production’’ of
any of the following equipment or
‘‘software’’: a. Equipment specified by
ECCN 4A001.a.2; b. ‘‘Digital computers’’
having an ‘Adjusted Peak Performance’
(‘APP’) exceeding 70 Weighted TeraFLOPS
(WT); or c. ‘‘software’’ specified in the
License Exception STA paragraph found in
the License Exception section of ECCN
4D001 to any of the destinations listed in
Country Group A:6 (See Supplement No. 1
to part 740 of the EAR); and may not be
used to ship or transmit ’’technology’’
specified in 4E001.a (for the
’’development’’, ’’production’’ or ’’use’’ of
equipment or ’’software’’ specified in
ECCN 4A005 or 4D004) and 4E001.c to any
of the destinations listed in Country Group
A:5 or A:6.
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: N/A
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. ‘‘Technology’’ according to the General
Technology Note, for the ‘‘development’’,
‘‘production’’, or ‘‘use’’ of equipment or
‘‘software’’ controlled by 4A (except 4A980
or 4A994) or 4D (except 4D980, 4D993,
4D994).
b. ‘‘Technology’’ according to the General
Technology Note, other than that controlled
by 4E001.a, for the ‘‘development’’ or
‘‘production’’ of equipment as follows:
b.1. ‘‘Digital computers’’ having an
‘‘Adjusted Peak Performance’’ (‘‘APP’’)
exceeding 24 Weighted TeraFLOPS (WT);
b.2. ‘‘Electronic assemblies’’ ‘‘specially
designed’’ or modified for enhancing
performance by aggregation of processors so
that the ‘‘APP’’ of the aggregation exceeds the
limit in 4E001.b.1.
c. ‘‘Technology’’ for the ‘‘development’’ of
‘‘intrusion software.’’
Note 1: 4E001.a and 4E001.c do not apply
to ‘‘vulnerability disclosure’’ or ‘‘cyber
incident response’’.
Note 2: Note 1 does not diminish national
authorities’ rights to ascertain compliance
with 4E001.a and 4E001.c.
*
*
*
*
*
5A001 Telecommunications systems,
equipment, ‘‘components’’ and
‘‘accessories,’’ as follows (see List of
Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, SL, AT
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
Control(s)
NS applies to
5A001.a, b.5, .e,
.f.3 and .h.
NS applies to
5A001.b (except
.b.5), .c, .d, .f (except f.3), .g, and .j.
SL applies to
5A001.f.1.
AT applies to entire
entry.
NS Column 1
NS Column 2
A license is required
for all destinations,
as specified in
§ 742.13 of the
EAR. Accordingly, a
column specific to
this control does
not appear on the
Commerce Country
Chart (Supplement
No. 1 to Part 738 of
the EAR). Note to
SL paragraph: This
licensing requirement does not supersede, nor does it
implement, construe or limit the
scope of any criminal statute, including, but not limited
to the Omnibus
Safe Streets Act of
1968, as amended
AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements
See § 743.1 of the EAR for reporting
requirements for exports under License
Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A for 5A001.a, b.5, .e, f.3 and .h;
$5000 for 5A001.b.1, .b.2, .b.3, .b.6, .d, f.2,
f.4, and .g;
$3000 for 5A001.c.
GBS: Yes, except 5A001.a, b.5, e, and h.
ACE: Yes for 5A001.j, except to Country
Group E:1 or E:2. See § 740.22 of the EAR
for eligibility criteria
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be
used to ship any commodity in 5A001.j to
any of the destinations listed in Country
Group A:5 or A:6 (See Supplement No. 1
to part 740 of the EAR), or any commodity
in 5A001.b.3, .b.5 or .h to any of the
destinations listed in Country Group A:6
(See Supplement No. 1 to part 740 of the
EAR).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See USML Category XI
for controls on direction-finding
‘‘equipment’’ including types of
‘‘equipment’’ in ECCN 5A001.e and any
other military or intelligence electronic
‘‘equipment’’ that is ‘‘subject to the ITAR.’’
(2) See USML Category XI(a)(4)(iii) for
controls on electronic attack and jamming
‘‘equipment’’ defined in 5A001.f and .h
PO 00000
Frm 00029
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
71959
that are subject to the ITAR. (3) See also
ECCNs 5A101, 5A980, and 5A991.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Any type of telecommunications
equipment having any of the following
characteristics, functions or features:
a.1. ‘‘Specially designed’’ to withstand
transitory electronic effects or
electromagnetic pulse effects, both arising
from a nuclear explosion;
a.2. Specially hardened to withstand
gamma, neutron or ion radiation;
a.3. ‘‘Specially designed’’ to operate below
218 K (¥55 °C); or
a.4. ‘‘Specially designed’’ to operate above
397 K (124 °C);
Note: 5A001.a.3 and 5A001.a.4 apply only
to electronic equipment.
b. Telecommunication systems and
equipment, and ‘‘specially designed’’
‘‘components’’ and ‘‘accessories’’ therefor,
having any of the following characteristics,
functions or features:
b.1 Being underwater untethered
communications systems having any of the
following:
b.1.a. An acoustic carrier frequency outside
the range from 20 kHz to 60 kHz;
b.1.b. Using an electromagnetic carrier
frequency below 30 kHz; or
b.1.c. Using electronic beam steering
techniques; or
b.1.d. Using ‘‘lasers’’ or light-emitting
diodes (LEDs), with an output wavelength
greater than 400 nm and less than 700 nm,
in a ‘‘local area network’’;
b.2. Being radio equipment operating in the
1.5 MHz to 87.5 MHz band and having all of
the following:
b.2.a. Automatically predicting and
selecting frequencies and ‘‘total digital
transfer rates’’ per channel to optimize the
transmission; and
b.2.b. Incorporating a linear power
amplifier configuration having a capability to
support multiple signals simultaneously at
an output power of 1 kW or more in the
frequency range of 1.5 MHz or more but less
than 30 MHz, or 250 W or more in the
frequency range of 30 MHz or more but not
exceeding 87.5 MHz, over an ‘‘instantaneous
bandwidth’’ of one octave or more and with
an output harmonic and distortion content of
better than ¥80 dB;
b.3. Being radio equipment employing
‘‘spread spectrum’’ techniques, including
‘‘frequency hopping’’ techniques, not
controlled in 5A001.b.4 and having any of
the following:
b.3.a. User programmable spreading codes;
or
b.3.b. A total transmitted bandwidth which
is 100 or more times the bandwidth of any
one information channel and in excess of 50
kHz;
Note: 5A001.b.3.b does not control radio
equipment ‘‘specially designed’’ for use with
any of the following:
a. Civil cellular radio-communications
systems; or
b. Fixed or mobile satellite Earth stations
for commercial civil telecommunications.
Note: 5A001.b.3 does not control
equipment operating at an output power of
1 W or less.
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
71960
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
b.4. Being radio equipment employing
ultra-wideband modulation techniques,
having user programmable channelizing
codes, scrambling codes, or network
identification codes and having any of the
following:
b.4.a. A bandwidth exceeding 500 MHz; or
b.4.b. A ‘‘fractional bandwidth’’ of 20% or
more;
b.5. Being digitally controlled radio
receivers having all of the following:
b.5.a. More than 1,000 channels;
b.5.b. A ‘channel switching time ’ of less
than 1 ms;
b.5.c. Automatic searching or scanning of
a part of the electromagnetic spectrum; and
b.5.d. Identification of the received signals
or the type of transmitter; or
Note: 5A001.b.5 does not control radio
equipment ‘‘specially designed’’ for use with
civil cellular radio-communications systems.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
5A001.b.5.b, ‘channel switching time’ means
the time (i.e., delay) to change from one
receiving frequency to another, to arrive at or
within ±0.05% of the final specified receiving
frequency. Items having a specified frequency
range of less than ±0.05% around their center
frequency are defined to be incapable of
channel frequency switching.
b.6. Employing functions of digital ‘‘signal
processing’’ to provide ’voice coding’ output
at rates of less than 700 bit/s.
Technical Notes:
1. For variable rate ’voice coding’,
5A001.b.6 applies to the ’voice coding’
output of continuous speech.
2. For the purposes of 5A001.b.6, ‘voice
coding’ is defined as the technique to take
samples of human voice and then convert
these samples of human voice into a digital
signal taking into account specific
characteristics of human speech.
c. Optical fibers of more than 500 m in
length and specified by the manufacturer as
being capable of withstanding a ‘proof test’
tensile stress of 2 × 109 N/m2 or more;
N.B.: For underwater umbilical cables, see
8A002.a.3.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
5A001.c, ‘proof test’ is the on-line or off-line
production screen testing that dynamically
applies a prescribed tensile stress over a 0.5
to 3 m length of fiber at a running rate of 2
to 5 m/s while passing between capstans
approximately 150 mm in diameter. The
ambient temperature is a nominal 293 K
(20 °C) and relative humidity 40%.
Equivalent national standards may be used
for executing the proof test.
d. ‘‘Electronically steerable phased array
antennae’’ as follows:
d.1. Rated for operation above 31.8 GHz,
but not exceeding 57 GHz, and having an
Effective Radiated Power (ERP) equal to or
greater than +20 dBm (22.15 dBm Effective
Isotropic Radiated Power (EIRP));
d.2. Rated for operation above 57 GHz, but
not exceeding 66 GHz, and having an ERP
equal to or greater than +24 dBm (26.15 dBm
EIRP);
d.3. Rated for operation above 66 GHz, but
not exceeding 90 GHz, and having an ERP
equal to or greater than +20 dBm (22.15 dBm
EIRP);
d.4. Rated for operation above 90 GHz;
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
Note 1: 5A001.d does not control
‘electronically steerable phased array
antennae’ for landing systems with
instruments meeting ICAO standards
covering Microwave Landing Systems (MLS).
Note 2: 5A001.d does not apply to
antennae ‘‘specially designed’’ for any of the
following:
a. Civil cellular or WLAN radiocommunications systems;
b. IEEE 802.15 or wireless HDMI; or
c. Fixed or mobile satellite earth stations
for commercial civil telecommunications.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
5A001.d, ‘electronically steerable phased
array antenna’ is an antenna which forms a
beam by means of phase coupling, (i.e., the
beam direction is controlled by the complex
excitation coefficients of the radiating
elements) and the direction of that beam can
be varied (both in transmission and
reception) in azimuth or in elevation, or both,
by application of an electrical signal.
e. Radio direction finding equipment
operating at frequencies above 30 MHz and
having all of the following, and ‘‘specially
designed’’ ‘‘components’’ therefor:
e.1. ‘‘Instantaneous bandwidth’’ of 10 MHz
or more; and
e.2. Capable of finding a Line Of Bearing
(LOB) to non-cooperating radio transmitters
with a signal duration of less than 1 ms;
f. Mobile telecommunications interception
or jamming equipment, and monitoring
equipment therefor, as follows, and
‘‘specially designed’’ ‘‘components’’ therefor:
f.1. Interception equipment designed for
the extraction of voice or data, transmitted
over the air interface;
f.2. Interception equipment not specified in
5A001.f.1, designed for the extraction of
client device or subscriber identifiers (e.g.,
IMSI, TIMSI or IMEI), signaling, or other
metadata transmitted over the air interface;
f.3. Jamming equipment ‘‘specially
designed’’ or modified to intentionally and
selectively interfere with, deny, inhibit,
degrade or seduce mobile telecommunication
services and performing any of the following:
f.3.a. Simulate the functions of Radio
Access Network (RAN) equipment;
f.3.b. Detect and exploit specific
characteristics of the mobile
telecommunications protocol employed (e.g.,
GSM); or
f.3.c. Exploit specific characteristics of the
mobile telecommunications protocol
employed (e.g., GSM);
f.4. Radio Frequency (RF) monitoring
equipment designed or modified to identify
the operation of items specified in 5A001.f.1,
5A001.f.2 or 5A001.f.3.
Note: 5A001.f.1 and 5A001.f.2 do not
apply to any of the following:
a. Equipment ‘‘specially designed’’ for the
interception of analog Private Mobile Radio
(PMR), IEEE 802.11 WLAN;
b. Equipment designed for mobile
telecommunications network operators; or
c. Equipment designed for the
‘‘development’’ or ‘‘production’’ of mobile
telecommunications equipment or systems.
N.B. 1: See also the International Traffic
in Arms Regulations (ITAR) (22 CFR parts
120–130). For items specified by 5A001.f.1
(including as previously specified by
PO 00000
Frm 00030
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
5A001.i), see also 5A980 and the U.S.
Munitions List (22 CFR part 121).
N.B. 2: For radio receivers see 5A001.b.5.
g. Passive Coherent Location (PCL) systems
or equipment, ‘‘specially designed’’ for
detecting and tracking moving objects by
measuring reflections of ambient radio
frequency emissions, supplied by non-radar
transmitters.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
5A001.g, non-radar transmitters may include
commercial radio, television or cellular
telecommunications base stations.
Note: 5A001.g. does not control:
a. Radio-astronomical equipment; or
b. Systems or equipment, that require any
radio transmission from the target.
h. Counter Improvised Explosive Device
(IED) equipment and related equipment, as
follows:
h.1. Radio Frequency (RF) transmitting
equipment, not specified by 5A001.f,
designed or modified for prematurely
activating or preventing the initiation of
Improvised Explosive Devices (IEDs);
h.2. Equipment using techniques designed
to enable radio communications in the same
frequency channels on which co-located
equipment specified by 5A001.h.1 is
transmitting.
N.B.: See also Category XI of the
International Traffic in Arms Regulations
(ITAR) (22 CFR parts 120–130).
i. [Reserved]
N.B.: See 5A001.f.1 for items previously
specified by 5A001.i.
j. IP network communications surveillance
systems or equipment, and ‘‘specially
designed’’ components therefor, having all of
the following:
j.1. Performing all of the following on a
carrier class IP network (e.g., national grade
IP backbone):
j.1.a. Analysis at the application layer (e.g.,
Layer 7 of Open Systems Interconnection
(OSI) model (ISO/IEC 7498–1));
j.1.b. Extraction of selected metadata and
application content (e.g., voice, video,
messages, attachments); and
j.1.c. Indexing of extracted data; and
j.2. Being ‘‘specially designed’’ to carry out
all of the following:
j.2.a. Execution of searches on the basis of
‘‘hard selectors’’; and
j.2.b. Mapping of the relational network of
an individual or of a group of people.
Note: 5A001.j does not apply to ‘‘systems’’
or ‘‘equipment’’, ‘‘specially designed’’ for any
of the following:
a. Marketing purpose;
b. Network Quality of Service (QoS); or
c. Quality of Experience (QoE).
N.B.: See also the International Traffic in
Arms Regulations (ITAR) (22 CFR parts 120–
130). Defense articles described in USML
Category XI(b) are ‘‘subject to the ITAR.’’
*
*
*
*
*
Category 5—Telecommunications and
‘‘Information Security’’
Part 2—‘‘Information Security’’
*
*
*
*
*
Technical Note: For the purposes of the
Cryptography Note, ‘executable software’
means ‘‘software’’ in executable form, from
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
an existing hardware component excluded
from 5A002, by the Cryptography Note.
*
*
*
*
*
5A002 ‘‘Information security’’ systems,
equipment and ‘‘components,’’ as
follows (see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT, EI
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
AT applies to entire
entry.
EI applies to entire
entry.
Country Chart (See
Supp. No. 1 to part
738)
NS Column 1
AT Column 1
Refer to § 742.15 of
the EAR.
License Requirements Note: See
§ 744.17 of the EAR for additional license
requirements for microprocessors having a
processing speed of 5 GFLOPS or more and
an arithmetic logic unit with an access width
of 32 bit or more, including those
incorporating ‘‘information security’’
functionality, and associated ‘‘software’’ and
‘‘technology’’ for the ‘‘production’’ or
‘‘development’’ of such microprocessors.
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: Yes: $500 for ‘‘components’’.
N/A for systems and equipment.
GBS: N/A
ENC: Yes for certain EI controlled
commodities, see § 740.17 of the EAR for
eligibility.
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) ECCN 5A002.a controls
‘‘components’’ providing the means or
functions necessary for ‘‘information
security.’’ All such ‘‘components’’ are
presumptively ‘‘specially designed’’ and
controlled by 5A002.a. (2) See USML
Categories XI (including XI(b)) and XIII(b)
(including XIII(b)(2)) for controls on
systems, equipment, and components
described in 5A002.d or .e that are subject
to the ITAR. (3) For ‘‘satellite navigation
system’’ receiving equipment containing or
employing decryption see 7A005, and for
related decryption ‘‘software’’ and
‘‘technology’’ see 7D005 and 7E001. (4)
Noting that items may be controlled
elsewhere on the CCL, examples of items
not controlled by ECCN 5A002.a.4 include
the following: (a) An automobile where the
only ‘cryptography for data confidentiality’
having a ‘described security algorithm’ is
performed by a Category 5—Part 2 Note 3
eligible mobile telephone that is built into
the car. In this case, secure phone
communications support a non-primary
function of the automobile but the mobile
telephone (equipment), as a standalone
item, is not controlled by ECCN 5A002
because it is excluded by the Cryptography
Note (Note 3) (See ECCN 5A992.c). (b) An
exercise bike with an embedded Category
5—Part 2 Note 3 eligible web browser,
where the only controlled cryptography is
performed by the web browser. In this case,
secure web browsing supports a non-
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
primary function of the exercise bike but
the web browser (‘‘software’’), as a
standalone item, is not controlled by ECCN
5D002 because it is excluded by the
Cryptography Note (Note 3) (See ECCN
5D992.c). (5) After classification or selfclassification in accordance with
§ 740.17(b) of the EAR, mass market
encryption commodities that meet
eligibility requirements are released from
‘‘EI’’ and ‘‘NS’’ controls. These
commodities are designated 5A992.c.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Designed or modified to use
‘cryptography for data confidentiality’ having
a ‘described security algorithm’, where that
cryptographic capability is usable, has been
activated, or can be activated by any means
other than secure ‘‘cryptographic activation’’,
as follows:
a.1. Items having ‘‘information security’’ as
a primary function;
a.2. Digital communication or networking
systems, equipment or components, not
specified in paragraph 5A002.a.1;
a.3. Computers, other items having
information storage or processing as a
primary function, and components therefor,
not specified in paragraphs 5A002.a.1 or .a.2;
N.B.: For operating systems see also
5D002.a.1 and .c.1.
a.4. Items, not specified in paragraphs
5A002.a.1 to a.3, where the ‘cryptography for
data confidentiality’ having a ‘described
security algorithm’ meets all of the following:
a.4.a. It supports a non-primary function of
the item; and
a.4.b. It is performed by incorporated
equipment or ‘‘software’’ that would, as a
standalone item, be specified by ECCNs
5A002, 5A003, 5A004, 5B002 or 5D002.
N.B. to paragraph a.4: See Related
Control Paragraph (4) of this ECCN 5A002 for
examples of items not controlled by
5A002.a.4.
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 5A002.a,
‘cryptography for data confidentiality’ means
‘‘cryptography’’ that employs digital
techniques and performs any cryptographic
function other than any of the following:
1.a. ‘‘Authentication;’’
1.b. Digital signature;
1.c. Data integrity;
1.d. Non-repudiation;
1.e. Digital rights management, including
the execution of copy-protected ‘‘software;’’
1.f. Encryption or decryption in support of
entertainment, mass commercial broadcasts
or medical records management; or
1.g. Key management in support of any
function described in paragraphs 1.a to 1.f of
this Technical Note paragraph 1.
2. For the purposes of 5A002.a, ‘described
security algorithm’ means any of the
following:
2.a. A ‘‘symmetric algorithm’’ employing a
key length in excess of 56 bits, not including
parity bits;
2.b. An ‘‘asymmetric algorithm’’ where the
security of the algorithm is based on any of
the following:
2.b.1. Factorization of integers in excess of
512 bits (e.g., RSA);
2.b.2. Computation of discrete logarithms
in a multiplicative group of a finite field of
PO 00000
Frm 00031
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
71961
size greater than 512 bits (e.g., Diffie-Hellman
over Z/pZ); or
2.b.3. Discrete logarithms in a group other
than mentioned in paragraph 2.b.2 of this
Technical Note in excess of 112 bits (e.g.,
Diffie-Hellman over an elliptic curve); or
2.c. An ‘‘asymmetric algorithm’’ where the
security of the algorithm is based on any of
the following:
2.c.1. Shortest vector or closest vector
problems associated with lattices (e.g.,
NewHope, Frodo, NTRUEncrypt, Kyber,
Titanium);
2.c.2. Finding isogenies between
Supersingular elliptic curves (e.g.,
Supersingular Isogeny Key Encapsulation); or
2.c.3. Decoding random codes (e.g.,
McEliece, Niederreiter).
Technical Note: An algorithm described
by Technical Note 2.c. may be referred to as
being post-quantum, quantum-safe or
quantum-resistant.
Note 1: Details of items must be accessible
and provided upon request, in order to
establish any of the following:
a. Whether the item meets the criteria of
5A002.a.1 to a.4; or
b. Whether the cryptographic capability for
data confidentiality specified by 5A002.a is
usable without ‘‘cryptographic activation.’’
Note 2: 5A002.a does not control any of
the following items, or specially designed
‘‘information security’’ components therefor:
a. Smart cards and smart card ‘readers/
writers’ as follows:
a.1. A smart card or an electronically
readable personal document (e.g., token coin,
e-passport) that meets any of the following:
a.1.a. The cryptographic capability meets
all of the following:
a.1.a.1. It is restricted for use in any of the
following:
a.1.a.1.a. Equipment or systems, not
described by 5A002.a.1 to a.4;
a.1.a.1.b. Equipment or systems, not using
‘cryptography for data confidentiality’ having
a ‘described security algorithm’; or
a.1.a.1.c. Equipment or systems, excluded
from 5A002.a by entries b. to f. of this Note;
and
a.1.a.2. It cannot be reprogrammed for any
other use; or
a.1.b. Having all of the following:
a.1.b.1. It is specially designed and limited
to allow protection of ‘personal data’ stored
within;
a.1.b.2. Has been, or can only be,
personalized for public or commercial
transactions or individual identification; and
a.1.b.3. Where the cryptographic capability
is not user-accessible;
Technical Note to paragraph a.1.b.1 of
Note 2: For the purposes of 5A002.a Note
2.a.1.b.1, ‘personal data’ includes any data
specific to a particular person or entity, such
as the amount of money stored and data
necessary for ‘‘authentication.’’
a.2. ‘Readers/writers’ specially designed or
modified, and limited, for items specified by
paragraph a.1 of this Note;
Technical Note to paragraph a.2 of
Note 2: For the purposes of 5A002.a Note
2.a.2, ‘readers/writers’ include equipment
that communicates with smart cards or
electronically readable documents through a
network.
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
71962
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
b. Cryptographic equipment specially
designed and limited for banking use or
‘money transactions’;
Technical Note to paragraph b of Note
2: For the purposes of 5A002.a Note 2.b,
‘money transactions’ in 5A002 Note 2
paragraph b. includes the collection and
settlement of fares or credit functions.
c. Portable or mobile radiotelephones for
civil use (e.g., for use with commercial civil
cellular radio communication systems) that
are not capable of transmitting encrypted
data directly to another radiotelephone or
equipment (other than Radio Access Network
(RAN) equipment), nor of passing encrypted
data through RAN equipment (e.g., Radio
Network Controller (RNC) or Base Station
Controller (BSC));
d. Cordless telephone equipment not
capable of end-to-end encryption where the
maximum effective range of unboosted
cordless operation (i.e., a single, unrelayed
hop between terminal and home base station)
is less than 400 meters according to the
manufacturer’s specifications;
e. Portable or mobile radiotelephones and
similar client wireless devices for civil use,
that implement only published or
commercial cryptographic standards (except
for anti-piracy functions, which may be nonpublished) and also meet the provisions of
paragraphs a.2 to a.4 of the Cryptography
Note (Note 3 in Category 5—Part 2), that have
been customized for a specific civil industry
application with features that do not affect
the cryptographic functionality of these
original non-customized devices;
f. Items, where the ‘‘information security’’
functionality is limited to wireless ‘‘personal
area network’’ functionality implementing
only published or commercial cryptographic
standards;
g. Mobile telecommunications Radio
Access Network (RAN) equipment designed
for civil use, which also meet the provisions
of paragraphs a.2 to a.4 of the Cryptography
Note (Note 3 in Category 5—Part 2), having
an RF output power limited to 0.1W (20 dBm)
or less, and supporting 16 or fewer
concurrent users;
h. Routers, switches, gateways or relays,
where the ‘‘information security’’
functionality is limited to the tasks of
‘‘Operations, Administration or
Maintenance’’ (‘‘OAM’’) implementing only
published or commercial cryptographic
standards;
i. General purpose computing equipment
or servers, where the ‘‘information security’’
functionality meets all of the following:
i.1. Uses only published or commercial
cryptographic standards; and
i.2. Is any of the following:
i.2.a. Integral to a CPU that meets the
provisions of Note 3 in Category 5—Part 2;
i.2.b. Integral to an operating system that
is not specified by 5D002; or
i.2.c. Limited to ‘‘OAM’’ of the equipment;
or
j. Items specially designed for a ‘connected
civil industry application’, meeting all of the
following:
j.1. Being any of the following:
j.1.a. A network-capable endpoint device
meeting any of the following:
j.1.a.1. The ‘‘information security’’
functionality is limited to securing ‘non-
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
arbitrary data’ or the tasks of ‘‘Operations,
Administration or Maintenance’’ (‘‘OAM’’);
or
j.1.a.2. The device is limited to a specific
‘connected civil industry application’; or
j.1.b. Networking equipment meeting all of
the following:
j.1.b.1. Being specially designed to
communicate with the devices specified by
paragraph j.1.a. above; and
j.1.b.2. The ‘‘information security’’
functionality is limited to supporting the
‘connected civil industry application’ of
devices specified by paragraph j.1.a. above,
or the tasks of ‘‘OAM’’ of this networking
equipment or of other items specified by
paragraph j. of this Note; and
j.2. Where the ‘‘information security’’
functionality implements only published or
commercial cryptographic standards, and the
cryptographic functionality cannot easily be
changed by the user.
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 5A002.a Note 2.j,
‘connected civil industry application’ means
a network-connected consumer or civil
industry application other than ‘‘information
security’’, digital communication, general
purpose networking or computing.
2. For the purposes of 5A002.a Note
2.j.1.a.1, ‘non-arbitrary data’ means sensor or
metering data directly related to the stability,
performance or physical measurement of a
system (e.g., temperature, pressure, flow rate,
mass, volume, voltage, physical location,
etc.), that cannot be changed by the user of
the device.
b. Being a ‘cryptographic activation token’;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
5A002.b, a ‘cryptographic activation token’ is
an item designed or modified for any of the
following:
1. Converting, by means of ‘‘cryptographic
activation’’, an item not specified by Category
5–Part 2 into an item specified by 5A002.a or
5D002.c.1, and not released by the
Cryptography Note (Note 3 in Category 5–
Part 2); or
2. Enabling by means of ‘‘cryptographic
activation’’, additional functionality
specified by 5A002.a of an item already
specified by Category 5–Part 2;
c. Designed or modified to use or perform
‘‘quantum cryptography’’;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
5A002.c, ‘‘quantum cryptography’’ is also
known as Quantum Key Distribution (QKD).
d. Designed or modified to use
cryptographic techniques to generate
channelizing codes, scrambling codes or
network identification codes, for systems
using ultra-wideband modulation techniques
and having any of the following:
d.1. A bandwidth exceeding 500 MHz; or
d.2. A ‘‘fractional bandwidth’’ of 20% or
more;
e. Designed or modified to use
cryptographic techniques to generate the
spreading code for ‘‘spread spectrum’’
systems, not specified by 5A002.d, including
the hopping code for ‘‘frequency hopping’’
systems.
*
*
*
*
*
5A004 ‘‘Systems,’’ ‘‘equipment’’ and
‘‘components’’ for defeating, weakening
or bypassing ‘‘information security,’’ as
follows (see List of Items Controlled).
PO 00000
Frm 00032
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT, EI
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
AT applies to entire
entry.
EI applies to entire
entry.
Country chart (see
Supp. No. 1 to part
738)
NS Column 1
AT Column 1
Refer to§ 742.15 of
the EAR
License Requirements Note: See
§ 744.17 of the EAR for additional license
requirements for microprocessors having a
processing speed of 5 GFLOPS or more and
an arithmetic logic unit with an access width
of 32 bit or more, including those
incorporating ‘‘information security’’
functionality, and associated ‘‘software’’ and
‘‘technology’’ for the ‘‘production’’ or
‘‘development’’ of such microprocessors.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: Yes: $500 for ‘‘components.’’
N/A for systems and equipment.
GBS: N/A
ENC: Yes for certain EI controlled
commodities. See § 740.17 of the EAR for
eligibility.
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: ECCN 5A004.a controls
‘‘components’’ providing the means or
functions necessary for ‘‘information
security.’’ All such ‘‘components’’ are
presumptively ‘‘specially designed’’ and
controlled by 5A004.a.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Designed or modified to perform
‘cryptanalytic functions.’
Note: 5A004.a includes systems or
equipment, designed or modified to perform
‘cryptanalytic functions’ by means of reverse
engineering.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
5A004.a, ‘cryptanalytic functions’ are
functions designed to defeat cryptographic
mechanisms in order to derive confidential
variables or sensitive data, including clear
text passwords or cryptographic keys.
b. Items, not specified by ECCNs 4A005 or
5A004.a, designed to perform all of the
following:
b.1. ‘Extract raw data’ from a computing or
communications device; and
b.2. Circumvent ‘‘authentication’’ or
authorization controls of the device, in order
to perform the function described in
5A004.b.1.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
5A004.b.1, ‘extract raw data’ from a
computing or communications device means
to retrieve binary data from a storage
medium, e.g., RAM, flash or hard disk, of the
device without interpretation by the device’s
operating system or filesystem.
Note 1: 5A004.b does not apply to systems
or equipment specially designed for the
‘‘development’’ or ‘‘production’’ of a
computing or communications device.
Note 2: 5A004.b does not include:
a. Debuggers, hypervisors;
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
b. Items limited to logical data extraction;
c. Data extraction items using chip-off or
JTAG; or
d. Items specially designed and limited to
jail-breaking or rooting.
*
*
*
*
*
6A001 Acoustic systems, equipment and
‘‘components,’’ as follows (see List of
Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
AT applies to entire
entry.
Country Chart (See
Supp. No. 1 to part
738)
NS Column 2
AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements
See § 743.1 of the EAR for reporting
requirements for exports under License
Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: $3000; N/A for 6A001.a.1.b.1 object
detection and location systems having a
transmitting frequency below 5 kHz or a
sound pressure level exceeding 210 dB
(reference 1 mPa at 1 m) for equipment with
an operating frequency in the band from 2
kHz to 30 kHz inclusive; 6A001.a.1.e,
6A001.a.2.a.1, a.2.a.2, 6A001.a.2.a.3,
a.2.a.5, a.2.a.6, 6A001.a.2.b; processing
equipment controlled by 6A001.a.2.c, and
‘‘specially designed’’ for real-time
application with towed acoustic
hydrophone arrays; a.2.e.1, a.2.e.2; and
bottom or bay cable systems controlled by
6A001.a.2.f and having processing
equipment ‘‘specially designed’’ for realtime application with bottom or bay cable
systems.
GBS: Yes for 6A001.a.1.b.4.
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be
used to ship commodities in 6A001.a.1.b,
6A001.a.1.e or 6A001.a.2 (except .a.2.a.4)
to any of the destinations listed in Country
Group A:6 (See Supplement No.1 to part
740 of the EAR).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: See also 6A991.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Marine acoustic systems, equipment and
‘‘specially designed’’ ‘‘components’’ therefor,
as follows:
a.1. Active (transmitting or transmittingand-receiving) systems, equipment and
‘‘specially designed’’ ‘‘components’’ therefor,
as follows:
Note: 6A001.a.1 does not control
equipment as follows:
a. Depth sounders operating vertically
below the apparatus, not including a
scanning function exceeding ± 20°, and
limited to measuring the depth of water, the
distance of submerged or buried objects or
fish finding;
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
b. Acoustic beacons, as follows:
1. Acoustic emergency beacons;
2. Pingers ‘‘specially designed’’ for
relocating or returning to an underwater
position.
a.1.a. Acoustic seabed survey equipment as
follows:
a.1.a.1. Surface vessel survey equipment
designed for sea bed topographic mapping
and having all of the following:
a.1.a.1.a. Designed to take measurements at
an angle exceeding 20° from the vertical;
a.1.a.1.b. Designed to measure seabed
topography at seabed depths exceeding 600
m;
a.1.a.1.c.‘Sounding resolution’ less than 2;
and
a.1.a.1.d. ’Enhancement’ of the depth
‘‘accuracy’’ through compensation for all the
following:
a.1.a.1.d.1. Motion of the acoustic sensor;
a.1.a.1.d.2. In-water propagation from
sensor to the seabed and back; and
a.1.a.1.d.3. Sound speed at the sensor;
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 6A001.a.1.a.1.c,
‘sounding resolution’ is the swath width
(degrees) divided by the maximum number of
soundings per swath.
2. For the purposes of 6A001.a.1.a,
‘enhancement’ includes the ability to
compensate by external means.
a.1.a.2. Underwater survey equipment
designed for seabed topographic mapping
and having any of the following:
Technical Note: For the purposes of
6A001.a.1.a.2, the acoustic sensor pressure
rating determines the depth rating.
a.1.a.2.a. Having all of the following:
a.1.a.2.a.1. Designed or modified to operate
at depths exceeding 300 m; and
a.1.a.2.a.2. ‘Sounding rate’ greater than
3,800 m/s; or
Technical Note: For the purposes of
6A001.a.1.a.2.a.2, ‘sounding rate’ is the
product of the maximum speed (m/s) at
which the sensor can operate and the
maximum number of soundings per swath
assuming 100% coverage. For systems that
produce soundings in two directions (3D
sonars), the maximum of the ‘sounding rate’
in either direction should be used.
a.1.a.2.b. Survey equipment, not specified
by 6A001.a.1.a.2.a, having all of the
following:
a.1.a.2.b.1. Designed or modified to operate
at depths exceeding 100 m;
a.1.a.2.b.2. Designed to take measurements
at an angle exceeding 20° from the vertical;
a.1.a.2.b.3. Having any of the following:
a.1.a.2.b.3.a. Operating frequency below
350 kHz; or
a.1.a.2.b.3.b. Designed to measure seabed
topography at a range exceeding 200 m from
the acoustic sensor; and
a.1.a.2.b.4. ‘Enhancement’ of the depth
‘‘accuracy’’ through compensation of all of
the following:
a.1.a.2.b.4.a. Motion of the acoustic sensor;
a.1.a.2.b.4.b. In-water propagation from
sensor to the seabed and back; and
a.1.a.2.b.4.c. Sound speed at the sensor.
a.1.a.3. Side Scan Sonar (SSS) or Synthetic
Aperture Sonar (SAS), designed for seabed
imaging and having all of the following, and
‘‘specially designed’’ transmitting and
receiving acoustic arrays therefor:
PO 00000
Frm 00033
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
71963
a.1.a.3.a. Designed or modified to operate
at depths exceeding 500 m; and
a.1.a.3.b. An ’area coverage rate’ of greater
than 570 m2/s while operating at the
maximum range that it can operate with an
‘along track resolution’ of less than 15 cm;
and
a.1.a.3.c. An ‘across track resolution’ of less
than 15 cm;
Technical Notes:
For the purposes of 6A001.a.1.a.3:
1. ‘Area coverage rate’ (m2/s) is twice the
product of the sonar range (m) and the
maximum speed (m/s) at which the sensor
can operate at that range.
2. ‘Along track resolution’ (cm), for SSS
only, is the product of azimuth (horizontal)
beamwidth (degrees) and sonar range (m)
and 0.873.
3. ‘Across track resolution’ (cm) is 75
divided by the signal bandwidth (kHz).
a.1.b Systems or transmitting and receiving
arrays, designed for object detection or
location, having any of the following:
a.1.b.1. A transmitting frequency below 10
kHz;
a.1.b.2. Sound pressure level exceeding
224dB (reference 1 mPa at 1 m) for equipment
with an operating frequency in the band from
10 kHz to 24 kHz inclusive;
a.1.b.3. Sound pressure level exceeding
235 dB (reference 1 mPa at 1 m) for
equipment with an operating frequency in
the band between 24 kHz and 30 kHz;
a.1.b.4. Forming beams of less than 1° on
any axis and having an operating frequency
of less than 100 kHz;
a.1.b.5. Designed to operate with an
unambiguous display range exceeding 5,120
m; or
a.1.b.6. Designed to withstand pressure
during normal operation at depths exceeding
1,000 m and having transducers with any of
the following:
a.1.b.6.a. Dynamic compensation for
pressure; or
a.1.b.6.b. Incorporating other than lead
zirconate titanate as the transduction
element;
a.1.c. Acoustic projectors, including
transducers, incorporating piezoelectric,
magnetostrictive, electrostrictive,
electrodynamic or hydraulic elements
operating individually or in a designed
combination and having any of the following:
Notes:
1. The control status of acoustic projectors,
including transducers, ‘‘specially designed’’
for other equipment is determined by the
control status of the other equipment.
2. 6A001.a.1.c does not control electronic
sources that direct the sound vertically only,
or mechanical (e.g., air gun or vapor-shock
gun) or chemical (e.g., explosive) sources.
3. Piezoelectric elements specified in
6A001.a.1.c include those made from leadmagnesium-niobate/lead-titanate
(Pb(Mg1/3Nb2/3)O3-PbTiO3, or PMN–PT) single
crystals grown from solid solution or leadindium-niobate/lead-magnesium niobate/
lead-titanate (Pb(In1/2Nb1/2)O3–
Pb(Mg1/3Nb2/3)O3–PbTiO3, or PIN–PMN–PT)
single crystals grown from solid solution.
a.1.c.1. Operating at frequencies below 10
kHz and having any of the following:
a.1.c.1.a. Not designed for continuous
operation at 100% duty cycle and having a
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
71964
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
radiated ‘free-field Source Level (SLRMS)’
exceeding (10log(f) + 169.77)dB (reference 1
mPa at 1 m) where f is the frequency in Hertz
of maximum Transmitting Voltage Response
(TVR) below 10 kHz; or
a.1.c.1.b. Designed for continuous
operation at 100% duty cycle and having a
continuously radiated ‘free-field Source
Level (SLRMS)’ at 100% duty cycle
exceeding (10log(f) + 159.77)dB (reference 1
mPa at 1 m) where f is the frequency in Hertz
of maximum Transmitting Voltage Response
(TVR) below 10 kHz; or
Technical Note: For the purposes of
6A001.a.1.c.1, the ‘free-field Source Level
(SLRMS)’ is defined along the maximum
response axis and in the far field of the
acoustic projector. It can be obtained from
the Transmitting Voltage Response using the
following equation: SLRMS = (TVR + 20log
VRMS) dB (ref 1mPa at 1 m), where SLRMS is
the source level, TVR is the Transmitting
Voltage Response and VRMS is the Driving
Voltage of the Projector.
a.1.c.2. [Reserved]
N.B. See 6A001.a.1.c.1 for items previously
specified in 6A001.a.1.c.2.
a.1.c.3. Side-lobe suppression exceeding 22
dB;
a.1.d. Acoustic systems and equipment,
designed to determine the position of surface
vessels or underwater vehicles and having all
of the following, and ‘‘specially designed’’
‘‘components’’ therefor:
a.1.d.1. Detection range exceeding 1,000 m;
and
a.1.d.2. Determined position error of less
than 10 m rms (root mean square) when
measured at a range of 1,000 m;
Note: 6A001.a.1.d includes:
a. Equipment using coherent ‘‘signal
processing’’ between two or more beacons
and the hydrophone unit carried by the
surface vessel or underwater vehicle;
b. Equipment capable of automatically
correcting speed-of-sound propagation errors
for calculation of a point.
a.1.e. Active individual sonars, ‘‘specially
designed’’ or modified to detect, locate and
automatically classify swimmers or divers,
having all of the following, and ‘‘specially
designed’’ transmitting and receiving
acoustic arrays therefor:
a.1.e.1. Detection range exceeding 530 m;
a.1.e.2. Determined position error of less
than 15 m rms (root mean square) when
measured at a range of 530 m; and
a.1.e.3. Transmitted pulse signal
bandwidth exceeding 3 kHz;
N.B.: For diver detection systems
‘‘specially designed’’ or modified for military
use, see the U.S. Munitions List in the
International Traffic in Arms Regulations
(ITAR) (22 CFR part 121).
Note: For 6A001.a.1.e, where multiple
detection ranges are specified for various
environments, the greatest detection range is
used.
a.2. Passive systems, equipment and
‘‘specially designed’’ ‘‘components’’ therefor,
as follows:
Note: 6A001.a.2 also applies to receiving
equipment, whether or not related in normal
application to separate active equipment,
and ‘‘specially designed’’ components
therefor.
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
a.2.a. Hydrophones having any of the
following:
Note: The control status of hydrophones
‘‘specially designed’’ for other equipment is
determined by the control status of the other
equipment.
Technical Notes:
For the purposes of 6A001.a.2.a:
1. Hydrophones consist of one or more
sensing elements producing a single acoustic
output channel. Those that contain multiple
elements can be referred to as a hydrophone
group.
2. Underwater acoustic transducers
designed to operate as passive receivers are
hydrophones.
a.2.a.1. Incorporating continuous flexible
sensing elements;
a.2.a.2. Incorporating flexible assemblies of
discrete sensing elements with either a
diameter or length less than 20 mm and with
a separation between elements of less than 20
mm;
a.2.a.3. Having any of the following sensing
elements:
a.2.a.3.a. Optical fibers;
a.2.a.3.b. ‘Piezoelectric polymer films’
other than polyvinylidene-fluoride (PVDF)
and its co-polymers {P(VDF-TrFE) and
P(VDF–TFE)};
a.2.a.3.c. ‘Flexible piezoelectric
composites’;
a.2.a.3.d. Lead-magnesium- niobate/leadtitanate (i.e., Pb(Mg1/3Nb2/3)O3-PbTiO3, or
PMN–PT) piezoelectric single crystals grown
from solid solution; or
a.2.a.3.e. Lead-indium-niobate/leadmagnesium niobate/lead-titanate (i.e.,
Pb(In1/2Nb1/2)O3-Pb(Mg1/3Nb2/3)O3–PbTiO3, or
PIN–PMN–PT) piezoelectric single crystals
grown from solid solution;
a.2.a.4. A ‘hydrophone sensitivity’ better
than ¥180dB at any depth with no
acceleration compensation;
a.2.a.5. Designed to operate at depths
exceeding 35 m with acceleration
compensation; or
a.2.a.6. Designed for operation at depths
exceeding 1,000 m and having a ‘hydrophone
sensitivity’ better than ¥230 dB below 4
kHz;
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 6A001.a.2.a.3.b,
‘piezoelectric polymer film’ sensing elements
consist of polarized polymer film that is
stretched over and attached to a supporting
frame or spool (mandrel).
2. For the purposes of 6A001.a.2.a.3.c,
‘flexible piezoelectric composite’ sensing
elements consist of piezoelectric ceramic
particles or fibers combined with an
electrically insulating, acoustically
transparent rubber, polymer or epoxy
compound, where the compound is an
integral part of the sensing elements.
3. For the purposes of 6A001.a.2.a,
‘hydrophone sensitivity’ is defined as twenty
times the logarithm to the base 10 of the ratio
of rms output voltage to a 1 V rms reference,
when the hydrophone sensor, without a preamplifier, is placed in a plane wave acoustic
field with an rms pressure of 1 mPa. For
example, a hydrophone of ¥160 dB
(reference 1 V per mPa) would yield an output
voltage of 10¥8 V in such a field, while one
of ¥180 dB sensitivity would yield only 10¥9
PO 00000
Frm 00034
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
V output. Thus, ¥160 dB is better than ¥180
dB.
a.2.b. Towed acoustic hydrophone arrays
having any of the following:
Technical Note: For the purposes of
6A001.a.2.b, hydrophones arrays consist of a
number of hydrophones providing multiple
acoustic output channels.
a.2.b.1. Hydrophone group spacing of less
than 12.5 m or ‘able to be modified’ to have
hydrophone group spacing of less than 12.5
m;
a.2.b.2. Designed or ‘able to be modified’ to
operate at depths exceeding 35m;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
6A001.a.2.b.2, ‘able to be modified’ in
6A001.a.2.b means having provisions to
allow a change of the wiring or
interconnections to alter hydrophone group
spacing or operating depth limits. These
provisions are: spare wiring exceeding 10%
of the number of wires, hydrophone group
spacing adjustment blocks or internal depth
limiting devices that are adjustable or that
control more than one hydrophone group.
a.2.b.3. Heading sensors controlled by
6A001.a.2.d;
a.2.b.4. Longitudinally reinforced array
hoses;
a.2.b.5. An assembled array of less than 40
mm in diameter;
a.2.b.6. [Reserved];
a.2.b.7. Hydrophone characteristics
controlled by 6A001.a.2.a; or
a.2.b.8. Accelerometer-based hydroacoustic sensors specified by 6A001.a.2.g;
a.2.c. Processing equipment, ‘‘specially
designed’’ for towed acoustic hydrophone
arrays, having ‘‘user-accessible
programmability’’ and time or frequency
domain processing and correlation, including
spectral analysis, digital filtering and
beamforming using Fast Fourier or other
transforms or processes;
a.2.d. Heading sensors having all of the
following:
a.2.d.1. An ‘‘accuracy’’ of better than ± 0.5°;
and
a.2.d.2. Designed to operate at depths
exceeding 35 m or having an adjustable or
removable depth sensing device in order to
operate at depths exceeding 35 m;
N.B.: For inertial heading systems, see
7A003.c.
a.2.e. Bottom or bay-cable hydrophone
arrays having any of the following:
a.2.e.1. Incorporating hydrophones
controlled by 6A001.a.2.a;
a.2.e.2. Incorporating multiplexed
hydrophone group signal modules having all
of the following characteristics:
a.2.e.2.a. Designed to operate at depths
exceeding 35 m or having an adjustable or
removal depth sensing device in order to
operate at depths exceeding 35 m; and
a.2.e.2.b. Capable of being operationally
interchanged with towed acoustic
hydrophone array modules; or
a.2.e.3. Incorporating accelerometer-based
hydro-acoustic sensors specified by
6A001.a.2.g;
a.2.f. Processing equipment, ‘‘specially
designed’’ for bottom or bay cable systems,
having ‘‘user-accessible programmability’’
and time or frequency domain processing
and correlation, including spectral analysis,
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
digital filtering and beamforming using Fast
Fourier or other transforms or processes;
a.2.g. Accelerometer-based hydro-acoustic
sensors having all of the following:
a.2.g.1. Composed of three accelerometers
arranged along three distinct axes;
a.2.g.2. Having an overall ‘acceleration
sensitivity’ better than 48 dB (reference 1,000
mV rms per 1g);
a.2.g.3. Designed to operate at depths
greater than 35 meters; and
a.2.g.4. Operating frequency below 20 kHz;
Note: 6A001.a.2.g does not apply to
particle velocity sensors or geophones.
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 6A001.a.2.g,
accelerometer-based hydro-acoustic sensors
are also known as vector sensors.
2. For the purposes of 6A001.a.2.g.2,
‘acceleration sensitivity’ is defined as twenty
times the logarithm to the base 10 of the ratio
of rms output voltage to a 1 V rms reference,
when the hydro-acoustic sensor, without a
preamplifier, is placed in a plane wave
acoustic field with an rms acceleration of 1
g (i.e., 9.81 m/s2).
b. Correlation-velocity and Dopplervelocity sonar log equipment designed to
measure the horizontal speed of the
equipment carrier relative to the sea bed, as
follows:
b.1. Correlation-velocity sonar log
equipment having any of the following
characteristics:
b.1.a. Designed to operate at distances
between the carrier and the sea bed
exceeding 500 m; or
b.1.b. Having speed ‘‘accuracy’’ better than
1% of speed;
b.2. Doppler-velocity sonar log equipment
having speed ‘‘accuracy’’ better than 1% of
speed;
Note 1: 6A001.b does not apply to depth
sounders limited to any of the following:
a. Measuring the depth of water;
b. Measuring the distance of submerged or
buried objects; or
c. Fish finding.
Note 2: 6A001.b does not apply to
equipment ‘‘specially designed’’ for
installation on surface vessels.
c. [Reserved]
N.B.: For diver deterrent acoustic systems,
see 8A002.r.
6A002 Optical sensors and equipment, and
‘‘components’’ therefor, as follows (see
List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
Reason for Control: NS, MT, CC, RS, AT, UN
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
VerDate Sep<11>2014
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
NS Column 2
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
Control(s)
MT applies to optical
detectors in
6A002.a.1, or a.3
that are ‘‘specially
designed’’ or modified to protect
‘‘missiles’’ against
nuclear effects
(e.g., Electromagnetic Pulse
(EMP), X-rays,
combined blast and
thermal effects),
and usable for
‘‘missiles’’.
RS applies to
6A002.a.1, a.2, a.3
(except a.3.d.2.a
and a.3.e for lead
selenide based
focal plane arrays
(FPAs)), .c, and .f..
CC applies to policemodel infrared
viewers in 6A002.c.
AT applies to entire
entry.
UN applies to
6A002.a.1, a.2, a.3
and .c.
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
MT Column 1
RS Column 1
CC Column 1
AT Column 1
See § 746.1(b) for UN
controls
Reporting Requirements
See § 743.1 of the EAR for reporting
requirements for exports under License
Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: $500 for 6A002.f.
$3000; except N/A for MT and for 6A002.a.1,
a.2, a.3, .c, and .f.
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See USML Category
XII(e) for infrared focal plane arrays, image
intensifier tubes, and related parts and
components, subject to the ITAR. (2) See
USML Category XV(e) for space-qualified
focal plane arrays subject to the ITAR. (3)
See also ECCNs 6A102, 6A202, and 6A992.
(4) See ECCN 0A919 for foreign-made
military commodities that incorporate
commodities described in 6A002. (5)
Section 744.9 imposes a license
requirement on commodities described in
ECCN 6A002 if being exported, reexported,
or transferred (in-country) for use by a
military end-user or for incorporation into
an item controlled by ECCN 0A919. (6) See
USML Categories XII(e) and XV(e)(3) for
read-out integrated circuits ‘‘subject to the
ITAR.’’ (7) See 6B002 for masks and
reticles, ‘‘specially designed’’ for optical
sensors specified by 6A002.a.1.b or
6A002.a.1.d.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Optical detectors as follows:
a.1. ‘‘Space-qualified’’ solid-state detectors
as follows:
PO 00000
Frm 00035
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
71965
Note: For the purposes of 6A002.a.1, solidstate detectors include ‘‘focal plane arrays’’.
a.1.a. ‘‘Space-qualified’’ solid-state
detectors having all of the following:
a.1.a.1. A peak response in the wavelength
range exceeding 10 nm but not exceeding 300
nm; and
a.1.a.2. A response of less than 0.1%
relative to the peak response at a wavelength
exceeding 400 nm;
a.1.b. ‘‘Space-qualified’’ solid-state
detectors having all of the following:
a.1.b.1. A peak response in the wavelength
range exceeding 900 nm but not exceeding
1,200 nm; and
a.1.b.2. A response ‘‘time constant’’ of 95
ns or less;
a.1.c. ‘‘Space-qualified’’ solid-state
detectors having a peak response in the
wavelength range exceeding 1,200 nm but
not exceeding 30,000 nm;
a.1.d. ‘‘Space-qualified’’ ‘‘focal plane
arrays’’ having more than 2,048 elements per
array and having a peak response in the
wavelength range exceeding 300 nm but not
exceeding 900 nm;
a.2. Image intensifier tubes and ‘‘specially
designed’’ ‘‘components’’ therefor, as follows:
Note: 6A002.a.2 does not control nonimaging photomultiplier tubes having an
electron sensing device in the vacuum space
limited solely to any of the following:
a. A single metal anode; or
b. Metal anodes with a center to center
spacing greater than 500 mm.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
6A002.a.2, ‘charge multiplication’ is a form
of electronic image amplification and is
defined as the generation of charge carriers
as a result of an impact ionization gain
process. ‘Charge multiplication’ sensors may
take the form of an image intensifier tube,
solid state detector or ‘‘focal plane array’’.
a.2.a. Image intensifier tubes having all of
the following:
a.2.a.1. A peak response in the wavelength
range exceeding 400 nm but not exceeding
1,050 nm;
a.2.a.2. Electron image amplification using
any of the following:
a.2.a.2.a. A microchannel plate with a hole
pitch (center-to-center spacing) of 12 mm or
less; or
a.2.a.2.b. An electron sensing device with
a non-binned pixel pitch of 500 mm or less,
‘‘specially designed’’ or modified to achieve
‘charge multiplication’ other than by a
microchannel plate; and
a.2.a.3. Any of the following
photocathodes:
a.2.a.3.a. Multialkali photocathodes (e.g.,
S–20 and S–5) having a luminous sensitivity
exceeding 350 mA/lm;
a.2.a.3.b. GaAs or GaInAs photocathodes;
or
a.2.a.3.c. Other ‘‘III–V compound’’
semiconductor photocathodes having a
maximum ‘‘radiant sensitivity’’ exceeding 10
mA/W;
a.2.b. Image intensifier tubes having all of
the following:
a.2.b.1. A peak response in the wavelength
range exceeding 1,050 nm but not exceeding
1,800 nm;
a.2.b.2. Electron image amplification using
any of the following:
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
71966
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
a.2.b.2.a. A microchannel plate with a hole
pitch (center-to-center spacing) of 12 mm or
less; or
a.2.b.2.b. An electron sensing device with
a non-binned pixel pitch of 500 mm or less,
‘‘specially designed’’ or modified to achieve
‘charge multiplication’ other than by a
microchannel plate; and
a.2.b.3. ‘‘III/V compound’’ semiconductor
(e.g., GaAs or GaInAs) photocathodes and
transferred electron photocathodes, having a
maximum ‘‘radiant sensitivity’’ exceeding 15
mA/W;
a.2.c. ‘‘Specially designed’’ ‘‘components’’
as follows:
a.2.c.1. Microchannel plates having a hole
pitch (center-to-center spacing) of 12 mm or
less;
a.2.c.2. An electron sensing device with a
non-binned pixel pitch of 500 mm or less,
‘‘specially designed’’ or modified to achieve
‘charge multiplication’ other than by a
microchannel plate;
a.2.c.3. ‘‘III–V compound’’ semiconductor
(e.g., GaAs or GaInAs) photocathodes and
transferred electron photocathodes;
Note: 6A002.a.2.c.3 does not control
compound semiconductor photocathodes
designed to achieve a maximum ‘‘radiant
sensitivity’’ of any of the following:
a. 10 mA/W or less at the peak response
in the wavelength range exceeding 400 nm
but not exceeding 1,050 nm; or
b. 15 mA/W or less at the peak response
in the wavelength range exceeding 1,050 nm
but not exceeding 1,800 nm.
a.3. Non-‘‘space-qualified’’ ‘‘focal plane
arrays’’ as follows:
N.B.: ‘Microbolometer’ non-‘‘spacequalified’’ ‘‘focal plane arrays’’ are only
specified by 6A002.a.3.f.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
6A002.a.3, linear or two-dimensional multielement detector arrays are referred to as
‘‘focal plane arrays’’;
Note 1: 6A002.a.3 includes
photoconductive arrays and photovoltaic
arrays.
Note 2: 6A002.a.3 does not control:
a. Multi-element (not to exceed 16
elements) encapsulated photoconductive
cells using either lead sulphide or lead
selenide;
b. Pyroelectric detectors using any of the
following:
b.1. Triglycine sulphate and variants;
b.2. Lead-lanthanum-zirconium titanate
and variants;
b.3. Lithium tantalate;
b.4. Polyvinylidene fluoride and variants;
or
b.5. Strontium barium niobate and
variants.
c. ‘‘Focal plane arrays’’ ‘‘specially
designed’’ or modified to achieve ‘charge
multiplication’ and limited by design to have
a maximum ‘‘radiant sensitivity’’ of 10 mA/
W or less for wavelengths exceeding 760 nm,
having all of the following:
c.1. Incorporating a response limiting
mechanism designed not to be removed or
modified; and
c.2. Any of the following:
c.2.a. The response limiting mechanism is
integral to or combined with the detector
element; or
VerDate Sep<11>2014
20:45 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
c.2.b. The ‘‘focal plane array’’ is only
operable with the response limiting
mechanism in place.
d. Thermopile arrays having less than
5,130 elements;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
6A002.a.3 Note 2.c.2.a, a response limiting
mechanism integral to the detector element
is designed not to be removed or modified
without rendering the detector inoperable.
a.3.a. Non-‘‘space-qualified’’ ‘‘focal plane
arrays’’ having all of the following:
a.3.a.1. Individual elements with a peak
response within the wavelength range
exceeding 900 nm but not exceeding 1,050
nm; and
a.3.a.2. Any of the following:
a.3.a.2.a. A response ‘‘time constant’’ of
less than 0.5 ns; or
a.3.a.2.b. ‘‘Specially designed’’ or modified
to achieve ‘charge multiplication’ and having
a maximum ‘‘radiant sensitivity’’ exceeding
10 mA/W;
a.3.b. Non-‘‘space-qualified’’ ‘‘focal plane
arrays’’ having all of the following:
a.3.b.1. Individual elements with a peak
response in the wavelength range exceeding
1,050 nm but not exceeding 1,200 nm; and
a.3.b.2. Any of the following:
a.3.b.2.a. A response ‘‘time constant’’ of 95
ns or less; or
a.3.b.2.b. ‘‘Specially designed’’ or modified
to achieve ‘charge multiplication’ and having
a maximum ‘‘radiant sensitivity’’ exceeding
10 mA/W;
a.3.c. Non-‘‘space-qualified’’ non-linear (2dimensional) ‘‘focal plane arrays’’ having
individual elements with a peak response in
the wavelength range exceeding 1,200 nm but
not exceeding 30,000 nm;
N.B.: Silicon and other material based
‘microbolometer’ non-‘‘space-qualified’’
‘‘focal plane arrays’’ are only specified by
6A002.a.3.f.
a.3.d. Non-‘‘space-qualified’’ linear (1dimensional) ‘‘focal plane arrays’’ having all
of the following:
a.3.d.1. Individual elements with a peak
response in the wavelength range exceeding
1,200 nm but not exceeding 3,000 nm; and
a.3.d.2. Any of the following:
a.3.d.2.a. A ratio of ‘scan direction’
dimension of the detector element to the
‘cross-scan direction’ dimension of the
detector element of less than 3.8; or
a.3.d.2.b. Signal processing in the detector
elements;
Note: 6A002.a.3.d does not control ‘‘focal
plane arrays’’ (not to exceed 32 elements)
having detector elements limited solely to
germanium material.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
6A002.a.3.d, ‘cross-scan direction’ is defined
as the axis parallel to the linear array of
detector elements and the ‘scan direction’ is
defined as the axis perpendicular to the
linear array of detector elements.
a.3.e. Non-‘‘space-qualified’’ linear (1dimensional) ‘‘focal plane arrays’’ having
individual elements with a peak response in
the wavelength range exceeding 3,000 nm but
not exceeding 30,000 nm;
a.3.f. Non-‘‘space-qualified’’ non-linear (2dimensional) infrared ‘‘focal plane arrays’’
based on ‘microbolometer’ material having
individual elements with an unfiltered
PO 00000
Frm 00036
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
response in the wavelength range equal to or
exceeding 8,000 nm but not exceeding 14,000
nm;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
6A002.a.3.f, ‘microbolometer’ is defined as a
thermal imaging detector that, as a result of
a temperature change in the detector caused
by the absorption of infrared radiation, is
used to generate any usable signal.
a.3.g. Non-‘‘space-qualified’’ ‘‘focal plane
arrays’’ having all of the following:
a.3.g.1. Individual detector elements with a
peak response in the wavelength range
exceeding 400 nm but not exceeding 900 nm;
a.3.g.2. ‘‘Specially designed’’ or modified
to achieve ‘charge multiplication’ and having
a maximum ‘‘radiant sensitivity’’ exceeding
10 mA/W for wavelengths exceeding 760 nm;
and
a.3.g.3. Greater than 32 elements;
b. ‘‘Monospectral imaging sensors’’ and
‘‘multispectral imaging sensors’’, designed
for remote sensing applications and having
any of the following:
b.1. An Instantaneous-Field-Of-View
(IFOV) of less than 200 mrad (microradians);
or
b.2. Specified for operation in the
wavelength range exceeding 400 nm but not
exceeding 30,000 nm and having all the
following:
b.2.a. Providing output imaging data in
digital format; and
b.2.b. Having any of the following
characteristics:
b.2.b.1. ‘‘Space-qualified’’; or
b.2.b.2. Designed for airborne operation,
using other than silicon detectors, and having
an IFOV of less than 2.5 mrad (milliradians);
Note: 6A002.b.1 does not control
‘‘monospectral imaging sensors’’ with a peak
response in the wavelength range exceeding
300 nm but not exceeding 900 nm and only
incorporating any of the following non‘‘space-qualified’’ detectors or non -‘‘spacequalified’’ ‘‘focal plane arrays’’:
a. Charge Coupled Devices (CCD) not
designed or modified to achieve ‘charge
multiplication’; or
b. Complementary Metal Oxide
Semiconductor (CMOS) devices not designed
or modified to achieve ‘charge
multiplication’.
c. ‘Direct view’ imaging equipment
incorporating any of the following:
c.1. Image intensifier tubes having the
characteristics listed in 6A002.a.2.a or
6A002.a.2.b;
c.2. ‘‘Focal plane arrays’’ having the
characteristics listed in 6A002.a.3; or
c.3. Solid state detectors specified by
6A002.a.1;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
6A002.c,‘direct view’ refers to imaging
equipment that presents a visual image to a
human observer without converting the
image into an electronic signal for television
display, and that cannot record or store the
image photographically, electronically or by
any other means.
Note: 6A002.c does not control equipment
as follows, when incorporating other than
GaAs or GaInAs photocathodes:
a. Industrial or civilian intrusion alarm,
traffic or industrial movement control or
counting systems;
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
b. Medical equipment;
c. Industrial equipment used for
inspection, sorting or analysis of the
properties of materials;
d. Flame detectors for industrial furnaces;
e. Equipment ‘‘specially designed’’ for
laboratory use.
d. Special support ‘‘components’’ for
optical sensors, as follows:
d.1. ‘‘Space-qualified’’ cryocoolers;
d.2. Non-‘‘space-qualified’’ cryocoolers
having a cooling source temperature below
218 K (¥55 °C), as follows:
d.2.a. Closed cycle type with a specified
Mean-Time-To-Failure (MTTF) or MeanTime-Between-Failures (MTBF), exceeding
2,500 hours;
d.2.b. Joule-Thomson (JT) self-regulating
minicoolers having bore (outside) diameters
of less than 8 mm;
d.3. Optical sensing fibers specially
fabricated either compositionally or
structurally, or modified by coating, to be
acoustically, thermally, inertially,
electromagnetically or nuclear radiation
sensitive.
Note: 6A002.d.3 does not apply to
encapsulated optical sensing fibers
‘‘specially designed’’ for bore hole sensing
applications.
e. [Reserved]
f. ‘Read-Out Integrated Circuits’ (‘ROIC’)
‘‘specially designed’’ for ‘‘focal plane arrays’’
specified by 6A002.a.3.
Note: 6A002.f does not apply to read-out
integrated circuits ‘‘specially designed’’ for
civil automotive applications.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
6A002.f, a ‘Read-Out Integrated Circuit’
(‘ROIC’) is an integrated circuit designed to
underlie or be bonded to a ‘‘focal plane
array’’ (‘‘FPA’’) and used to read-out (i.e.,
extract and register) signals produced by the
detector elements. At a minimum the ‘ROIC’
reads the charge from the detector elements
by extracting the charge and applying a
multiplexing function in a manner that
retains the relative spatial position and
orientation information of the detector
elements for processing inside or outside the
‘ROIC’.
6A003 Cameras, systems or equipment,
and ‘‘components’’ therefor, as follows
(see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, NP, RS, AT, UN
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
NP applies to cameras controlled by
6A003.a.3 or a.4
and to plug-ins in
6A003.a.6 for cameras controlled by
6A003.a.3 or a.4.
VerDate Sep<11>2014
Country chart (see
Supp. No. 1 to part
738)
NS Column 2
NP Column 1
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Control(s)
RS applies to
6A003.b.3,
6A003.b.4.a,
6A003.b.4.c and to
items controlled in
6A003.b.4.b that
have a frame rate
greater than 60 Hz
or that incorporate
a focal plane array
with more than
111,000 elements,
or to items in
6A003.b.4.b when
being exported or
reexported to be
embedded in a civil
product. (But see
§ 742.6(a)(2)(iii)
and (v) for certain
exemptions).
RS applies to items
controlled in
6A003.b.4.b that
have a frame rate
of 60 Hz or less
and that incorporate a focal
plane array with
not more than
111,000 elements if
not being exported
or reexported to be
embedded in a civil
product.
AT applies to entire
entry.
UN applies to
6A003.b.3 and b.4.
Country chart (see
Supp. No. 1 to part
738)
RS Column 1
RS Column 2
AT Column 1
See § 746.1(b) for UN
controls
License Requirement Note: Commodities
that are not subject to the ITAR but are of
the type described in USML Category XII(c)
are controlled as cameras in ECCN 6A003
when they incorporate a camera controlled
in this ECCN.
Reporting Requirements
See § 743.3 of the EAR for thermal camera
reporting for exports that are not authorized
by an individually validated license of
thermal imaging cameras controlled by ECCN
6A003.b.4.b to destinations in Country Group
A:1 (see Supplement No. 1 to part 740 of the
EAR), must be reported to BIS.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: $1,500, except N/A for 6A003.a.3
through a.6, b.1, b.3 and b.4
GBS: N/A
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be
used to ship any commodity in 6A003.b.3
or b.4 to any of the destinations listed in
Country Group A:6 (See Supplement No. 1
to part 740 of the EAR).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See ECCNs 6E001
(‘‘development’’), 6E002 (‘‘production’’), and
6E201 (‘‘use’’) for technology for items
Jkt 262001
PO 00000
Frm 00037
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
71967
controlled under this entry. (2) Also see
ECCN 6A203. (3) See ECCN 0A919 for foreign
made military commodities that incorporate
cameras described in 6A003. (4) Section
744.9 imposes a license requirement on
cameras described in 6A003 if being
exported, reexported, or transferred (incountry) for use by a military end-user or for
incorporation into a commodity controlled
by ECCN 0A919. (5) See USML Category
XII(c) and (e) for cameras subject to the ITAR.
Related Definitions: N/A.
Items:
a. Instrumentation cameras and ‘‘specially
designed’’ ‘‘components’’ therefor, as follows:
Note: Instrumentation cameras, controlled
by 6A003.a.3 to 6A003.a.5, with modular
structures should be evaluated by their
maximum capability, using plug-ins
available according to the camera
manufacturer’s specifications.
a.1. [Reserved]
a.2. [Reserved]
a.3. Electronic streak cameras having
temporal resolution better than 50 ns;
a.4. Electronic framing cameras having a
speed exceeding 1,000,000 frames/s;
a.5. Electronic cameras having all of the
following:
a.5.a. An electronic shutter speed (gating
capability) of less than 1ms per full frame;
and
a.5.b. A read out time allowing a framing
rate of more than 125 full frames per second;
a.6. Plug-ins having all of the following
characteristics:
a.6.a. ‘‘Specially designed’’ for
instrumentation cameras which have
modular structures and that are controlled by
6A003.a; and
a.6.b. Enabling these cameras to meet the
characteristics specified by 6A003.a.3,
6A003.a.4 or 6A003.a.5, according to the
manufacturer’s specifications;
b. Imaging cameras as follows:
Note: 6A003.b does not control television
or video cameras ‘‘specially designed’’ for
television broadcasting.
b.1. Video cameras incorporating solid
state sensors, having a peak response in the
wavelength range exceeding 10 nm, but not
exceeding 30,000 nm and having all of the
following:
b.1.a. Having any of the following:
b.1.a.1. More than 4 × 106 ‘‘active pixels’’
per solid state array for monochrome (black
and white) cameras;
b.1.a.2. More than 4 × 106 ‘‘active pixels’’
per solid state array for color cameras
incorporating three solid state arrays; or
b.1.a.3. More than 12 × 106 ‘‘active pixels’’
for solid state array color cameras
incorporating one solid state array; and
b.1.b. Having any of the following:
b.1.b.1. Optical mirrors controlled by
6A004.a.;
b.1.b.2. Optical control equipment
controlled by 6A004.d.; or
b.1.b.3. The capability for annotating
internally generated ‘camera tracking data’;
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 6A003.b.1, digital
video cameras should be evaluated by the
maximum number of ‘‘active pixels’’ used for
capturing moving images.
2. For the purposes of 6A003.b.1.b.3,
‘camera tracking data’ is the information
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
71968
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
necessary to define camera line of sight
orientation with respect to the earth. This
includes: (1) the horizontal angle the camera
line of sight makes with respect to the earth’s
magnetic field direction and; (2) the vertical
angle between the camera line of sight and
the earth’s horizon.
b.2. Scanning cameras and scanning
camera systems, having all of the following:
b.2.a. A peak response in the wavelength
range exceeding 10 nm, but not exceeding
30,000 nm;
b.2.b. Linear detector arrays with more
than 8,192 elements per array; and
b.2.c. Mechanical scanning in one
direction;
Note: 6A003.b.2 does not apply to
scanning cameras and scanning camera
systems, ‘‘specially designed’’ for any of the
following:
a. Industrial or civilian photocopiers;
b. Image scanners ‘‘specially designed’’ for
civil, stationary, close proximity scanning
applications (e.g., reproduction of images or
print contained in documents, artwork or
photographs); or
c. Medical equipment.
b.3. Imaging cameras incorporating image
intensifier tubes having the characteristics
listed in 6A002.a.2.a or 6A002.a.2.b;
b.4. Imaging cameras incorporating ‘‘focal
plane arrays’’ having any of the following:
b.4.a. Incorporating ‘‘focal plane arrays’’
controlled by 6A002.a.3.a to 6A002.a.3.e;
b.4.b. Incorporating ‘‘focal plane arrays’’
controlled by 6A002.a.3.f; or
b.4.c. Incorporating ‘‘focal plane arrays’’
controlled by 6A002.a.3.g;
Note 1: Imaging cameras described in
6A003.b.4 include ‘‘focal plane arrays’’
combined with sufficient ‘‘signal processing’’
electronics, beyond the read out integrated
circuit, to enable as a minimum the output
of an analog or digital signal once power is
supplied.
Note 2: 6A003.b.4.a does not control
imaging cameras incorporating linear ‘‘focal
plane arrays’’ with 12 elements or fewer, not
employing time-delay-and-integration within
the element and designed for any of the
following:
a. Industrial or civilian intrusion alarm,
traffic or industrial movement control or
counting systems;
b. Industrial equipment used for inspection
or monitoring of heat flows in buildings,
equipment or industrial processes;
c. Industrial equipment used for
inspection, sorting or analysis of the
properties of materials;
d. Equipment ‘‘specially designed’’ for
laboratory use; or
e. Medical equipment.
Note 3: 6A003.b.4.b does not control
imaging cameras having any of the following:
a. A maximum frame rate equal to or less
than 9 Hz;
b. Having all of the following:
1. Having a minimum horizontal or vertical
‘Instantaneous-Field-of-View (IFOV)’ of at
least 2 mrad (milliradians);
2. Incorporating a fixed focal-length lens
that is not designed to be removed;
3. Not incorporating a ‘direct view’ display;
and
Technical Note: For the purposes of
6A003.b.4 Note 3.b.3, ’direct view’ refers to
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
an imaging camera operating in the infrared
spectrum that presents a visual image to a
human observer using a near-to-eye micro
display incorporating any light-security
mechanism.
4. Having any of the following:
a. No facility to obtain a viewable image of
the detected field-of-view; or
b. The camera is designed for a single kind
of application and designed not to be user
modified; or
Technical Note:
For the purposes of 6A003.b.4 Note 3.b.1,
‘Instantaneous-Field-of-View (IFOV)’ is the
lesser figure of the ‘Horizontal IFOV’ or the
‘Vertical IFOV’.
‘Horizontal IFOV’ = horizontal Field-ofView (FOV)/number of horizontal detector
elements.
‘Vertical IFOV’ = vertical Field-of-View
(FOV)/number of vertical detector elements.
c. The camera is ‘‘specially designed’’ for
installation into a civilian passenger land
vehicle and having all of the following:
1. The placement and configuration of the
camera within the vehicle are solely to assist
the driver in the safe operation of the vehicle;
2. Is operable only when installed in any
of the following:
a. The civilian passenger land vehicle for
which it was intended and the vehicle weighs
less than 4,500 kg (gross vehicle weight); or
b. A ‘‘specially designed’’, authorized
maintenance test facility; and
3. Incorporates an active mechanism that
forces the camera not to function when it is
removed from the vehicle for which it was
intended.
Note: When necessary, details of the items
will be provided, upon request, to the Bureau
of Industry and Security in order to ascertain
compliance with the conditions described in
Note 3.b.4 and Note 3.c in this Note to
6A003.b.4.b.
Note 4: 6A003.b.4.c does not apply to
‘imaging cameras’ having any of the
following characteristics:
a. Having all of the following:
1. Where the camera is ‘‘specially
designed’’ for installation as an integrated
component into indoor and wall-plugoperated systems or equipment, limited by
design for a single kind of application, as
follows:
a. Industrial process monitoring, quality
control, or analysis of the properties of
materials;
b. Laboratory equipment ‘‘specially
designed’’ for scientific research;
c. Medical equipment;
d. Financial fraud detection equipment;
and
2. Is only operable when installed in any
of the following:
a. The system(s) or equipment for which it
was intended; or
b. A ‘‘specially designed,’’ authorized
maintenance facility; and
3. Incorporates an active mechanism that
forces the camera not to function when it is
removed from the system(s) or equipment for
which it was intended;
b. Where the camera is ‘‘specially
designed’’ for installation into a civilian
passenger land vehicle or passenger and
vehicle ferries and having all of the following:
PO 00000
Frm 00038
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
1. The placement and configuration of the
camera within the vehicle or ferry are solely
to assist the driver or operator in the safe
operation of the vehicle or ferry;
2. Is only operable when installed in any
of the following:
a. The civilian passenger land vehicle for
which it was intended and the vehicle weighs
less than 4,500 kg (gross vehicle weight);
b. The passenger and vehicle ferry for
which it was intended and having a length
overall (LOA) 65 m or greater; or
c. A ‘‘specially designed’’, authorized
maintenance test facility; and
3. Incorporates an active mechanism that
forces the camera not to function when it is
removed from the vehicle for which it was
intended;
c. Limited by design to have a maximum
‘‘radiant sensitivity’’ of 10 mA/W or less for
wavelengths exceeding 760 nm, having all of
the following:
1. Incorporating a response limiting
mechanism designed not to be removed or
modified; and
2. Incorporates an active mechanism that
forces the camera not to function when the
response limiting mechanism is removed;
and
3. Not ‘‘specially designed’’ or modified for
underwater use; or
d. Having all of the following:
1. Not incorporating a ‘direct view’ or
electronic image display;
2. Has no facility to output a viewable
image of the detected field of view;
3. The ‘‘focal plane array’’ is only operable
when installed in the camera for which it was
intended; and
4. The ‘‘focal plane array’’ incorporates an
active mechanism that forces it to be
permanently inoperable when removed from
the camera for which it was intended.
Note: When necessary, details of the item
will be provided, upon request, to the Bureau
of Industry and Security in order to ascertain
compliance with the conditions described in
Note 4 above.
b.5. Imaging cameras incorporating solidstate detectors specified by 6A002.a.1.
6A004 Optical equipment and
‘‘components,’’ as follows (see List of
Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
AT applies to entire
entry.
Country chart (see
Supp. No. 1 to part
738)
NS Column 2
AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements
See § 743.1 of the EAR for reporting
requirements for exports under License
Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: $3000
GBS: Yes for 6A004.a.1, a.2, a.4, .b, d.2, and
.f.
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
Special Conditions for STA
STA: Paragraph (c)(2) of License Exception
STA may not be used to ship any
commodity in 6A004.c or .d to any of the
destinations listed in Country Group A:6
(See Supplement No. 1 to part 740 of the
EAR).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) For optical mirrors or
‘aspheric optical elements’ ‘‘specially
designed’’ for lithography ‘‘equipment,’’
see ECCN 3B001. (2) See USML Category
XII(e) for gimbals ‘‘subject to the ITAR.’’ (3)
See also 6A994.
Related Definitions: An ‘aspheric optical
element’ is any element used in an optical
system whose imaging surface or surfaces
are designed to depart from the shape of an
ideal sphere.
Items:
a. Optical mirrors (reflectors) as follows:
Technical Note: For the purposes of
6A004.a, Laser Induced Damage Threshold
(LIDT) is measured according to ISO 21254–
1:2011.
a.1. ‘Deformable mirrors’ having an active
optical aperture greater than 10 mm and
having any of the following, and ‘‘specially
designed’’ components therefor:
a.1.a. Having all the following:
a.1.a.1. A mechanical resonant frequency
of 750 Hz or more; and
a.1.a.2. More than 200 actuators; or
a.1.b. A Laser Induced Damage Threshold
(LIDT) being any of the following:
a.1.b.1. Greater than 1 kW/cm2 using a
‘‘CW laser’’; or
a.1.b.2. Greater than 2 J/cm2 using 20 ns
‘‘laser’’ pulses at 20 Hz repetition rate;
Technical Notes:
For the purposes of 6A004.a.1:
1. ‘Deformable mirrors’ are mirrors having
any of the following:
a. A single continuous optical reflecting
surface which is dynamically deformed by
the application of individual torques or
forces to compensate for distortions in the
optical waveform incident upon the mirror;
or
b. Multiple optical reflecting elements that
can be individually and dynamically
repositioned by the application of torques or
forces to compensate for distortions in the
optical waveform incident upon the mirror.
2. ‘Deformable mirrors’ are also known as
adaptive optic mirrors.
a.2. Lightweight monolithic mirrors having
an average ‘‘equivalent density’’ of less than
30 kg/m2 and a total mass exceeding 10 kg;
a.3. Lightweight ‘‘composite’’ or foam
mirror structures having an average
‘‘equivalent density’’ of less than 30 kg/m2
and a total mass exceeding 2 kg;
Note: 6A004.a.2 and 6A004.a.3 do not
apply to mirrors ‘‘specially designed’’ to
direct solar radiation for terrestrial heliostat
installations.
a.4. Mirrors ‘‘specially designed’’ for beam
steering mirror stages specified in
6A004.d.2.a with a flatness of l/10 or better
(l is equal to 633 nm) and having any of the
following:
a.4.a. Diameter or major axis length greater
than or equal to 100 mm; or
a.4.b. Having all of the following:
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
a.4.b.1. Diameter or major axis length
greater than 50 mm but less than 100 mm;
and
a.4.b.2. A Laser Induced Damage Threshold
(LIDT) being any of the following:
a.4.b.2.a. Greater than 10 kW/cm2 using a
‘‘CW laser’’; or
a.4.b.2.b. Greater than 20 J/cm2 using 20 ns
‘‘laser’’ pulses at 20 Hz repetition rate;
N.B. For optical mirrors ‘‘specially
designed’’ for lithography equipment, see
3B001.
b. Optical ‘‘components’’ made from zinc
selenide (ZnSe) or zinc sulfide (ZnS) with
transmission in the wavelength range
exceeding 3,000 nm but not exceeding 25,000
nm and having any of the following:
b.1. Exceeding 100 cm3 in volume; or
b.2. Exceeding 80 mm in diameter or
length of major axis and 20 mm in thickness
(depth);
c. ‘‘Space-qualified’’ ‘‘components’’ for
optical systems, as follows:
c.1. ‘‘Components’’ lightweighted to less
than 20% ‘‘equivalent density’’ compared
with a solid blank of the same aperture and
thickness;
c.2. Raw substrates, processed substrates
having surface coatings (single-layer or multilayer, metallic or dielectric, conducting,
semiconducting or insulating) or having
protective films;
c.3. Segments or assemblies of mirrors
designed to be assembled in space into an
optical system with a collecting aperture
equivalent to or larger than a single optic 1
m in diameter;
c.4. ‘‘Components’’ manufactured from
‘‘composite’’ materials having a coefficient of
linear thermal expansion, in any coordinate
direction, equal to or less than 5 × 10¥6/K;
d. Optical control equipment as follows:
d.1. Equipment ‘‘specially designed’’ to
maintain the surface figure or orientation of
the ‘‘space-qualified’’ ‘‘components’’
controlled by 6A004.c.1 or 6A004.c.3;
d.2. Steering, tracking, stabilisation and
resonator alignment equipment as follows:
d.2.a. Beam steering mirror stages designed
to carry mirrors having diameter or major
axis length greater than 50 mm and having
all of the following, and ‘‘specially designed’’
electronic control equipment therefor:
d.2.a.1. A maximum angular travel of ±26
mrad or more;
d.2.a.2. A mechanical resonant frequency
of 500 Hz or more; and
d.2.a.3. An angular ‘‘accuracy’’ of 10 mrad
(microradians) or less (better);
d.2.b. Resonator alignment equipment
having bandwidths equal to or more than 100
Hz and an ‘‘accuracy’’ of 10 mrad or less
(better);
d.3. Gimbals having all of the following:
d.3.a. A maximum slew exceeding 5°;
d.3.b. A bandwidth of 100 Hz or more;
d.3.c. Angular pointing errors of 200 mrad
(microradians) or less; and
d.3.d. Having any of the following:
d.3.d.1. Exceeding 0.15 m but not
exceeding 1 m in diameter or major axis
length and capable of angular accelerations
exceeding 2 rad (radians)/s2; or
d.3.d.2. Exceeding 1 m in diameter or
major axis length and capable of angular
accelerations exceeding 0.5 rad (radians)/s2;
PO 00000
Frm 00039
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
71969
d.4. [Reserved]
e. ‘Aspheric optical elements’ having all of
the following:
e.1. Largest dimension of the opticalaperture greater than 400 mm;
e.2. Surface roughness less than 1 nm (rms)
for sampling lengths equal to or greater than
1 mm; and
e.3. Coefficient of linear thermal
expansion’s absolute magnitude less than 3 ×
10¥6/K at 25°C;
Technical Note:
1. For the purposes of 6A004.e, an
‘aspheric optical element’ is any element
used in an optical system whose imaging
surface or surfaces are designed to depart
from the shape of an ideal sphere.
2. For the purposes of 6A004.e.2,
manufacturers are not required to measure
the surface roughness unless the optical
element was designed or manufactured with
the intent to meet, or exceed, the control
parameter.
Note: 6A004.e does not control ‘aspheric
optical elements’ having any of the following:
a. Largest optical-aperture dimension less
than 1 m and focal length to aperture ratio
equal to or greater than 4.5:1;
b. Largest optical-aperture dimension
equal to or greater than 1 m and focal length
to aperture ratio equal to or greater than 7:1;
c. Designed as Fresnel, flyeye, stripe, prism
or diffractive optical elements;
d. Fabricated from borosilicate glass
having a coefficient of linear thermal
expansion greater than 2.5 × 10¥6/K at 25 °C;
or
e. An x-ray optical element having inner
mirror capabilities (e.g., tube-type mirrors).
f. Dynamic wavefront measuring
equipment having all of the following:
f.1. ‘Frame rates’ equal to or more than 1
kHz; and
f.2. A wavefront accuracy equal to or less
(better) than l/20 at the designed wavelength.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
6A004.f, ‘frame rate’ is a frequency at which
all ‘‘active pixels’’ in the ‘‘focal plane array’’
are integrated for recording images projected
by the wavefront sensor optics.
6A005 ‘‘Lasers’’, ‘‘components’’ and optical
equipment, as follows (see List of Items
Controlled), excluding items that are
subject to the export licensing authority
of the Nuclear Regulatory Commission
(see 10 CFR part 110).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, NP, AT
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
NP applies to lasers
controlled by
6A005.a.2, a.3, a.4,
b.2.b, b.3, b.4,
b.6.c, c.1.b, c.2.b,
d.2, d.3.c, or d.4.c
that meet or exceed the technical
parameters described in 6A205.
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
NS Column 2
NP Column 1
71970
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
Control(s)
AT applies to entire
entry.
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
AT Column 1
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A for NP items
$3000 for all other items
GBS: Neodymium-doped (other than glass)
‘‘lasers’’ controlled by 6A005.b.6.d.2
(except 6A005.b.6.d.2.b) that have an
output wavelength exceeding 1,000 nm,
but not exceeding 1,100 nm, and an
average or CW output power not exceeding
2 kW, and operate in a pulse-excited, non‘‘Q-switched’’ multiple-transverse mode, or
in a continuously excited, multipletransverse mode; Dye and Liquid Lasers
controlled by 6A005.c.1, c.2 and c.3,
except for a pulsed single longitudinal
mode oscillator having an average output
power exceeding 1 W and a repetition rate
exceeding 1 kHz if the ‘‘pulse duration’’ is
less than 100 ns; CO ‘‘lasers’’ controlled by
6A005.d.2 having a CW maximum rated
single or multimode output power not
exceeding 10 kW; CO2 or CO/CO2 ‘‘lasers’’
controlled by 6A005.d.3 having an output
wavelength in the range from 9,000 to
11,000 nm and having a pulsed output not
exceeding 2 J per pulse and a maximum
rated average single or multimode output
power not exceeding 5 kW; and CO2
‘‘lasers’’ controlled by 6A005.d.3 that
operate in CW multiple-transverse mode,
and having a CW output power not
exceeding 15 kW.
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls (1) See ECCN 6D001 for
‘‘software’’ for items controlled under this
entry. (2) See ECCNs 6E001
(‘‘development’’), 6E002 (‘‘production’’),
and 6E201 (‘‘use’’) for technology for items
controlled under this entry. (3) Also see
ECCNs 6A205 and 6A995. (4) See ECCN
3B001 for excimer ‘‘lasers’’ ‘‘specially
designed’’ for lithography equipment. (5)
‘‘Lasers’’ ‘‘especially designed’’ or prepared
for use in isotope separation are subject to
the export licensing authority of the
Nuclear Regulatory Commission (see 10
CFR part 110). (6) See USML Category
XII(b) and (e) for laser systems or lasers
subject to the ITAR. (7) See USML Category
XVIII for certain laser-based directed
energy weapon systems, equipment, and
components subject to the ITAR.
Related Definitions: For the purposes of
6A005: (1) ‘Wall-plug efficiency’ is defined
as the ratio of ‘‘laser’’ output power (or
‘‘average output power’’) to total electrical
input power required to operate the
‘‘laser’’, including the power supply/
conditioning and thermal conditioning/
heat exchanger, see 6A005.a.6.b.1 and
6A005.b.6; (2) ‘Non-repetitive pulsed’
refers to ‘‘lasers’’ that produce either a
single output pulse or that have a time
interval between pulses exceeding one
minute, see Note 2 of 6A005 and
6A005.d.6.
Items:
Notes:
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
1. Pulsed ‘‘lasers’’ include those that run
in a continuous wave (CW) mode with pulses
superimposed.
2. Excimer, semiconductor, chemical, CO,
CO2, and ‘non-repetitive pulsed’ Nd:glass
‘‘lasers’’ are only specified by 6A005.d.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
6A005 Note 2, ‘non-repetitive pulsed’ refers
to ‘‘lasers’’ that produce either a single
output pulse or that have a time interval
between pulses exceeding one minute.
3. 6A005 includes fiber ‘‘lasers’’.
4. The control status of ‘‘lasers’’
incorporating frequency conversion (i.e.,
wavelength change) by means other than one
‘‘laser’’ pumping another ‘‘laser’’ is
determined by applying the control
parameters for both the output of the source
‘‘laser’’ and the frequency-converted optical
output.
5. 6A005 does not control ‘‘lasers’’ as
follows:
a. Ruby with output energy below 20 J;
b. Nitrogen;
c. Krypton.
6. For the purposes of 6A005.a and
6A005.b, ‘single transverse mode’ refers to
‘‘lasers’’ with a beam profile having an M2factor of less than 1.3, while ‘multiple
transverse mode’ refers to ‘‘lasers’’ with a
beam profile having an M2-factor of 1.3 or
higher
a. Non-‘‘tunable’’ continuous wave ‘‘(CW)
lasers’’ having any of the following:
a.1. Output wavelength less than 150 nm
and output power exceeding 1W;
a.2. Output wavelength of 150 nm or more
but not exceeding 510 nm and output power
exceeding 30 W;
Note: 6A005.a.2 does not control Argon
‘‘lasers’’ having an output power equal to or
less than 50 W.
a.3. Output wavelength exceeding 510 nm
but not exceeding 540 nm and any of the
following:
a.3.a. ‘Single transverse mode’ output and
output power exceeding 50 W; or
a.3.b. ‘Multiple transverse mode’ output
and output power exceeding 150 W;
a.4. Output wavelength exceeding 540 nm
but not exceeding 800 nm and output power
exceeding 30 W;
a.5. Output wavelength exceeding 800 nm
but not exceeding 975 nm and any of the
following:
a.5.a. ‘Single transverse mode’ output and
output power exceeding 50 W; or
a.5.b. ‘Multiple transverse mode’ output
and output power exceeding 80 W;
a.6. Output wavelength exceeding 975 nm
but not exceeding 1,150 nm and any of the
following;
a.6.a. ‘Single transverse mode’ output and
any of the following:
a.6.a.1. Output power exceeding 1,000 W;
or
a.6.a.2. Having all of the following:
a.6.a.2.a. Output power exceeding 500 W;
and
a.6.a.2.b. Spectral bandwidth less than 40
GHz; or
a.6.b. ‘Multiple transverse mode’ output
and any of the following:
a.6.b.1. ‘Wall-plug efficiency’ exceeding
18% and output power exceeding 1,000 W;
or
PO 00000
Frm 00040
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
a.6.b.2. Output power exceeding 2 kW;
Note 1: 6A005.a.6.b does not control
‘multiple transverse mode’, industrial
‘‘lasers’’ with output power exceeding 2 kW
and not exceeding 6 kW with a total mass
greater than 1,200 kg. For the purpose of this
note, total mass includes all ‘‘components’’
required to operate the ‘‘laser,’’ e.g., ‘‘laser,’’
power supply, heat exchanger, but excludes
external optics for beam conditioning or
delivery.
Note 2: 6A005.a.6.b does not apply to
‘multiple transverse mode’, industrial
‘‘lasers’’ having any of the following:
a. [Reserved];
b. Output power exceeding 1 kW but not
exceeding 1.6 kW and having a BPP
exceeding 1.25 mm·mrad;
c. Output power exceeding 1.6 kW but not
exceeding 2.5 kW and having a BPP
exceeding 1.7 mm·mrad;
d. Output power exceeding 2.5 kW but not
exceeding 3.3 kW and having a BPP
exceeding 2.5 mm·mrad;
e. Output power exceeding 3.3 kW but not
exceeding 6 kW and having a BPP exceeding
3.5 mm·mrad;
f. [Reserved]
g. [Reserved]
h. Output power exceeding 6 kW but not
exceeding 8 kW and having a BPP exceeding
12 mm·mrad; or
i. Output power exceeding 8 kW but not
exceeding 10 kW and having a BPP
exceeding 24 mm·mrad;
a.7. Output wavelength exceeding 1,150
nm but not exceeding 1,555 nm and any of
the following:
a.7.a. ‘Single transverse mode’ and output
power exceeding 50 W; or
a.7.b. ‘Multiple transverse mode’ and
output power exceeding 80 W;
a.8. Output wavelength exceeding 1,555
nm but not exceeding 1,850 nm and output
power exceeding 1 W;
a.9. Output wavelength exceeding 1,850
nm but not exceeding 2,100 nm, and any of
the following:
a.9.a. ‘Single transverse mode’ and output
power exceeding 1 W; or
a.9.b. ‘Multiple transverse mode’ output
and output power exceeding 120 W; or
a.10. Output wavelength exceeding 2,100
nm and output power exceeding 1 W;
b. Non-‘‘tunable’’ ‘‘pulsed lasers’’ having
any of the following:
b.1. Output wavelength less than 150 nm
and any of the following:
b.1.a. Output energy exceeding 50 mJ per
pulse and ‘‘peak power’’ exceeding 1 W; or
b.1.b. ‘‘Average output power’’ exceeding 1
W;
b.2. Output wavelength of 150 nm or more
but not exceeding 510 nm and any of the
following:
b.2.a. Output energy exceeding 1.5 J per
pulse and ‘‘peak power’’ exceeding 30 W; or
b.2.b. ‘‘Average output power’’ exceeding
30 W;
Note: 6A005.b.2.b does not control Argon
‘‘lasers’’ having an ‘‘average output power’’
equal to or less than 50 W.
b.3. Output wavelength exceeding 510 nm,
but not exceeding 540 nm and any of the
following:
b.3.a. ‘Single transverse mode’ output and
any of the following:
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
b.3.a.1. Output energy exceeding 1.5 J per
pulse and ‘‘peak power’’ exceeding 50 W; or
b.3.a.2. ‘‘Average output power’’ exceeding
80 W; or
b.3.b. ‘Multiple transverse mode’ output
and any of the following:
b.3.b.1. Output energy exceeding 1.5 J per
pulse and ‘‘peak power’’ exceeding 150 W; or
b.3.b.2. ‘‘Average output power’’ exceeding
150 W;
b.4. Output wavelength exceeding 540 nm
but not exceeding 800 nm and any of the
following:
b.4.a. ‘‘Pulse duration’’ less than 1 ps and
any of the following:
b.4.a.1. Output energy exceeding 0.005 J
per pulse and ‘‘peak power’’ exceeding 5 GW;
or
b.4.a.2. ‘‘Average output power’’ exceeding
20 W; or
b.4.b. ‘‘Pulse duration’’ equal to or
exceeding 1 ps and any of the following:
b.4.b.1. Output energy exceeding 1.5 J per
pulse and ‘‘peak power’’ exceeding 30 W; or
b.4.b.2. ‘‘Average output power’’ exceeding
30 W;
b.5. Output wavelength exceeding 800 nm
but not exceeding 975 nm and any of the
following:
b.5.a. ‘‘Pulse duration’’ less than 1ps and
any of the following:
b.5.a.1. Output energy exceeding 0.005 J
per pulse and ‘‘peak power’’ exceeding 5 GW;
or
b.5.a.2. ‘Single transverse mode’ output
and ‘‘average output power’’ exceeding 20 W;
b.5.b. ‘‘Pulse duration’’ equal to or
exceeding 1 ps and not exceeding 1 ms and
any of the following:
b.5.b.1. Output energy exceeding 0.5 J per
pulse and ‘‘peak power’’ exceeding 50 W;
b.5.b.2. ‘Single transverse mode’ output
and ‘‘average output power’’ exceeding 20 W;
or
b.5.b.3. ‘Multiple transverse mode’ output
and ‘‘average output power’’ exceeding 50 W;
or
b.5.c. ‘‘Pulse duration’’ exceeding 1 ms and
any of the following:
b.5.c.1. Output energy exceeding 2 J per
pulse and ‘‘peak power’’ exceeding 50 W;
b.5.c.2. ‘Single transverse mode’ output
and ‘‘average output power’’ exceeding 50 W;
or
b.5.c.3. ‘Multiple transverse mode’ output
and ‘‘average output power’’ exceeding 80 W.
b.6. Output wavelength exceeding 975 nm
but not exceeding 1,150 nm and any of the
following:
b.6.a. ‘‘Pulse duration’’ of less than 1 ps,
and any of the following:
b.6.a.1. Output ‘‘peak power’’ exceeding 2
GW per pulse;
b.6.a.2. ‘‘Average output power’’ exceeding
30 W; or
b.6.a.3. Output energy exceeding 0.002 J
per pulse;
b.6.b. ‘‘Pulse duration’’ equal to or
exceeding 1 ps and less than 1 ns, and any
of the following:
b.6.b.1. Output ‘‘peak power’’ exceeding 5
GW per pulse;
b.6.b.2. ‘‘Average output power’’ exceeding
50 W; or
b.6.b.3. Output energy exceeding 0.1 J per
pulse;
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
b.6.c. ‘‘Pulse duration’’ equal to or
exceeding 1 ns but not exceeding 1 ms and
any of the following:
b.6.c.1. ‘Single transverse mode’ output
and any of the following:
b.6.c.1.a. ‘‘Peak power’’ exceeding 100
MW;
b.6.c.1.b. ‘‘Average output power’’
exceeding 20 W limited by design to a
maximum pulse repetition frequency less
than or equal to 1 kHz;
b.6.c.1.c. ‘Wall-plug efficiency’ exceeding
12%, ‘‘average output power’’ exceeding 100
W and capable of operating at a pulse
repetition frequency greater than 1 kHz;
b.6.c.1.d. ‘‘Average output power’’
exceeding 150 W and capable of operating at
a pulse repetition frequency greater than 1
kHz; or
b.6.c.1.e. Output energy exceeding 2 J per
pulse; or
b.6.c.2. ‘Multiple transverse mode’ output
and any of the following:
b.6.c.2.a. ‘‘Peak power’’ exceeding 400
MW;
b.6.c.2.b. ‘Wall-plug efficiency’ exceeding
18% and ‘‘average output power’’ exceeding
500 W;
b.6.c.2.c. ‘‘Average output power’’
exceeding 2 kW; or
b.6.c.2.d. Output energy exceeding 4 J per
pulse; or
b.6.d. ‘‘Pulse duration’’ exceeding 1 ms and
any of the following:
b.6.d.1. ‘Single transverse mode’ output
and any of the following:
b.6.d.1.a. ‘‘Peak power’’ exceeding 500 kW;
b.6.d.1.b. ‘Wall-plug efficiency’ exceeding
12% and ‘‘average output power’’ exceeding
100 W; or
b.6.d.1.c. ‘‘Average output power’’
exceeding 150 W; or
b.6.d.2. ‘Multiple transverse mode’ output
and any of the following:
b.6.d.2.a. ‘‘Peak power’’ exceeding 1 MW;
b.6.d.2.b. ‘Wall-plug efficiency’ exceeding
18% and ‘‘average output power’’ exceeding
500 W; or
b.6.d.2.c. ‘‘Average output power’’
exceeding 2 kW;
b.7. Output wavelength exceeding 1,150
nm but not exceeding 1,555 nm and any of
the following:
b.7.a. ‘‘Pulse duration’’ not exceeding 1 ms
and any of the following:
b.7.a.1. Output energy exceeding 0.5 J per
pulse and ‘‘peak power’’ exceeding 50 W;
b.7.a.2. ‘Single transverse mode’ output
and ‘‘average output power’’ exceeding 20 W;
or
b.7.a.3. ‘Multiple transverse mode’ output
and ‘‘average output power’’ exceeding 50 W;
or
b.7.b. ‘‘Pulse duration’’ exceeding 1 ms and
any of the following:
b.7.b.1. Output energy exceeding 2 J per
pulse and ‘‘peak power’’ exceeding 50 W;
b.7.b.2. ‘Single transverse mode’ output
and ‘‘average output power’’ exceeding 50 W;
or
b.7.b.3. ‘Multiple transverse mode’ output
and ‘‘average output power’’ exceeding 80 W;
b.8. Output wavelength exceeding 1,555
nm but not exceeding 1,850 nm, and any of
the following:
b.8.a. Output energy exceeding 100 mJ per
pulse and ‘‘peak power’’ exceeding 1 W; or
PO 00000
Frm 00041
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
71971
b.8.b. ‘‘Average output power’’ exceeding 1
W;
b.9. Output wavelength exceeding 1,850
nm but not exceeding 2,100 nm, and any of
the following:
b.9.a. ‘Single transverse mode’ and any of
the following:
b.9.a.1. Output energy exceeding 100 mJ
per pulse and ‘‘peak power’’ exceeding 1 W;
or
b.9.a.2. ‘‘Average output power’’ exceeding
1 W;
b.9.b. ‘Multiple transverse mode’ and any
of the following:
b.9.b.1. Output energy exceeding 100 mJ
per pulse and ‘‘peak power’’ exceeding 10
kW; or
b.9.b.2. ‘‘Average output power’’ exceeding
120 W; or
b.10. Output wavelength exceeding 2,100
nm and any of the following:
b.10.a. Output energy exceeding 100 mJ per
pulse and ‘‘peak power’’ exceeding 1 W; or
b.10.b. ‘‘Average output power’’ exceeding
1 W;
c. ‘‘Tunable’’ lasers having any of the
following:
c.1. Output wavelength less than 600 nm
and any of the following:
c.1.a. Output energy exceeding 50 mJ per
pulse and ‘‘peak power’’ exceeding 1 W; or
c.1.b. Average or CW output power
exceeding 1W;
Note: 6A005.c.1 does not apply to dye
‘‘lasers’’ or other liquid ‘‘lasers,’’ having a
multimode output and a wavelength of 150
nm or more but not exceeding 600 nm and
all of the following:
1. Output energy less than 1.5 J per pulse
or a ‘‘peak power’’ less than 20 W; and
2. Average or CW output power less than
20 W.
c.2. Output wavelength of 600 nm or more
but not exceeding 1,400 nm, and any of the
following:
c.2.a. Output energy exceeding 1 J per
pulse and ‘‘peak power’’ exceeding 20 W; or
c.2.b. Average or CW output power
exceeding 20 W; or
c.3. Output wavelength exceeding 1,400
nm and any of the following:
c.3.a. Output energy exceeding 50 mJ per
pulse and ‘‘peak power’’ exceeding 1 W; or
c.3.b. Average or CW output power
exceeding 1 W;
d. Other ‘‘lasers’’, not controlled by
6A005.a, 6A005.b, or 6A005.c as follows:
d.1. Semiconductor ‘‘lasers’’ as follows:
Notes:
1. 6A005.d.1 includes semiconductor
‘‘lasers’’ having optical output connectors
(e.g., fiber optic pigtails).
2. The control status of semiconductor
‘‘lasers’’ ‘‘specially designed’’ for other
equipment is determined by the control
status of the other equipment.
d.1.a. Individual single-transverse mode
semiconductor ‘‘lasers’’ having any of the
following:
d.1.a.1. Wavelength equal to or less than
1,570 nm and average or CW output power,
exceeding 2.0 W; or
d.1.a.2. Wavelength greater than 1,570 nm
and average or CW output power, exceeding
500 mW;
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
71972
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
d.1.b. Individual ‘multiple-transverse
mode’ semiconductor ‘‘lasers’’ having any of
the following:
d.1.b.1. Wavelength of less than 1,400 nm
and average or CW output power, exceeding
25 W;
d.1.b.2. Wavelength equal to or greater than
1,400 nm and less than 1,900 nm and average
or CW output power, exceeding 2.5 W; or
d.1.b.3. Wavelength equal to or greater than
1,900 nm and average or CW output power,
exceeding 1 W;
d.1.c. Individual semiconductor ‘‘laser’’
‘bars’ having any of the following:
d.1.c.1. Wavelength of less than 1,400 nm
and average or CW output power, exceeding
100 W;
d.1.c.2. Wavelength equal to or greater than
1,400 nm and less than 1,900 nm and average
or CW output power, exceeding 25 W; or
d.1.c.3. Wavelength equal to or greater than
1,900 nm and average or CW output power,
exceeding 10 W;
d.1.d. Semiconductor ‘‘laser’’ ‘stacked
arrays’ (two dimensional arrays) having any
of the following:
d.1.d.1. Wavelength less than 1,400 nm
and having any of the following:
d.1.d.1.a. Average or CW total output
power less than 3 kW and having average or
CW output ‘power density’ greater than 500
W/cm2;
d.1.d.1.b. Average or CW total output
power equal to or exceeding 3 kW but less
than or equal to 5 kW, and having average
or CW output ‘power density’ greater than
350W/cm2;
d.1.d.1.c. Average or CW total output
power exceeding 5 kW;
d.1.d.1.d. Peak pulsed ‘power density’
exceeding 2,500 W/cm2; or
Note: 6A005.d.1.d.1.d does not apply to
epitaxially-fabricated monolithic devices.
d.1.d.1.e. Spatially coherent average or CW
total output power, greater than 150 W;
d.1.d.2. Wavelength greater than or equal
to 1,400 nm but less than 1,900 nm, and
having any of the following:
d.1.d.2.a. Average or CW total output
power less than 250 W and average or CW
output ‘power density’ greater than 150 W/
cm2;
d.1.d.2.b. Average or CW total output
power equal to or exceeding 250 W but less
than or equal to 500 W, and having average
or CW output ‘power density’ greater than
50W/cm2;
d.1.d.2.c. Average or CW total output
power exceeding 500 W;
d.1.d.2.d. Peak pulsed ‘power density’
exceeding 500 W/cm2; or
Note: 6A005.d.1.d.2.d does not apply to
epitaxially-fabricated monolithic devices.
d.1.d.2.e. Spatially coherent average or CW
total output power, exceeding 15 W;
d.1.d.3. Wavelength greater than or equal
to 1,900 nm and having any of the following:
d.1.d.3.a. Average or CW output ‘power
density’ greater than 50 W/cm2;
d.1.d.3.b. Average or CW output power
greater than 10 W; or
d.1.d.3.c. Spatially coherent average or CW
total output power, exceeding 1.5 W; or
d.1.d.4. At least one ‘‘laser’’ ‘bar’ specified
by 6A005.d.1.c;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
6A005.d.1.d, ’power density’ means the total
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
‘‘laser’’ output power divided by the emitter
surface area of the ‘stacked array’.
d.1.e. Semiconductor ‘‘laser’’ ‘stacked
arrays’, other than those specified by
6A005.d.1.d, having all of the following:
d.1.e.1. ‘‘Specially designed’’ or modified
to be combined with other ‘stacked arrays’ to
form a larger ‘stacked array’; and
d.1.e.2. Integrated connections, common
for both electronics and cooling;
Note 1: ‘Stacked arrays’, formed by
combining semiconductor ‘‘laser’’ ‘stacked
arrays’ specified by 6A005.d.1.e, that are not
designed to be further combined or modified
are specified by 6A005.d.1.d.
Note 2: ‘Stacked arrays’, formed by
combining semiconductor ‘‘laser’’ ‘stacked
arrays’ specified by 6A005.d.1.e, that are
designed to be further combined or modified
are specified by 6A005.d.1.e.
Note 3: 6A005.d.1.e does not apply to
modular assemblies of single ‘bars’ designed
to be fabricated into end to end stacked
linear arrays.
Technical Notes:
For the purposes of 6A005.d.1.e:
1. Semiconductor ‘‘lasers’’ are commonly
called ‘‘laser’’ diodes.
2. A ‘bar’ (also called a semiconductor
‘‘laser’’ ‘bar’, a ‘‘laser’’ diode ‘bar’ or diode
‘bar’) consists of multiple semiconductor
‘‘lasers’’ in a one-dimensional array.
3. A ‘stacked array’ consists of multiple
‘bars’ forming a two-dimensional array of
semiconductor ‘‘lasers’’.
d.2. Carbon monoxide (CO) ‘‘lasers’’ having
any of the following:
d.2.a. Output energy exceeding 2 J per
pulse and ‘‘peak power’’ exceeding 5 kW; or
d.2.b. Average or CW output power,
exceeding 5 kW;
d.3. Carbon dioxide (CO2) ‘‘lasers’’ having
any of the following:
d.3.a. CW output power exceeding 15 kW;
d.3.b. Pulsed output with ‘‘pulse duration’’
exceeding 10 ms and any of the following:
d.3.b.1. ‘‘Average output power’’ exceeding
10 kW; or
d.3.b.2. ‘‘Peak power’’ exceeding 100 kW;
or
d.3.c. Pulsed output with a ‘‘pulse
duration’’ equal to or less than 10 ms and any
of the following:
d.3.c.1. Pulse energy exceeding 5 J per
pulse; or
d.3.c.2. ‘‘Average output power’’ exceeding
2.5 kW;
d.4. Excimer ‘‘lasers’’ having any of the
following:
d.4.a. Output wavelength not exceeding
150 nm and any of the following:
d.4.a.1. Output energy exceeding 50 mJ per
pulse; or
d.4.a.2. ‘‘Average output power’’ exceeding
1 W;
d.4.b. Output wavelength exceeding 150
nm but not exceeding 190 nm and any of the
following:
d.4.b.1. Output energy exceeding 1.5 J per
pulse; or
d.4.b.2. ‘‘Average output power’’ exceeding
120 W;
d.4.c. Output wavelength exceeding 190
nm but not exceeding 360 nm and any of the
following:
d.4.c.1. Output energy exceeding 10 J per
pulse; or
PO 00000
Frm 00042
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
d.4.c.2. ‘‘Average output power’’ exceeding
500 W; or
d.4.d. Output wavelength exceeding 360
nm and any of the following:
d.4.d.1. Output energy exceeding 1.5 J per
pulse; or
d.4.d.2. ‘‘Average output power’’ exceeding
30 W;
Note: For excimer ‘‘lasers’’ ‘‘specially
designed’’ for lithography equipment, see
3B001.
d.5. ‘‘Chemical lasers’’ as follows:
d.5.a. Hydrogen Fluoride (HF) ‘‘lasers’;
d.5.b. Deuterium Fluoride (DF) ‘‘lasers’’;
d.5.c. ‘Transfer lasers’ as follows:
d.5.c.1. Oxygen Iodine (O2-I) ‘‘lasers’’;
d.5.c.2. Deuterium Fluoride-Carbon
dioxide (DF–CO2) ‘‘lasers’’;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
6A005.d.5.c, ‘transfer lasers’ are ‘‘lasers’’ in
which the lasing species are excited through
the transfer of energy by collision of a nonlasing atom or molecule with a lasing atom
or molecule species.
d.6. ‘Non-repetitive pulsed’ Neodymium
(Nd) glass ‘‘lasers’’ having any of the
following:
d.6.a. A ‘‘pulse duration’’ not exceeding 1
ms and output energy exceeding 50 J per
pulse; or
d.6.b. A ‘‘pulse duration’’ exceeding 1 ms
and output energy exceeding 100 J per pulse;
e. ‘‘Components’’ as follows:
e.1. Mirrors cooled either by ‘active
cooling’ or by heat pipe cooling;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
6A005.e.1, ‘active cooling’ is a cooling
technique for optical ‘‘components’’ using
flowing fluids within the subsurface
(nominally less than 1 mm below the optical
surface) of the optical component to remove
heat from the optic.
e.2. Optical mirrors or transmissive or
partially transmissive optical or electrooptical-’’components,’’ other than fused
tapered fiber combiners and Multi-Layer
Dielectric gratings (MLDs), ‘‘specially
designed’’ for use with controlled ‘‘lasers’’;
Note to 6A005.e.2: Fiber combiners and
MLDs are specified by 6A005.e.3.
e.3. Fiber ‘‘laser’’ ‘‘components’’ as follows:
e.3.a. Multimode to multimode fused
tapered fiber combiners having all of the
following:
e.3.a.1. An insertion loss better (less) than
or equal to 0.3 dB maintained at a rated total
average or CW output power (excluding
output power transmitted through the single
mode core if present) exceeding 1,000 W; and
e.3.a.2. Number of input fibers equal to or
greater than 3;
e.3.b. Single mode to multimode fused
tapered fiber combiners having all of the
following:
e.3.b.1. An insertion loss better (less) than
0.5 dB maintained at a rated total average or
CW output power exceeding 4,600 W;
e.3.b.2. Number of input fibers equal to or
greater than 3; and
e.3.b.3. Having any of the following:
e.3.b.3.a. A Beam Parameter Product (BPP)
measured at the output not exceeding 1.5 mm
mrad for a number of input fibers less than
or equal to 5; or
e.3.b.3.b. A BPP measured at the output not
exceeding 2.5 mm mrad for a number of
input fibers greater than 5;
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
e.3.c. MLDs having all of the following:
e.3.c.1. Designed for spectral or coherent
beam combination of 5 or more fiber ‘‘lasers;’’
and
e.3.c.2. CW ‘‘Laser’’ Induced Damage
Threshold (LIDT) greater than or equal to 10
kW/cm2;
f. Optical equipment as follows:
N.B.: For shared aperture optical elements,
capable of operating in ‘‘Super-High Power
Laser’’ (‘‘SHPL’’) applications, see the U.S.
Munitions List (22 CFR part 121).
f.1. [Reserved]
N.B.: For items previously specified by
6A005.f.1, see 6A004.f.
f.2. ‘‘Laser’’ diagnostic equipment
‘‘specially designed’’ for dynamic
measurement of ‘‘SHPL’’ system angular
beam steering errors and having an angular
‘‘accuracy’’ of 10 mrad (microradians) or less
(better);
f.3. Optical equipment and ‘‘components’’,
‘‘specially designed’’ for coherent beam
combination in a phased-array ‘‘SHPL’’
system and having any of the following:
f.3.a. An ‘‘accuracy’’ of 0.1 mm or less, for
wavelengths greater than 1 mm; or
f.3.b. An ‘‘accuracy’’ of l/10 or less (better)
at the designed wavelength, for wavelengths
equal to or less than 1 mm;
f.4. Projection telescopes ‘‘specially
designed’’ for use with ‘‘SHPL’’ systems;
g. ‘Laser acoustic detection equipment’
having all of the following:
g.1. CW ‘‘laser’’ output power greater than
or equal to 20 mW;
g.2. ‘‘Laser’’ frequency stability equal to or
better (less) than 10 MHz;
g.3. ‘‘Laser’’ wavelengths equal to or
exceeding 1,000 nm but not exceeding 2,000
nm;
g.4. Optical system resolution better (less)
than 1 nm; and
g.5. Optical Signal to Noise ratio equal to
or exceeding 103.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
6A005.g, ‘laser acoustic detection equipment’
is sometimes referred to as a ‘‘Laser’’
Microphone or Particle Flow Detection
Microphone.
6A006 ‘‘Magnetometers’’, ‘‘magnetic
gradiometers’’, ‘‘intrinsic magnetic
gradiometers’’, underwater electric field
sensors, ‘‘compensation systems’’, and
‘‘specially designed’’ ‘‘components’’
therefor, as follows (see List of Items
Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
AT applies to entire
entry.
NS Column 2
AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements
See § 743.1 of the EAR for reporting
requirements for exports under License
Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: $1500, N/A for 6A006.a.1;
‘‘Magnetometers’’ and subsystems defined
in 6A006.a.2 using optically pumped or
nuclear precession (proton/Overhauser)
having a ‘sensitivity’ lower (better) than 2
pT (rms) per square root Hz; and 6A006.d,
and 6A006.e.
GBS: N/A
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be
used to ship any commodity in: 6A006.a.1;
or 6A006.a.2; or 6A006.c.1 ‘‘Magnetic
gradiometers’’ using multiple
‘‘magnetometers’’ specified by 6A006.a.1 or
6.A006.a.2; or 6A006.d or .e (only for
underwater receivers incorporating
magnetometers specified in 6A006.a.1 or
6A006.a.2) to any of the destinations listed in
Country Group A:6 (See Supplement No.1 to
part 740 of the EAR).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: See also 6A996. This entry
does not control instruments ‘‘specially
designed’’ for fishery applications or
biomagnetic measurements for medical
diagnostics.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. ‘‘Magnetometers’’ and subsystems, as
follows:
a.1. ‘‘Magnetometers’’ using
‘‘superconductive’’ (SQUID) ‘‘technology’’
and having any of the following:
a.1.a. SQUID systems designed for
stationary operation, without ‘‘specially
designed’’ subsystems designed to reduce inmotion noise, and having a ‘sensitivity’ equal
to or lower (better) than 50 fT (rms) per
square root Hz at a frequency of 1 Hz; or
a.1.b. SQUID systems having an in-motionmagnetometer ‘sensitivity’ lower (better) than
20 pT (rms) per square root Hz at a frequency
of 1 Hz and ‘‘specially designed’’ to reduce
in-motion noise;
a.2. ‘‘Magnetometers’’ using optically
pumped or nuclear precession (proton/
Overhauser) ‘‘technology’’ having a
‘sensitivity’ lower (better) than 20 pT (rms)
per square root Hz at a frequency of 1 Hz;
a.3. ‘‘Magnetometers’’ using fluxgate
‘‘technology’’ having a ’sensitivity’ equal to
or lower (better) than 10 pT (rms) per square
root Hz at a frequency of 1 Hz;
a.4. Induction coil ‘‘magnetometers’’
having a ‘sensitivity’ lower (better) than any
of the following:
a.4.a. 0.05 nT (rms)/square root Hz at
frequencies of less than 1 Hz;
a.4.b. 1 × 10¥3 nT (rms)/square root Hz at
frequencies of 1 Hz or more but not
exceeding 10 Hz; or
a.4.c. 1 × 10¥4 nT (rms)/square root Hz at
frequencies exceeding 10 Hz;
a.5. Fiber optic ‘‘magnetometers’’ having a
‘sensitivity’ lower (better) than 1 nT (rms) per
square root Hz;
b. Underwater electric field sensors having
a ‘sensitivity’ lower (better) than 8 nanovolt
per meter per square root Hz when measured
at 1 Hz;
c. ‘‘Magnetic gradiometers’’ as follows:
PO 00000
Frm 00043
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
71973
c.1. ‘‘Magnetic gradiometers’’ using
multiple ‘‘magnetometers’’ controlled by
6A006.a;
c.2. Fiber optic ‘‘intrinsic magnetic
gradiometers’’ having a magnetic gradient
field ‘sensitivity’ lower (better) than 0.3 nT/
m (rms) per square root Hz;
c.3. ‘‘Intrinsic magnetic gradiometers’’,
using ‘‘technology’’ other than fiber-optic
‘‘technology’’, having a magnetic gradient
field ‘sensitivity’ lower (better) than 0.015
nT/m (rms) per square root Hz;
d. ‘‘Compensation systems’’ for magnetic
and underwater electric field sensors
resulting in a performance equal to or better
than the control parameters of 6A006.a,
6A006.b, and 6A006.c; and
e. Underwater electromagnetic receivers
incorporating magnetic field sensors
specified by 6A006.a or underwater electric
field sensors specified by 6A006.b.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
6A006, ‘sensitivity’ (noise level) is the root
mean square of the device-limited noise floor
which is the lowest signal that can be
measured.
6A007 Gravity meters (gravimeters) and
gravity gradiometers, as follows (see List
of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, AT
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
MT applies to
6A007.b and .c
when the accuracies in 6A007.b.1
and b.2 are met or
exceeded.
AT applies to entire
entry.
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
NS Column 2
MT Column 1
AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: $3000; N/A for MT
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See USML Category
XII(d) for certain gravity meters
(gravimeters) and gravity gradiometers
subject to the ITAR. (2) See also ECCNs
6A107, 6A997, and 7A611.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Gravity meters designed or modified for
ground use and having a static ‘‘accuracy’’ of
less (better) than 10 mGal;
Note: 6A007.a does not control ground
gravity meters of the quartz element
(Worden) type.
b. Gravity meters designed for mobile
platforms and having all of the following:
b.1. A static ‘‘accuracy’’ of less (better) than
0.7 mGal; and
b.2. An in-service (operational) ‘‘accuracy’’
of less (better) than 0.7 mGal having a ‘timeto-steady-state registration’ of less than 2
minutes under any combination of attendant
corrective compensations and motional
influences;
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
71974
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
Technical Note: For the purposes of
6A007.b.2, ’time-to-steady-state registration’
(also referred to as the gravimeter’s response
time) is the time over which the disturbing
effects of platform induced accelerations
(high frequency noise) are reduced.
c. Gravity gradiometers.
6A008 Radar systems, equipment and
assemblies, having any of the following
(see List of Items Controlled), and
‘‘specially designed’’ ‘‘components’’
therefor.
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, RS, AT
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
MT applies to items
that are designed
for airborne applications and that
are usable in systems controlled for
MT reasons.
RS applies to
6A008.j.1.
AT applies to entire
entry.
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
NS Column 2
MT Column 1
RS Column 1
AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements
See § 743.1 of the EAR for reporting
requirements for exports under License
Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: $5000; N/A for MT and for 6A008.j.1.
GBS: Yes, for 6A008.b, .c, and l.1 only
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be
used to ship any commodity in 6A008.d,
6A008.h or 6A008.k to any of the
destinations listed in Country Group A:6
(See Supplement No. 1 to part 740 of the
EAR).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See also ECCNs 6A108
and 6A998. ECCN 6A998 controls, inter
alia, the Light Detection and Ranging
(LIDAR) equipment excluded by the note
to paragraph j of this ECCN (6A008). (2)
See USML Category XII(b) for certain
LIDAR, Laser Detection and Ranging
(LADAR), or range-gated systems subject to
the ITAR.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
Note: 6A008 does not control:
—Secondary surveillance radar (SSR);
—Civil Automotive Radar;
—Displays or monitors used for air traffic
control (ATC);
—Meteorological (weather) radar;
—Precision Approach Radar (PAR)
equipment conforming to ICAO standards
and employing electronically steerable
linear (1-dimensional) arrays or
mechanically positioned passive antennas.
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
a. Operating at frequencies from 40 GHz to
230 GHz and having any of the following:
a.1. An average output power exceeding
100 mW; or
a.2. Locating ‘‘accuracy’’ of 1 m or less
(better) in range and 0.2 degree or less (better)
in azimuth;
b. A tunable bandwidth exceeding ±6.25%
of the ‘center operating frequency’;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
6A008.b, the ‘center operating frequency’
equals one half of the sum of the highest plus
the lowest specified operating frequencies.
c. Capable of operating simultaneously on
more than two carrier frequencies;
d. Capable of operating in synthetic
aperture (SAR), inverse synthetic aperture
(ISAR) radar mode, or sidelooking airborne
(SLAR) radar mode;
e. Incorporating electronically scanned
array antennae;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
6A008.e, electronically scanned array
antennae are also known as electronically
steerable array antennae.
f. Capable of heightfinding non-cooperative
targets;
g. ‘‘Specially designed’’ for airborne
(balloon or airframe mounted) operation and
having Doppler ‘‘signal processing’’ for the
detection of moving targets;
h. Employing processing of radar signals
and using any of the following:
h.1. ‘‘Radar spread spectrum’’ techniques;
or
h.2. ‘‘Radar frequency agility’’ techniques;
i. Providing ground-based operation with a
maximum ‘instrumented range’ exceeding
185 km;
Note: 6A008.i does not control:
a. Fishing ground surveillance radar;
b. Ground radar equipment ‘‘specially
designed’’ for en route air traffic control, and
having all of the following:
1. A maximum ‘instrumented range’ of 500
km or less;
2. Configured so that radar target data can
be transmitted only one way from the radar
site to one or more civil ATC centers;
3. Contains no provisions for remote
control of the radar scan rate from the en
route ATC center; and
4. Permanently installed;
c. Weather balloon tracking radars.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
6A008.i, ‘instrumented range’ is the specified
unambiguous display range of a radar.
j. Being ‘‘laser’’ radar or Light Detection
and Ranging (LIDAR) equipment and having
any of the following:
j.1. ‘‘Space-qualified’’;
j.2. Employing coherent heterodyne or
homodyne detection techniques and having
an angular resolution of less (better) than 20
mrad (microradians); or
j.3. Designed for carrying out airborne
bathymetric littoral surveys to International
Hydrographic Organization (IHO) Order 1a
Standard (5th Edition February 2008) for
Hydrographic Surveys or better, and using
one or more ‘‘lasers’’ with a wavelength
exceeding 400 nm but not exceeding 600 nm;
Note 1: LIDAR equipment ‘‘specially
designed’’ for surveying is only specified by
6A008.j.3.
PO 00000
Frm 00044
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
Note 2: 6A008.j does not apply to LIDAR
equipment ‘‘specially designed’’ for
meteorological observation.
Note 3: Parameters in the IHO Order 1a
Standard 5th Edition February 2008 are
summarized as follows:
Horizontal Accuracy (95% Confidence
Level)= 5 m + 5% of depth.
Depth Accuracy for Reduced Depths (95%
confidence level) = ±√(a2 + (b*d)2) where:
a = 0.5 m = constant depth error, i.e., the sum
of all constant depth errors
b = 0.013 = factor of depth dependent error
b*d = depth dependent error, i.e., the sum of
all depth dependent errors
d = depth
Feature Detection = Cubic features > 2 m
in depths up to 40 m; 10% of depth beyond
40 m.
k. Having ‘‘signal processing’’ sub-systems
using ‘‘pulse compression’’ and having any of
the following:
k.1. A ‘‘pulse compression’’ ratio exceeding
150; or
k.2. A compressed pulse width of less than
200 ns; or
Note: 6A008.k.2 does not apply to two
dimensional ‘marine radar’ or ‘vessel traffic
service’ radar, having all of the following:
a. ‘‘Pulse compression’’ ratio not exceeding
150;
b. Compressed pulse width of greater than
30 ns;
c. Single and rotating mechanically
scanned antenna;
d. Peak output power not exceeding 250 W;
and
e. Not capable of ‘‘frequency hopping’’.
l. Having data processing sub-systems and
having any of the following:
l.1. ‘Automatic target tracking’ providing,
at any antenna rotation, the predicted target
position beyond the time of the next antenna
beam passage; or
Note: 6A008.l.1 does not control conflict
alert capability in ATC systems, or ‘marine
radar’.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
6A008.l.1, ‘automatic target tracking’ is a
processing technique that automatically
determines and provides as output an
extrapolated value of the most probable
position of the target in real time.
l.2. [Reserved]
l.3. [Reserved]
l.4. Configured to provide superposition
and correlation, or fusion, of target data
within six seconds from two or more
‘geographically dispersed’ radar sensors to
improve the aggregate performance beyond
that of any single sensor specified by
6A008.f, or 6A008.i.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
6A008.l.4, sensors are considered
‘geographically dispersed’ when each
location is distant from any other more than
1,500 m in any direction. Mobile sensors are
always considered ‘geographically
dispersed’.
N.B.: See also the U.S. Munitions List (22
CFR part 121).
Note: 6A008.l does not apply to systems,
equipment and assemblies designed for
‘vessel traffic services’.
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 6A008, ‘marine
radar’ is a radar that is designed to navigate
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
safely at sea, inland waterways or near-shore
environments.
2. For the purposes of 6A008, ‘vessel traffic
service’ is a vessel traffic monitoring and
control service similar to air traffic control
for ‘‘aircraft.’’
*
*
*
*
*
6B007 Equipment to produce, align and
calibrate land-based gravity meters with
a static ‘‘accuracy’’ of less (better) than
0.1 mGal.
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
AT applies to entire
entry.
NS Column 2
AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: $5000
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: N/A
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
The list of items controlled is contained in
the ECCN heading.
*
*
*
*
*
6C002 Optical sensor materials as follows
(see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
AT applies to entire
entry.
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
NS Column 2
AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: $3000
GBS: N/A
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
Related Controls: See also 6C992.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Elemental tellurium (Te) of purity levels
of 99.9995% or more;
b. Single crystals (including epitaxial
wafers) of any of the following:
b.1. Cadmium zinc telluride (CdZnTe),
with zinc content less than 6% by ‘mole
fraction’;
b.2. Cadmium telluride (CdTe) of any
purity level; or
b.3. Mercury cadmium telluride (HgCdTe)
of any purity level.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
6C002.b.1, ‘mole fraction’ is defined as the
ratio of moles of ZnTe to the sum of the
VerDate Sep<11>2014
moles of CdTe and ZnTe present in the
crystal.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
*
TSR: Yes, except for 6D003.c and exports or
reexports to destinations outside of those
countries listed in Country Group A:5 (See
Supplement No. 1 to part 740 of the EAR)
of ‘‘software’’ for items controlled by
6D003.a.
*
*
*
*
6C005 ‘‘Laser’’ materials as follows (see
List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
AT applies to entire
entry.
NS Column 2
AT Column 1
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be
used to ship or transmit software in
6D003.a to any of the destinations listed in
Country Group A:6 (See Supplement No.1
to part 740 of the EAR).
List of Items Controlled
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: $1500
GBS: N/A
Related Controls: See also ECCNs 6D103,
6D991, and 6D993.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: N/A
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Synthetic crystalline ‘‘laser’’ host
material in unfinished form as follows:
a.1. Titanium doped sapphire;
a.2. [Reserved]
b. Rare-earth-metal doped double-clad
fibers having any of the following:
b.1. Nominal ‘‘laser’’ wavelength of 975 nm
to 1,150 nm and having all of the following:
b.1.a. Average core diameter equal to or
greater than 25 mm; and
b.1.b. Core ‘Numerical Aperture’ (‘NA’) less
than 0.065; or
Note to 6C005.b.1: 6C005.b.1 does not
apply to double-clad fibers having an inner
glass cladding diameter exceeding 150 mm
and not exceeding 300 mm.
b.2. Nominal ‘‘laser’’ wavelength exceeding
1,530 nm and having all of the following:
b.2.a. Average core diameter equal to or
greater than 20 mm; and
b.2.b. Core ‘NA’ less than 0.1.
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 6C005.b.1.b, the core
‘Numerical Aperture’ (‘NA’) is measured at
the emission wavelengths of the fiber.
2. 6C005.b includes fibers assembled with
end caps.
Acoustics
*
Cameras
*
*
*
*
6D003 Other ‘‘software’’ as follows (see List
of Items Controlled).
List of Items Controlled
71975
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, RS, AT
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
RS applies to paragraph c.
AT applies to entire
entry.
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
NS Column 1
RS Column 1
AT Column 1
Frm 00045
Fmt 4701
c. ‘‘Software’’ designed or modified for
cameras incorporating ‘‘focal plane arrays’’
specified by 6A002.a.3.f and designed or
modified to remove a frame rate restriction
and allow the camera to exceed the frame
rate specified in 6A003.b.4 Note 3.a;
Optics
d. ‘‘Software’’ ‘‘specially designed’’ to
maintain the alignment and phasing of
segmented mirror systems consisting of
mirror segments having a diameter or major
axis length equal to or larger than 1 m;
e. Lasers. None.
Magnetic and Electric Field Sensors
Reporting Requirements
See § 743.1 of the EAR for reporting
requirements for exports under License
Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
PO 00000
a. ‘‘Software’’ as follows:
a.1. ‘‘Software’’ ‘‘specially designed’’ for
acoustic beam forming for the ‘‘real-time
processing’’ of acoustic data for passive
reception using towed hydrophone arrays;
a.2. ‘‘Source code’’ for the ‘‘real-time
processing’’ of acoustic data for passive
reception using towed hydrophone arrays;
a.3. ‘‘Software’’ ‘‘specially designed’’ for
acoustic beam forming for the ‘‘real-time
processing’’ of acoustic data for passive
reception using bottom or bay cable systems;
a.4. ‘‘Source code’’ for the ‘‘real-time
processing’’ of acoustic data for passive
reception using bottom or bay cable systems;
a.5. ‘‘Software’’ or ‘‘source code’’,
‘‘specially designed’’ for all of the following:
a.5.a. ‘‘Real-time processing’’ of acoustic
data from sonar systems controlled by
6A001.a.1.e; and
a.5.b. Automatically detecting, classifying
and determining the location of divers or
swimmers;
N.B.: For diver detection ‘‘software’’ or
‘‘source code’’, ‘‘specially designed’’ or
modified for military use, see the U.S.
Munitions List of the International Traffic in
Arms Regulations (ITAR) (22 CFR part 121).
b. Optical sensors. None.
Sfmt 4700
f. ‘‘Software’’ as follows:
f.1. ‘‘Software’’ ‘‘specially designed’’ for
magnetic and electric field ‘‘compensation
systems’’ for magnetic sensors designed to
operate on mobile platforms;
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
71976
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
f.2. ‘‘Software’’ ‘‘specially designed’’ for
magnetic and electric field anomaly detection
on mobile platforms;
f.3. ‘‘Software’’ ‘‘specially designed’’ for
‘‘real-time processing’’ of electromagnetic
data using underwater electromagnetic
receivers specified by 6A006.e;
f.4. ‘‘Source code’’ for ‘‘real-time
processing’’ of electromagnetic data using
underwater electromagnetic receivers
specified by 6A006.e;
Gravimeters
g. ‘‘Software’’ ‘‘specially designed’’ to
correct motional influences of gravity meters
or gravity gradiometers;
Radar
h. ‘‘Software’’ as follows:
h.1. Air Traffic Control (ATC) ‘‘software’’
designed to be hosted on general purpose
computers located at Air Traffic Control
centers and capable of accepting radar target
data from more than four primary radars;
h.2. ‘‘Software’’ for the design or
‘‘production’’ of radomes having all of the
following:
h.2.a. ‘‘Specially designed’’ to protect the
‘‘electronically scanned array antennae’’
specified by 6A008.e; and
h.2.b. Resulting in an antenna pattern
having an ‘average side lobe level’ more than
40 dB below the peak of the main beam level.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
6D003.h.2.b ‘average side lobe level’ is
measured over the entire array excluding the
angular extent of the main beam and the first
two side lobes on either side of the main
beam.
*
*
*
*
achieve an ‘optical thickness’ uniformity of
99.5% or better for optical coatings 500 mm
or more in diameter or major axis length and
with a total loss (absorption and scatter) of
less than 5 × 10¥3;
N.B.: See also 2E003.f.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
6E003.d.1, ‘optical thickness’ is the
mathematical product of the index of
refraction and the physical thickness of the
coating.
d.2. ‘‘Technology’’ for the fabrication of
optics using single point diamond turning
techniques to produce surface finish
‘‘accuracies’’ of better than 10 nm rms on
non-planar surfaces exceeding 0.5 m2;
Lasers
e. ‘‘Technology’’ ‘‘required’’ for the
‘‘development,’’ ‘‘production’’ or ‘‘use’’ of
‘‘specially designed’’ diagnostic instruments
or targets in test facilities for ‘‘SHPL’’ testing
or testing or evaluation of materials
irradiated by ‘‘SHPL’’ beams;
Magnetic and Electric Field Sensors
f. [Reserved]
Gravimeters
g. [Reserved]
Radar
h. [Reserved]
*
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
NS Column 1
AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
TSR: Yes
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: See also 6E993.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
Acoustics
a. [Reserved]
Optical Sensors
b. [Reserved]
Cameras
c. [Reserved]
Optics
d. ‘‘Technology’’ as follows:
d.1. ‘‘Technology’’ ‘‘required’’ for the
coating and treatment of optical surfaces to
VerDate Sep<11>2014
*
*
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
NS applies to entire
entry.
AT applies to entire
entry.
*
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
*
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, AT
6E003 Other ‘‘technology’’ as follows (see
List of Items Controlled).
Control(s)
*
7A003 ‘Inertial measurement equipment or
systems’, having any of the following.
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
MT applies to commodities in
7A003.d that meet
or exceed the parameters of 7A103.
AT applies to entire
entry.
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
NS Column 1
MT Column 1
AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See also ECCNs 7A103,
7A611, and 7A994. (2) See USML Category
XII(d) for guidance or navigation systems
subject to the ITAR.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
7A003 does not apply to ‘inertial
measurement equipment or systems’ which
are certified for use on ‘‘civil aircraft’’ by civil
aviation authorities of one or more
Wassenaar Arrangement Participating States,
see Supplement No. 1 to part 743 of the EAR.
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 7A003, ’inertial
measurement equipment or systems’
incorporate accelerometers or gyroscopes to
measure changes in velocity and orientation
PO 00000
Frm 00046
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
in order to determine or maintain heading or
position without requiring an external
reference once aligned. ’Inertial
measurement equipment or systems’ include:
Attitude and Heading Reference Systems
(AHRSs);
Gyrocompasses;
Inertial Measurement Units (IMUs);
Inertial Navigation Systems (INSs);
Inertial Reference Systems (IRSs);
Inertial Reference Units (IRUs).
2. For the purposes of 7A003, ‘positional
aiding references’ independently provide
position, and include:
a. ‘‘Satellite navigation system’’;
b.’’Data-Based Referenced Navigation’’
(‘‘DBRN’’).
a. Designed for ‘‘aircraft’’, land vehicles or
vessels, providing position without the use of
‘positional aiding references’, and having any
of the following ‘‘accuracies’’ subsequent to
normal alignment:
a.1. 0.8 nautical miles per hour (nm/hr)
‘‘Circular Error Probable’’ (‘‘CEP’’) rate or less
(better);
a.2. 0.5% distanced travelled ‘‘CEP’’ or less
(better); or
a.3. Total drift of 1 nautical mile ‘‘CEP’’ or
less (better) in a 24 hr period;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
7A003.a.1, 7A003.a.2 and 7A003.a.3, the
performance parameters typically apply to
‘inertia measurement equipment or systems’
designed for ‘‘aircraft’’, vehicles and vessels,
respectively. These parameters result from
the utilization of specialized non-‘positional
aiding references’ (e.g., altimeter, odometer,
velocity log). As a consequence, the specified
performance values cannot be readily
converted between these parameters.
Equipment designed for multiple platforms
are evaluated against each applicable entry
7A003.a.1, 7A003.a.2, or 7A003.a.3.
b. Designed for ‘‘aircraft’’, land vehicles or
vessels, with an embedded ‘positional aiding
reference’ and providing position after loss of
all ‘positional aiding references’ for a period
of up to 4 minutes, having an ‘‘accuracy’’ of
less (better) than 10 meters ‘‘CEP’’;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
7A003.b, this entry refers to systems in which
‘inertial measurement equipment or systems’
and other independent ‘positional aiding
references’ are built into a single unit (i.e.,
embedded) in order to achieve improved
performance.
c. Designed for ‘‘aircraft’’, land vehicles or
vessels, providing heading or True North
determination and having any of the
following:
c.1. A maximum operating angular rate less
(lower) than 500 deg/s and a heading
‘‘accuracy’’ without the use of ‘positional
aiding references’ equal to or less (better)
than 0.07 deg sec (Lat) (equivalent to 6 arc
minutes rms at 45 degrees latitude); or
c.2. A maximum operating angular rate
equal to or greater (higher) than 500 deg/s
and a heading ‘‘accuracy’’ without the use of
‘positional aiding references’ equal to or less
(better) than 0.2 deg sec (Lat) (equivalent to
17 arc minutes rms at 45 degrees latitude);
d. Providing acceleration measurements or
angular rate measurements, in more than one
dimension, and having any of the following:
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
d.1. Performance specified by 7A001 or
7A002 along any axis, without the use of any
aiding references; or
d.2. Being ‘‘space-qualified’’ and providing
angular rate measurements having an ‘‘angle
random walk’’ along any axis of less (better)
than or equal to 0.1 degree per square root
hour.
Note: 7A003.d.2 does not apply to ‘inertial
measurement equipment or systems’ that
contain ‘‘spinning mass gyros’’ as the only
type of gyro.
7A004 ‘Star trackers’ and ‘‘components’’
therefor, as follows (see List of Items
Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, AT
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
MT applies to entire
entry.
AT applies to entire
entry.
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
NS Column 1
MT Column 1
AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See USML Category XV
for certain ‘star trackers’ that are ‘‘subject
to the ITAR’’ (see 22 CFR parts 120 through
130). (2) See also 7A104 and 7A994.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. ‘Star trackers’ with a specified azimuth
‘‘accuracy’’ of equal to or less (better) than 20
seconds of arc throughout the specified
lifetime of the equipment;
b. ‘‘Components’’ ‘‘specially designed’’ for
equipment specified in 7A004.a as follows:
b.1. Optical heads or baffles;
b.2. Data processing units.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
7A004.a, ‘star trackers’ are also referred to as
stellar attitude sensors or gyro-astro
compasses.
7A005 ‘‘Satellite navigation system’’
receiving equipment having any of the
following and ‘‘specially designed’’
‘‘components’’ therefor.
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT and AT
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
Control(s)
NS applies to
7A005.b.
MT applies to commodities in
7A005.b that meet
or exceed the parameters of 7A105.
AT applies to
7A005.b.
VerDate Sep<11>2014
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
NS Column 1
MT Column 1
AT Column 1
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See also ECCNs 7A105,
7A611 and 7A994. Commercially available
‘‘satellite navigation system’’ receivers do
not typically employ decryption or
adaptive antennae and are classified as
7A994. (2) See USML Category XII(d) for
‘‘satellite navigation system’’ receiving
equipment subject to the ITAR and USML
Category XI(c)(10) for antennae that are
subject to the ITAR. (3) Items that
otherwise would be covered by ECCN
7A005.a are ‘‘subject to the ITAR’’ (see 22
CFR parts 120 through 130).
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Employing a decryption algorithm
‘‘specially designed’’ or modified for
government use to access the ranging code
for position and time; or
b. Employing ‘adaptive antenna systems’.
Note: 7A005.b does not apply to ‘‘satellite
navigation system’’ receiving equipment that
only uses ‘‘components’’ designed to filter,
switch, or combine signals from multiple
omni-directional antennas that do not
implement adaptive antenna techniques.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
7A005.b, ‘adaptive antenna systems’
dynamically generate one or more spatial
nulls in an antenna array pattern by signal
processing in the time domain or frequency
domain.
7A006 Airborne altimeters operating at
frequencies other than 4.2 to 4.4 GHz
inclusive and having any of the
following (see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, AT
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
MT applies to commodities in this
entry that meet or
exceed the parameters of 7A106.
AT applies to entire
entry.
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
NS Column 1
MT Column 1
AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: See also 7A106, 7A994 and
Category 6 for controls on radar.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. ‘Power management’; or
Technical Note: For the purposes of
7A006.a, ‘power management’ is changing
the transmitted power of the altimeter signal
so that received power at the ‘‘aircraft’’
altitude is always at the minimum necessary
to determine the altitude.
PO 00000
Frm 00047
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
71977
b. Using phase shift key modulation.
*
*
*
*
*
7B001 Test, calibration or alignment
equipment, ‘‘specially designed’’ for
equipment controlled by 7A (except
7A994).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, AT
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
MT applies to entire
entry.
AT applies to entire
entry.
NS Column 1
MT Column 1
AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See also 7B101, 7B102
and 7B994. (2) This entry does not control
test, calibration or alignment equipment for
‘Maintenance level I’ or ‘Maintenance
Level II’.
Related Definition: For the purposes of
7B001: (1) ‘Maintenance Level I’: The
failure of an inertial navigation unit is
detected on the ‘‘aircraft’’ by indications
from the Control and Display Unit (CDU)
or by the status message from the
corresponding sub-system. By following
the manufacturer’s manual, the cause of
the failure may be localized at the level of
the malfunctioning Line Replaceable Unit
(LRU). The operator then removes the LRU
and replaces it with a spare. (2)
‘Maintenance Level II’: The defective LRU
is sent to the maintenance workshop (the
manufacturer’s or that of the operator
responsible for level II maintenance). At
the maintenance workshop, the
malfunctioning LRU is tested by various
appropriate means to verify and localize
the defective Shop Replaceable Assembly
(SRA) module responsible for the failure.
This SRA is removed and replaced by an
operative spare. The defective SRA (or
possibly the complete LRU) is then
shipped to the manufacturer. ‘Maintenance
Level II’ does not include the disassembly
or repair of controlled accelerometers or
gyro sensors.
Items:
The list of items controlled is contained in
the ECCN heading.
*
*
*
*
*
7D002 ‘‘Source code’’ for the operation or
maintenance of any inertial navigation
equipment, including inertial equipment
not controlled by 7A003 or 7A004, or
Attitude and Heading Reference Systems
(‘AHRS’).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, AT
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
71978
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
MT applies to entire
entry.
AT applies to entire
entry.
NS Column 1
MT Column 1
AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements
See § 743.1 of the EAR for reporting
requirements for exports under License
Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
TSR: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1.) See also 7D102 and
7D994. (2.) This entry does not control
‘‘source code’’ for the operation or
maintenance of gimballed ‘AHRS’.
Related Definition: For the purposes of
7D002, ‘AHRS’ generally differ from
Inertial Navigation Systems (INS) in that an
‘AHRS’ provides attitude and heading
information and normally does not provide
the acceleration, velocity and position
information associated with an INS.
Items:
The list of items controlled is contained in
the ECCN heading.
*
*
*
*
*
7E004 Other ‘‘technology’’ as follows (see
List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, AT
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
MT applies to ‘‘technology’’ for equipment or systems
controlled for MT
reasons.
AT applies to entire
entry.
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
NS Column 1
MT Column 1
AT Column 1
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
TSR: N/A
Special Conditions for STA
STA: (1) Paragraph (c)(1) of License
Exception STA (§ 740.20(c)(1) of the EAR)
may not be used for 7E004, except for
7E004.a.7. (2) Paragraph (c)(2) of License
Exception STA (§ 740.20(c)(2) of the EAR)
may not be used for 7E004, except for
7E004.a.7.
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See also 7E001, 7E002,
7E101, and 7E994. (2) In addition to the
Related Controls in 7E001, 7E002, and
7E101 that include MT controls, also see
the MT controls in 7E104 for design
‘‘technology’’ for the integration of the
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
flight control, guidance, and propulsion
data into a flight management system,
designed or modified for rockets or
missiles capable of achieving a ‘‘range’’
equal to or greater than 300 km, for
optimization of rocket system trajectory;
and also see 9E101 for design ‘‘technology’’
for integration of air vehicle fuselage,
propulsion system and lifting control
surfaces, designed or modified for
unmanned aerial vehicles capable of
achieving a ‘‘range’’ equal to or greater than
300 km, to optimize aerodynamic
performance throughout the flight regime
of an unmanned aerial vehicle.
Related Definitions: N/A.
Items:
a. ‘‘Technology’’ for the ‘‘development’’ or
‘‘production’’ of any of the following:
a.1. [Reserved]
a.2. Air data systems based on surface
static data only, i.e., which dispense with
conventional air data probes;
a.3. Three dimensional displays for
‘‘aircraft’’;
a.4. [Reserved]
a.5. Electric actuators (i.e.,
electromechanical, electrohydrostatic and
integrated actuator package) ‘‘specially
designed’’ for ‘primary flight control’;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
7E004.a.5, ‘primary flight control’ is
‘‘aircraft’’ stability or maneuvering control
using force/moment generators, i.e.,
aerodynamic control surfaces or propulsive
thrust vectoring.
a.6. ‘Flight control optical sensor array’
‘‘specially designed’’ for implementing
‘‘active flight control systems’’; or
Technical Note: For the purposes of
7E004.a.6, a ‘flight control optical sensor
array’ is a network of distributed optical
sensors, using ‘‘laser’’ beams, to provide realtime flight control data for on-board
processing.
a.7. ‘‘DBRN’’ systems designed to navigate
underwater, using sonar or gravity databases,
that provide a positioning ‘‘accuracy’’ equal
to or less (better) than 0.4 nautical miles;
b. ‘‘Development’’ ‘‘technology’’, as
follows, for ‘‘active flight control systems’’
(including ‘‘fly-by-wire systems’’ or ‘‘fly-bylight systems’’):
b.1. Photonic-based ‘‘technology’’ for
sensing ‘‘aircraft’’ or flight control
component state, transferring flight control
data, or commanding actuator movement,
‘‘required’’ for ‘‘fly-by-light systems’’ ‘‘active
flight control systems’’;
b.2. [Reserved]
b.3. Real-time algorithms to analyze
component sensor information to predict and
preemptively mitigate impending
degradation and failures of components
within an ‘‘active flight control system’’;
Note: 7E004.b.3 does not include
algorithms for purpose of off-line
maintenance.
b.4. Real-time algorithms to identify
component failures and reconfigure force and
moment controls to mitigate ‘‘active flight
control system’’ degradations and failures;
Note: 7E004.b.4 does not include
algorithms for the elimination of fault effects
through comparison of redundant data
sources, or off-line pre-planned responses to
anticipated failures.
PO 00000
Frm 00048
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
b.5. Integration of digital flight control,
navigation and propulsion control data, into
a digital flight management system for ‘‘total
control of flight’’;
Note: 7E004.b.5 does not apply to:
1. ‘‘Technology’’ for integration of digital
flight control, navigation and propulsion
control data, into a digital flight management
system for ‘flight path optimization’;
2. ‘‘Technology’’ for ‘‘aircraft’’ flight
instrument systems integrated solely for VOR,
DME, ILS or MLS navigation or approaches.
Technical Note: ‘Flight path
optimization’ is a procedure that minimizes
deviations from a four-dimensional (space
and time) desired trajectory based on
maximizing performance or effectiveness for
mission tasks.
b.6. [Reserved]
b.7. ‘‘Technology’’ ‘‘required’’ for deriving
the functional requirements for ‘‘fly-by-wire
systems’’ having all of the following:
b.7.a. ‘Inner-loop’ airframe stability
controls requiring loop closure rates of 40 Hz
or greater; and
Technical Note: For the purposes of
7E004.b.7.a, ‘inner-loop’ refers to functions of
‘‘active flight control systems’’ that automate
airframe stability controls.
b.7.b. Having any of the following:
b.7.b.1. Corrects an aerodynamically
unstable airframe, measured at any point in
the design flight envelope, that would lose
recoverable control if not corrected within
0.5 seconds;
b.7.b.2. Couples controls in two or more
axes while compensating for ‘abnormal
changes in aircraft state’;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
7E004.b.7.b.2, ‘abnormal changes in aircraft
state’ include in-flight structural damage,
loss of engine thrust, disabled control
surface, or destabilizing shifts in cargo load.
b.7.b.3. Performs the functions specified in
7E004.b.5; or
Note: 7E004.b.7.b.3 does not apply to
autopilots.
b.7.b.4. Enables ’’aircraft’’ to have stable
controlled flight, other than during take-off or
landing, at greater than 18 degrees angle of
attack, 15 degrees side slip, 15 degrees/
second pitch or yaw rate, or 90 degrees/
second roll rate;
b.8. ‘‘Technology’’ ‘‘required’’ for deriving
the functional requirements of ‘‘fly-by-wire
systems’’ to achieve all of the following:
b.8.a. No loss of control of the ’’aircraft’’ in
the event of a consecutive sequence of any
two individual faults within the ‘‘fly-by-wire
system’’; and
b.8.b. Probability of loss of control of the
’’aircraft’’ being less (better) than 1 × 10¥9
failures per flight hour;
Note: 7E004.b does not apply to
‘‘technology’’ associated with common
computer elements and utilities (e.g., input
signal acquisition, output signal
transmission, computer ‘‘program’’ and data
loading, built-in test, task scheduling
mechanisms) not providing a specific flight
control system function.
c. ‘‘Technology’’ for the ‘‘development’’ of
helicopter systems, as follows:
c.1. Multi-axis fly-by-wire or fly-by-light
controllers, which combine the functions of
at least two of the following into one
controlling element:
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
c.1.a. Collective controls;
c.1.b. Cyclic controls;
c.1.c. Yaw controls;
c.2. ‘‘Circulation-controlled anti-torque or
circulation-controlled direction control
systems’’;
c.3. Rotor blades incorporating ‘variable
geometry airfoils’, for use in systems using
individual blade control.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
7E004.c.3, ‘variable geometry airfoils’ use
trailing edge flaps or tabs, or leading edge
slats or pivoted nose droop, the position of
which can be controlled in flight.
*
*
*
*
*
8A001 Submersible vehicles and surface
vessels, as follows (see List of Items
Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
AT applies to entire
entry.
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
NS Column 2
AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements
See § 743.1 of the EAR for reporting
requirements for exports under License
Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: $5000; N/A for 8A001.b and .c.1
GBS: N/A
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be
used to ship any commodity in 8A001.b,
8A001.c or 8A001.d to any of the
destinations listed in Country Group A:6
(See Supplement No.1 to part 740 of the
EAR).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: For the control status of
equipment for submersible vehicles, see:
Category 6 for sensors; Categories 7 and 8
for navigation equipment; Category 8A for
underwater equipment.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Manned, tethered submersible vehicles
designed to operate at depths exceeding
1,000 m;
b. Manned, untethered submersible
vehicles having any of the following:
b.1. Designed to ‘operate autonomously’
and having a lifting capacity of all the
following:
b.1.a. 10% or more of their weight in air;
and
b.1.b. 15 kN or more;
b.2. Designed to operate at depths
exceeding 1,000 m; or
b.3. Having all of the following:
b.3.a. Designed to continuously ‘operate
autonomously’ for 10 hours or more; and
b.3.b. ‘Range’ of 25 nautical miles or more;
Technical Notes:
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
1. For the purposes of 8A001.b, ‘operate
autonomously’ means fully submerged,
without snorkel, all systems working and
cruising at minimum speed at which the
submersible can safely control its depth
dynamically by using its depth planes only,
with no need for a support vessel or support
base on the surface, sea-bed or shore, and
containing a propulsion system for
submerged or surface use.
2. For the purposes of 8A001.b, ‘range’
means half the maximum distance a
submersible vehicle can ‘operate
autonomously’.
c. Unmanned submersible vehicles as
follows:
c.1. Unmanned submersible vehicles
having any of the following:
c.1.a. Designed for deciding a course
relative to any geographical reference
without real-time human assistance;
c.1.b. Acoustic data or command link; or
c.1.c. Wireless optical data or command
link exceeding 1,000 m;
c.2. Unmanned, submersible vehicles, not
specified in 8A001.c.1, having all of the
following:
c.2.a. Designed to operate with a tether;
c.2.b. Designed to operate at depths
exceeding 1,000 m; and
c.2.c. Having any of the following:
c.2.c.1. Designed for self-propelled
maneuver using propulsion motors or
thrusters specified by 8A002.a.2; or
c.2.c.2. Fiber optic data link;
d. [Reserved]
e. Ocean salvage systems with a lifting
capacity exceeding 5 MN for salvaging
objects from depths exceeding 250 m and
having any of the following:
e.1. Dynamic positioning systems capable
of position keeping within 20 m of a given
point provided by the navigation system; or
e.2. Seafloor navigation and navigation
integration systems, for depths exceeding
1,000 m and with positioning ‘‘accuracies’’ to
within 10 m of a predetermined point.
8A002 Marine systems, equipment, ‘‘parts’’
and ‘‘components,’’ as follows (see List
of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
AT applies to entire
entry.
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
NS Column 2
AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements
See § 743.1 of the EAR for reporting
requirements for exports under License
Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: $5000; N/A for 8A002.o.3.b
GBS: Yes for manipulators for civil end uses
(e.g., underwater oil, gas or mining
operations) controlled by 8A002.i.2 and
having 5 degrees of freedom of movement;
and 8A002.r.
PO 00000
Frm 00049
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
71979
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be
used to ship any commodity in 8A002.b, h,
j, o.3, or p to any of the destinations listed
in Country Group A:6 (See Supplement
No.1 to part 740 of the EAR).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See also 8A992 and for
underwater communications systems, see
Category 5, Part I—Telecommunications.
(2) See also 8A992 for self-contained
underwater breathing apparatus that is not
controlled by 8A002 or released for control
by the 8A002.q Note. (3) For electronic
imaging systems ‘‘specially designed’’ or
modified for underwater use incorporating
image intensifier tubes specified by
6A002.a.2.a or 6A002.a.2.b, see 6A003.b.3.
(4) For electronic imaging systems
‘‘specially designed’’ or modified for
underwater use incorporating ‘‘focal plane
arrays’’ specified by 6A002.a.3.g, see
6A003.b.4.c. (5) Section 744.9 imposes a
license requirement on commodities
described in 8A002.d if being exported,
reexported, or transferred (in-country) for
use by a military end-user or for
incorporation into an item controlled by
ECCN 0A919.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Systems, equipment, ‘‘parts’’ and
‘‘components,’’ ‘‘specially designed’’ or
modified for submersible vehicles and
designed to operate at depths exceeding
1,000 m, as follows:
a.1. Pressure housings or pressure hulls
with a maximum inside chamber diameter
exceeding 1.5 m;
a.2. Direct current propulsion motors or
thrusters;
a.3. Umbilical cables, and connectors
therefor, using optical fiber and having
synthetic strength members;
a.4. ‘‘Parts’’ and ‘‘components’’
manufactured from material specified by
ECCN 8C001;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
8A002.a.4, this entry should not be defeated
by the export of ‘syntactic foam’ controlled
by 8C001 when an intermediate stage of
manufacture has been performed and it is
not yet in its final component form.
b. Systems ‘‘specially designed’’ or
modified for the automated control of the
motion of submersible vehicles controlled by
8A001, using navigation data, having closed
loop servo-controls and having any of the
following:
b.1. Enabling a vehicle to move within 10
m of a predetermined point in the water
column;
b.2. Maintaining the position of the vehicle
within 10 m of a predetermined point in the
water column; or
b.3. Maintaining the position of the vehicle
within 10 m while following a cable on or
under the seabed;
c. Fiber optic pressure hull penetrators;
d. Underwater vision systems having all of
the following:
d.1. ‘‘Specially designed’’ or modified for
remote operation with an underwater
vehicle; and
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
71980
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
d.2. Employing any of the following
techniques to minimize the effects of back
scatter:
d.2.a. Range-gated illuminators; or
d.2.b. Range-gated ‘‘laser’’ systems;
e. [Reserved]
f. [Reserved]
g. Light systems ‘‘specially designed’’ or
modified for underwater use, as follows:
g.1. Stroboscopic light systems capable of
a light output energy of more than 300 J per
flash and a flash rate of more than 5 flashes
per second;
g.2. Argon arc light systems ‘‘specially
designed’’ for use below 1,000 m;
h. ‘‘Robots’’ ‘‘specially designed’’ for
underwater use, controlled by using a
dedicated computer and having any of the
following:
h.1. Systems that control the ‘‘robot’’ using
information from sensors which measure
force or torque applied to an external object,
distance to an external object, or tactile sense
between the ‘‘robot’’ and an external object;
or
h.2. The ability to exert a force of 250 N
or more or a torque of 250 Nm or more and
using titanium based alloys or ‘‘composite’’
‘‘fibrous or filamentary materials’’ in their
structural members;
i. Remotely controlled articulated
manipulators ‘‘specially designed’’ or
modified for use with submersible vehicles
and having any of the following:
i.1. Systems which control the manipulator
using information from sensors which
measure any of the following:
i.1.a. Torque or force applied to an external
object; or
i.1.b. Tactile sense between the
manipulator and an external object; or
i.2. Controlled by proportional masterslave techniques and having 5 degrees of
‘freedom of movement’ or more;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
8A002.i.2, only functions having
proportionally related motion control using
positional feedback are counted when
determining the number of degrees of
‘freedom of movement’.
j. Air independent power systems
‘‘specially designed’’ for underwater use, as
follows:
j.1. Brayton or Rankine cycle engine air
independent power systems having any of
the following:
j.1.a. Chemical scrubber or absorber
systems, ‘‘specially designed’’ to remove
carbon dioxide, carbon monoxide and
particulates from recirculated engine
exhaust;
j.1.b. Systems ‘‘specially designed’’ to use
a monoatomic gas;
j.1.c. Devices or enclosures, ‘‘specially
designed’’ for underwater noise reduction in
frequencies below 10 kHz, or special
mounting devices for shock mitigation; or
j.1.d. Systems having all of the following:
j.1.d.1. ‘‘Specially designed’’ to pressurize
the products of reaction or for fuel
reformation;
j.1.d.2. ‘‘Specially designed’’ to store the
products of the reaction; and
j.1.d.3. ‘‘Specially designed’’ to discharge
the products of the reaction against a
pressure of 100 kPa or more;
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
j.2. Diesel cycle engine air independent
systems having all of the following:
j.2.a. Chemical scrubber or absorber
systems, ‘‘specially designed’’ to remove
carbon dioxide, carbon monoxide and
particulates from recirculated engine
exhaust;
j.2.b. Systems ‘‘specially designed’’ to use
a monoatomic gas;
j.2.c. Devices or enclosures, ‘‘specially
designed’’ for underwater noise reduction in
frequencies below 10 kHz, or special
mounting devices for shock mitigation; and
j.2.d. ‘‘Specially designed’’ exhaust
systems that do not exhaust continuously the
products of combustion;
j.3. ‘‘Fuel cell’’ air independent power
systems with an output exceeding 2 kW and
having any of the following:
j.3.a. Devices or enclosures, ‘‘specially
designed’’ for underwater noise reduction in
frequencies below 10 kHz, or special
mounting devices for shock mitigation; or
j.3.b. Systems having all of the following:
j.3.b.1. ‘‘Specially designed’’ to pressurize
the products of reaction or for fuel
reformation;
j.3.b.2. ‘‘Specially designed’’ to store the
products of the reaction; and
j.3.b.3. ‘‘Specially designed’’ to discharge
the products of the reaction against a
pressure of 100 kPa or more;
j.4. Stirling cycle engine air independent
power systems having all of the following:
j.4.a. Devices or enclosures, ‘‘specially
designed’’ for underwater noise reduction in
frequencies below 10 kHz, or special
mounting devices for shock mitigation; and
j.4.b. ‘‘Specially designed’’ exhaust systems
which discharge the products of combustion
against a pressure of 100 kPa or more;
k. [Reserved]
l. [Reserved]
m. [Reserved]
n. [Reserved]
o. Propellers, power transmission systems,
power generation systems and noise
reduction systems, as follows:
o.1. [Reserved]
o.2. Water-screw propeller, power
generation systems or transmission systems,
designed for use on vessels, as follows:
o.2.a. Controllable-pitch propellers and
hub assemblies, rated at more than 30 MW;
o.2.b. Internally liquid-cooled electric
propulsion motors with a power output
exceeding 2.5 MW;
o.2.c. ‘‘Superconductive’’ propulsion
motors with a power output exceeding 0.1
MW;
o.2.d. Power transmission shaft systems
incorporating ‘‘composite’’ material ‘‘parts’’
or ‘‘components’’ and capable of transmitting
more than 2 MW;
o.2.e. Ventilated or base-ventilated
propeller systems, rated at more than 2.5
MW;
o.3. Noise reduction systems designed for
use on vessels of 1,000 tonnes displacement
or more, as follows:
o.3.a. Systems that attenuate underwater
noise at frequencies below 500 Hz and
consist of compound acoustic mounts for the
acoustic isolation of diesel engines, diesel
generator sets, gas turbines, gas turbine
generator sets, propulsion motors or
PO 00000
Frm 00050
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
propulsion reduction gears, ‘‘specially
designed’’ for sound or vibration isolation
and having an intermediate mass exceeding
30% of the equipment to be mounted;
o.3.b. ‘Active noise reduction or
cancellation systems’ or magnetic bearings,
‘‘specially designed’’ for power transmission
systems;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
8A002.o.3.b, ’active noise reduction or
cancellation systems’ incorporate electronic
control systems capable of actively reducing
equipment vibration by the generation of
anti-noise or anti-vibration signals directly to
the source.
o.4. Permanent magnet electric propulsion
motors ‘‘specially designed’’ for submersible
vehicles, having a power output exceeding
0.1 MW.
Note: 8A002.o.4. includes rim-driven
propulsion systems.
p. Pumpjet propulsion systems having all
of the following:
p.1. Power output exceeding 2.5 MW; and
p.2. Using divergent nozzle and flow
conditioning vane techniques to improve
propulsive efficiency or reduce propulsiongenerated underwater-radiated noise;
q. Underwater swimming and diving
equipment as follows;
q.1. Closed circuit rebreathers;
q.2. Semi-closed circuit rebreathers;
Note: 8A002.q does not control individual
rebreathers for personal use when
accompanying their users.
N.B. For equipment and devices ‘‘specially
designed’’ for military use see ECCN 8A620.f.
r. Diver deterrent acoustic systems
‘‘specially designed’’ or modified to disrupt
divers and having a sound pressure level
equal to or exceeding 190 dB (reference 1 mPa
at 1 m) at frequencies of 200 Hz and below.
Note 1: 8A002.r does not apply to diver
deterrent systems based on under-waterexplosive devices, air guns or combustible
sources.
Note 2: 8A002.r includes diver deterrent
acoustic systems that use spark gap sources,
also known as plasma sound sources.
*
*
*
*
*
8C001 ‘Syntactic foam’ designed for
underwater use and having all of the
following (see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
AT applies to entire
entry.
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
NS Column 2
AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: See also 8A002.a.4.
Related Definition: For the purposes of
8C001, ‘Syntactic foam’ consists of hollow
spheres of plastic or glass embedded in a
resin ‘‘matrix.’’
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
Items:
a. Designed for marine depths exceeding
1,000 m; and
b. A density less than 561 kg/m3.
*
*
*
*
*
8E002 Other ‘‘technology’’ as follows (see
List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
AT applies to entire
entry.
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
*
NS Column 1
AT Column 1
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
*
*
Reason for Control: NS, MT, AT
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
Control(s)
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be
used to ship or transmit technology in
8E002.a to any of the destinations listed in
Country Group A:6 (See Supplement No. 1
to part 740 of the EAR).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: See also 8E992.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. ‘‘Technology’’ for the ‘‘development’’,
‘‘production’’, repair, overhaul or
refurbishing (re-machining) of propellers
‘‘specially designed’’ for underwater noise
reduction;
b. ‘‘Technology’’ for the overhaul or
refurbishing of equipment controlled by
8A001, 8A002.b, 8A002.j, 8A002.o or
8A002.p.
c. ‘‘Technology’’ according to the General
Technology Note for the ‘‘development’’ or
‘‘production’’ of any of the following:
c.1. Surface-effect vehicles (fully skirted
variety) having all of the following:
c.1.a. Maximum design speed, fully loaded,
exceeding 30 knots in a significant wave
height of 1.25 m or more;
c.1.b. Cushion pressure exceeding 3,830
Pa; and
c.1.c. Light-ship-to-full-load displacement
ratio of less than 0.70;
c.2. Surface-effect vehicles (rigid sidewalls)
with a maximum design speed, fully loaded,
exceeding 40 knots in a significant wave
height of 3.25 m or more;
c.3. Hydrofoil vessels with active systems
for automatically controlling foil systems,
with a maximum design speed, fully loaded,
of 40 knots or more in a significant wave
height of 3.25 m or more; or
c.4. ‘Small waterplane area vessels’ having
any of the following:
Jkt 262001
*
License Requirements
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
TSR: N/A
License Exceptions Note: License
Exception TSU is not applicable for the
repair ‘‘technology’’ controlled by 8E002.a or
.b, see Supplement No. 2 to part 774.
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
*
9A001 Aero gas turbine engines having any
of the following (see List of Items
Controlled).
Reporting Requirements
See § 743.1 of the EAR for reporting
requirements for exports under License
Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
VerDate Sep<11>2014
c.4.a. Full load displacement exceeding
500 tonnes with a maximum design speed,
fully loaded, exceeding 35 knots in a
significant wave height of 3.25 m or more; or
c.4.b. Full load displacement exceeding
1,500 tonnes with a maximum design speed,
fully loaded, exceeding 25 knots in a
significant wave height of 4 m or more.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
8E002.c.4, a ‘small waterplane area vessel’ is
defined by the following formula: waterplane
area at an operational design draft less than
2x (displaced volume at the operational
design draft)2/3.
NS applies to entire
entry.
MT applies to only to
those engines that
meet the characteristics listed in
9A101.
AT applies to entire
entry.
NS Column 1
MT Column 1
AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
the following aero gas turbine engines
(see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
AT applies to entire
entry.
*
*
*
*
*
PO 00000
Frm 00051
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
NS Column 2
AT Column 1
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: N/A
Related Definition: N/A
Items:
a. Controlled by 9A001; or
b. Whose design or production origins are
either not from a Wassenaar Participating
State (see Supplement No. 1 to part 743 of
the EAR) or unknown to the manufacturer.
9A004 Space launch vehicles and
‘‘spacecraft,’’ ‘‘spacecraft buses’’,
‘‘spacecraft payloads’’, ‘‘spacecraft’’ onboard systems or equipment, terrestrial
equipment, air-launch platforms, and
‘‘sub-orbital craft’’, as follows (see List
of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS and AT
Control(s)
9A003 ‘‘Specially designed’’ assemblies or
‘‘components’’, incorporating any of the
‘‘technologies’’ controlled by 9E003.a,
9E003.h, 9E003.i, or 9E003.k, for any of
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: $5000
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: See also 9A101 and 9A991.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Incorporating any of the ‘‘technologies’’
controlled by 9E003.a, 9E003.h, or 9E003.i;
Note 1: 9A001 does not control aero gas
turbine engines which meet all of the
following:
a. Certified by the civil aviation authority
in a country listed in Supplement No. 1 to
Part 743; and
b. Intended to power non-military manned
‘‘aircraft’’ for which any of the following has
been issued by a Wassenaar Arrangement
Participating State listed in Supplement No.
1 to Part 743 for the ‘‘aircraft’’ with this
specific engine type:
b.1. A civil type certificate; or
b.2. An equivalent document recognized by
the International Civil Aviation Organization
(ICAO).
Note 2: 9A001 does not apply to aero gas
turbine engines designed for Auxiliary Power
Units (APUs) approved by the civil aviation
authority in a Wassenaar Arrangement
Participating State (see Supplement No. 1 to
part 743 of the EAR).
b. [Reserved]
71981
NS applies to
9A004.g, .u, .v, .w
and .x.
AT applies to
9A004.g, .u, .v, .w,
.x and .y.
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
NS Column 1
AT Column 1
License Requirement Note: 9A004.b
through .f, and .h are controlled under
ECCN 9A515.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See also 9A104, 9A515,
and 9B515. (2) See ECCNs 9E001
(‘‘development’’) and 9E002
(‘‘production’’) for technology for items
controlled by this entry. (3) See USML
Categories IV for the space launch vehicles
and XV for other spacecraft that are
‘‘subject to the ITAR’’ (see 22 CFR parts
120 through 130).
Related Definition: N/A
Items:
a. Space launch vehicles;
b. ‘‘Spacecraft’’;
c. ‘‘Spacecraft buses’’;
d. ‘‘Spacecraft payloads’’ incorporating
items specified by 3A001.b.1.a.4, 3A002.g,
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
71982
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
5A001.a.1, 5A001.b.3, 5A002.c, 5A002.e,
6A002.a.1, 6A002.a.2, 6A002.b, 6A002.d,
6A003.b, 6A004.c, 6A004.e, 6A008.d,
6A008.e, 6A008.k, 6A008.l or 9A010.c;
e. On-board systems or equipment,
‘‘specially designed’’ for ‘‘spacecraft’’ and
having any of the following functions:
e.1. ‘Command and telemetry data
handling’;
Note: For the purposes of 9A004.e.1,
‘command and telemetry data handling’
includes bus data management, storage, and
processing.
e.2. ‘Payload data handling’; or
Note: For the purposes of 9A004.e.2,
‘payload data handling’ includes payload
data management, storage, and processing.
e.3. ‘Attitude and orbit control’;
Note: For the purposes of 9A004.e.3,
‘attitude and orbit control’ includes sensing
and actuation to determine and control the
position and orientation of a ‘‘spacecraft’’.
N.B.: Equipment ‘‘specially designed’’ for
military use is ‘‘subject to the ITAR’’. See 22
CFR parts 120 through 130.
f. Terrestrial equipment ‘‘specially
designed’’ for ‘‘spacecraft’’, as follows:
f.1. Telemetry and telecommand
equipment ‘‘specially designed’’ for any of
the following data processing functions:
f.1.a. Telemetry data processing of frame
synchronization and error corrections, for
monitoring of operational status (also known
as health and safe status) of the ‘‘spacecraft
bus’’; or
f.1.b. Command data processing for
formatting command data being sent to the
‘‘spacecraft’’ to control the ‘‘spacecraft bus’’;
f.2. Simulators ‘‘specially designed’’ for
‘verification of operational procedures’ of
‘‘spacecraft’’.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
9A004.f.2, ‘verification of operational
procedures’ is any of the following:
1. Command sequence confirmation;
2. Operational training;
3. Operational rehearsals; or
4. Operational analysis.
g. ‘‘Aircraft’’ ‘‘specially designed’’ or
modified to be air-launch platforms for space
launch vehicles or ‘‘sub-orbital craft’’.
h. ‘‘Sub-orbital craft’’.
i. through t. [Reserved]
u. The James Webb Space Telescope
(JWST) being developed, launched, and
operated under the supervision of the U.S.
National Aeronautics and Space
Administration (NASA).
v. ‘‘Parts,’’ ‘‘components,’’ ‘‘accessories’’
and ‘‘attachments’’ that are ‘‘specially
designed’’ for the James Webb Space
Telescope and that are not:
v.1. Enumerated or controlled in the
USML;
v.2. Microelectronic circuits;
v.3. Described in ECCN 7A004 or 7A104;
or
v.4. Described in an ECCN containing
‘‘space-qualified’’ as a control criterion (See
ECCN 9A515.x.4).
w. The International Space Station being
developed, launched, and operated under the
supervision of the U.S. National Aeronautics
and Space Administration.
x. ‘‘Parts,’’ ‘‘components,’’ ‘‘accessories’’
and ‘‘attachments’’ that are ‘‘specially
designed’’ for the International Space Station.
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
y. Items that would otherwise be within
the scope of ECCN 9A004.v or .x but that
have been identified in an interagencycleared commodity classification (CCATS)
pursuant to § 748.3(e) as warranting control
in 9A004.y.
9B005 On-line (real time) control systems,
instrumentation (including sensors) or
automated data acquisition and
processing equipment, ‘‘specially
designed’’ for use with any of the
following (see List of Items Controlled).
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
AT applies to entire
entry.
NS Column 1
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
Control(s)
MT applies to ‘‘technology’’ for items
controlled by
9A012, 9B001,
9B002, 9B003,
9B004, 9B005,
9B007, 9B104,
9B105, 9B106,
9B115, 9B116,
9B117, 9D001,
9D002, 9D003, or
9D004 for MT reasons.
AT applies to entire
entry.
MT Column 1
AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements
AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
See § 743.1 of the EAR for reporting
requirements for exports under License
Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
List of Items Controlled
TSR: N/A
Related Controls: See also 9B105.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Wind tunnels designed for speeds of
Mach 1.2 or more;
Note: 9B005.a does not control wind
tunnels ‘‘specially designed’’ for educational
purposes and having a ‘test section size’
(measured laterally) of less than 250 mm.
Technical Note: For the purposes of
9B005.a Note, ‘test section size’ means the
diameter of the circle, or the side of the
square, or the longest side of the rectangle,
at the largest test section location.
b. Devices for simulating flowenvironments at speeds exceeding Mach 5,
including hot-shot tunnels, plasma arc
tunnels, shock tubes, shock tunnels, gas
tunnels and light gas guns; or
c. Wind tunnels or devices, other than twodimensional sections, capable of simulating
Reynolds number flows exceeding 25 × 106.
Special Conditions for STA
*
*
*
*
*
9E001 ‘‘Technology’’ according to the
General Technology Note for the
‘‘development’’ of equipment or
‘‘software’’, controlled by 9A004, 9A012,
9B (except for ECCNs 9B604, 9B610,
9B619, 9B990 and 9B991), or ECCN
9D001 to 9D004, 9D101, or 9D104.
STA: License Exception STA may not be
used to ship or transmit any technology in
this entry to any of the destinations listed
in Country Group A:6 (See Supplement No.
1 to part 740 of the EAR)
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See also 9E101 and
1E002.f (for controls on ‘‘technology’’ for
the repair of controlled structures,
laminates or materials). (2) ‘‘Technology’’
required for the ‘‘development’’ of
equipment described in ECCNs 9A005 to
9A011 or ‘‘software’’ described in ECCNs
9D103 and 9D105 is ‘‘subject to the ITAR.’’
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
The list of items controlled is contained in
the ECCN heading.
9E002 ‘‘Technology’’ according to the
General Technology Note for the
‘‘production’’ of ‘‘equipment’’ controlled
by ECCN 9A004 or 9B (except for ECCNs
9B117, 9B604, 9B610, 9B619, 9B990, and
9B991).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, AT
Control(s)
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, AT
Control(s)
NS applies to ‘‘technology’’ for items
controlled by
9A004, 9A012,
9B001 to 9B010,
9D001 to 9D004
for NS reasons.
PO 00000
Frm 00052
Fmt 4701
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
NS Column 1
Sfmt 4700
NS applies to entire
entry.
MT applies to ‘‘technology’’ for equipment controlled by
9B001, 9B002,
9B003, 9B004,
9B005, 9B007,
9B104, 9B105,
9B106, 9B115 or
9B116 for MT reasons.
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
NS Column 1
MT Column 1
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
Control(s)
AT applies to entire
entry.
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements
See § 743.1 of the EAR for reporting
requirements for exports under License
Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
TSR: N/A
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be
used to ship or transmit any technology in
this entry to any of the destinations listed in
Country Group A:6 (See Supplement No.1 to
part 740 of the EAR).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See also 9E102. (2) See
also 1E002.f for ‘technology’’ for the repair
of controlled structures, laminates, or
materials. (3) ‘‘Technology’’ that is
required for the ‘‘production’’ of
equipment described in ECCNs 9A005 to
9A011 is ‘‘subject to the ITAR.’’
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
The list of items controlled is contained in
the ECCN heading.
9E003 Other ‘‘technology’’ as follows (see
List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, SI, AT
Control(s)
NS applies to entire
entry.
SI applies to
9E003.a.1 through
a.8, .h, .i, and .l.
AT applies to entire
entry.
Country chart
(see Supp. No. 1 to
part 738)
NS Column 1
See § 742.14 of the
EAR for additional
information.
AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements
See § 743.1 of the EAR for reporting
requirements for exports under License
Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740
for a Description of All License Exceptions)
TSR: N/A
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be
used to ship or transmit any technology in
9E003.a.1 to a.5, 9E003.c., 9E003.h, or
9E003.i (other than technology for fan or
power turbines) to any of the destinations
listed in Country Group A:5 or A:6 (See
Supplement No.1 to part 740 of the EAR).
License Exception STA may not be used to
ship or transmit any technology in 9E003.k
to any of the destinations listed in Country
Group A:6 (See Supplement No.1 to part 740
of the EAR).
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) Hot section
‘‘technology’’ specifically designed,
modified, or equipped for military uses or
purposes, or developed principally with
U.S. Department of Defense funding, is
‘‘subject to the ITAR’’ (see 22 CFR parts
120 through 130). (2) ‘‘Technology’’ is
subject to the EAR when actually applied
to a commercial ‘‘aircraft’’ engine program.
Exporters may seek to establish
commercial application either on a caseby-case basis through submission of
documentation demonstrating application
to a commercial program in requesting an
export license from the Department of
Commerce in respect to a specific export,
or in the case of use for broad categories
of ‘‘aircraft,’’ engines, ‘‘parts’’ or
‘‘components,’’ a commodity jurisdiction
determination from the Department of
State.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. ‘‘Technology’’ ‘‘required’’ for the
‘‘development’’ or ‘‘production’’ of any of the
following gas turbine engine ‘‘parts,’’
‘‘components’’ or systems:
a.1. Gas turbine blades, vanes or ‘‘tip
shrouds’’, made from Directionally Solidified
(DS) or Single Crystal (SC) alloys and having
(in the 001 Miller Index Direction) a stressrupture life exceeding 400 hours at 1,273 K
(1,000 °C) at a stress of 200 MPa, based on the
average property values;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
9E003.a.1, stress-rupture life testing is
typically conducted on a test specimen.
a.2. Combustors having any of the
following:
a.2.a. ‘Thermally decoupled liners’
designed to operate at ‘combustor exit
temperature’ exceeding 1,883 K (1,610 °C);
a.2.b. Non-metallic liners;
a.2.c. Non-metallic shells; or
a.2. d. Liners designed to operate at
’combustor exit temperature’ exceeding 1,883
K (1,610 °C) and having holes that meet the
parameters specified by 9E003.c;
a.2.e. Utilizing ‘pressure gain combustion’;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
9E003.a.2.e, in ‘pressure gain combustion’
the bulk average stagnation pressure at the
combustor outlet is greater than the bulk
average stagnation pressure at the combustor
inlet due primarily to the combustion
process, when the engine is running in a
‘‘steady state mode’’ of operation.
Note: The ‘‘required’’ ‘‘technology’’ for
holes in 9E003.a.2 is limited to the derivation
of the geometry and location of the holes.
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 9E003.a.2.a,
‘thermally decoupled liners’ are liners that
feature at least a support structure designed
to carry mechanical loads and a combustion
facing structure designed to protect the
support structure from the heat of
combustion. The combustion facing structure
and support structure have independent
thermal displacement (mechanical
displacement due to thermal load) with
respect to one another, i.e., they are
thermally decoupled.
2. For the purposes of 9E003.a.2.d,
‘combustor exit temperature’ is the bulk
PO 00000
Frm 00053
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
71983
average gas path total (stagnation)
temperature between the combustor exit
plane and the leading edge of the turbine
inlet guide vane (i.e., measured at engine
station T40 as defined in SAE ARP 755A)
when the engine is running in a ‘‘steady state
mode’’ of operation at the certificated
maximum continuous operating temperature.
N.B.: See 9E003.c for ‘‘technology’’
‘‘required’’ for manufacturing cooling holes.
a.3. ‘‘Parts’’ or ‘‘components,’’ that are any
of the following:
a.3.a. Manufactured from organic
‘‘composite’’ materials designed to operate
above 588 K (315 °C);
a.3.b. Manufactured from any of the
following:
a.3.b.1. Metal ‘‘matrix’’ ‘‘composites’’
reinforced by any of the following:
a.3.b.1.a. Materials controlled by 1C007;
a.3.b.1.b. ‘‘Fibrous or filamentary
materials’’ specified by 1C010; or
a.3.b.1.c. Aluminides specified by 1C002.a;
or
a.3.b.2. Ceramic ‘‘matrix’’ ‘‘composites’’
specified by 1C007; or
a.3.c. Stators, vanes, blades, tip seals
(shrouds), rotating blings, rotating blisks or
‘splitter ducts’, that are all of the following:
a.3.c.1. Not specified in 9E003.a.3.a;
a.3.c.2. Designed for compressors or fans;
and
a.3.c.3. Manufactured from material
controlled by 1C010.e with resins controlled
by 1C008;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
9E003.a.3.c, a ‘splitter duct’ performs the
initial separation of the air-mass flow
between the bypass and core sections of the
engine.
a.4. Uncooled turbine blades, vanes or ‘‘tip
shrouds’’ designed to operate at a ‘gas path
temperature’ of 1,373 K (1,100 °C) or more;
a.5. Cooled turbine blades, vanes or ‘‘tip
shrouds’’, other than those described in
9E003.a.1, designed to operate at a ‘gas path
temperature’ of 1,693 K (1,420 °C) or more;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
9E003.a.5, ‘gas path temperature’ is the bulk
average gas path total (stagnation)
temperature at the leading-edge plane of the
turbine component when the engine is
running in a ‘‘steady state mode’’ of
operation at the certificated or specified
maximum continuous operating temperature.
a.6. Airfoil-to-disk blade combinations
using solid state joining;
a.7. [Reserved]
a.8. ‘Damage tolerant’ gas turbine engine
rotor ‘‘parts’’ or ‘‘components’’ using powder
metallurgy materials controlled by 1C002.b;
or
Technical Note: For the purposes of
9E003.a.8, ‘damage tolerant’ ‘‘parts’’ and
‘‘components’’ are designed using
methodology and substantiation to predict
and limit crack growth.
a.9. [Reserved]
N.B.: For ‘‘FADEC systems’’, see 9E003.h.
a.10. [Reserved]
N.B.: For adjustable flow path geometry,
see 9E003.i.
a.11. ‘Fan blades’ having all of the
following:
a.11.a. 20% or more of the total volume
being one or more closed cavities containing
vacuum or gas only; and
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
71984
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
a.11.b. One or more closed cavities having
a volume of 5 cm3 or larger;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
9E003.a.11, a ‘fan blade’ is the aerofoil
portion of the rotating stage or stages, which
provide both compressor and bypass flow in
a gas turbine engine.
b. ‘‘Technology’’ ‘‘required’’ for the
‘‘development’’ or ‘‘production’’ of any of the
following:
b.1. Wind tunnel aero-models equipped
with non-intrusive sensors capable of
transmitting data from the sensors to the data
acquisition system; or
b.2. ‘‘Composite’’ propeller blades or propfans, capable of absorbing more than 2,000
kW at flight speeds exceeding Mach 0.55;
c. ‘‘Technology’’ ‘‘required’’ for
manufacturing cooling holes in gas turbine
engine ‘‘parts’’ or ‘‘components’’
incorporating any of the ‘‘technologies’’
specified by 9E003.a.1, 9E003.a.2, or
9E003.a.5, and having any of the following:
c.1. Having all of the following:
c.1.a. Minimum ‘cross-sectional area’ less
than 0.45 mm2;
c.1.b. ‘Hole shape ratio’ greater than 4.52;
and
c.1.c. ‘Incidence angle’ equal to or less than
25°; or
c.2. Having all of the following:
c.2.a. Minimum ‘cross-sectional area’ less
than 0.12 mm2;
c.2.b. ‘Hole shape ratio’ greater than 5.65;
and
c.2.c. ‘Incidence angle’ more than 25°;
Note: 9E003.c does not apply to
‘‘technology’’ for manufacturing constant
radius cylindrical holes that are straight
through and enter and exit on the external
surfaces of the component.
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 9E003.c, the ‘crosssectional area’ is the area of the hole in the
plane perpendicular to the hole axis.
2. For the purposes of 9E003.c, ‘hole shape
ratio’ is the nominal length of the axis of the
hole divided by the square root of its
minimum ’cross-sectional area’.
3. For the purposes of 9E003.c, ‘incidence
angle’ is the acute angle measured between
the plane tangential to the airfoil surface and
the hole axis at the point where the hole axis
enters the airfoil surface.
4. For the purposes of 9E003.c, methods for
manufacturing holes include ‘‘laser’’ beam
machining, water jet machining, ElectroChemical Machining (ECM) or Electrical
Discharge Machining (EDM).
d. ‘‘Technology’’ ‘‘required’’ for the
‘‘development’’ or ‘‘production’’ of helicopter
power transfer systems or tilt rotor or tilt
wing ‘‘aircraft’’ power transfer systems;
e. ‘‘Technology’’ for the ‘‘development’’ or
‘‘production’’ of reciprocating diesel engine
ground vehicle propulsion systems having all
of the following:
e.1. ‘Box volume’ of 1.2 m3 or less;
e.2. An overall power output of more than
750 kW based on 80/1269/EEC, ISO 2534 or
national equivalents; and
e.3. Power density of more than 700 kW/
m3 of ‘box volume’;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
9E003.e.1., ‘box volume’ is the product of
three perpendicular dimensions measured in
the following way:
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
Length: The length of the crankshaft from
front flange to flywheel face;
Width: The widest of any of the following:
a. The outside dimension from valve cover
to valve cover;
b. The dimensions of the outside edges of
the cylinder heads; or
c. The diameter of the flywheel housing;
Height: The largest of any of the following:
a. The dimension of the crankshaft centerline to the top plane of the valve cover (or
cylinder head) plus twice the stroke; or
b. The diameter of the flywheel housing.
f. ‘‘Technology’’ ‘‘required’’ for the
‘‘production’’ of ‘‘specially designed’’ ‘‘parts’’
or ‘‘components’’ for high output diesel
engines, as follows:
f.1. ‘‘Technology’’ ‘‘required’’ for the
‘‘production’’ of engine systems having all of
the following ‘‘parts’’ and ‘‘components’’
employing ceramics materials controlled by
1C007:
f.1.a Cylinder liners;
f.1.b. Pistons;
f.1.c. Cylinder heads; and
f.1.d. One or more other ‘‘part’’ or
‘‘component’’ (including exhaust ports,
turbochargers, valve guides, valve assemblies
or insulated fuel injectors);
f.2. ‘‘Technology’’ ‘‘required’’ for the
‘‘production’’ of turbocharger systems with
single-stage compressors and having all of
the following:
f.2.a. Operating at pressure ratios of 4:1 or
higher;
f.2.b. Mass flow in the range from 30 to 130
kg per minute; and
f.2.c. Variable flow area capability within
the compressor or turbine sections;
f.3. ‘‘Technology’’ ‘‘required’’ for the
‘‘production’’ of fuel injection systems with
a ‘‘specially designed’’ multifuel (e.g., diesel
or jet fuel) capability covering a viscosity
range from diesel fuel (2.5 cSt at 310.8 K
(37.8 °C)) down to gasoline fuel (0.5 cSt at
310.8 K (37.8 °C)) and having all of the
following:
f.3.a. Injection amount in excess of 230
mm3 per injection per cylinder; and
f.3.b. Electronic control features ‘‘specially
designed’’ for switching governor
characteristics automatically depending on
fuel property to provide the same torque
characteristics by using the appropriate
sensors;
g. ‘‘Technology’’ ‘‘required’’ for the
‘‘development’’ or ‘‘production’’ of ‘high
output diesel engines’ for solid, gas phase or
liquid film (or combinations thereof) cylinder
wall lubrication and permitting operation to
temperatures exceeding 723 K (450 °C),
measured on the cylinder wall at the top
limit of travel of the top ring of the piston;
Technical Note: For the purposes of
9E003.g, ‘high output diesel engines’ are
diesel engines with a specified brake mean
effective pressure of 1.8 MPa or more at a
speed of 2,300 r.p.m., provided the rated
speed is 2,300 r.p.m. or more.
h. ‘‘Technology’’ for gas turbine engine
‘‘FADEC systems’’ as follows:
h.1. ‘‘Development’’ ‘‘technology’’ for
deriving the functional requirements for the
‘‘parts’’ or ‘‘components’’ necessary for the
‘‘FADEC system’’ to regulate engine thrust or
shaft power (e.g., feedback sensor time
PO 00000
Frm 00054
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4700
constants and accuracies, fuel valve slew
rate);
h.2. ‘‘Development’’ or ‘‘production’’
‘‘technology’’ for control and diagnostic
‘‘parts’’ or ‘‘components’’ unique to the
‘‘FADEC system’’ and used to regulate engine
thrust or shaft power;
h.3. ‘‘Development’’ ‘‘technology’’ for the
control law algorithms, including ‘‘source
code’’, unique to the ‘‘FADEC system’’ and
used to regulate engine thrust or shaft power;
Note: 9E003.h does not apply to
technology related to engine-‘‘aircraft’’
integration required by civil aviation
authorities of one or more Wassenaar
Arrangement Participating States (See
Supplement No. 1 to part 743 of the EAR) to
be published for general airline use (e.g.,
installation manuals, operating instructions,
instructions for continued airworthiness) or
interface functions (e.g., input/output
processing, airframe thrust or shaft power
demand).
i. ‘‘Technology’’ for adjustable flow path
systems designed to maintain engine stability
for gas generator turbines, fan or power
turbines, or propelling nozzles, as follows:
i.1. ‘‘Development’’ ‘‘technology’’ for
deriving the functional requirements for the
‘‘parts’’ or ‘‘components’’ that maintain
engine stability;
i.2. ‘‘Development’’ or ‘‘production’’
‘‘technology’’ for ‘‘parts’’ or ‘‘components’’
unique to the adjustable flow path system
and that maintain engine stability;
i.3. ‘‘Development’’ ‘‘technology’’ for the
control law algorithms, including ‘‘source
code’’, unique to the adjustable flow path
system and that maintain engine stability;
Note: 9E003.i does not apply to
‘‘technology’’ for any of the following:
a. Inlet guide vanes;
b. Variable pitch fans or prop-fans;
c. Variable compressor vanes;
d. Compressor bleed valves; or
e. Adjustable flow path geometry for
reverse thrust.
j. ‘‘Technology’’ ‘‘required’’ for the
‘‘development’’ of wing-folding systems
designed for fixed-wing ‘‘aircraft’’ powered
by gas turbine engines.
N.B.: For ‘‘technology’’ ‘‘required’’ for the
‘‘development’’ of wing-folding systems
designed for fixed-wing ‘‘aircraft’’ specified
in USML Category VIII (a), see USML
Category VIII (i).
k. ‘‘Technology’’, not specified in 9E003.a,
9E003.h, or 9E003.i, ‘‘required’’ for the
‘‘development’’ of any of the following
components or systems, ‘‘specially designed’’
for aero gas turbine engines to enable
‘‘aircraft’’ to cruise at Mach 1 or greater for
more than 30 minutes:
k.1. Propulsion inlet systems;
k.2. Propulsion exhaust systems;
k.3. ’Reheat systems’;
k.4. ‘Active thermal management systems’
to condition fluids used to lubricate or cool
‘engine rotor supports’;
k.5. Oil-free ’engine rotor supports’; or
k.6. Systems to remove heat from
’compression system’ core gas path flow.
Technical Notes: For the purposes of
9E003.k:
1. Propulsion inlet systems include core
flow pre-coolers.
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 / Rules and Regulations
ddrumheller on DSK120RN23PROD with RULES2
2. ’Reheat systems’ provide additional
thrust by combusting fuel in exhaust and/or
bypass flow downstream of the last
turbomachinery stage. ’Reheat systems’ are
also referred to as afterburners.
3. ’Active thermal management systems’
employ methods other than passive oil-to-air
cooling or oil-to-fuel cooling, such as vapor
cycle systems.
4. ’Compression system’ is any stage or
combination of stages between the engine
inlet face and the combustor that increases
gas path pressure through mechanical work.
5. An ’engine rotor support’ is the bearing
supporting the main engine shaft that drives
the compression system or turbine rotors.
VerDate Sep<11>2014
19:44 Oct 17, 2023
Jkt 262001
N.B. 1 See 9E003.h, for engine control
technology.
N.B. 2 See 9E003.i, for adjustable flow
path systems technology.
l. ‘‘Technology’’ not otherwise controlled
in 9E003.a.1 through a.8, a.10, and .h and
used in the ‘‘development’’, ‘‘production’’, or
overhaul of hot section ‘‘parts’’ or
‘‘components’’ of civil derivatives of military
engines controlled on the U.S. Munitions
List.
*
*
*
*
*
■ 13. Supplement no. 6 to part 774 is
amended by revising paragraph (4) to
read as follows:
PO 00000
Frm 00055
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 9990
71985
Supplement No. 6 to Part 774—
Sensitive List
*
*
*
*
(4) Category 4
(i) 4A001.a.2.
(ii) [Reserved]
*
*
*
*
*
*
Thea D. Rozman Kendler,
Assistant Secretary for Export
Administration.
[FR Doc. 2023–22299 Filed 10–12–23; 4:15 pm]
BILLING CODE 3510–33–P
E:\FR\FM\18OCR2.SGM
18OCR2
Agencies
[Federal Register Volume 88, Number 200 (Wednesday, October 18, 2023)]
[Rules and Regulations]
[Pages 71932-71985]
From the Federal Register Online via the Government Publishing Office [www.gpo.gov]
[FR Doc No: 2023-22299]
[[Page 71931]]
Vol. 88
Wednesday,
No. 200
October 18, 2023
Part II
Department of Commerce
-----------------------------------------------------------------------
Bureau of Industry and Security
-----------------------------------------------------------------------
15 CFR Parts 734, 740, 742, et al.
Implementation of 2022 Wassenaar Arrangement Decisions and Request for
Comments on License Exception Eligibility for Certain Supersonic Aero
Gas Turbine Engine Component Technology; Interim Final Rule
Federal Register / Vol. 88, No. 200 / Wednesday, October 18, 2023 /
Rules and Regulations
[[Page 71932]]
-----------------------------------------------------------------------
DEPARTMENT OF COMMERCE
Bureau of Industry and Security
15 CFR Parts 734, 740, 742, 772, and 774
[Docket No. 230929-0236]
RIN 0694-AI95
Implementation of 2022 Wassenaar Arrangement Decisions and
Request for Comments on License Exception Eligibility for Certain
Supersonic Aero Gas Turbine Engine Component Technology
AGENCY: Bureau of Industry and Security, Commerce.
ACTION: Interim final rule, with request for comment.
-----------------------------------------------------------------------
SUMMARY: The Bureau of Industry and Security (BIS) maintains, as part
of its Export Administration Regulations (EAR), the Commerce Control
List (CCL), which identifies certain items subject to Department of
Commerce jurisdiction. During the December 2022 Wassenaar Arrangement
on Export Controls for Conventional Arms and Dual-Use Goods and
Technologies (WA) Plenary meeting, Participating States of the WA
(Participating States) made certain decisions affecting the WA dual-use
and munitions control lists, which BIS is now implementing via
amendments to the CCL. BIS seeks comments on restricting STA
eligibility for countries in EAR Country Group A:5 of certain
technology for the development of supersonic aero gas turbine engine
components controlled under ECCN 9E003.k, formerly controlled under
ECCN 9E001 as part of its ongoing assessment of current export control
licensing policy.
DATES: This rule is effective October 18, 2023. Comments specific to
ECCN 9E003.k must be received by BIS no later than December 4, 2023.
ADDRESSES: Comments on this rule may be submitted to the Federal
rulemaking portal (www.regulations.gov). The regulations.gov ID for
this rule is: BIS-2023-0025. Please refer to RIN 0694-AI95 in all
comments.
All filers using the portal should use the name of the person or
entity submitting the comments as the name of their files, in
accordance with the instructions below. Anyone submitting business
confidential information should clearly identify the business
confidential portion at the time of submission, file a statement
justifying nondisclosure and referring to the specific legal authority
claimed, and provide a non-confidential version of the submission.
For comments submitted electronically containing business
confidential information, the file name of the business confidential
version should begin with the characters ``BC.'' Any page containing
business confidential information must be clearly marked ``BUSINESS
CONFIDENTIAL'' on the top of that page. The corresponding non-
confidential version of those comments must be clearly marked
``PUBLIC.'' The file name of the non-confidential version should begin
with the character ``P.'' Any submissions with file names that do not
begin with either a ``BC'' or a ``P'' will be assumed to be public and
will be made publicly available through https://www.regulations.gov.
Commenters submitting business confidential information are encouraged
to scan a hard copy of the non-confidential version to create an image
of the file, rather than submitting a digital copy with redactions
applied, to avoid inadvertent redaction errors which could enable the
public to read business confidential information.
FOR FURTHER INFORMATION CONTACT: For general questions, contact Sharron
Cook, Office of Exporter Services, Bureau of Industry and Security,
U.S. Department of Commerce at 202-482-2440 or by email:
[email protected].
For Technical Questions Contact
Categories 0, 1 & 2: Sean Ghannadian at 202-482-3429 or
[email protected]
Category 3: Carlos Monroy at 202-482-3246 or [email protected]
Categories 4 & 5: Aaron Amundson or [email protected]
Categories 6: John Varesi at 202-482-1114 or [email protected]
Categories 7: David Rosenberg at 202-482-5987, John Varesi at 202-482-
1114 or [email protected] or [email protected]
Category 9: David Rosenberg at 202-482-5987, Jason Chauvin at 202-482-
6462 or [email protected] or [email protected]
``600 Series'' (munitions items): Jeffrey Leitz at 202-482-7417 or
[email protected]
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION:
Background
The WA (https://www.wassenaar.org/) is a group of 42 like-minded
states committed to promoting responsibility and transparency in the
global arms trade and preventing destabilizing accumulations of
conventional weapons. As a Participating State of the WA (Participating
State), the United States has committed to controlling for export all
items on the WA's List of Dual-Use Goods and Technologies (WA Dual-Use
List) and on the WA Munitions List (together, WA control lists). The WA
control lists were first established in 1996 and have been revised
annually thereafter. Participating States implement changes to the WA
control lists as soon as possible after the WA Plenary. By doing so in
a timely manner, the United States demonstrates its decisive support
for the goals of the WA, namely, that transfers do not contribute to
the development or enhancement of military capabilities or are not
diverted to support such capabilities. Timely implementation also
ensures that U.S. companies have a level playing field with their
competitors in other Participating States.
Revisions to the Commerce Control List Related to WA 2022 Plenary
Meeting Decisions
Revisions (14) ECCNs: 1B001, 4D001,4E001, 6A005, 6B007, 7A003,
7E004, 8A001, 8A002, 9A001, 9A003, 9E001, 9E002, and 9E003.
Editorial Revision to Technical Notes in (55) ECCNS: This rule adds
the phrase `For the purposes of' in various Technical Notes in singular
and plural form in ECCNs 1A004, 1A006, 1A007, 1A008, 1B001, 1C001,
1C002, 1C005, 1C008, 1C010, 1C011, 2A001, 2B004, 2B006, 2B008, 2B009,
2E003, 3A001, 3A002, 3B001, 3D003, 3D006, 3E001, 3E002, 4A004, 4D001,
4E001, 5A001, 5A002, 5A004, 6A001, 6A002, 6A003, 6A004, 6A005, 6A006,
6A007, 6A008, 6B007, 6C002, 6C005, 6D003, 6E003,7A004, 7A005, 7A006,
7B001, 7D002, 7E004, 8A002, 8C001, 8E002, 9A004, 9B005, and 9E003. The
intention of this revision is to ensure consistency among ECCNs.
1C010 ``Fibrous or Filamentary Materials''
This rule makes an editorial revision by adding a reference to
1C010.e.1.b to technical note 1 because both paragraphs e.1.b.1 and
e.1.b.2 use terms referenced in this technical note.
4D001 ``Software'' and 4E001 ``Technology''
In paragraphs 4D001.b.1 and 4E001.b.1, this rule changes the
parameters of Weighted TeraFLOPS (WT) from 15 to 24. This change is
made because processors with built-in hardware memory-coherent
interconnects allow groupings of up to 8 processors without any
additional
[[Page 71933]]
technical know-how, and it is widely believed that a single processor
will reach Adjusted Peak Performance (APP) levels of up to 2 WT in the
next year, and up to 2.5 WT by the 2025 timeframe. Thus, companies will
soon be able to build computers that exceed the current APP levels
without any additional technology. The corresponding technology and
software levels in License Exception APP (Section 740.7 of the EAR)
were adjusted in a final rule that implemented certain changes agreed
to at the December 2021 WA Plenary. See 88 FR 12108 (February 24,
2023). Thus, BIS is not making any additional adjustments to those
thresholds at this time.
6A005 ``Lasers'', ``Components'' and Optical Equipment
This rule raises the ``average output power'' parameter from ``50
W'' to ``80 W'' in 6A005.b.3.a.2. For the industrial applications that
use green lasers, the power level is a key factor in manufacturing
productivity. These applications require certain pulse energies for the
resultant processes. To enhance manufacturing productivity, the
repetition frequency for a given pulse energy must be increased,
thereby requiring an increase in the average output power. Today, the
average output power requirements for industrial green lasers exceed
the WA threshold of 50 W, and are expected to continue an upward trend
to more than 80 W. Companies outside of Participating States compete in
the industrial green laser market, for example, several Chinese
companies manufacture green lasers with average output power in the 50-
80 W range.
To accommodate increased demand for single-mode semiconductor laser
diodes, a decision was made during the WA 2022 Plenary to increase the
technical parameters for semiconductor lasers. Specifically, adjusting
the wavelength from 1,510 nm to 1,570 nm in 6A005.d.1.a.1 and d.1.a.2
groups these lasers with other semiconductor lasers with lower
sensitivity applications. As a result, the necessary output power
accommodation for automotive Light Detection and Ranging (LIDAR)
applications is achieved with a modest output power increase from 1.5 W
to 2.0 W in 6A005.d.1.a.1. Semiconductor lasers that fall within these
parameters, while very useful for automotive LIDAR, have limited
utility in military applications.
6A007 Gravity Meters (Gravimeters) and Gravity Gradiometers
A technical note to define `time-to-steady-state registration' is
added after paragraph 6A007.b.2, to harmonize this entry with the entry
on the WA Dual-Use List.
6B007 Equipment To Produce, Align and Calibrate Land-Based Gravity
Meters
This rule adds the word ``less'' to the heading of ECCN 6B007 to
clarify that an ``accuracy'' better than 0.1 mGal is less than 0.1
mGal.
7A003 `Inertial Measurement Equipment or Systems'
This rule moves the definition of `inertial measurement equipment
or systems' from Note 1 to a technical note, so that this entry is
consistent with other CCL entries in which definitions are set forth in
technical notes.
8A001 Submersible Vehicles and Surface Vessels
In paragraph 8A001.c.1.c, this rule adds the term `wireless' before
the term `optical data' to clarify that the reference is to
communications through water and to distinguish Remotely Operated
Vehicles (ROVs) having this capability from those designed to only use
a fiber optic data link.
8A002 Marine Systems, Equipment, ``Parts'' and ``Components''
In paragraphs 8A002.o.2.b and 8A002.o.2.c, this rule replaces the
term `engines' with `motors' before the term `propulsion.' While the
terms ``engines'' and ``motors'' are largely interchangeable, it was
determined that ``motor'' is more commonly used in the context of 8A002
items. In paragraph 8A002.o.4, this rule adds a new control for
permanent magnet propulsion systems (PM propulsion systems) to
adequately cover propulsion systems using permanent magnet motors,
including Rim Driven Propulsion systems (RDPs).
9A001 Aero Gas Turbine Engines, and Technology Therefor in 9E001 and
9E002
This rule revises 9A001, 9A003, 9E001, 9E002, and 9E003 to permit
the same civil certification release from 9A001 to 9A991 for supersonic
aero gas turbine engines that is available for subsonic aero gas
turbine engines.
The rule conforms with the decisions made at WA with regard to
9A001, specifically to combine 9A001.a and 9A001.b to allow for the
same exclusion when the engine is certified by type with a civil
certified supersonic aircraft. This rule revises the reference to
9A001.a in Notes 1 and 2 to read as 9A001, as 9A001.a is now the only
subparagraph in 9A001. Note 1 now excludes from 9A001 aero gas turbine
engines that power an ``aircraft'' to Mach 1 or higher for more than 30
minutes if the engines have been certified by an appropriate civil
aviation authority, and are intended to power an ``aircraft'' for which
a type certificate (or equivalent document) has been issued, as these
engines are now controlled under ECCN 9A991 for AT reasons. As a
conforming revision, the reference to 9A001.b is removed from the
headings of ECCNs 9E001 and 9E002, as well as from the license
requirements tables of these ECCNs. In addition, consistent with the
removal of 9A001.b from the CCL, as described above, this rule also
removes paragraphs (E) and (F) from Sec. 740.20(b)(2)(viii), which had
identified technology associated with 9A001.b that was ineligible for
export, reexport, and transfer (in-country) under License Exception
STA. Former paragraph (G) is redesignated as paragraph (E).
9A003 ``Specially Designed'' Assemblies or ``Components,''
Incorporating Any of the ``Technologies'' Controlled by 9E003.a,
9E003.h, 9E003.i, or 9E003.k, for Any of the Following Aero Gas Turbine
Engines
This rule adds paragraph 9E003.k to the heading of ECCN 9A003,
which expands the scope of control of assemblies and components under
this ECCN.
9E003 Other ``Technology'' as Specified
This rule makes a simple editorial change to remove the first comma
in 9E003.c after ``cooling holes'' that otherwise might bring confusion
to the control text. This rule also redesignates 9E003.k as 9E003.l and
adds a new paragraph 9E003.k to control specific technologies, formerly
controlled by 9E001, that are peculiarly responsible for the
development of an aero gas turbine engine that can enable an aircraft
to cruise at supersonic speeds (Mach 1 or greater) for more than 30
minutes. This technology addition to 9E003 addresses the
``development'' of systems and components that enable the engine and
aircraft to operate a supersonic speed. Because 9E003.k references
engine capability (which does not change with certification) this
important ``development'' technology will remain controlled even after
the engine enters civil operation. The license requirement table is
amended to reflect the redesignation of 9E003.k to
[[Page 71934]]
9E003.l to the SI control paragraph. Related revisions as a result of
this redesignation are made to Sec. Sec. 734.4(a)(4),
740.20(b)(2)(viii), 742.14(a), and the introductory text of 742.14(b).
The new 9E003.k technology for supersonic engines controls
development technology only. The associated production technology has
shifted from ECCN 9E002 to ECCN 9E991 and is designated as ``No License
Required'' (NLR) to all destinations or countries listed in Country
Group A:5 and A:6 (see supplement no. 1 to part 740 of the EAR).
The STA restrictions under 9E003 are revised by adding an ``or''
after 9E003.h and adding Country Group A:5 to harmonize with
740.20(b)(2) for 9E003. In addition, this rule adds a new STA
restriction paragraph for 9E003.k for Country Group A:6 in order to
maintain the STA restriction previously on ECCN 9E001 for ECCN
paragraph 9A001.b. As required by the Export Control Reform Act (ECRA)
(50 U.S.C. 4801-4852), BIS continually evaluates the control status of
a range of technologies, including those related to supersonic engines,
to effectively protect U.S. national security and foreign policy
interests. In light of the amendments to 9E001 and 9E003 implementing
the WA revisions, which identify technologies required for the
development of specific components or systems specially designed for
supersonic engines, BIS is seeking comment on whether to retain License
Exception STA eligibility for destinations specified in Country Group
A:5 of supplement no. 1 to part 740 of the EAR for the technology
specified in 9E003.k. We invite the public to comment on this issue
before the comment period closes. Information about how to comment is
provided in the Address section of this rule.
Part 772--Definitions of Terms
This rule revises the definition for ``intrusion software'' by
adding double quotes around the term ``program'' in paragraph (2) to
indicate it is a defined term in Sec. 772.1.
This rule notes the two occurrences of the term ``program'' that
did not have double quotation marks indicating it is a defined term in
Sec. 772.1 and corrects this omission in technical note 1 below
paragraph .g in ECCN 1B001 and in paragraph (2) in the definition of
``intrusion software'' in Sec. 772.1. This rule also amends the term
``program'' in Sec. 772.1 to add category 1 and 7 and remove category
2 from the categories where the term is used.
Supplement No. 6 to Part 774 Sensitive List
Paragraph 4 of supplement no. 6 to part 774 Sensitive List (SL) is
amended by removing paragraphs (ii) 4D001 and (iii) 4E001. This change
is being made as a consequence of the raising of the APP thresholds in
4D001 and 4E001. This rule implements the WA 2022 Plenary determination
that high performance computer technology and software do not merit the
same level of sensitivity as other items on the SL.
Savings Clause
Shipments of items removed from license exception eligibility or
eligibility for export, reexport or transfer (in-country) without a
license as a result of this regulatory action that were on dock for
loading, on lighter, laden aboard an exporting carrier, or en route
aboard a carrier to a port of export, on October 18, 2023, pursuant to
actual orders for exports, reexports and transfers (in-country) to a
foreign destination, may proceed to that destination under the previous
license exception eligibility or without a license so long as they have
been exported, reexported or transferred (in-country) before December
18, 2023. Any such items not actually exported, reexported or
transferred (in-country) before midnight, on December 18, 2023, require
a license in accordance with this interim final rule.
Export Control Reform Act of 2018
On August 13, 2018, the President signed into law the John S.
McCain National Defense Authorization Act for Fiscal Year 2019, which
included the Export Control Reform Act (ECRA), 50 U.S.C. 4801-4852.
ECRA, as amended, provides the legal basis for BIS's principal
authorities and serves as the authority under which BIS issues this
rule.
Rulemaking Requirements
1. Executive Orders 12866, 13563, and 14094 direct agencies to
assess all costs and benefits of available regulatory alternatives and,
if regulation is necessary, to select regulatory approaches that
maximize net benefits (including potential economic, environmental,
public health and safety effects and distributive impacts and equity).
Executive Order 13563 emphasizes the importance of quantifying both
costs and benefits and of reducing costs, harmonizing rules, and
promoting flexibility.
This interim final rule has been designated a ``significant
regulatory action'' under section 3(f) of Executive Order 12866, as
amended by Executive Order 14094. This rule does not contain policies
with Federalism implications as that term is defined under Executive
Order 13132.
2. Notwithstanding any other provision of law, no person is
required to respond to, nor shall any person be subject to a penalty
for failure to comply with, a collection of information subject to the
requirements of the Paperwork Reduction Act of 1995 (44 U.S.C. 3501 et
seq.) (PRA), unless that collection of information displays a currently
valid Office of Management and Budget (OMB) Control Number. Although
this rule makes important changes to the EAR for items controlled for
national security reasons, BIS believes that the overall increases in
burdens and costs associated with the following information collections
due to this rule will be minimal.
0694-0088, ``Simplified Network Application Processing
System,'' which carries a burden- hour estimate of 29.6 minutes for a
manual or electronic submission;
0694-0137 ``License Exceptions and Exclusions,'' which
carries a burden-hour estimate average of 1.5 hours per submission
(Note: submissions for License Exceptions are rarely required);
0694-0096 ``Five Year Records Retention Period,'' which
carries a burden-hour estimate of less than 1 minute; and
0607-0152 ``Automated Export System (AES) Program,'' which
carries a burden-hour estimate of 3 minutes per electronic submission.
Additional information regarding these collections of information--
including all background materials--can be found at https://www.reginfo.gov/public/do/PRAMain and using the search function to
enter either the title of the collection or the OMB Control Number.
3. Pursuant to Section 1762 of ECRA (50 U.S.C. 4821), this action
is exempt from the Administrative Procedure Act (APA) (5 U.S.C. 553)
requirements for notice of proposed rulemaking, opportunity for public
participation and delay in effective date.
List of Subjects
15 CFR Part 734
Administrative practice and procedure, Exports, Inventions and
patents, Research, Science and technology.
15 CFR Part 740
Administrative practice and procedure, Exports, Reporting and
recordkeeping.
15 CFR Part 742
Exports, Terrorism.
[[Page 71935]]
15 CFR Part 772
Exports.
15 CFR Part 774
Exports, Reporting and recordkeeping requirements, Terrorism.
Accordingly, parts 734, 740, 742, 772 and 774 of the Export
Administration Regulations (15 CFR parts 730-774) are amended as
follows:
PART 734--SCOPE OF THE EXPORT ADMINISTRATION REGULATIONS
0
1. The authority citation for part 734 continues to read as follows:
Authority: 50 U.S.C. 4801-4852; 50 U.S.C. 4601 et seq.; 50
U.S.C. 1701 et seq.; E.O. 12938, 59 FR 59099, 3 CFR, 1994 Comp., p.
950; E.O. 13020, 61 FR 54079, 3 CFR, 1996 Comp., p. 219; E.O. 13026,
61 FR 58767, 3 CFR, 1996 Comp., p. 228; E.O. 13222, 66 FR 44025, 3
CFR, 2001 Comp., p. 783; E.O. 13637, 78 FR 16129, 3 CFR, 2014 Comp.,
p. 223; Notice of November 8, 2022, 87 FR 68015 (November 10, 2022).
0
2. Section 734.4 is amended to revise paragraph (a)(4) to read as
follows:
Sec. 734.4 De Minimis U.S. content.
(a) * * *
(4) There is no de minimis level for U.S.-origin technology
controlled by ECCN 9E003.a.1 through a.6, a.8, .h, .i, and .l, when
redrawn, used, consulted, or otherwise commingled abroad.
* * * * *
PART 740--LICENSE EXCEPTIONS
0
3. The authority citation for part 740 continues to read as follows:
Authority: 50 U.S.C. 4801-4852; 50 U.S.C. 4601 et seq.; 50
U.S.C. 1701 et seq.; 22 U.S.C. 7201 et seq.; E.O. 13026, 61 FR
58767, 3 CFR, 1996 Comp., p. 228; E.O. 13222, 66 FR 44025, 3 CFR,
2001 Comp., p. 783.
0
4. Section 740.20 is amended by revising paragraph (b)(2)(viii) to read
as follows:
Sec. 740.20 License Exception Strategic Trade Authorization (STA).
* * * * *
(b) * * *
(2) * * *
(viii) Commerce Control List Category 9 limitations on use of
License Exception STA.
(A) License Exception STA may not be used for 9B001 when destined
to a country in Country Group A:6.
(B) License Exception STA may not be used for 9D001 or 9D002
``software'' that is ``specially designed'' or modified for the
``development'' or ``production'' of:
(1) Components of engines controlled by ECCN 9A001 if such
components incorporate any of the ``technologies'' controlled by
9E003.a.1, 9E003.a.2, 9E003.a.3, 9E003.a.4, 9E003.a.5, 9E003.c,
9E003.h, or 9E003.i (other than technology for fan or power turbines);
or
(2) Equipment controlled by 9B001.
(C) License Exception STA may not be used for 9D001 ``software''
that is ``specially designed'' or modified for the ``development'' of
``technology'' controlled by 9E003.a.1, 9E003.a.2, 9E003.a.3,
9E003.a.4, 9E003.a.5, 9E003.c, 9E003.h, or 9E003.i (other than
technology for fan or power turbines).
(D) License Exception STA may not be used for 9D004.f or 9D004.g
``software''.
(E) License Exception STA may not be used for ``technology'' in
9E003.a.1, 9E003.a.2, 9E003.a.3, 9E003.a.4, 9E003.a.5, 9E003.c,
9E003.h, or 9E003.i (other than technology for fan or power turbines).
* * * * *
PART 742--CONTROL POLICY--CCL BASED CONTROLS
0
5. The authority citation for part 742 continues to read as follows:
Authority: 50 U.S.C. 4801-4852; 50 U.S.C. 4601 et seq.; 50
U.S.C. 1701 et seq.; 22 U.S.C. 3201 et seq.; 42 U.S.C. 2139a; 22
U.S.C. 7201 et seq.; 22 U.S.C. 7210; Sec. 1503, Pub. L. 108-11, 117
Stat. 559; E.O. 12058, 43 FR 20947, 3 CFR, 1978 Comp., p. 179; E.O.
12851, 58 FR 33181, 3 CFR, 1993 Comp., p. 608; E.O. 12938, 59 FR
59099, 3 CFR, 1994 Comp., p. 950; E.O. 13026, 61 FR 58767, 3 CFR,
1996 Comp., p. 228; E.O. 13222, 66 FR 44025, 3 CFR, 2001 Comp., p.
783; Presidential Determination 2003-23, 68 FR 26459, 3 CFR, 2004
Comp., p. 320; Notice of November 8, 2022, 87 FR 68015 (November 10,
2022).
0
6. Section 742.14 is amended by revising paragraphs (a) and (b)
introductory text to read as follows:
Sec. 742.14 Significant items: hot section technology for the
development, production or overhaul of commercial aircraft engines,
components, and systems.
(a) License requirement. Licenses are required for all
destinations, except Canada, for ECCNs having an ``SI'' under the
``Reason for Control'' paragraph. These items include hot section
technology for the development, production or overhaul of commercial
aircraft engines controlled under ECCN 9E003.a.1 through a.6, a.8, .h,
.i, and .l, and related controls.
(b) Licensing policy. Pursuant to section 6 of the Export
Administration Act of 1979, as amended, foreign policy controls apply
to technology required for the development, production or overhaul of
commercial aircraft engines controlled by ECCN 9E003a.1 through a.6,
a.8, .h, .i, and .l, and related controls. These controls supplement
the national security controls that apply to these items. Applications
for export and reexport to all destinations will be reviewed on a case-
by-case basis to determine whether the export or reexport is consistent
with U.S. national security and foreign policy interests. The following
factors are among those that will be considered to determine what
action will be taken on license applications:
* * * * *
PART 772--DEFINITIONS OF TERMS
0
7. The authority citation for part 772 continues to read as follows:
Authority: 50 U.S.C. 4801-4852; 50 U.S.C. 4601 et seq.; 50
U.S.C. 1701 et seq.; E.O. 13222, 66 FR 44025, 3 CFR, 2001 Comp., p.
783.
0
8. Section 772.1 is amended by revising the definitions for ``Intrusion
software'' and ``Program'' to read as follows:
Sec. 772.1 Definitions of terms as used in the Export Administration
Regulations (EAR).
* * * * *
Intrusion software. (5P2) ``Software'' specially designed or
modified to avoid detection by `monitoring tools', or to defeat
`protective countermeasures', of a computer or network-capable device,
and performing any of the following:
(1) The extraction of data or information, from a computer or
network-capable device, or the modification of system or user data; or
(2) The modification of the standard execution path of a
``program'' or process in order to allow the execution of externally
provided instructions.
Note 1 to ``Intrusion Software'' Definition: ``Intrusion software''
does not include any of the following: Hypervisors, debuggers or
Software Reverse Engineering (SRE) tools; Digital Rights Management
(DRM) ``software''; or ``Software'' designed to be installed by
manufacturers, administrators or users, for the purposes of asset
tracking or recovery.
Note 2 to ``Intrusion Software'' Definition: Network-capable
devices include mobile devices and smart meters.
Technical note 1 to ``Intrusion Software'' Definition: `Monitoring
tools': ``software'' or hardware devices, that monitor system behaviors
or processes running on a device. This includes antivirus (AV)
products, end point security products, Personal Security Products
(PSP), Intrusion Detection Systems (IDS), Intrusion Prevention Systems
(IPS) or firewalls.
[[Page 71936]]
Technical note 2 to ``Intrusion Software'' Definition: `Protective
countermeasures': techniques designed to ensure the safe execution of
code, such as Data Execution Prevention (DEP), Address Space Layout
Randomization (ASLR) or sandboxing.
* * * * *
Program. (Cat 1, 4, 6, and 7)--A sequence of instructions to carry
out a process in, or convertible into, a form executable by an
electronic computer.
PART 774--THE COMMERCE CONTROL LIST
0
9. The authority citation for part 774 continues to read as follows:
Authority: 50 U.S.C. 4801-4852; 50 U.S.C. 4601 et seq.; 50
U.S.C. 1701 et seq.; 10 U.S.C. 8720; 10 U.S.C. 8730(e); 22 U.S.C.
287c, 22 U.S.C. 3201 et seq.; 22 U.S.C. 6004; 42 U.S.C. 2139a; 15
U.S.C. 1824; 50 U.S.C. 4305; 22 U.S.C. 7201 et seq.; 22 U.S.C. 7210;
E.O. 13026, 61 FR 58767, 3 CFR, 1996 Comp., p. 228; E.O. 13222, 66
FR 44025, 3 CFR, 2001 Comp., p. 783.
0
10. In supplement no. 1 to part 774, ECCNs 1A004, 1A006, 1A007, 1A008,
1B001, 1C001, 1C002, 1C003, 1C005, 1C008, 1C010, 1C011, 2A001, 2B004,
2B006, 2B008, 2B009, 2E003, 3A001, 3A002, 3B001, 3D003, 3D006, 3E001,
3E002, 4A004, 4D001, 4E001, 5A001, 5A002, 5A004, 6A001, 6A002, 6A003,
6A004, 6A005, 6A006, 6A007, 6A008, 6B007, 6C002, 6C005, 6D003, 6E003,
7A003, 7A004, 7A005, 7A006, 7B001, 7D002, 7E004, 8A001, 8A002, 8C001,
8E002, 9A001, 9A003, 9A004, 9A005, 9B005, 9E001, 9E002, and 9E003 are
revised to read as follows:
Supplement No. 1 to Part 774--The Commerce Control List
* * * * *
1A004 Protective and detection equipment and ``components'', not
``specially designed'' for military use, as follows (see List of
Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, CB, RS, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
CB applies to chemical detection systems CB Column 2
and dedicated detectors therefor, in
1A004.c, that also have the technical
characteristic.
RS apply to 1A004.d....................... RS Column 2
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: Yes for 1A004.a, .b, and .c.2.
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See ECCNs 1A995, 2B351, and 2B352. (2) See
ECCN 1D003 for ``software'' ``specially designed'' or modified to
enable equipment to perform the functions of equipment controlled
under section 1A004.c (Nuclear, biological, and chemical (NBC)
detection systems). (3) See ECCN 1E002.g for control libraries
(parametric technical databases) ``specially designed'' or modified
to enable equipment to perform the functions of equipment controlled
under 1A004.c (Nuclear, biological, and chemical (NBC) detection
systems). (4) Chemical and biological protective and detection
equipment specifically designed, developed, modified, configured, or
adapted for military applications is ``subject to the ITAR'' (see 22
CFR parts 120 through 130, including USML Category XIV(f)), as is
commercial equipment that incorporates ``parts'' or ``components''
controlled under that category except for domestic preparedness
devices for individual protection that integrate ``components'' and
``parts'' identified in USML Category XIV(f)(4) when such ``parts''
or ``components'' are: Integral to the device; inseparable from the
device; and incapable of replacement without compromising the
effectiveness of the device, in which case the equipment is subject
to the export licensing jurisdiction of the Department of Commerce
under ECCN 1A004. (5) This entry does not control radionuclides
incorporated in equipment listed in this entry--such materials are
subject to the licensing jurisdiction of the Nuclear Regulatory
Commission (See 10 CFR part 110).
Related Definitions: (1) `Biological agents' means: pathogens or
toxins, selected or modified (such as altering purity, shelf life,
virulence, dissemination characteristics, or resistance to UV
radiation) to produce casualties in humans or animals, degrade
equipment or damage crops or the environment. (2) `Riot control
agents' are substances which, under the expected conditions of use
for riot control purposes, produce rapidly in humans sensory
irritation or disabling physical effects which disappear within a
short time following termination of exposure. (Tear gases are a
subset of `riot control agents.')
Items:
a. Full face masks, filter canisters and decontamination
equipment therefor, designed or modified for defense against any of
the following, and ``specially designed'' ``components'' therefor:
Note: 1A004.a includes Powered Air Purifying Respirators (PAPR)
that are designed or modified for defense against agents or
materials, listed in 1A004.a.
Technical Notes: For the purposes of 1A004.a:
1. Full face masks are also known as gas masks.
2. Filter canisters include filter cartridges.
a.1. `Biological agents';
a.2. `Radioactive materials';
a.3. Chemical warfare (CW) agents; or
a.4. `Riot control agents', as follows:
a.4.a. [alpha]-Bromobenzeneacetonitrile, (Bromobenzyl cyanide)
(CA) (CAS 5798-79-8);
a.4.b. [(2-chlorophenyl) methylene] propanedinitrile, (o-
Chlorobenzylidenemalononitrile) (CS) (CAS 2698-41-1);
a.4.c. 2-Chloro-1-phenylethanone, Phenylacyl chloride ([omega]-
chloroacetophenone) (CN) (CAS 532-27-4);
a.4.d. Dibenz-(b,f)-1,4-oxazephine, (CR) (CAS 257-07-8);
a.4.e. 10-Chloro-5, 10-dihydrophenarsazine, (Phenarsazine
chloride), (Adamsite), (DM) (CAS 578-94-9);
a.4.f. N-Nonanoylmorpholine, (MPA) (CAS 5299-64-9);
b. Protective suits, gloves and shoes, ``specially designed'' or
modified for defense against any of the following:
b.1. `Biological agents';
b.2. `Radioactive materials'; or
b.3. Chemical warfare (CW) agents;
c. Detection systems, ``specially designed'' or modified for
detection or identification of any of the following, and ``specially
designed'' ``components'' therefor:
c.1. `Biological agents';
c.2. `Radioactive materials'; or
c.3. Chemical warfare (CW) agents;
d. Electronic equipment designed for automatically detecting or
identifying the presence of ``explosives'' (as listed in the annex
at the end of Category 1) residues and utilizing `trace detection'
techniques (e.g., surface acoustic wave, ion mobility spectrometry,
differential mobility spectrometry, mass spectrometry).
Technical Note: For the purposes of 1A004.d, `trace detection'
is defined as the capability to detect less than 1 ppm vapor, or 1
mg solid or liquid.
Note 1: 1A004.d does not apply to equipment ``specially
designed'' for laboratory use.
Note 2: 1A004.d does not apply to non-contact walk-through
security portals.
Note: 1A004 does not control:
a. Personal radiation monitoring dosimeters;
b. Occupational health or safety equipment limited by design or
function to protect against hazards specific to residential safety
or civil industries, including:
1. Mining;
2. Quarrying;
3. Agriculture;
4. Pharmaceutical;
5. Medical;
6. Veterinary;
7. Environmental;
8. Waste management;
9. Food industry.
Technical Notes:
1. 1A004 includes equipment, ``components'' that have been
`identified,' successfully tested to national standards or otherwise
proven effective, for the detection of or defense against
`radioactive materials' `biological agents,' chemical warfare
agents, `simulants' or ``riot control agents,'' even if such
equipment or ``components'' are used in civil industries such as
mining, quarrying,
[[Page 71937]]
agriculture, pharmaceuticals, medical, veterinary, environmental,
waste management, or the food industry.
2. `Simulant': A substance or material that is used in place of
toxic agent (chemical or biological) in training, research, testing
or evaluation.
3. For the purposes of 1A004, `radioactive materials' are those
selected or modified to increase their effectiveness in producing
casualties in humans or animals, degrading equipment or damaging
crops or the environment.
* * * * *
1A006 Equipment, ``specially designed'' or modified for the disposal
of Improvised Explosive Devices (IEDs), as follows (see List of
Items Controlled), and ``specially designed'' ``components'' and
``accessories'' therefor.
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Country chart (see supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
License Requirement Note: 1A006 does not apply to equipment when
accompanying its operator.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: Equipment ``specially designed'' for military use
for the disposal of IEDs is ``subject to the ITAR'' (see 22 CFR
parts 120 through 130, including USML Category IV).
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Remotely operated vehicles;
b. `Disruptors'.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 1A006.b `disruptors' are
devices ``specially designed'' for the purpose of preventing the
operation of an explosive device by projecting a liquid, solid or
frangible projectile.
Note: 1A006 does not apply to equipment when accompanying its
operator.
1A007 Equipment and devices, ``specially designed'' to initiate
charges and devices containing ``energetic materials,'' by
electrical means, as follows (see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, NP, AT
Country chart (see supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
NP applies to 1A007.b, as well as 1A007.a NP Column 1
when the detonator firing set meets or
exceeds the parameters of 3A229.
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: High explosives and related equipment ``specially
designed'' for military use are ``subject to the ITAR'' (see 22 CFR
parts 120 through 130). This entry does not control detonators using
only primary explosives, such as lead azide. See also ECCNs 0A604,
3A229, and 3A232. See 1E001 for ``development'' and ``production''
technology controls, and 1E201 for ``use'' technology controls.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Explosive detonator firing sets designed to drive explosive
detonators specified by 1A007.b;
b. Electrically driven explosive detonators as follows:
b.1. Exploding bridge (EB);
b.2. Exploding bridge wire (EBW);
b.3. Slapper;
b.4. Exploding foil initiators (EFI).
Technical Notes:
1. The word initiator or igniter is sometimes used in place of
the word detonator.
2. For the purposes of 1A007.b, the detonators of concern all
utilize a small electrical conductor (bridge, bridge wire, or foil)
that explosively vaporizes when a fast, high-current electrical
pulse is passed through it. In non slapper types, the exploding
conductor starts a chemical detonation in a contacting high
explosive material such as PETN (pentaerythritoltetranitrate). In
slapper detonators, the explosive vaporization of the electrical
conductor drives a flyer or slapper across a gap, and the impact of
the slapper on an explosive starts a chemical detonation. The
slapper in some designs is driven by magnetic force. The term
exploding foil detonator may refer to either an EB or a slapper-type
detonator.
1A008 Charges, devices and ``components'', as follows (see List of
Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, UN, AT
Country chart (see supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
UN applies to entire entry................ See Sec. 746.1(b) for UN
controls.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: $3,000 for .a through .c; $6,000 for .d.
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) All of the following are ``subject to the
ITAR'' (see 22 CFR parts 120 through 130):
a. High explosives and related equipment ``specially designed''
for military use;
b. Explosive devices or charges in this entry that utilize USML
controlled energetic materials (See 22 CFR 121.1 Category V), if
they have been specifically designed, developed, configured,
adapted, or modified for a military application;
c. Shaped charges that have all of the following a uniform
shaped conical liner with an included angle of 90 degrees or less,
more than 2.0 kg of controlled materials, and a diameter exceeding
4.5 inches;
d. Detonating cord containing greater than 0.1 kg per meter (470
grains per foot) of controlled materials;
e. Cutters and severing tools containing greater than 10 kg of
controlled materials;
f. With the exception of cutters and severing tools, devices or
charges controlled by this entry where the USML controlled materials
can be easily extracted without destroying the device or charge; and
g. Individual USML controlled energetic materials in this entry,
even when compounded with other materials, when not incorporated
into explosive devices or charges controlled by this entry or 1C992.
(2) See also ECCNs 1C011, 1C018, 1C111, 1C239, and 1C608 for
additional controlled energetic materials. See ECCN 1E001 for the
``development'' or ``production'' ``technology'' for the commodities
controlled by ECCN 1A008, but not for explosives or commodities that
are ``subject to the ITAR'' (see 22 CFR parts 120 through 130).
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. `Shaped charges' having all of the following:
a.1. Net Explosive Quantity (NEQ) greater than 90 g; and
a.2. Outer casing diameter equal to or greater than 75 mm;
b. Linear shaped cutting charges having all of the following,
and ``specially designed'' ``components'' therefor:
b.1. An explosive load greater than 40 g/m; and
b.2. A width of 10 mm or more;
c. Detonating cord with explosive core load greater than 64 g/m;
d. Cutters, not specified by 1A008.b, and severing tools, having
a NEQ greater than 3.5 kg.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 1A008.a, `shaped charges'
are explosive
[[Page 71938]]
charges shaped to focus the effects of the explosive blast.
Note: The only charges and devices specified in 1A008 are those
containing ``explosives'' (see list of explosives in the Annex at
the end of Category 1) and mixtures thereof.
* * * * *
1B001 Equipment for the production or inspection of ``composite''
structures or laminates controlled by 1A002 or ``fibrous or
filamentary materials'' controlled by 1C010, as follows (see List of
Items Controlled), and ``specially designed'' ``components'' and
``accessories'' therefor.
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, NP, AT
Country chart (see supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
MT applies to entire entry, except MT Column 1
1B001.d.4, e and f. Note: MT applies to
equipment in 1B001.d that meet or exceed
the parameters of 1B101.
NP applies to filament winding machines NP Column 1.
described in 1B001.a that are capable of
winding cylindrical rotors having a
diameter between 75 mm (3 in) and 400 mm
(16 in) and lengths of 600 mm (24 in) or
greater; AND coordinating and programming
controls and precision mandrels for these
filament winding machines.
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A for MT and for 1B001.a; $5000 for all other items
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See ECCN 1D001 for software for items
controlled by this entry and see ECCNs 1E001 (``development'' and
``production'') and 1E101 (``use'') for technology for items
controlled by this entry. (2) Also see ECCNs 1B101 and 1B201.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Filament winding machines, of which the motions for
positioning, wrapping and winding fibers are coordinated and
programmed in three or more `primary servo positioning' axes,
``specially designed'' for the manufacture of ``composite''
structures or laminates, from ``fibrous or filamentary materials'';
b. `Tape laying machines', of which the motions for positioning
and laying tape are coordinated and programmed in five or more
`primary servo positioning' axes, ``specially designed'' for the
manufacture of ``composite'' airframe or missile structures;
Technical Note: For the purposes of 1B001.b, `tape-laying
machines' have the ability to lay one or more `filament bands'
limited to widths greater than 25.4 mm and less than or equal to
304.8 mm, and to cut and restart individual `filament band' courses
during the laying process.
c. Multidirectional, multidimensional weaving machines or
interlacing machines, including adapters and modification kits,
``specially designed'' or modified for weaving, interlacing or
braiding fibers for ``composite'' structures;
Technical Note: For the purposes of 1B001.c the technique of
interlacing includes knitting.
d. Equipment ``specially designed'' or adapted for the
production of reinforcement fibers, as follows:
d.1. Equipment for converting polymeric fibers (such as
polyacrylonitrile, rayon, pitch or polycarbosilane) into carbon
fibers or silicon carbide fibers, including special equipment to
strain the fiber during heating;
d.2. Equipment for the chemical vapor deposition of elements or
compounds, on heated filamentary substrates, to manufacture silicon
carbide fibers;
d.3. Equipment for the wet-spinning of refractory ceramics (such
as aluminum oxide);
d.4. Equipment for converting aluminum containing precursor
fibers into alumina fibers by heat treatment;
e. Equipment for producing prepregs controlled by 1C010.e by the
hot melt method;
f. Non-destructive inspection equipment ``specially designed''
for ``composite'' materials, as follows:
f.1. X-ray tomography systems for three dimensional defect
inspection;
f.2. Numerically controlled ultrasonic testing machines of which
the motions for positioning transmitters or receivers are
simultaneously coordinated and programmed in four or more axes to
follow the three dimensional contours of the ``part'' or
``component'' under inspection;
g. Tow-placement machines, of which the motions for positioning
and laying tows are coordinated and programmed in two or more
`primary servo positioning' axes, ``specially designed'' for the
manufacture of ``composite'' airframe or missile structures.
Technical Note to 1B001.g: For the purposes of 1B001.g, `tow-
placement machines' have the ability to place one or more `filament
bands' having widths less than or equal to 25.4 mm, and to cut and
restart individual `filament band' courses during the placement
process.
Technical Notes for 1B001:
1. For the purposes of 1B001, `primary servo positioning' axes
control, under computer ``program'' direction, the position of the
end effector (i.e., head) in space relative to the work piece at the
correct orientation and direction to achieve the desired process.
2. For the purposes of 1B001, a `filament band' is a single
continuous width of fully or partially resin-impregnated tape, tow
or fiber. Fully or partially resin-impregnated `filament bands'
include those coated with dry powder that tacks upon heating.
* * * * *
1C001 Materials ``specially designed'' for absorbing electromagnetic
radiation, or intrinsically conductive polymers, as follows (see
List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 1
MT applies to items that meet or exceed MT Column 1
the parameters of ECCN 1C101.
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements
See Sec. 743.1 of the EAR for reporting requirements for
exports under License Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be used to ship any item in this
entry to any of the destinations listed in Country Group A:6 (See
Supplement No.1 to part 740 of the EAR).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: See also 1C101.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Materials for absorbing frequencies exceeding 2 x 10\8\ Hz
but less than 3 x 10\12\ Hz.
Note 1: 1C001.a does not control:
a. Hair type absorbers, constructed of natural or synthetic
fibers, with non-magnetic loading to provide absorption;
b. Absorbers having no magnetic loss and whose incident surface
is non-planar in shape, including pyramids, cones, wedges and
convoluted surfaces;
c. Planar absorbers, having all of the following:
1. Made from any of the following:
a. Plastic foam materials (flexible or non-flexible) with
carbon-loading, or organic materials, including binders, providing
more than 5% echo compared with metal over a bandwidth exceeding
15% of the center frequency of the incident
energy, and not capable of withstanding temperatures exceeding 450 K
(177 [deg]C); or
[[Page 71939]]
b. Ceramic materials providing more than 20% echo compared with
metal over a bandwidth exceeding 15% of the
center frequency of the incident energy, and not capable of
withstanding temperatures exceeding 800 K (527 [deg]C);
Technical Note: For the purposes of 1C001.a Note 1.c.1,
absorption test samples should be a square at least 5 wavelengths of
the center frequency on a side and positioned in the far field of
the radiating element.
2. Tensile strength less than 7 x 10\6\ N/m\2\; and
3. Compressive strength less than 14 x 10\6\ N/m\2\;
d. Planar absorbers made of sintered ferrite, having all of the
following:
1. A specific gravity exceeding 4.4; and
2. A maximum operating temperature of 548 K (275 [deg]C) or
less;
e. Planar absorbers having no magnetic loss and fabricated from
`open-cell foams' plastic material with a density of 0.15 grams/
cm\3\ or less.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 1C001.a Note e., `open-cell
foams' are flexible and porous materials, having an inner structure
open to the atmosphere. `Open-cell foams' are also known as
reticulated foams.
Note 2: Nothing in Note 1 releases magnetic materials to provide
absorption when contained in paint.
b. Materials not transparent to visible light and ``specially
designed'' for absorbing near-infrared radiation having a wavelength
exceeding 810 nm but less than 2,000 nm (frequencies exceeding 150
THz but less than 370 THz);
Note: 1C001.b does not apply to materials, ``specially
designed'' or formulated for any of the following applications:
a. ``Laser'' marking of polymers; or
b. ``Laser'' welding of polymers.
c. Intrinsically conductive polymeric materials with a `bulk
electrical conductivity' exceeding 10,000 S/m (Siemens per meter) or
a `sheet (surface) resistivity' of less than 100 ohms/square, based
on any of the following polymers:
c.1. Polyaniline;
c.2. Polypyrrole;
c.3. Polythiophene;
c.4. Poly phenylene-vinylene; or
c.5. Poly thienylene-vinylene.
Note: 1C001.c does not apply to materials in a liquid form.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 1C001.c, `bulk electrical
conductivity' and `sheet (surface) resistivity' should be determined
using ASTM D-257 or national equivalents.
1C002 Metal alloys, metal alloy powder and alloyed materials, as
follows (see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, NP, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
NP applies to 1C002.b.3 or b.4 if they NP Column 1
exceed the parameters stated in 1C202.
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: $3000; N/A for NP
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See ECCNs 1E001 (``development'' and
``production'') and 1E201 (``use'') for technology for items
controlled by this entry. (2) Also see ECCN 1C202. (3) Aluminum
alloys and titanium alloys in physical forms and finished products
``especially designed'' or prepared for use in separating uranium
isotopes are subject to the export licensing authority of the
Nuclear Regulatory Commission (see 10 CFR part 110).
Related Definition: N/A
Items:
Note: 1C002 does not control metal alloys, metal alloy powder
and alloyed materials, specially formulated for coating purposes.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 1C002, metal alloys are
those containing a higher percentage by weight of the stated metal
than of any other element.
a. Aluminides, as follows:
a.1. Nickel aluminides containing a minimum of 15% by weight
aluminum, a maximum of 38% by weight aluminum and at least one
additional alloying element;
a.2. Titanium aluminides containing 10% by weight or more
aluminum and at least one additional alloying element;
b. Metal alloys, as follows, made from the powder or particulate
material controlled by 1C002.c:
b.1. Nickel alloys having any of the following:
b.1.a. A `stress-rupture life' of 10,000 hours or longer at 923
K (650 [deg]C) at a stress of 676 MPa; or
b.1.b. A `low cycle fatigue life' of 10,000 cycles or more at
823 K (550 [deg]C) at a maximum stress of 1,095 MPa;
b.2. Niobium alloys having any of the following:
b.2.a. A `stress-rupture life' of 10,000 hours or longer at
1,073 K (800 [deg]C) at a stress of 400 MPa; or
b.2.b. A `low cycle fatigue life' of 10,000 cycles or more at
973 K (700 [deg]C) at a maximum stress of 700 MPa;
b.3. Titanium alloys having any of the following:
b.3.a. A `stress-rupture life' of 10,000 hours or longer at 723
K (450 [deg]C) at a stress of 200 MPa; or
b.3.b. A `low cycle fatigue life' of 10,000 cycles or more at
723 K (450 [deg]C) at a maximum stress of 400 MPa;
b.4 Aluminum alloys having any of the following:
b.4.a. A tensile strength of 240 MPa or more at 473 K (200
[deg]C); or
b.4.b. A tensile strength of 415 MPa or more at 298 K (25
[deg]C);
b.5. Magnesium alloys having all the following:
b.5.a. A tensile strength of 345 MPa or more; and
b.5.b. A corrosion rate of less than 1 mm/year in 3% sodium
chloride aqueous solution measured in accordance with ASTM standard
G-31 or national equivalents;
Technical Notes: For the purposes of 1C002.b:
1. `Stress-rupture life' should be measured in accordance with
ASTM standard E-139 or national equivalents.
2. `Low cycle fatigue life' should be measured in accordance
with ASTM Standard E-606 `Recommended Practice for Constant-
Amplitude Low-Cycle Fatigue Testing' or national equivalents.
Testing should be axial with an average stress ratio equal to 1 and
a stress-concentration factor (Kt) equal to 1. The average stress
ratio is defined as maximum stress minus minimum stress divided by
maximum stress.
c. Metal alloy powder or particulate material, having all of the
following:
c.1. Made from any of the following composition systems:
Technical Note: For the purposes of 1C002.c.1, X equals one or
more alloying elements.
c.1.a. Nickel alloys (Ni-Al-X, Ni-X-Al) qualified for turbine
engine ``parts'' or ``components,'' i.e., with less than 3 non-
metallic particles (introduced during the manufacturing process)
larger than 100 [mu]m in 109 alloy particles;
c.1.b. Niobium alloys (Nb-Al-X or Nb-X-Al, Nb-Si-X or Nb-X-Si,
Nb-Ti-X or Nb-X-Ti);
c.1.c. Titanium alloys (Ti-Al-X or Ti-X-Al);
c.1.d. Aluminum alloys (Al-Mg-X or Al-X-Mg, Al-Zn-X or Al-X-Zn,
Al-Fe-X or Al-X-Fe); or
c.1.e. Magnesium alloys (Mg-Al-X or Mg-X-Al);
c.2. Made in a controlled environment by any of the following
processes:
c.2.a. `Vacuum atomization';
c.2.b. `Gas atomization';
c.2.c. `Rotary atomization';
c.2.d. `Splat quenching';
c.2.e. `Melt spinning' and `comminution';
c.2.f. `Melt extraction' and `comminution';
c.2.g. `Mechanical alloying'; or
c.2.h. `Plasma atomization'; and
c.3. Capable of forming materials controlled by 1C002.a or
1C002.b;
d. Alloyed materials, having all the following:
d.1. Made from any of the composition systems specified by
1C002.c.1;
d.2. In the form of uncomminuted flakes, ribbons or thin rods;
and
d.3. Produced in a controlled environment by any of the
following:
d.3.a. `Splat quenching';
d.3.b. `Melt spinning'; or
d.3.c. `Melt extraction'.
Technical Notes: For the purposes of 1C002:
1. `Vacuum atomization' is a process to reduce a molten stream
of metal to droplets of a diameter of 500 [mu]m or less by the rapid
evolution of a dissolved gas upon exposure to a vacuum.
[[Page 71940]]
2. `Gas atomization' is a process to reduce a molten stream of
metal alloy to droplets of 500 [mu]m diameter or less by a high
pressure gas stream.
3. `Rotary atomization' is a process to reduce a stream or pool
of molten metal to droplets of a diameter of 500 [mu]m or less by
centrifugal force.
4. `Splat quenching' is a process to `solidify rapidly' a molten
metal stream impinging upon a chilled block, forming a flake-like
product.
5. `Melt spinning' is a process to `solidify rapidly' a molten
metal stream impinging upon a rotating chilled block, forming a
flake, ribbon or rod-like product.
6. `Comminution' is a process to reduce a material to particles
by crushing or grinding.
7. `Melt extraction' is a process to `solidify rapidly' and
extract a ribbon-like alloy product by the insertion of a short
segment of a rotating chilled block into a bath of a molten metal
alloy.
8. `Mechanical alloying' is an alloying process resulting from
the bonding, fracturing and rebonding of elemental and master alloy
powders by mechanical impact. Non-metallic particles may be
incorporated in the alloy by addition of the appropriate powders.
9. `Plasma atomization' is a process to reduce a molten stream
or solid metal to droplets of 500 [mu]m diameter or less, using
plasma torches in an inert gas environment.
10. For the purposes of 1C002 Technical Notes, `solidify
rapidly' is a process involving the solidification of molten
material at cooling rates exceeding 1000 K/sec.
1C003 Magnetic metals, of all types and of whatever form, having any
of the following (see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: $3000
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: N/A
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Initial relative permeability of 120,000 or more and a
thickness of 0.05 mm or less;
Technical Note: For the purposes of 1C003.a, measurement of
initial relative permeability must be performed on fully annealed
materials.
b. Magnetostrictive alloys having any of the following:
b.1. A saturation magnetostriction of more than 5 x
104-4; or
b.2. A magnetomechanical coupling factor (k) of more than 0.8;
or
c. Amorphous or `nanocrystalline' alloy strips, having all of
the following:
c.1. A composition having a minimum of 75% by weight of iron,
cobalt or nickel;
c.2. A saturation magnetic induction (Bs) of 1.6 T or
more; and
c.3. Any of the following:
c.3.a. A strip thickness of 0.02 mm or less; or
c.3.b. An electrical resistivity of 2 x 10-4 ohm cm
or more.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 1C003.c, `nanocrystalline'
materials are those materials having a crystal grain size of 50 nm
or less, as determined by X-ray diffraction.
* * * * *
1C005 ``Superconductive'' ``composite'' conductors in lengths
exceeding 100 m or with a mass exceeding 100 g, as follows (see List
of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: $1500
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: N/A
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. ``Superconductive'' ``composite'' conductors containing one
or more niobium-titanium `filaments', having all of the following:
a.1. Embedded in a ``matrix'' other than a copper or copper-
based mixed ``matrix''; and
a.2. Having a cross-section area less than 0.28 x
10-4 mm\2\ (6 [mu]m in diameter for circular
`filaments');
b. ``Superconductive'' ``composite'' conductors consisting of
one or more ``superconductive'' `filaments' other than niobium-
titanium, having all of the following:
b.1. A ``critical temperature'' at zero magnetic induction
exceeding 9.85 K (-263.31 [deg]C); and
b.2. Remaining in the ``superconductive'' state at a temperature
of 4.2 K (-268.96 [deg]C) when exposed to a magnetic field oriented
in any direction perpendicular to the longitudinal axis of conductor
and corresponding to a magnetic induction of 12 T with critical
current density exceeding 1750 A/mm\2\ on overall cross-section of
the conductor.
c. ``Superconductive'' ``composite'' conductors consisting of
one or more ``superconductive'' `filaments' which remain
``superconductive'' above 115 K (-158.16 [deg]C).
Technical Note: For the purposes of 1C005, `filaments' may be in
wire, cylinder, film, tape or ribbon form.
* * * * *
1C008 Non-fluorinated polymeric substances as follows (see List of
Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Country chart (see supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: $200
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: See also 1A003.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Imides as follows:
a.1. Bismaleimides;
a.2. Aromatic polyamide-imides (PAI) having a `glass transition
temperature (Tg)' exceeding 563 K (290 [deg]C);
a.3. Aromatic polyimides having a `glass transition temperature
(Tg)' exceeding 505 K (232 [deg]C);
a.4. Aromatic polyetherimides having a `glass transition
temperature (Tg)' exceeding 563 K (290 [deg]C);
Note: 1C008.a controls the substances in liquid or solid
``fusible'' form, including resin, powder, pellet, film, sheet,
tape, or ribbon.
N.B.: For non-``fusible'' aromatic polyimides in film, sheet,
tape, or ribbon form, see ECCN 1A003.
b. [Reserved]
c. [Reserved]
d. Polyarylene ketones;
e. Polyarylene sulfides, where the arylene group is biphenylene,
triphenylene or combinations thereof;
f. Polybiphenylenethersulphone having a `glass transition
temperature (Tg)' exceeding 563 K (290 [deg]C).
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 1C008.a.2 thermoplastic materials,
1C008.a.4 materials, and 1C008.f materials, the `glass transition
temperature (Tg)' is determined using the method described in ISO
11357-2 (1999) or national equivalents.
2. For the purposes of 1C008.a.2 thermosetting materials and
1C008.a.3 materials, the `glass transition temperature (Tg)' is
determined using the 3-point bend method described in ASTM D 7028-07
or equivalent national standard. The test is to be performed using a
dry test specimen which has attained a minimum of 90% degree of cure
as specified by ASTM E 2160-04 or equivalent national standard, and
was cured using the combination of standard- and post-cure processes
that yield the highest Tg.
* * * * *
1C010 ``Fibrous or filamentary materials'' as follows (see List of
Items Controlled).
[[Page 71941]]
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, NP, AT
Country chart (see supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
NP applies to 1C010.a (aramid ``fibrous or NP Column 1
filamentary materials'', b (carbon
``fibrous and filamentary materials''),
and e.1 for ``fibrous and filamentary
materials'' that meet or exceed the
control criteria of ECCN 1C210.
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements
See Sec. 743.1 of the EAR for reporting requirements for
exports under License Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: $1500, N/A for NP
GBS: N/A
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be used to ship any item in
1C010.c to any of the destinations listed in Country Group A:6 (See
Supplement No.1 to part 740 of the EAR).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See ECCNs 1E001 (``development'' and
``production'') and 1E201 (``use'') for technology for items
controlled by this entry. (2) Also see ECCNs 1C210 and 1C990. (3)
See also 9C110 for material not controlled by 1C010.e, as defined by
notes 1 or 2.
Related Definitions: (1) ``Specific modulus'': Young's modulus in
pascals, equivalent to N/m2 divided by specific weight in N/m3,
measured at a temperature of (296+2) K ((23+2) [deg]C) and a
relative humidity of (50+5) %. (2) ``Specific tensile strength'':
ultimate tensile strength in pascals, equivalent to N/m2 divided by
specific weight in N/m3, measured at a temperature of (296+2) K
((23+2) [deg]C) and a relative humidity of (50+5) %.
Items:
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of calculating ``specific tensile
strength'', ``specific modulus'' or specific weight of ``fibrous or
filamentary materials'' in 1C010.a, 1C010.b, 1C010.c, or 1C010.e.1.b
the tensile strength and modulus should be determined by using
Method A described in ISO 10618 (2004) or national equivalents.
2. For the purposes of assessing the ``specific tensile
strength'', ``specific modulus'' or specific weight of non-
unidirectional ``fibrous or filamentary materials'' (e.g., fabrics,
random mats or braids) in 1C010, this is to be based on the
mechanical properties of the constituent unidirectional
monofilaments (e.g., monofilaments, yarns, rovings or tows) prior to
processing into the non-unidirectional ``fibrous or filamentary
materials''.
a. Organic ``fibrous or filamentary materials'', having all of
the following:
a.1. ``Specific modulus'' exceeding 12.7 x 10\6\ m; and
a.2. ``Specific tensile strength'' exceeding 23.5 x 10\4\ m;
Note: 1C010.a does not control polyethylene.
b. Carbon ``fibrous or filamentary materials'', having all of
the following:
b.1. ``Specific modulus'' exceeding 14.65 x 10\6\ m; and
b.2. ``Specific tensile strength'' exceeding 26.82 x 10\4\ m;
Note: 1C010.b does not control:
a. ``Fibrous or filamentary materials'', for the repair of
``civil aircraft'' structures or laminates, having all of the
following:
1. An area not exceeding 1 m2;
2. A length not exceeding 2.5 m; and
3. A width exceeding 15 mm.
b. Mechanically chopped, milled or cut carbon ``fibrous or
filamentary materials'' 25.0 mm or less in length.
c. Inorganic ``fibrous or filamentary materials'', having all of
the following:
c.1. Having any of the following:
c.1.a. Composed of 50% or more by weight silicon dioxide
(SiO2) and having a ``specific modulus'' exceeding 2.54 x
10\6\ m; or
c.1.b. Not specified in 1C010.c.1.a and having a ``specific
modulus'' exceeding 5.6 x 10\6\ m; and
c.2. Melting, softening, decomposition or sublimation point
exceeding 1,922 K (1,649 [deg]C) in an inert environment;
Note: 1C010.c does not control:
a. Discontinuous, multiphase, polycrystalline alumina fibers in
chopped fiber or random mat form, containing 3% by weight or more
silica, with a ``specific modulus'' of less than 10 x 106 m;
b. Molybdenum and molybdenum alloy fibers;
c. Boron fibers;
d. Discontinuous ceramic fibers with a melting, softening,
decomposition or sublimation point lower than 2,043 K (1,770 [deg]C)
in an inert environment.
d. ``Fibrous or filamentary materials'', having any of the
following:
d.1. Composed of any of the following:
d.1.a. Polyetherimides controlled by 1C008.a; or
d.1.b. Materials controlled by 1C008.b to 1C008.f; or
d.2. Composed of materials controlled by 1C010.d.1.a or
1C010.d.1.b and `commingled' with other fibers controlled by
1C010.a, 1C010.b or 1C010.c;
Technical Note: For the purposes of 1C010.d.2, `commingled' is
filament to filament blending of thermoplastic fibers and
reinforcement fibers in order to produce a fiber reinforcement
``matrix'' mix in total fiber form.
e. Fully or partially resin impregnated or pitch impregnated
``fibrous or filamentary materials'' (prepregs), metal or carbon
coated ``fibrous or filamentary materials'' (preforms) or `carbon
fiber preforms', having all of the following:
e.1. Having any of the following:
e.1.a. Inorganic ``fibrous or filamentary materials'' controlled
by 1C010.c; or
e.1.b. Organic or carbon ``fibrous or filamentary materials'',
having all of the following:
e.1.b.1. ``Specific modulus'' exceeding 10.15 x 10\6\ m; and
e.1.b.2 ``Specific tensile strength'' exceeding 17.7 x 10\4\m;
and
e.2. Having any of the following:
e.2.a. Resin or pitch, controlled by 1C008 or 1C009.b;
e.2.b. `Dynamic Mechanical Analysis glass transition temperature
(DMA Tg)' equal to or exceeding 453 K (180[deg]C) and
having a phenolic resin; or
e.2.c. `Dynamic Mechanical Analysis glass transition temperature
(DMA Tg)' equal to or exceeding 505 K (232[deg]C) and
having a resin or pitch, not specified by 1C008 or 1C009.b, and not
being a phenolic resin;
Note 1: Metal or carbon coated ``fibrous or filamentary
materials'' (preforms) or `carbon fiber preforms', not impregnated
with resin or pitch, are specified by ``fibrous or filamentary
materials'' in 1C010.a, 1C010.b or 1C010.c.
Note 2: 1C010.e does not apply to:
a. Epoxy resin ``matrix'' impregnated carbon ``fibrous or
filamentary materials'' (prepregs) for the repair of ``civil
aircraft'' structures or laminates, having all of the following:
1. An area not exceeding 1 m2
2. A length not exceeding 2.5 m; and
3. A width exceeding 15 mm;
b. Fully or partially resin-impregnated or pitch-impregnated
mechanically chopped, milled or cut carbon ``fibrous or filamentary
materials'' 25.0 mm or less in length when using a resin or pitch
other than those specified by 1C008 or 1C009.b.
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 1C010.e and Note 1, `carbon fiber
preforms' are an ordered arrangement of uncoated or coated fibers
intended to constitute a framework of a part before the ``matrix''
is introduced to form a ``composite''.
2. For the purposes of 1C010.e.2, `Dynamic Mechanical Analysis
glass transition temperature (DMA Tg)' is determined using the
method described in ASTM D 7028 -07, or equivalent national
standard, on a dry test specimen. In the case of thermoset
materials, degree of cure of a dry test specimen shall be a minimum
of 90% as defined by ASTM E 2160 04 or equivalent national standard.
1C011 Metals and compounds, as follows (see List of Items
Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, AT
Country chart (see supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
MT applies to 1C011.a and .b for items MT Column 1
that meet or exceed the parameters in
1C111..
[[Page 71942]]
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See also ECCNs 1C111 and 1C608. (2) All of the
following are ``subject to the ITAR'' (see 22 CFR parts 120 through
130): (a) Materials controlled by 1C011.a, and metal fuels in
particle form, whether spherical, atomized, spheroidal, flaked or
ground, manufactured from material consisting of 99 percent or more
of items controlled by 1C011.b; and (b) Metal powders mixed with
other substances to form a mixture formulated for military purposes.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Metals in particle sizes of less than 60 [mu]m whether
spherical, atomized, spheroidal, flaked or ground, manufactured from
material consisting of 99% or more of zirconium, magnesium and
alloys thereof;
Technical Note: For the purposes of 1C011.a, the natural content
of hafnium in the zirconium (typically 2% to 7%) is counted with the
zirconium.
Note: The metals or alloys specified by 1C011.a also refer to
metals or alloys encapsulated in aluminum, magnesium, zirconium or
beryllium.
b. Boron or boron alloys, with a particle size of 60 [mu]m or
less, as follows:
b.1. Boron with a purity of 85% by weight or more;
b.2. Boron alloys with a boron content of 85% by weight or more;
Note: The metals or alloys specified by 1C011.b also refer to
metals or alloys encapsulated in aluminum, magnesium, zirconium or
beryllium.
c. Guanidine nitrate (CAS 506-93-4);
d. Nitroguanidine (NQ) (CAS 556-88-7).
* * * * *
2A001 Anti-friction bearings, bearing systems and ``components,'' as
follows, (see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, AT
Country chart (see supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
MT applies to radial ball bearings having MT Column 1
all tolerances specified in accordance
with ISO 492 Tolerance Class 2 (or ANSI/
ABMA Std 20 Tolerance Class ABEC-9, or
other national equivalents) or better and
having all the following characteristics:
an inner ring bore diameter between 12
and 50 mm; an outer ring outside diameter
between 25 and 100 mm; and a width
between 10 and 20 mm..
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: $3000, N/A for MT
GBS: Yes, for 2A001.a,
N/A for MT
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See also 2A991. (2) Quiet running bearings
are ``subject to the ITAR'' (see 22 CFR parts 120 through 130.)
Related Definitions: Annular Bearing Engineers Committee (ABEC).
Items:
Note: 2A001.a includes ball bearing and roller elements
``specially designed'' for the items specified therein.
a. Ball bearings and solid roller bearings, having all
tolerances specified by the manufacturer in accordance with ISO 492
Tolerance Class 2 or Class 4 (or national equivalents), or better,
and having both `rings' and `rolling elements', made from monel or
beryllium;
Note: 2A001.a does not control tapered roller bearings.
Technical Notes: For the purposes of 2A001.a:
1. `Ring'--is an annular part of a radial rolling bearing
incorporating one or more raceways (ISO 5593:1997).
2. `Rolling element'--is a ball or roller which rolls between
raceways (ISO 5593:1997).
b. [Reserved]
c. Active magnetic bearing systems using any of the following,
and ``specially designed'' components therefor:
c.1. Materials with flux densities of 2.0 T or greater and yield
strengths greater than 414 MPa;
c.2. All-electromagnetic 3D homopolar bias designs for
actuators; or
c.3. High temperature (450 K (177 [deg]C) and above) position
sensors.
* * * * *
B. ``Test,'' ``Inspection'' and ``Production Equipment''
Technical Notes for 2B001 to 2B009, 2B201, and 2B991 to 2B999:
1. For the purposes of 2B, secondary parallel contouring axes,
(e.g., the w-axis on horizontal boring mills or a secondary rotary
axis the center line of which is parallel to the primary rotary
axis) are not counted in the total number of contouring axes. Rotary
axes need not rotate over 360 [deg]. A rotary axis can be driven by
a linear device (e.g., a screw or a rack-and-pinion).
2. For the purposes of 2B, the number of axes which can be
coordinated simultaneously for ``contouring control'' is the number
of axes along or around which, during processing of the workpiece,
simultaneous and interrelated motions are performed between the
workpiece and a tool. This does not include any additional axes
along or around which other relative motions within the machine are
performed, such as:
2.a. Wheel-dressing systems in grinding machines;
2.b. Parallel rotary axes designed for mounting of separate
workpieces;
2.c. Co-linear rotary axes designed for manipulating the same
workpiece by holding it in a chuck from different ends.
3. For the purposes of 2B, axis nomenclature shall be in
accordance with International Standard ISO 841:2001, Industrial
automation systems and integration--Numerical control of machines--
Coordinate system and motion nomenclature.
4. For the purposes of this Category, a ``tilting spindle'' is
counted as a rotary axis.
5. For the purposes of 2B, `stated ``unidirectional positioning
repeatability''' may be used for each specific machine model as an
alternative to individual machine tests, and is determined as
follows:
5.a. Select five machines of a model to be evaluated;
5.b. Measure the linear axis repeatability (R[uarr],R[darr])
according to ISO 230-2:2014 and evaluate ``unidirectional
positioning repeatability'' for each axis of each of the five
machines;
5.c. Determine the arithmetic mean value of the ``unidirectional
positioning repeatability''-values for each axis of all five
machines together. These arithmetic mean values ``unidirectional
positioning repeatability'' (UPR) become the stated value of each
axis for the model. . .)(UPRx, UPRy, . . .);
5.d. Since the Category 2 list refers to each linear axis there
will be as many `stated ``unidirectional positioning
repeatability''' values as there are linear axes;
5.e. If any axis of a machine model not controlled by 2B001.a.
to 2B001.c. has a `stated ``unidirectional positioning
repeatability''' equal to or less than the specified
``unidirectional positioning repeatability'' of each machine tool
model plus 0.7 [micro]m, the builder should be required to reaffirm
the accuracy level once every eighteen months.
6. For the purposes of 2B, measurement uncertainty for the
``unidirectional positioning repeatability'' of machine tools, as
defined in the International Standard ISO 230-2:2014, shall not be
considered.
[[Page 71943]]
7. For the purposes of 2B, the measurement of axes shall be made
according to test procedures in 5.3.2. of ISO 230-2:2014. Tests for
axes longer than 2 meters shall be made over 2 m segments. Axes
longer than 4 m require multiple tests (e.g., two tests for axes
longer than 4 m and up to 8 m, three tests for axes longer than 8 m
and up to 12 m), each over 2 m segments and distributed in equal
intervals over the axis length. Test segments are equally spaced
along the full axis length, with any excess length equally divided
at the beginning, in between, and at the end of the test segments.
The smallest ``unidirectional positioning repeatability''-value of
all test segments is to be reported.
* * * * *
2B004 Hot ``isostatic presses'' having all of the characteristics
described in the List of Items Controlled, and ``specially
designed'' ``components'' and ``accessories'' therefor.
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT NP, AT
Country chart (see supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
MT applies to entire entry................ MT Column 1
NP applies to entire entry, except NP Column 1
2B004.b.3 and presses with maximum
working pressures below 69 MPa.
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See ECCN 2D001 for software for items
controlled under this entry. (2) See ECCNs 2E001 (``development''),
2E002 (``production''), and 2E101 (``use'') for technology for items
controlled under this entry. (3) For ``specially designed'' dies,
molds and tooling, see ECCNs 0B501, 0B602, 0B606, 1B003, 9B004, and
9B009. (4) For additional controls on dies, molds and tooling, see
ECCNs 1B101.d, 2B104 and 2B204. (5) Also see ECCNs 2B117 and
2B999.a.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. A controlled thermal environment within the closed cavity and
possessing a chamber cavity with an inside diameter of 406 mm or
more; and
b. Having any of the following:
b.1. A maximum working pressure exceeding 207 MPa;
b.2. A controlled thermal environment exceeding 1,773 K (1,500
[deg]C); or
b.3. A facility for hydrocarbon impregnation and removal of
resultant gaseous degradation products.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 2B004, the inside chamber
dimension is that of the chamber in which both the working
temperature and the working pressure are achieved and does not
include fixtures. That dimension will be the smaller of either the
inside diameter of the pressure chamber or the inside diameter of
the insulated furnace chamber, depending on which of the two
chambers is located inside the other.
* * * * *
2B006 Dimensional inspection or measuring systems, equipment,
position feedback units and ``electronic assemblies'', as follows
(see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, NP, AT
Country chart (see supp. no.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
NP applies to those items in 2B006.a, b.1, NP Column 1
b.3, and .c (angular displacement
measuring instruments) that meet or
exceed the technical parameters in 2B206..
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See ECCNs 2D001 and 2D002 for ``software'' for
items controlled under this entry. (2) See ECCNs 2E001
(``development''), 2E002 (``production''), and 2E201 (``use'') for
technology for items controlled under this entry. (3) Also see ECCNs
2B206 and 2B996.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Computer controlled or ``numerically controlled'' Coordinate
Measuring Machines (CMM), having a three dimensional length
(volumetric) maximum permissible error of length measurement
(E0,MPE) at any point within the operating range of the
machine (i.e., within the length of axes) equal to or less (better)
than (1.7 + L/1,000) [mu]m (L is the measured length in mm)
according to ISO 10360-2 (2009);
Technical Note: For the purposes of 2B006.a, E0,MPE
of the most accurate configuration of the CMM specified by the
manufacturer (e.g.,best of the following: Probe, stylus length,
motion parameters, environment) and with ``all compensations
available'' shall be compared to the 1.7 + L/1,000 [mu]m threshold.
b. Linear displacement measuring instruments or systems, linear
position feedback units, and ``electronic assemblies'', as follows:
Note: Interferometer and optical-encoder measuring systems
containing a ``laser'' are only specified by 2B006.b.3.
b.1. `Non-contact type measuring systems' with a `resolution'
equal to or less (better) than 0.2 [mu]m within 0 to 0.2 mm of the
'measuring range';
Technical Notes: For the purposes of 2B006.b.1:
1. `Non-contact type measuring systems' are designed to measure
the distance between the probe and measured object along a single
vector, where the probe or measured object is in motion.
2. `Measuring range' means the distance between the minimum and
maximum working distance.
b.2. Linear position feedback units ``specially designed'' for
machine tools and having an overall ``accuracy'' less (better) than
(800 + (600 x L/1,000)) nm (L equals effective length in mm);
b.3. Measuring systems having all of the following:
b.3.a. Containing a ``laser'';
b.3.b. A `resolution' over their full scale of 0.200 nm or less
(better); and
b.3.c. Capable of achieving a ``measurement uncertainty'' equal
to or less (better) than (1.6 + L/2,000) nm (L is the measured
length in mm) at any point within a measuring range, when
compensated for the refractive index of air and measured over a
period of 30 seconds at a temperature of 200.01[deg]C;
Technical Note: For the purposes of 2B006.b, `resolution' is the
least increment of a measuring device; on digital instruments, the
least significant bit.
b.4. ``Electronic assemblies'' ``specially designed'' to provide
feedback capability in systems controlled by 2B006.b.3;
c. Rotary position feedback units ``specially designed'' for
machine tools or angular displacement measuring instruments, having
an angular position ``accuracy'' equal to or less (better) than 0.9
second of arc;
Note: 2B006.c does not control optical instruments, such as
autocollimators, using collimated light (e.g., ``laser'' light) to
detect angular displacement of a mirror.
d. Equipment for measuring surface roughness (including surface
defects), by measuring optical scatter with a sensitivity of 0.5 nm
or less (better).
Note: 2B006 includes machine tools, other than those specified
by 2B001, that can be used as measuring machines, if they meet or
exceed the criteria specified for the measuring machine function.
* * * * *
2B008 `Compound rotary tables' and ``tilting spindles'', ``specially
designed'' for machine tools, as follows (see List of Items
Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Country chart (see supp. no.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
[[Page 71944]]
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: See also 2B998.
Related Definition: N/A
Items:
a. [Reserved]
b. [Reserved]
c. `Compound rotary tables' having all of the following:
c.1. Designed for machine tools for turning, milling or
grinding; and
c.2. Two rotary axes designed to be coordinated simultaneously
for ``contouring control''.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 2B008.c, a `compound rotary
table' is a table allowing the workpiece to rotate and tilt about
two non-parallel axes.
d. ``Tilting spindles'' having all of the following:
d.1. Designed for machine tools for turning, milling or
grinding; and
d.2. Designed to be coordinated simultaneously for ``contouring
control''.
* * * * *
2B009 Spin-forming machines and flow-forming machines, which,
according to the manufacturer's technical specifications, can be
equipped with ``numerical control'' units or a computer control and
having all of the following characteristics (see List of Items
Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, NP, AT
Country chart (see supp. no.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
MT applies to: spin-forming............... MT Column 1
machines combining the functions of spin-
forming and flow-forming; and flow-
forming machines that meet or exceed the
parameters of 2B009.a and 2B109.
NP applies to flow-forming machines, and NP Column 1
spin-forming machines capable of flow-
forming functions, that meet or exceed
the parameters of 2B209.
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See ECCN 2D001 for ``software'' for items
controlled under this entry. (2) See ECCNs 2E001 (``development''),
2E002 (``production''), and 2E101 (``use'') for technology for items
controlled under this entry. (3) Also see ECCNs 2B109 and 2B209 for
additional flow-forming machines for MT and NP reasons.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Three or more axes which can be coordinated simultaneously
for ``contouring control''; and
b. A roller force more than 60 kN.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 2B009, machines combining
the function of spin-forming and flow-forming are regarded as flow-
forming machines.
* * * * *
2E003 Other ``technology'', as follows (see List of Items
Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 1
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
TSR: Yes, except 2E003.b, .e and .f
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: See 2E001, 2E002, and 2E101 for ``development''
and ``use'' technology for equipment that are designed or modified
for densification of carbon-carbon composites, structural composite
rocket nozzles and reentry vehicle nose tips.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. [Reserved]
b. ``Technology'' for metal-working manufacturing processes, as
follows:
b.1. ``Technology'' for the design of tools, dies or fixtures
``specially designed'' for any of the following processes:
b.1.a. ``Superplastic forming'';
b.1.b. ``Diffusion bonding''; or
b.1.c. `Direct-acting hydraulic pressing';
b.2. [Reserved]
N.B.: For ``technology'' for metal-working manufacturing
processes for gas turbine engines and components, see 9E003 and USML
Category XIX
Technical Note: For the purposes of 2E003.b.1.c, `direct-acting
hydraulic pressing' is a deformation process which uses a fluid-
filled flexible bladder in direct contact with the workpiece.
c. ``Technology'' for the ``development'' or ``production'' of
hydraulic stretch-forming machines and dies therefor, for the
manufacture of airframe structures;
d. [Reserved]
e. ``Technology'' for the ``development'' of integration
``software'' for incorporation of expert systems for advanced
decision support of shop floor operations into ``numerical control''
units;
f. ``Technology'' for the application of inorganic overlay
coatings or inorganic surface modification coatings (specified in
column 3 of the following table) to non-electronic substrates
(specified in column 2 of the following table), by processes
specified in column 1 of the following table and defined in the
Technical Note.
N.B. This table should be read to control the technology of a
particular `Coating Process' only when the resultant coating in
column 3 is in a paragraph directly across from the relevant
`Substrate' under column 2. For example, Chemical Vapor Deposition
(CVD) `coating process' control the ``technology'' for a particular
application of `silicides' to `Carbon-carbon, Ceramic and Metal
``matrix'' ``composites'' substrates, but are not controlled for the
application of `silicides' to `Cemented tungsten carbide (16),
Silicon carbide (18)' substrates. In the second case, the resultant
coating is not listed in the paragraph under column 3 directly
across from the paragraph under column 2 listing `Cemented tungsten
carbide (16), Silicon carbide (18)'.
Category 2E--Materials Processing Table; Deposition Techniques
---------------------------------------------------------------------------
\1\ The numbers in parenthesis refer to the Notes following this
Table.
------------------------------------------------------------------------
3. Resultant
1. Coating process (1) \1\ 2. Substrate coating
------------------------------------------------------------------------
A. Chemical Vapor Deposition ``Superalloys''... Aluminides for
(CVD). internal passages
Ceramics (19) and Silicides
Low-expansion Carbides
glasses(14). Dielectric layers
(15)
Diamond
Diamond-like
carbon (17)
[[Page 71945]]
Carbon-carbon, Silicides
Ceramic, and Carbides
Metal ``matrix'' Refractory metals
``composites``.
Mixtures thereof
(4)
Dielectric layers
(15)
Aluminides
Alloyed aluminides
(2)
Boron nitride
Cemented tungsten. Carbides
carbide (16),..... Tungsten
Silicon carbide Mixtures thereof
(18). (4)
Dielectric layers
(15)
Molybdenum and Dielectric layers
Molybdenum alloys. (15)
Beryllium and Dielectric layers
Beryllium alloys. (15)
Diamond
Diamond-like
carbon (17)
Sensor window Dielectric layers
materials (9). (15)
Diamond
Diamond-like
carbon (17)
B. Thermal-Evaporation Physical
Vapor:
1. Physical Vapor Deposition ``Superalloys''... Alloyed silicides
(PVD): Deposition (TE-PVD) Alloyed aluminides
Electron-Beam (EB-PVD). (2)
MCrAlX (5)
Modified zirconia
(12)
Silicides
Aluminides
Mixtures thereof
(4)
Ceramics (19) and Dielectric layers
Low-expansion (15)
glasses (14).
Corrosion MCrAlX (5)
resistant steel Modified zirconia
(7). (12)
Mixtures thereof
(4)
Carbon-carbon, Silicides
Ceramic and Metal Carbides
``matrix'' Refractory metals
``composites''.
Mixtures thereof
(4)
Dielectric layers
(15)
Boron nitride
Cemented tungsten Carbides
carbide (16), Tungsten
Silicon carbide Mixtures thereof
(18). (4)
Dielectric layers
(15)
Molybdenum and Dielectric layers
Molybdenum alloys. (15)
Beryllium and Dielectric layers
Beryllium alloys. (15)
Borides
Beryllium
Sensor window Dielectric layers
materials (9). (15)
Titanium alloys Borides
(13). Nitrides
2. Ion assisted resistive Ceramics (19) and Dielectric layers
heating Physical Vapor Low-expansion (15)
Deposition (PVD)(Ion glasses (14). Diamond-like
Plating). carbon (17)
Carbon-carbon, Dielectric layers
Ceramic and Metal (15)
``matrix''
``composites''.
Cemented tungsten Dielectric layers
carbide (16). (15)
Silicon carbide...
Molybdenum and Dielectric layers
Molybdenum alloys. (15)
Beryllium and Dielectric layers
Beryllium alloys. (15)
Sensor window Dielectric Layers
materials (9). (15)
Diamond-like
carbon (17)
3. Physical Vapor Deposition Ceramics (19) and Silicides
(PVD): ``Laser'' Low-expansion Dielectric layers
Vaporization. glasses (14). (15)
Diamond-like
carbon (17)
Carbon-carbon, Dielectric layers
Ceramic and Metal (15)
``matrix''
``composites''.
Cemented tungsten Dielectric Layers
carbide (16), (15)
Silicon carbide.
Molybdenum and Dielectric layers
Molybdenum alloys. (15)
Beryllium and Dielectric layers
Beryllium alloys. (15)
Sensor window Dielectric layers
materials (9). (15)
Diamond-like
carbon
4. Physical Vapor Deposition ``Superalloys''... Alloyed silicides
(PVD): Cathodic Arc Alloyed Aluminides
Discharge. (2)
MCrA1X (5)
[[Page 71946]]
Polymers (11) and Borides
Organic Carbides
``matrix'' Nitrides
``composites''. Diamond-like
carbon (17)
C. Pack cementation (see A above Carbon-carbon, Silicides
for out-of-pack cementation) Ceramic and Metal Carbides
(10). ``matrix'' Mixtures thereof
``composites''. (4)
Titanium alloys Silicides
(13). Aluminides
Alloyed aluminides
(2)
Refractory metals Silicides
and alloys (8). Oxides
D. Plasma spraying.............. ``Superalloys''... MCrAlX (5)
Modified zirconia
(12)
Mixtures thereof
(4)
Abradable Nickel-
Graphite
Abradable
materials
containing
Ni-Cr-Al Abradable
Al-Si-Polyester
Alloyed
aluminides (2)
Aluminum alloys MCrAlX (5)
(6). Modified zirconia
(12)
Silicides
Mixtures thereof
(4)
Refractory metals Aluminides
and alloys (8), Silicides
Carbides, MCrAlX (5)
Corrosion Modified zirconia
resistant steel (12)
(7). Mixtures thereof
(4)
D. Plasma spraying (continued).. Titanium alloys Carbides
(13). Aluminides
Silicides
Alloyed aluminides
(2)
Abradable Nickel Abradable
Graphite. materials
containing
Ni-Cr-Al
Abradable Al-Si-
Polyester
E. Slurry Deposition............ Refractory metals Fused silicides
and alloys (8). Fused aluminides
except for
resistance
heating elements
Carbon-carbon, Silicides
Ceramic and Metal Carbides
``matrix'' Mixtures thereof
``composites''. (4)
F. Sputter Deposition........... ``Superalloys''... Alloyed silicides
Alloyed aluminides
(2)
Noble metal
modified
aluminides (3)
MCrAlX (5)
Modified zirconia
(12)
Platinum
Mixtures thereof
(4)
Ceramics and Low- Silicides
expansion glasses Platinum
(14). Mixtures thereof
(4)
Dielectric layers
(15)
Diamond-like
carbon (17)
Titanium alloys Borides
(13). Nitrides
Oxides
Silicides
Aluminides
Alloyed aluminides
(2)
Carbides
F. Sputter Deposition Carbon-carbon, Silicides
(continued). Ceramic and Metal Carbides
``matrix'' Refractory metals
``Composites''.
Mixtures thereof
(4)
Dielectric layers
(15)
Boron nitride
Cemented tungsten Carbides
carbide (16), Tungsten
Silicon carbide Mixtures thereof
(18). (4)
Dielectric layers
(15)
Boron nitride
Molybdenum and Dielectric layers
Molybdenum alloys. (15)
[[Page 71947]]
Beryllium and Borides
Beryllium alloys. Dielectric layers
(15)
Beryllium
Sensor window Dielectric layers
materials (9). (15)
Diamond-like
carbon (17)
Refractory metals Aluminides
and alloys (8). Silicides
Oxides
Carbides
G. Ion Implantation............. High temperature Additions of
bearing steels. Chromium,Tantalum
, or Niobium
(Columbium)
Titanium alloys Borides
(13). Nitrides
Beryllium and Borides
Beryllium alloys.
Cemented tungsten Carbides
carbide (16). Nitrides
------------------------------------------------------------------------
Notes to Table on Deposition Techniques:
1. The term ``coating process'' includes coating repair and
refurbishing as well as original coating.
2. The term ``alloyed aluminide coating'' includes single or
multiple-step coatings in which an element or elements are deposited
prior to or during application of the aluminide coating, even if
these elements are deposited by another coating process. It does
not, however, include the multiple use of single-step pack
cementation processes to achieve alloyed aluminides.
3. The term ``noble metal modified aluminide'' coating includes
multiple-step coatings in which the noble metal or noble metals are
laid down by some other coating process prior to application of the
aluminide coating.
4. The term ``mixtures thereof'' includes infiltrated material,
graded compositions, co-deposits and multilayer deposits and are
obtained by one or more of the coating processes specified in the
Table.
5. MCrAlX refers to a coating alloy where M equals cobalt, iron,
nickel or combinations thereof and X equals hafnium, yttrium,
silicon, tantalum in any amount or other intentional additions over
0.01% by weight in various proportions and combinations, except:
a. CoCrAlY coatings which contain less than 22% by weight of
chromium, less than 7% by weight of aluminum and less than 2% by
weight of yttrium;
b. CoCrAlY coatings which contain 22 to 24% by weight of
chromium, 10 to 12% by weight of aluminum and 0.5 to 0.7% by weight
of yttrium; or
c. NiCrAlY coatings which contain 21 to 23% by weight of
chromium, 10 to 12% by weight of aluminum and 0.9 to 1.1% by weight
of yttrium.
6. The term ``aluminum alloys'' refers to alloys having an
ultimate tensile strength of 190 MPa or more measured at 293 K (20
[deg]C).
7. The term ``corrosion resistant steel'' refers to AISI
(American Iron and Steel Institute) 300 series or equivalent
national standard steels.
8. ``Refractory metals and alloys'' include the following metals
and their alloys: niobium (columbium), molybdenum, tungsten and
tantalum.
9. ``Sensor window materials'', as follows: alumina, silicon,
germanium, zinc sulphide, zinc selenide, gallium arsenide, diamond,
gallium phosphide, sapphire and the following metal halides: sensor
window materials of more than 40 mm diameter for zirconium fluoride
and hafnium fluoride.
10. Category 2 does not include ``technology'' for single-step
pack cementation of solid airfoils.
11. ``Polymers'', as follows: polyimide, polyester, polysulfide,
polycarbonates and polyurethanes.
12. ``Modified zirconia'' refers to additions of other metal
oxides, (e.g., calcia, magnesia, yttria, hafnia, rare earth oxides)
to zirconia in order to stabilize certain crystallographic phases
and phase compositions. Thermal barrier coatings made of zirconia,
modified with calcia or magnesia by mixing or fusion, are not
controlled.
13. ``Titanium alloys'' refers only to aerospace alloys having
an ultimate tensile strength of 900 MPa or more measured at 293 K
(20 [deg]C).
14. ``Low-expansion glasses'' refers to glasses which have a
coefficient of thermal expansion of 1 x 10-7 K-1 or less measured at
293 K (20 [deg]C).
15. ``Dielectric layers'' are coatings constructed of multi-
layers of insulator materials in which the interference properties
of a design composed of materials of various refractive indices are
used to reflect, transmit or absorb various wavelength bands.
Dielectric layers refers to more than four dielectric layers or
dielectric/metal ``composite'' layers.
16. ``Cemented tungsten carbide'' does not include cutting and
forming tool materials consisting of tungsten carbide/(cobalt,
nickel), titanium carbide/(cobalt, nickel), chromium carbide/nickel-
chromium and chromium carbide/nickel.
17. ``Technology'' for depositing diamond-like carbon on any of
the following is not controlled: magnetic disk drives and heads,
equipment for the manufacture of disposables, valves for faucets,
acoustic diaphragms for speakers, engine parts for automobiles,
cutting tools, punching-pressing dies, office automation equipment,
microphones, medical devices or molds, for casting or molding of
plastics, manufactured from alloys containing less than 5%
beryllium.
18. ``Silicon carbide'' does not include cutting and forming
tool materials.
19. Ceramic substrates, as used in this entry, does not include
ceramic materials containing 5% by weight, or greater, clay or
cement content, either as separate constituents or in combination.
Technical Note to Table on Deposition Techniques: Processes
specified in Column 1 of the Table are defined as follows:
a. Chemical Vapor Deposition (CVD) is an overlay coating or
surface modification coating process wherein a metal, alloy,
``composite'', dielectric or ceramic is deposited upon a heated
substrate. Gaseous reactants are decomposed or combined in the
vicinity of a substrate resulting in the deposition of the desired
elemental, alloy or compound material on the substrate. Energy for
this decomposition or chemical reaction process may be provided by
the heat of the substrate, a glow discharge plasma, or ``laser''
irradiation.
Note 1: CVD includes the following processes: directed gas flow
out-of-pack deposition, pulsating CVD, controlled nucleation thermal
decomposition (CNTD), plasma enhanced or plasma assisted CVD
processes.
Note 2: Pack denotes a substrate immersed in a powder mixture.
Note 3: The gaseous reactants used in the out-of-pack process
are produced using the same basic reactions and parameters as the
pack cementation process, except that the substrate to be coated is
not in contact with the powder mixture.
b. Thermal Evaporation-Physical Vapor Deposition (TE-PVD) is an
overlay coating process conducted in a vacuum with a pressure less
than 0.1 Pa wherein a source of thermal energy is used to vaporize
the coating material. This process results in the condensation, or
deposition, of the evaporated species onto appropriately positioned
substrates. The addition of gases to the vacuum chamber during the
coating process to synthesize compound coatings is an ordinary
modification of the process. The use of ion or electron beams, or
plasma, to activate or assist the coating's deposition is also a
common modification in this technique. The use of monitors to
provide in-process measurement of optical characteristics and
thickness of coatings can
[[Page 71948]]
be a feature of these processes. Specific TE-PVD processes are as
follows:
1. Electron Beam PVD uses an electron beam to heat and evaporate
the material which forms the coating;
2. Ion Assisted Resistive Heating PVD employs electrically
resistive heating sources in combination with impinging ion beam(s)
to produce a controlled and uniform flux of evaporated coating
species;
3. ``Laser'' Vaporization uses either pulsed or continuous wave
``laser'' beams to vaporize the material which forms the coating;
4. Cathodic Arc Deposition employs a consumable cathode of the
material which forms the coating and has an arc discharge
established on the surface by a momentary contact of a ground
trigger. Controlled motion of arcing erodes the cathode surface
creating a highly ionized plasma. The anode can be either a cone
attached to the periphery of the cathode, through an insulator, or
the chamber. Substrate biasing is used for non line-of-sight
deposition;
Note: This definition does not include random cathodic arc
deposition with non-biased substrates.
5. Ion Plating is a special modification of a general TE-PVD
process in which a plasma or an ion source is used to ionize the
species to be deposited, and a negative bias is applied to the
substrate in order to facilitate the extraction of the species from
the plasma. The introduction of reactive species, evaporation of
solids within the process chamber, and the use of monitors to
provide in-process measurement of optical characteristics and
thicknesses of coatings are ordinary modifications of the process.
c. Pack Cementation is a surface modification coating or overlay
coating process wherein a substrate is immersed in a powder mixture
(a pack), that consists of:
1. The metallic powders that are to be deposited (usually
aluminum, chromium, silicon or combinations thereof);
2. An activator (normally a halide salt); and
3. An inert powder, most frequently alumina.
Note: The substrate and powder mixture is contained within a
retort which is heated to between 1,030 K (757 [deg]C) to 1,375 K
(1,102 [deg]C) for sufficient time to deposit the coating.
d. Plasma Spraying is an overlay coating process wherein a gun
(spray torch) which produces and controls a plasma accepts powder or
wire coating materials, melts them and propels them towards a
substrate, whereon an integrally bonded coating is formed. Plasma
spraying constitutes either low pressure plasma spraying or high
velocity plasma spraying.
Note 1: Low pressure means less than ambient atmospheric
pressure.
Note 2: High velocity refers to nozzle-exit gas velocity
exceeding 750 m/s calculated at 293 K (20 [deg]C) at 0.1 MPa.
e. Slurry Deposition is a surface modification coating or
overlay coating process wherein a metallic or ceramic powder with an
organic binder is suspended in a liquid and is applied to a
substrate by either spraying, dipping or painting, subsequent air or
oven drying, and heat treatment to obtain the desired coating.
f. Sputter Deposition is an overlay coating process based on a
momentum transfer phenomenon, wherein positive ions are accelerated
by an electric field towards the surface of a target (coating
material). The kinetic energy of the impacting ions is sufficient to
cause target surface atoms to be released and deposited on an
appropriately positioned substrate.
Note 1: The Table refers only to triode, magnetron or reactive
sputter deposition which is used to increase adhesion of the coating
and rate of deposition and to radio frequency (RF) augmented sputter
deposition used to permit vaporization of non-metallic coating
materials.
Note 2: Low-energy ion beams (less than 5 keV) can be used to
activate the deposition.
g. Ion Implantation is a surface modification coating process in
which the element to be alloyed is ionized, accelerated through a
potential gradient and implanted into the surface region of the
substrate. This includes processes in which ion implantation is
performed simultaneously with electron beam physical vapor
deposition or sputter deposition.
Accompanying Technical Information to Table on Deposition
Techniques:
1. Technical information for pretreatments of the substrates
listed in the Table, as follows:
a. Chemical stripping and cleaning bath cycle parameters, as
follows:
1. Bath composition;
a. For the removal of old or defective coatings corrosion
product or foreign deposits;
b. For preparation of virgin substrates;
2. Time in bath;
3. Temperature of bath;
4. Number and sequences of wash cycles;
b. Visual and macroscopic criteria for acceptance of the cleaned
part;
c. Heat treatment cycle parameters, as follows:
1. Atmosphere parameters, as follows:
a. Composition of the atmosphere;
b. Pressure of the atmosphere;
2. Temperature for heat treatment;
3. Time of heat treatment;
d. Substrate surface preparation parameters, as follows:
1. Grit blasting parameters, as follows:
a. Grit composition;
b. Grit size and shape;
c. Grit velocity;
2. Time and sequence of cleaning cycle after grit blast;
3. Surface finish parameters;
4. Application of binders to promote adhesion;
e. Masking technique parameters, as follows:
1. Material of mask;
2. Location of mask;
2. Technical information for in situ quality assurance
techniques for evaluation of the coating processes listed in the
Table, as follows:
a. Atmosphere parameters, as follows:
1. Composition of the atmosphere;
2. Pressure of the atmosphere;
b. Time parameters;
c. Temperature parameters;
d. Thickness parameters;
e. Index of refraction parameters;
f. Control of composition;
3. Technical information for post deposition treatments of the
coated substrates listed in the Table, as follows:
a. Shot peening parameters, as follows:
1. Shot composition;
2. Shot size;
3. Shot velocity;
b. Post shot peening cleaning parameters;
c. Heat treatment cycle parameters, as follows:
1. Atmosphere parameters, as follows:
a. Composition of the atmosphere;
b. Pressure of the atmosphere;
2. Time-temperature cycles;
d. Post heat treatment visual and macroscopic criteria for
acceptance of the coated substrates;
4. Technical information for quality assurance techniques for
the evaluation of the coated substrates listed in the Table, as
follows:
a. Statistical sampling criteria;
b. Microscopic criteria for:
1. Magnification;
2. Coating thickness, uniformity;
3. Coating integrity;
4. Coating composition;
5. Coating and substrates bonding;
6. Microstructural uniformity.
c. Criteria for optical properties assessment (measured as a
function of wavelength):
1. Reflectance;
2. Transmission;
3. Absorption;
4. Scatter;
5. Technical information and parameters related to specific
coating and surface modification processes listed in the Table, as
follows:
a. For Chemical Vapor Deposition (CVD):
1. Coating source composition and formulation;
2. Carrier gas composition;
3. Substrate temperature;
4. Time-temperature-pressure cycles;
5. Gas control and part manipulation;
b. For Thermal Evaporation-Physical Vapor Deposition (PVD):
1. Ingot or coating material source composition;
2. Substrate temperature;
3. Reactive gas composition;
4. Ingot feed rate or material vaporization rate;
5. Time-temperature-pressure cycles;
6. Beam and part manipulation;
7. ``Laser'' parameters, as follows:
a. Wave length;
b. Power density;
c. Pulse length;
d. Repetition ratio;
e. Source;
c. For Pack Cementation:
1. Pack composition and formulation;
2. Carrier gas composition;
3. Time-temperature-pressure cycles;
d. For Plasma Spraying:
1. Powder composition, preparation and size distributions;
2. Feed gas composition and parameters;
3. Substrate temperature;
4. Gun power parameters;
5. Spray distance;
6. Spray angle;
[[Page 71949]]
7. Cover gas composition, pressure and flow rates;
8. Gun control and part manipulation;
e. For Sputter Deposition:
1. Target composition and fabrication;
2. Geometrical positioning of part and target;
3. Reactive gas composition;
4. Electrical bias;
5. Time-temperature-pressure cycles;
6. Triode power;
7. Part manipulation;
f. For Ion Implantation:
1. Beam control and part manipulation;
2. Ion source design details;
3. Control techniques for ion beam and deposition rate
parameters;
4. Time-temperature-pressure cycles.
g. For Ion Plating:
1. Beam control and part manipulation;
2. Ion source design details;
3. Control techniques for ion beam and deposition rate
parameters;
4. Time-temperature-pressure cycles;
5. Coating material feed rate and vaporization rate;
6. Substrate temperature;
7. Substrate bias parameters.
* * * * *
3A001 Electronic items as follows (see List of Items Controlled).
Reason for Control: NS, RS, MT, NP, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to ``Monolithic Microwave NS Column 1
Integrated Circuit'' (``MMIC'')
amplifiers in 3A001.b.2 and discrete
microwave transistors in 3A001.b.3,
except those 3A001.b.2 and b.3 items
being exported or reexported for use in
civil telecommunications applications.
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
RS applies ``Monolithic Microwave RS Column 1
Integrated Circuit'' (``MMIC'')
amplifiers in 3A001.b.2 and discrete
microwave transistors in 3A001.b.3,
except those 3A001.b.2 and b.3 items
being exported or reexported for use in
civil telecommunications applications.
MT applies to 3A001.a.1.a when usable in MT Column 1
``missiles''; and to 3A001.a.5.a when
``designed or modified'' for military
use, hermetically sealed and rated for
operation in the temperature range from
below -54 [deg]C to above +125 [deg]C.
NP applies to pulse discharge capacitors NP Column 1
in 3A001.e.2 and superconducting
solenoidal electromagnets in 3A001.e.3
that meet or exceed the technical
parameters in 3A201.a and 3A201.b,
respectively.
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements: See Sec. 743.1 of the EAR for reporting
requirements for exports under 3A001.b.2 or b.3 under License
Exceptions, and Validated End-User authorizations.
License Requirements Note: See Sec. 744.17 of the EAR for
additional license requirements for microprocessors having a
processing speed of 5 GFLOPS or more and an arithmetic logic unit
with an access width of 32 bit or more, including those
incorporating ``information security'' functionality, and associated
``software'' and ``technology'' for the ``production'' or
``development'' of such microprocessors.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A for MT or NP; N/A for ``Monolithic Microwave Integrated
Circuit'' (``MMIC'') amplifiers in 3A001.b.2 and discrete microwave
transistors in 3A001.b.3, except those that are being exported or
reexported for use in civil telecommunications applications.
Yes for:
$1500: 3A001.c
$3000: 3A001.b.1, b.2 (exported or reexported for use in civil
telecommunications applications), b.3 (exported or reexported for
use in civil telecommunications applications), b.9, .d, .e, .f, and
.g.
$5000: 3A001.a (except a.1.a and a.5.a when controlled for MT), .b.4
to b.7, and b.12.
GBS: Yes for 3A001.a.1.b, a.2 to a.14 (except .a.5.a when controlled
for MT), b.2 (exported or reexported for use in civil
telecommunications applications), b.8 (except for ``vacuum
electronic devices'' exceeding 18 GHz), b.9., b.10, .g, and .h, and
.i.
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be used to ship any item in
3A001.b.2 or b.3, except those that are being exported or reexported
for use in civil telecommunications applications, to any of the
destinations listed in Country Group A:5 or A:6 (See Supplement No.
1 to part 740 of the EAR).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See Category XV of the USML for certain
``space-qualified'' electronics and Category XI of the USML for
certain ASICs, `transmit/receive modules,' or `transmit modules'
``subject to the ITAR'' (see 22 CFR parts 120 through 130). (2) See
also 3A101, 3A201, 3A611, 3A991, and 9A515.
Related Definitions: `Microcircuit' means a device in which a number
of passive or active elements are considered as indivisibly
associated on or within a continuous structure to perform the
function of a circuit. For the purposes of integrated circuits in
3A001.a.1, 5 x 10\3\ Gy(Si) = 5 x 10\5\ Rads (Si); 5 x 10\6\ Gy
(Si)/s = 5 x 10\8\ Rads (Si)/s.
Items:
a. General purpose integrated circuits, as follows:
Note 1: Integrated circuits include the following types:
--``Monolithic integrated circuits'';
--``Hybrid integrated circuits'';
--``Multichip integrated circuits'';
--Film type integrated circuits, including silicon-on-sapphire
integrated circuits'';
--``Optical integrated circuits'';
--``Three dimensional integrated circuits'';
--``Monolithic Microwave Integrated Circuits'' (``MMICs'').
a.1. Integrated circuits designed or rated as radiation hardened
to withstand any of the following:
a.1.a. A total dose of 5 x 10\3\ Gy (Si), or higher;
a.1.b. A dose rate upset of 5 x 10\6\ Gy (Si)/s, or higher; or
a.1.c. A fluence (integrated flux) of neutrons (1 MeV
equivalent) of 5 x 10\13\ n/cm\2\ or higher on silicon, or its
equivalent for other materials;
Note: 3A001.a.1.c does not apply to Metal Insulator
Semiconductors (MIS).
a.2. ``Microprocessor microcircuits,'' ``microcomputer
microcircuits,'' microcontroller microcircuits, storage integrated
circuits manufactured from a compound semiconductor, analog-to-
digital converters, integrated circuits that contain analog-to-
digital converters and store or process the digitized data, digital-
to-analog converters, electro-optical or ``optical integrated
circuits'' designed for ``signal processing'', field programmable
logic devices, custom integrated circuits for which either the
function is unknown or the control status of the equipment in which
the integrated circuit will be used in unknown, Fast Fourier
Transform (FFT) processors, Static Random-Access Memories (SRAMs),
or `non-volatile memories,' having any of the following:
Technical Note: For the purposes of 3A001.a.2, `non-volatile
memories' are
[[Page 71950]]
memories with data retention over a period of time after a power
shutdown.
a.2.a. Rated for operation at an ambient temperature above 398 K
(+125 [deg]C);
a.2.b. Rated for operation at an ambient temperature below 218 K
(-55 [deg]C); or
a.2.c. Rated for operation over the entire ambient temperature
range from 218 K (-55 [deg]C) to 398 K (+125 [deg]C);
Note: 3A001.a.2 does not apply to integrated circuits designed
for civil automobile or railway train applications.
a.3. ``Microprocessor microcircuits'', ``microcomputer
microcircuits'' and microcontroller microcircuits, manufactured from
a compound semiconductor and operating at a clock frequency
exceeding 40 MHz;
Note: 3A001.a.3 includes digital signal processors, digital
array processors and digital coprocessors.
a.4. [Reserved]
a.5. Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) and Digital-to-Analog
Converter (DAC) integrated circuits, as follows:
a.5.a. ADCs having any of the following:
a.5.a.1. A resolution of 8 bit or more, but less than 10 bit,
with a ``sample rate'' greater than 1.3 Giga Samples Per Second
(GSPS);
a.5.a.2. A resolution of 10 bit or more, but less than 12 bit,
with a ``sample rate'' greater than 600 Mega Samples Per Second
(MSPS);
a.5.a.3. A resolution of 12 bit or more, but less than 14 bit,
with a ``sample rate'' greater than 400 MSPS;
a.5.a.4. A resolution of 14 bit or more, but less than 16 bit,
with a ``sample rate'' greater than 250 MSPS; or
a.5.a.5. A resolution of 16 bit or more with a ``sample rate''
greater than 65 MSPS;
N.B.: For integrated circuits that contain analog-to-digital
converters and store or process the digitized data see 3A001.a.14.
Technical Notes: For the purposes of 3A001.a.5.a:
1. A resolution of n bit corresponds to a quantization of 2\n\
levels.
2. The resolution of the ADC is the number of bits of the
digital output that represents the measured analog input. Effective
Number of Bits (ENOB) is not used to determine the resolution of the
ADC.
3. For ``multiple channel ADCs'', the ``sample rate'' is not
aggregated and the ``sample rate'' is the maximum rate of any single
channel.
4. For ``interleaved ADCs'' or for ``multiple channel ADCs''
that are specified to have an interleaved mode of operation, the
``sample rates'' are aggregated and the ``sample rate'' is the
maximum combined total rate of all of the interleaved channels.
a.5.b. Digital-to-Analog Converters (DAC) having any of the
following:
a.5.b.1. A resolution of 10-bit or more but less than 12-
bit,with an `adjusted update rate' of exceeding 3,500 MSPS; or
a.5.b.2. A resolution of 12-bit or more and having any of the
following:
a.5.b.2.a. An `adjusted update rate' exceeding 1,250 MSPS but
not exceeding 3,500 MSPS, and having any of the following:
a.5.b.2.a.1. A settling time less than 9 ns to arrive at or
within 0.024% of full scale from a full scale step; or
a.5.b.2.a.2. A `Spurious Free Dynamic Range' (SFDR) greater than
68 dBc (carrier) when synthesizing a full scale analog signal of 100
MHz or the highest full scale analog signal frequency specified
below 100 MHz; or
a.5.b.2.b. An `adjusted update rate' exceeding 3,500 MSPS;
Technical Notes: For the purposes of 3A001.a.5.b:
1. `Spurious Free Dynamic Range' (SFDR) is defined as the ratio
of the RMS value of the carrier frequency (maximum signal component)
at the input of the DAC to the RMS value of the next largest noise
or harmonic distortion component at its output.
2. SFDR is determined directly from the specification table or
from the characterization plots of SFDR versus frequency.
3. A signal is defined to be full scale when its amplitude is
greater than -3 dBfs (full scale).
4. `Adjusted update rate' for DACs is:
a. For conventional (non-interpolating) DACs, the `adjusted
update rate' is the rate at which the digital signal is converted to
an analog signal and the output analog values are changed by the
DAC. For DACs where the interpolation mode may be bypassed
(interpolation factor of one), the DAC should be considered as a
conventional (non-interpolating) DAC.
b. For interpolating DACs (oversampling DACs), the `adjusted
update rate' is defined as the DAC update rate divided by the
smallest interpolating factor. For interpolating DACs, the `adjusted
update rate' may be referred to by different terms including:
input data rate
input word rate
input sample rate
maximum total input bus rate
maximum DAC clock rate for DAC clock input.
a.6. Electro-optical and ``optical integrated circuits'',
designed for ``signal processing'' and having all of the following:
a.6.a. One or more than one internal ``laser'' diode;
a.6.b. One or more than one internal light detecting element;
and
a.6.c. Optical waveguides;
a.7. `Field programmable logic devices' having any of the
following:
a.7.a. A maximum number of single-ended digital input/outputs of
greater than 700; or
a.7.b. An `aggregate one-way peak serial transceiver data rate'
of 500 Gb/s or greater;
Note: 3A001.a.7 includes:
--Complex Programmable Logic Devices (CPLDs);
--Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs);
--Field Programmable Logic Arrays (FPLAs);
--Field Programmable Interconnects (FPICs).
N.B.: For integrated circuits having field programmable logic
devices that are combined with an analog-to-digital converter, see
3A001.a.14.
Technical Notes: For the purposes of 3A001.a.7:
1. Maximum number of digital input/outputs in 3A001.a.7.a is
also referred to as maximum user input/outputs or maximum available
input/outputs, whether the integrated circuit is packaged or bare
die.
2. `Aggregate one-way peak serial transceiver data rate' is the
product of the peak serial one-way transceiver data rate times the
number of transceivers on the FPGA.
a.8. [Reserved]
a.9. Neural network integrated circuits;
a.10. Custom integrated circuits for which the function is
unknown, or the control status of the equipment in which the
integrated circuits will be used is unknown to the manufacturer,
having any of the following:
a.10.a. More than 1,500 terminals;
a.10.b. A typical ``basic gate propagation delay time'' of less
than 0.02 ns; or
a.10.c. An operating frequency exceeding 3 GHz;
a.11. Digital integrated circuits, other than those described in
3A001.a.3 to 3A001.a.10 and 3A001.a.12, based upon any compound
semiconductor and having any of the following:
a.11.a. An equivalent gate count of more than 3,000 (2 input
gates); or
a.11.b. A toggle frequency exceeding 1.2 GHz;
a.12. Fast Fourier Transform (FFT) processors having a rated
execution time for an N-point complex FFT of less than (N
log2 N)/20,480 ms, where N is the number of points;
Technical Note: For the purposes of 3A001.a.12, when N is equal
to 1,024 points, the formula in 3A001.a.12 gives an execution time
of 500 [mu]s.
a.13. Direct Digital Synthesizer (DDS) integrated circuits
having any of the following:
a.13.a. A Digital-to-Analog Converter (DAC) clock frequency of
3.5 GHz or more and a DAC resolution of 10 bit or more, but less
than 12 bit; or
a.13.b. A DAC clock frequency of 1.25 GHz or more and a DAC
resolution of 12 bit or more;
Technical Note: For the purposes of 3A001.a.13, the DAC clock
frequency may be specified as the master clock frequency or the
input clock frequency.
a.14. Integrated circuits that perform or are programmable to
perform all of the following:
a.14.a. Analog-to-digital conversions meeting any of the
following:
a.14.a.1. A resolution of 8 bit or more, but less than 10 bit,
with a ``sample rate'' greater than 1.3 Giga Samples Per Second
(GSPS);
a.14.a.2. A resolution of 10 bit or more, but less than 12 bit,
with a ``sample rate'' greater than 1.0 GSPS;
a.14.a.3. A resolution of 12 bit or more, but less than 14 bit,
with a ``sample rate'' greater than 1.0 GSPS;
a.14.a.4. A resolution of 14 bit or more, but less than 16 bit,
with a ``sample rate'' greater than 400 Mega Samples Per Second
(MSPS); or
a.14.a.5. A resolution of 16 bit or more with a ``sample rate''
greater than 180 MSPS; and
a.14.b. Any of the following:
a.14.b.1. Storage of digitized data; or
a.14.b.2. Processing of digitized data;
N.B. 1: For analog-to-digital converter integrated circuits see
3A001.a.5.a.
N.B. 2: For field programmable logic devices see 3A001.a.7.
Technical Notes: For the purposes of 3A001.a.14:
[[Page 71951]]
1. A resolution of n bit corresponds to a quantization of 2\n\
levels.
2. The resolution of the ADC is the number of bits of the
digital output of the ADC that represents the measured analog input.
Effective Number of Bits (ENOB) is not used to determine the
resolution of the ADC.
3. For integrated circuits with non-interleaving ``multiple
channel ADCs'', the ``sample rate'' is not aggregated and the
``sample rate'' is the maximum rate of any single channel.
4. For integrated circuits with ``interleaved ADCs'' or with
``multiple channel ADCs'' that are specified to have an interleaved
mode of operation, the ``sample rates'' are aggregated and the
``sample rate'' is the maximum combined total rate of all of the
interleaved channels.
b. Microwave or millimeter wave items, as follows:
Technical Note: For the purposes of 3A001.b, the parameter peak
saturated power output may also be referred to on product data
sheets as output power, saturated power output, maximum power
output, peak power output, or peak envelope power output.
b.1. ``Vacuum electronic devices'' and cathodes, as follows:
Note 1: 3A001.b.1 does not control ``vacuum electronic devices''
designed or rated for operation in any frequency band and having all
of the following:
a. Does not exceed 31.8 GHz; and
b. Is ``allocated by the ITU'' for radio-communications
services, but not for radio-determination.
Note 2: 3A001.b.1 does not control non-``space-qualified''
``vacuum electronic devices'' having all the following:
a. An average output power equal to or less than 50 W; and
b. Designed or rated for operation in any frequency band and
having all of the following:
1. Exceeds 31.8 GHz but does not exceed 43.5 GHz; and
2. Is ``allocated by the ITU'' for radio-communications
services, but not for radio-determination.
b.1.a. Traveling-wave ``vacuum electronic devices,'' pulsed or
continuous wave, as follows:
b.1.a.1. Devices operating at frequencies exceeding 31.8 GHz;
b.1.a.2. Devices having a cathode heater with a turn on time to
rated RF power of less than 3 seconds;
b.1.a.3. Coupled cavity devices, or derivatives thereof, with a
``fractional bandwidth'' of more than 7% or a peak power exceeding
2.5 kW;
b.1.a.4. Devices based on helix, folded waveguide, or serpentine
waveguide circuits, or derivatives thereof, having any of the
following:
b.1.a.4.a. An ``instantaneous bandwidth'' of more than one
octave, and average power (expressed in kW) times frequency
(expressed in GHz) of more than 0.5;
b.1.a.4.b. An ``instantaneous bandwidth'' of one octave or less,
and average power (expressed in kW) times frequency (expressed in
GHz) of more than 1;
b.1.a.4.c. Being ``space-qualified''; or
b.1.a.4.d. Having a gridded electron gun;
b.1.a.5. Devices with a ``fractional bandwidth'' greater than or
equal to 10%, with any of the following:
b.1.a.5.a. An annular electron beam;
b.1.a.5.b. A non-axisymmetric electron beam; or
b.1.a.5.c. Multiple electron beams;
b.1.b. Crossed-field amplifier ``vacuum electronic devices''
with a gain of more than 17 dB;
b.1.c. Thermionic cathodes, designed for ``vacuum electronic
devices,'' producing an emission current density at rated operating
conditions exceeding 5 A/cm\2\ or a pulsed (non-continuous) current
density at rated operating conditions exceeding 10 A/cm\2\;
b.1.d. ``Vacuum electronic devices'' with the capability to
operate in a `dual mode.'
Technical Note: For the purposes of 3A001.b.1.d, `dual mode'
means the ``vacuum electronic device'' beam current can be
intentionally changed between continuous-wave and pulsed mode
operation by use of a grid and produces a peak pulse output power
greater than the continuous-wave output power.
b.2. ``Monolithic Microwave Integrated Circuit'' (``MMIC'')
amplifiers that are any of the following:
N.B.: For ``MMIC'' amplifiers that have an integrated phase
shifter see 3A001.b.12.
b.2.a. Rated for operation at frequencies exceeding 2.7 GHz up
to and including 6.8 GHz with a ``fractional bandwidth'' greater
than 15%, and having any of the following:
b.2.a.1. A peak saturated power output greater than 75 W (48.75
dBm) at any frequency exceeding 2.7 GHz up to and including 2.9 GHz;
b.2.a.2. A peak saturated power output greater than 55 W (47.4
dBm) at any frequency exceeding 2.9 GHz up to and including 3.2 GHz;
b.2.a.3. A peak saturated power output greater than 40 W (46
dBm) at any frequency exceeding 3.2 GHz up to and including 3.7 GHz;
or
b.2.a.4. A peak saturated power output greater than 20 W (43
dBm) at any frequency exceeding 3.7 GHz up to and including 6.8 GHz;
b.2.b. Rated for operation at frequencies exceeding 6.8 GHz up
to and including 16 GHz with a ``fractional bandwidth'' greater than
10%, and having any of the following:
b.2.b.1. A peak saturated power output greater than 10 W (40
dBm) at any frequency exceeding 6.8 GHz up to and including 8.5 GHz;
or
b.2.b.2. A peak saturated power output greater than 5 W (37 dBm)
at any frequency exceeding 8.5 GHz up to and including 16 GHz;
b.2.c. Rated for operation with a peak saturated power output
greater than 3 W (34.77 dBm) at any frequency exceeding 16 GHz up to
and including 31.8 GHz, and with a ``fractional bandwidth'' of
greater than 10%;
b.2.d. Rated for operation with a peak saturated power output
greater than 0.1 nW (-70 dBm) at any frequency exceeding 31.8 GHz up
to and including 37 GHz;
b.2.e. Rated for operation with a peak saturated power output
greater than 1 W (30 dBm) at any frequency exceeding 37 GHz up to
and including 43.5 GHz, and with a ``fractional bandwidth'' of
greater than 10%;
b.2.f. Rated for operation with a peak saturated power output
greater than 31.62 mW (15 dBm) at any frequency exceeding 43.5 GHz
up to and including 75 GHz, and with a ``fractional bandwidth'' of
greater than 10%;
b.2.g. Rated for operation with a peak saturated power output
greater than 10 mW (10 dBm) at any frequency exceeding 75 GHz up to
and including 90 GHz, and with a ``fractional bandwidth'' of greater
than 5%; or
b.2.h. Rated for operation with a peak saturated power output
greater than 0.1 nW (-70 dBm) at any frequency exceeding 90 GHz;
Note 1: [Reserved]
Note 2: The control status of the ``MMIC'' whose rated operating
frequency includes frequencies listed in more than one frequency
range, as defined by 3A001.b.2.a through 3A001.b.2.h, is determined
by the lowest peak saturated power output control threshold.
Note 3: Notes 1 and 2 following the Category 3 heading for
product group A. Systems, Equipment, and Components mean that
3A001.b.2 does not control ``MMICs'' if they are ``specially
designed'' for other applications, e.g., telecommunications, radar,
automobiles.
b.3. Discrete microwave transistors that are any of the
following:
b.3.a. Rated for operation at frequencies exceeding 2.7 GHz up
to and including 6.8 GHz and having any of the following:
b.3.a.1. A peak saturated power output greater than 400 W (56
dBm) at any frequency exceeding 2.7 GHz up to and including 2.9 GHz;
b.3.a.2. A peak saturated power output greater than 205 W (53.12
dBm) at any frequency exceeding 2.9 GHz up to and including 3.2 GHz;
b.3.a.3. A peak saturated power output greater than 115 W (50.61
dBm) at any frequency exceeding 3.2 GHz up to and including 3.7 GHz;
or
b.3.a.4. A peak saturated power output greater than 60 W (47.78
dBm) at any frequency exceeding 3.7 GHz up to and including 6.8 GHz;
b.3.b. Rated for operation at frequencies exceeding 6.8 GHz up
to and including 31.8 GHz and having any of the following:
b.3.b.1. A peak saturated power output greater than 50 W (47
dBm) at any frequency exceeding 6.8 GHz up to and including 8.5 GHz;
b.3.b.2. A peak saturated power output greater than 15 W (41.76
dBm) at any frequency exceeding 8.5 GHz up to and including 12 GHz;
b.3.b.3. A peak saturated power output greater than 40 W (46
dBm) at any frequency exceeding 12 GHz up to and including 16 GHz;
or
b.3.b.4. A peak saturated power output greater than 7 W (38.45
dBm) at any frequency exceeding 16 GHz up to and including 31.8 GHz;
b.3.c. Rated for operation with a peak saturated power output
greater than 0.5 W (27 dBm) at any frequency exceeding 31.8 GHz up
to and including 37 GHz;
[[Page 71952]]
b.3.d. Rated for operation with a peak saturated power output
greater than 1 W (30 dBm) at any frequency exceeding 37 GHz up to
and including 43.5 GHz;
b.3.e. Rated for operation with a peak saturated power output
greater than 0.1 nW (-70 dBm) at any frequency exceeding 43.5 GHz;
or
b.3.f. Other than those specified by 3A001.b.3.a to 3A001.b.3.e
and rated for operation with a peak saturated power output greater
than 5 W (37.0 dBm) at all frequencies exceeding 8.5 GHz up to and
including 31.8 GHz;
Note 1: The control status of a transistor in 3A001.b.3.a
through 3A001.b.3.e, whose rated operating frequency includes
frequencies listed in more than one frequency range, as defined by
3A001.b.3.a through 3A001.b.3.e, is determined by the lowest peak
saturated power output control threshold.
Note 2: 3A001.b.3 includes bare dice, dice mounted on carriers,
or dice mounted in packages. Some discrete transistors may also be
referred to as power amplifiers, but the status of these discrete
transistors is determined by 3A001.b.3.
b.4. Microwave solid state amplifiers and microwave assemblies/
modules containing microwave solid state amplifiers, that are any of
the following:
b.4.a. Rated for operation at frequencies exceeding 2.7 GHz up
to and including 6.8 GHz with a ``fractional bandwidth'' greater
than 15%, and having any of the following:
b.4.a.1. A peak saturated power output greater than 500 W (57
dBm) at any frequency exceeding 2.7 GHz up to and including 2.9 GHz;
b.4.a.2. A peak saturated power output greater than 270 W (54.3
dBm) at any frequency exceeding 2.9 GHz up to and including 3.2 GHz;
b.4.a.3. A peak saturated power output greater than 200 W (53
dBm) at any frequency exceeding 3.2 GHz up to and including 3.7 GHz;
or
b.4.a.4. A peak saturated power output greater than 90 W (49.54
dBm) at any frequency exceeding 3.7 GHz up to and including 6.8 GHz;
b.4.b. Rated for operation at frequencies exceeding 6.8 GHz up
to and including 31.8 GHz with a ``fractional bandwidth'' greater
than 10%, and having any of the following:
b.4.b.1. A peak saturated power output greater than 70 W (48.45
dBm) at any frequency exceeding 6.8 GHz up to and including 8.5 GHz;
b.4.b.2. A peak saturated power output greater than 50 W (47
dBm) at any frequency exceeding 8.5 GHz up to and including 12 GHz;
b.4.b.3. A peak saturated power output greater than 30 W (44.77
dBm) at any frequency exceeding 12 GHz up to and including 16 GHz;
or
b.4.b.4. A peak saturated power output greater than 20 W (43
dBm) at any frequency exceeding 16 GHz up to and including 31.8 GHz;
b.4.c. Rated for operation with a peak saturated power output
greater than 0.5 W (27 dBm) at any frequency exceeding 31.8 GHz up
to and including 37 GHz;
b.4.d. Rated for operation with a peak saturated power output
greater than 2 W (33 dBm) at any frequency exceeding 37 GHz up to
and including 43.5 GHz, and with a ``fractional bandwidth'' of
greater than 10%;
b.4.e. Rated for operation at frequencies exceeding 43.5 GHz and
having any of the following:
b.4.e.1. A peak saturated power output greater than 0.2 W (23
dBm) at any frequency exceeding 43.5 GHz up to and including 75 GHz,
and with a ``fractional bandwidth'' of greater than 10%;
b.4.e.2. A peak saturated power output greater than 20 mW (13
dBm) at any frequency exceeding 75 GHz up to and including 90 GHz,
and with a ``fractional bandwidth'' of greater than 5%; or
b.4.e.3. A peak saturated power output greater than 0.1 nW (-70
dBm) at any frequency exceeding 90 GHz; or
b.4.f. [Reserved]
N.B.:
1. For ``MMIC'' amplifiers see 3A001.b.2.
2. For `transmit/receive modules' and `transmit modules' see
3A001.b.12.
3. For converters and harmonic mixers, designed to extend the
operating or frequency range of signal analyzers, signal generators,
network analyzers or microwave test receivers, see 3A001.b.7.
Note 1: [Reserved]
Note 2: The control status of an item whose rated operating
frequency includes frequencies listed in more than one frequency
range, as defined by 3A001.b.4.a through 3A001.b.4.e, is determined
by the lowest peak saturated power output control threshold.
b.5. Electronically or magnetically tunable band-pass or band-
stop filters, having more than 5 tunable resonators capable of
tuning across a 1.5:1 frequency band (fmax/
fmin) in less than 10 [mu]s and having any of the
following:
b.5.a. A band-pass bandwidth of more than 0.5% of center
frequency; or
b.5.b. A band-stop bandwidth of less than 0.5% of center
frequency;
b.6. [Reserved]
b.7. Converters and harmonic mixers, that are any of the
following:
b.7.a. Designed to extend the frequency range of ``signal
analyzers'' beyond 90 GHz;
b.7.b. Designed to extend the operating range of signal
generators as follows:
b.7.b.1. Beyond 90 GHz;
b.7.b.2. To an output power greater than 100 mW (20 dBm)
anywhere within the frequency range exceeding 43.5 GHz but not
exceeding 90 GHz;
b.7.c. Designed to extend the operating range of network
analyzers as follows:
b.7.c.1. Beyond 110 GHz;
b.7.c.2. To an output power greater than 31.62 mW (15 dBm)
anywhere within the frequency range exceeding 43.5 GHz but not
exceeding 90 GHz;
b.7.c.3. To an output power greater than 1 mW (0 dBm) anywhere
within the frequency range exceeding 90 GHz but not exceeding 110
GHz; or
b.7.d. Designed to extend the frequency range of microwave test
receivers beyond 110 GHz;
b.8. Microwave power amplifiers containing ``vacuum electronic
devices'' controlled by 3A001.b.1 and having all of the following:
b.8.a. Operating frequencies above 3 GHz;
b.8.b. An average output power to mass ratio exceeding 80 W/kg;
and
b.8.c. A volume of less than 400 cm\3\;
Note: 3A001.b.8 does not control equipment designed or rated for
operation in any frequency band which is ``allocated by the ITU''
for radio-communications services, but not for radio-determination.
b.9. Microwave Power Modules (MPM) consisting of, at least, a
traveling-wave ``vacuum electronic device,'' a ``Monolithic
Microwave Integrated Circuit'' (``MMIC'') and an integrated
electronic power conditioner and having all of the following:
b.9.a. A `turn-on time' from off to fully operational in less
than 10 seconds;
b.9.b. A volume less than the maximum rated power in Watts
multiplied by 10 cm\3\/W; and
b.9.c. An ``instantaneous bandwidth'' greater than 1 octave
(fmax > 2fmin) and having any of the
following:
b.9.c.1. For frequencies equal to or less than 18 GHz, an RF
output power greater than 100 W; or
b.9.c.2. A frequency greater than 18 GHz;
Technical Notes: For the purposes of 3A001.b.9:
1. To calculate the volume in 3A001.b.9.b, the following example
is provided: for a maximum rated power of 20 W, the volume would be:
20 W X 10 cm3/W = 200 cm3.
2. The `turn-on time' in 3A001.b.9.a refers to the time from
fully-off to fully operational, i.e., it includes the warm-up time
of the MPM.
b.10. Oscillators or oscillator assemblies, specified to operate
with a single sideband (SSB) phase noise, in dBc/Hz, less (better)
than -(126 + 20log10F-20log10f) anywhere
within the range of 10 Hz <= F <= 10 kHz;
Technical Note: For the purposes of 3A001.b.10, F is the offset
from the operating frequency in Hz and f is the operating frequency
in MHz.
b.11. `Frequency synthesizer' ``electronic assemblies'' having a
``frequency switching time'' as specified by any of the following:
b.11.a. Less than 143 ps;
b.11.b. Less than 100 [mu]s for any frequency change exceeding
2.2 GHz within the synthesized frequency range exceeding 4.8 GHz but
not exceeding 31.8 GHz;
b.11.c. [Reserved]
b.11.d. Less than 500 [micro]s for any frequency change
exceeding 550 MHz within the synthesized frequency range exceeding
31.8 GHz but not exceeding 37 GHz;
b.11.e. Less than 100 [micro]s for any frequency change
exceeding 2.2 GHz within the synthesized frequency range exceeding
37 GHz but not exceeding 75 GHz;
b.11.f. Less than 100 [micro]s for any frequency change
exceeding 5.0 GHz within the synthesized frequency range exceeding
75 GHz but not exceeding 90 GHz; or
b.11.g. Less than 1 ms within the synthesized frequency range
exceeding 90 GHz;
Technical Note: For the purposes of 3A001.b.11, a `frequency
synthesizer' is any kind of frequency source, regardless of the
actual technique used, providing a
[[Page 71953]]
multiplicity of simultaneous or alternative output frequencies, from
one or more outputs, controlled by, derived from or disciplined by a
lesser number of standard (or master) frequencies.
N.B.: For general purpose ``signal analyzers'', signal
generators, network analyzers and microwave test receivers, see
3A002.c, 3A002.d, 3A002.e and 3A002.f, respectively.
b.12. `Transmit/receive modules,' `transmit/receive MMICs,'
`transmit modules,' and `transmit MMICs,' rated for operation at
frequencies above 2.7 GHz and having all of the following:
b.12.a. A peak saturated power output (in watts),
Psat, greater than 505.62 divided by the maximum
operating frequency (in GHz) squared [Psat>505.62
W*GHz\2\/fGHz\2\] for any channel;
b.12.b. A ``fractional bandwidth'' of 5% or greater for any
channel;
b.12.c. Any planar side with length d (in cm) equal to or less
than 15 divided by the lowest operating frequency in GHz [d <=
15cm*GHz*N/fGHz] where N is the number of transmit or
transmit/receive channels; and
b.12.d. An electronically variable phase shifter per channel.
Technical Notes: For the purposes of 3A001.b.12:
1. A `transmit/receive module' is a multifunction ``electronic
assembly'' that provides bi-directional amplitude and phase control
for transmission and reception of signals.
2. A `transmit module' is an ``electronic assembly'' that
provides amplitude and phase control for transmission of signals.
3. A `transmit/receive MMIC' is a multifunction ``MMIC'' that
provides bi-directional amplitude and phase control for transmission
and reception of signals.
4. A `transmit MMIC' is a ``MMIC'' that provides amplitude and
phase control for transmission of signals.
5. 2.7 GHz should be used as the lowest operating frequency
(fGHz) in the formula in 3A001.b.12.c for transmit/receive or
transmit modules that have a rated operation range extending
downward to 2.7 GHz and below [d<=15cm*GHz*N/2.7 GHz].
6. 3A001.b.12 applies to `transmit/receive modules' or `transmit
modules' with or without a heat sink. The value of d in 3A001.b.12.c
does not include any portion of the `transmit/receive module' or
`transmit module' that functions as a heat sink.
7. `Transmit/receive modules' or `transmit modules,' `transmit/
receive MMICs' or `transmit MMICs' may or may not have N integrated
radiating antenna elements where N is the number of transmit or
transmit/receive channels.
c. Acoustic wave devices as follows and ``specially designed''
``components'' therefor:
c.1. Surface acoustic wave and surface skimming (shallow bulk)
acoustic wave devices, having any of the following:
c.1.a. A carrier frequency exceeding 6 GHz;
c.1.b. A carrier frequency exceeding 1 GHz, but not exceeding 6
GHz and having any of the following:
c.1.b.1. A `frequency side-lobe rejection' exceeding 65 dB;
c.1.b.2. A product of the maximum delay time and the bandwidth
(time in [mu]s and bandwidth in MHz) of more than 100;
c.1.b.3. A bandwidth greater than 250 MHz; or
c.1.b.4. A dispersive delay of more than 10 [micro]s; or
c.1.c. A carrier frequency of 1 GHz or less and having any of
the following:
c.1.c.1. A product of the maximum delay time and the bandwidth
(time in [micro]s and bandwidth in MHz) of more than 100;
c.1.c.2. A dispersive delay of more than 10 [micro]s; or
c.1.c.3. A `frequency side-lobe rejection' exceeding 65 dB and a
bandwidth greater than 100 MHz;
Technical Note: For the purposes of 3A001.c.1, `frequency side-
lobe rejection' is the maximum rejection value specified in data
sheet.
c.2. Bulk (volume) acoustic wave devices that permit the direct
processing of signals at frequencies exceeding 6 GHz;
c.3. Acoustic-optic ``signal processing'' devices employing
interaction between acoustic waves (bulk wave or surface wave) and
light waves that permit the direct processing of signals or images,
including spectral analysis, correlation or convolution;
Note: 3A001.c does not control acoustic wave devices that are
limited to a single band pass, low pass, high pass or notch
filtering, or resonating function.
d. Electronic devices and circuits containing ``components,''
manufactured from ``superconductive'' materials, ``specially
designed'' for operation at temperatures below the ``critical
temperature'' of at least one of the ``superconductive''
constituents and having any of the following:
d.1. Current switching for digital circuits using
``superconductive'' gates with a product of delay time per gate (in
seconds) and power dissipation per gate (in watts) of less than
10-14 J; or
d.2. Frequency selection at all frequencies using resonant
circuits with Q-values exceeding 10,000;
e. High energy devices as follows:
e.1. `Cells' as follows:
e.1.a `Primary cells' having any of the following at 20[deg]C:
e.1.a.1. `Energy density' exceeding 550 Wh/kg and a `continuous
power density' exceeding 50 W/kg; or
e.1.a.2. `Energy density' exceeding 50 Wh/kg and a `continuous
power density' exceeding 350 W/kg;
e.1.b. `Secondary cells' having an `energy density' exceeding
350 Wh/kg at 20[deg]C;
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 3A001.e.1, `energy density' (Wh/kg) is
calculated from the nominal voltage multiplied by the nominal
capacity in ampere-hours (Ah) divided by the mass in kilograms. If
the nominal capacity is not stated, energy density is calculated
from the nominal voltage squared then multiplied by the discharge
duration in hours divided by the discharge load in Ohms and the mass
in kilograms.
2. For the purposes of 3A001.e.1, a `cell' is defined as an
electrochemical device, which has positive and negative electrodes,
an electrolyte, and is a source of electrical energy. It is the
basic building block of a battery.
3. For the purposes of 3A001.e.1.a, a `primary cell' is a `cell'
that is not designed to be charged by any other source.
4. For the purposes of 3A001.e.1.b, a `secondary cell' is a
`cell' that is designed to be charged by an external electrical
source.
5. For the purposes of 3A001.e.1.a, `continuous power density'
(W/kg) is calculated from the nominal voltage multiplied by the
specified maximum continuous discharge current in amperes (A)
divided by the mass in kilograms. `Continuous power density' is also
referred to as specific power.
Note: 3A001.e does not control batteries, including single-cell
batteries.
e.2. High energy storage capacitors as follows:
e.2.a. Capacitors with a repetition rate of less than 10 Hz
(single shot capacitors) and having all of the following:
e.2.a.1. A voltage rating equal to or more than 5 kV;
e.2.a.2. An energy density equal to or more than 250 J/kg; and
e.2.a.3. A total energy equal to or more than 25 kJ;
e.2.b. Capacitors with a repetition rate of 10 Hz or more
(repetition rated capacitors) and having all of the following:
e.2.b.1. A voltage rating equal to or more than 5 kV;
e.2.b.2. An energy density equal to or more than 50 J/kg;
e.2.b.3. A total energy equal to or more than 100 J; and
e.2.b.4. A charge/discharge cycle life equal to or more than
10,000;
e.3. ``Superconductive'' electromagnets and solenoids,
``specially designed'' to be fully charged or discharged in less
than one second and having all of the following:
Note: 3A001.e.3 does not control ``superconductive''
electromagnets or solenoids ``specially designed'' for Magnetic
Resonance Imaging (MRI) medical equipment.
e.3.a. Energy delivered during the discharge exceeding 10 kJ in
the first second;
e.3.b. Inner diameter of the current carrying windings of more
than 250 mm; and
e.3.c. Rated for a magnetic induction of more than 8 T or
``overall current density'' in the winding of more than 300 A/mm\2\;
e.4. Solar cells, cell-interconnect-coverglass (CIC) assemblies,
solar panels, and solar arrays, which are ``space-qualified,''
having a minimum average efficiency exceeding 20% at an operating
temperature of 301 K (28 [deg]C) under simulated `AM0' illumination
with an irradiance of 1,367 Watts per square meter (W/m\2\);
Technical Note: For the purposes of 3A001.e.4, `AM0', or `Air
Mass Zero', refers to the spectral irradiance of sun light in the
earth's outer atmosphere when the distance between the earth and sun
is one astronomical unit (AU).
f. Rotary input type absolute position encoders having an
``accuracy'' equal to or less (better) than 1.0 second of arc and
``specially designed'' encoder rings, discs or scales therefor;
g. Solid-state pulsed power switching thyristor devices and
`thyristor modules',
[[Page 71954]]
using either electrically, optically, or electron radiation
controlled switch methods and having any of the following:
g.1. A maximum turn-on current rate of rise (di/dt) greater than
30,000 A/[mu]s and off-state voltage greater than 1,100 V; or
g.2. A maximum turn-on current rate of rise (di/dt) greater than
2,000 A/[mu]s and having all of the following:
g.2.a. An off-state peak voltage equal to or greater than 3,000
V; and
g.2.b. A peak (surge) current equal to or greater than 3,000 A;
Note 1: 3A001.g. includes:
--Silicon Controlled Rectifiers (SCRs)
--Electrical Triggering Thyristors (ETTs)
--Light Triggering Thyristors (LTTs)
--Integrated Gate Commutated Thyristors (IGCTs)
--Gate Turn-off Thyristors (GTOs)
--MOS Controlled Thyristors (MCTs)
--Solidtrons
Note 2: 3A001.g does not control thyristor devices and
`thyristor modules' incorporated into equipment designed for civil
railway or ``civil aircraft'' applications.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 3A001.g, a `thyristor
module' contains one or more thyristor devices.
h. Solid-state power semiconductor switches, diodes, or
`modules', having all of the following:
h.1. Rated for a maximum operating junction temperature greater
than 488 K (215[deg]C);
h.2. Repetitive peak off-state voltage (blocking voltage)
exceeding 300 V; and
h.3. Continuous current greater than 1 A.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 3A001.h, `modules' contain
one or more solid-state power semiconductor switches or diodes.
Note 1: Repetitive peak off-state voltage in 3A001.h includes
drain to source voltage, collector to emitter voltage, repetitive
peak reverse voltage and peak repetitive off-state blocking voltage.
Note 2: 3A001.h includes:
--Junction Field Effect Transistors (JFETs)
--Vertical Junction Field Effect Transistors (VJFETs)
--Metal Oxide Semiconductor Field Effect Transistors (MOSFETs)
--Double Diffused Metal Oxide Semiconductor Field Effect Transistor
(DMOSFET)
--Insulated Gate Bipolar Transistor (IGBT)
--High Electron Mobility Transistors (HEMTs)
--Bipolar Junction Transistors (BJTs)
--Thyristors and Silicon Controlled Rectifiers (SCRs)
--Gate Turn-Off Thyristors (GTOs)
--Emitter Turn-Off Thyristors (ETOs)
--PiN Diodes
--Schottky Diodes
Note 3: 3A001.h does not apply to switches, diodes, or
`modules', incorporated into equipment designed for civil
automobile, civil railway, or ``civil aircraft'' applications.
i. Intensity, amplitude, or phase electro-optic modulators,
designed for analog signals and having any of the following:
i.1. A maximum operating frequency of more than 10 GHz but less
than 20 GHz, an optical insertion loss equal to or less than 3 dB
and having any of the following:
i.1.a. A `half-wave voltage' (`V[pi]') less than 2.7 V when
measured at a frequency of 1 GHz or below; or
i.1.b. A `V[pi]' of less than 4 V when measured at a frequency
of more than 1 GHz; or
i.2. A maximum operating frequency equal to or greater than 20
GHz, an optical insertion loss equal to or less than 3 dB and having
any of the following:
i.2.a. A `V[pi]' less than 3.3 V when measured at a frequency of
1 GHz or below; or
i.2.b. A `V[pi]' less than 5 V when measured at a frequency of
more than 1 GHz.
Note: 3A001.i includes electro-optic modulators having optical
input and output connectors (e.g., fiber-optic pigtails).
Technical Note: For the purposes of 3A001.i, a `half-wave
voltage' (`V[pi]') is the applied voltage necessary to make a phase
change of 180 degrees in the wavelength of light propagating through
the optical modulator.
* * * * *
3A002 General purpose ``electronic assemblies,'' modules and
equipment, as follows (see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
MT applies to 3A002.h when the parameters MT Column 1
in 3A101.a.2.b are met or exceeded.
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements: See Sec. 743.1 of the EAR for reporting
requirements for exports under License Exceptions, and Validated
End-User authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: $3000: 3A002.a, .e, .f, and .g
$5000: 3A002.c to .d, and .h (unless controlled for MT);
GBS: Yes, for 3A002.h (unless controlled for MT)
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be used to ship any item in
3A002.g.1 to any of the destinations listed in Country Group A:6
(See Supplement No. 1 to part 740 of the EAR).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: See Category XV(e)(9) of the USML for certain
``space-qualified'' atomic frequency standards ``subject to the
ITAR'' (see 22 CFR parts 120 through 130). See also 3A101, 3A992 and
9A515.x.
Related Definitions: Constant percentage bandwidth filters are also
known as octave or fractional octave filters.
Items:
a. Recording equipment and oscilloscopes, as follows:
a.1. to a.5. [Reserved]
N.B.: For waveform digitizers and transient recorders, see
3A002.h.
a.6. Digital data recorders having all of the following:
a.6.a. A sustained `continuous throughput' of more than 6.4
Gbit/s to disk or solid-state drive memory; and
a.6.b. ``Signal processing'' of the radio frequency signal data
while it is being recorded;
Technical Notes: For the purposes of 3A002.a.6:
1. For recorders with a parallel bus architecture, the
`continuous throughput' rate is the highest word rate multiplied by
the number of bits in a word.
2. `Continuous throughput' is the fastest data rate the
instrument can record to disk or solid-state drive memory without
the loss of any information while sustaining the input digital data
rate or digitizer conversion rate.
a.7. Real-time oscilloscopes having a vertical root-mean-square
(rms) noise voltage of less than 2% of full-scale at the vertical
scale setting that provides the lowest noise value for any input 3dB
bandwidth of 60 GHz or greater per channel;
Note: 3A002.a.7 does not apply to equivalent-time sampling
oscilloscopes.
b. [Reserved]
c. ``Signal analyzers'' as follows:
c.1. ``Signal analyzers'' having a 3 dB resolution bandwidth
(RBW) exceeding 40 MHz anywhere within the frequency range exceeding
31.8 GHz but not exceeding 37 GHz;
c.2. ``Signal analyzers'' having a Displayed Average Noise Level
(DANL) less (better) than -150 dBm/Hz anywhere within the frequency
range exceeding 43.5 GHz but not exceeding 90 GHz;
c.3. ``Signal analyzers'' having a frequency exceeding 90 GHz;
c.4. ``Signal analyzers'' having all of the following:
c.4.a. `Real-time bandwidth' exceeding 170 MHz; and
c.4.b. Having any of the following:
c.4.b.1. 100% probability of discovery, with less than a 3 dB
reduction from full amplitude due to gaps or windowing effects, of
signals having a duration of 15 [mu]s or less; or
c.4.b.2. A `frequency mask trigger' function, with 100%
probability of trigger (capture) for signals having a duration of 15
[mu]s or less;
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 3A002.c.4.a, `real-time bandwidth' is the
widest frequency range for which the analyzer can continuously
transform time-domain data entirely into frequency-domain results,
using a Fourier or other discrete time transform that processes
every incoming time point, without a reduction of measured amplitude
of more than 3 dB below the actual signal amplitude caused by gaps
or windowing effects, while outputting or displaying the transformed
data.
2. For the purposes of 3A002.c.4.b.1., probability of discovery
is also referred to as probability of intercept or probability of
capture.
[[Page 71955]]
3. For the purposes of 3A002.c.4.b.1, the duration for 100%
probability of discovery is equivalent to the minimum signal
duration necessary for the specified level measurement uncertainty.
4. For the purposes of 3A002.c.4.b.2, a `frequency mask trigger'
is a mechanism where the trigger function is able to select a
frequency range to be triggered on as a subset of the acquisition
bandwidth while ignoring other signals that may also be present
within the same acquisition bandwidth. A `frequency mask trigger'
may contain more than one independent set of limits.
Note: 3A002.c.4 does not apply to those ``signal analyzers''
using only constant percentage bandwidth filters (also known as
octave or fractional octave filters).
c.5. [Reserved]
d. Signal generators having any of the following:
d.1. Specified to generate pulse-modulated signals having all of
the following, anywhere within the frequency range exceeding 31.8
GHz but not exceeding 37 GHz:
d.1.a. `Pulse duration' of less than 25 ns; and
d.1.b. On/off ratio equal to or exceeding 65 dB;
d.2. An output power exceeding 100 mW (20 dBm) anywhere within
the frequency range exceeding 43.5 GHz but not exceeding 90 GHz;
d.3. A ``frequency switching time'' as specified by any of the
following:
d.3.a. [Reserved]
d.3.b. Less than 100 [mu]s for any frequency change exceeding
2.2 GHz within the frequency range exceeding 4.8 GHz but not
exceeding 31.8 GHz;
d.3.c. [Reserved]
d.3.d. Less than 500 [mu]s for any frequency change exceeding
550 MHz within the frequency range exceeding 31.8 GHz but not
exceeding 37 GHz;
d.3.e. Less than 100 [mu]s for any frequency change exceeding
2.2 GHz within the frequency range exceeding 37 GHz but not
exceeding 75 GHz; or
d.3.f. [Reserved]
d.3.g. Less than 100 [mu]s for any frequency change exceeding
5.0 GHz within the frequency range exceeding 75 GHz but not
exceeding 90 GHz.
d.4. A single sideband (SSB) phase noise, in dBc/Hz, specified
as being any of the following:
d.4.a. Less (better) than -(126 + 20 log10 F-
20log10f) for anywhere within the range of 10 Hz <= F <=
10 kHz anywhere within the frequency range exceeding 3.2 GHz but not
exceeding 90 GHz; or
d.4.b. Less (better) than -(206-20log10f) for
anywhere within the range of 10 kHz < F <= 100 kHz anywhere within
the frequency range exceeding 3.2 GHz but not exceeding 90 GHz;
Technical Note: For the purposes of 3A002.d.4, F is the offset
from the operating frequency in Hz and f is the operating frequency
in MHz.
d.5. An `RF modulation bandwidth' of digital baseband signals as
specified by any of the following:
d.5.a. Exceeding 2.2 GHz within the frequency range exceeding
4.8 GHz but not exceeding 31.8 GHz;
d.5.b. Exceeding 550 MHz within the frequency range exceeding
31.8 GHz but not exceeding 37 GHz;
d.5.c. Exceeding 2.2 GHz within the frequency range exceeding 37
GHz but not exceeding 75 GHz;
d.5.d. Exceeding 5.0 GHz within the frequency range exceeding 75
GHz but not exceeding 90 GHz; or
Technical Note: For the purposes of 3A002.d.5, `RF modulation
bandwidth' is the Radio Frequency (RF) bandwidth occupied by a
digitally encoded baseband signal modulated onto an RF signal. It is
also referred to as information bandwidth or vector modulation
bandwidth. I/Q digital modulation is the technical method for
producing a vector-modulated RF output signal, and that output
signal is typically specified as having an `RF modulation
bandwidth'.
d.6. A maximum frequency exceeding 90 GHz;
Note 1: For the purposes of 3A002.d, signal generators include
arbitrary waveform and function generators.
Note 2: 3A002.d does not control equipment in which the output
frequency is either produced by the addition or subtraction of two
or more crystal oscillator frequencies, or by an addition or
subtraction followed by a multiplication of the result.
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 3A002.d, the maximum frequency of an
arbitrary waveform or function generator is calculated by dividing
the sample rate, in samples/second, by a factor of 2.5.
2. For the purposes of 3A002.d.1.a, `pulse duration' is defined
as the time interval from the point on the leading edge that is 50%
of the pulse amplitude to the point on the trailing edge that is 50%
of the pulse amplitude.
e. Network analyzers having any of the following:
e.1. An output power exceeding 31.62 mW (15 dBm) anywhere within
the operating frequency range exceeding 43.5 GHz but not exceeding
90 GHz;
e.2. An output power exceeding 1 mW (0 dBm) anywhere within the
operating frequency range exceeding 90 GHz but not exceeding 110
GHz;
e.3. `Nonlinear vector measurement functionality' at frequencies
exceeding 50 GHz but not exceeding 110 GHz; or
Technical Note: For the purposes of 3A002.e.3, `nonlinear vector
measurement functionality' is an instrument's ability to analyze the
test results of devices driven into the large-signal domain or the
non-linear distortion range.
e.4. A maximum operating frequency exceeding 110 GHz;
f. Microwave test receivers having all of the following:
f.1. Maximum operating frequency exceeding 110 GHz; and
f.2. Being capable of measuring amplitude and phase
simultaneously;
g. Atomic frequency standards being any of the following:
g.1. ``Space-qualified'';
g.2. Non-rubidium and having a long-term stability less (better)
than 1 x 10-11/month; or
g.3. Non-``space-qualified'' and having all of the following:
g.3.a. Being a rubidium standard;
g.3.b. Long-term stability less (better) than 1 x
10-11/month; and
g.3.c. Total power consumption of less than 1 Watt.
h. ``Electronic assemblies,'' modules or equipment, specified to
perform all of the following:
h.1. Analog-to-digital conversions meeting any of the following:
h.1.a. A resolution of 8 bit or more, but less than 10 bit, with
a ``sample rate'' greater than 1.3 Giga Samples Per Second (GSPS);
h.1.b. A resolution of 10 bit or more, but less than 12 bit,
with a ``sample rate'' greater than 1.0 GSPS;
h.1.c. A resolution of 12 bit or more, but less than 14 bit,
with a ``sample rate'' greater than 1.0 GSPS;
h.1.d. A resolution of 14 bit or more but less than 16 bit, with
a ``sample rate'' greater than 400 Mega Samples Per Second (MSPS);
or
h.1.e. A resolution of 16 bit or more with a ``sample rate''
greater than 180 MSPS; and
h.2. Any of the following:
h.2.a. Output of digitized data;
h.2.b. Storage of digitized data; or
h.2.c. Processing of digitized data;
N.B.: Digital data recorders, oscilloscopes, ``signal
analyzers,'' signal generators, network analyzers and microwave test
receivers, are specified by 3A002.a.6, 3A002.a.7, 3A002.c, 3A002.d,
3A002.e and 3A002.f, respectively.
Technical Notes: For the purposes of 3A002.h:
1. A resolution of n bit corresponds to a quantization of 2\n\
levels.
2. The resolution of the ADC is the number of bits of the
digital output of the ADC that represents the measured analog input
word. Effective Number of Bits (ENOB) is not used to determine the
resolution of the ADC.
3. For non-interleaved multiple-channel ``electronic
assemblies'', modules, or equipment, the ``sample rate'' is not
aggregated and the ``sample rate'' is the maximum rate of any single
channel.
4. For interleaved channels on multiple-channel ``electronic
assemblies'', modules, or equipment, the ``sample rates'' are
aggregated and the ``sample rate'' is the maximum combined total
rate of all the interleaved channels.
Note: 3A002.h includes ADC cards, waveform digitizers, data
acquisition cards, signal acquisition boards and transient
recorders.
* * * * *
3B001 Equipment for the manufacturing of semiconductor devices or
materials, as follows (see List of Items Controlled) and ``specially
designed'' ``components'' and ``accessories'' therefor.
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
[[Page 71956]]
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: $500
GBS: Yes, except a.3 (molecular beam epitaxial growth equipment
using gas sources), .e (automatic loading multi-chamber central
wafer handling systems only if connected to equipment controlled by
3B001. a.3, or .f), and .f (lithography equipment).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: See also 3B991.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Equipment designed for epitaxial growth as follows:
a.1. Equipment designed or modified to produce a layer of any
material other than silicon with a thickness uniform to less than
2.5% across a distance of 75 mm or more;
Note: 3B001.a.1 includes atomic layer epitaxy (ALE) equipment.
a.2. Metal Organic Chemical Vapor Deposition (MOCVD) reactors
designed for compound semiconductor epitaxial growth of material
having two or more of the following elements: aluminum, gallium,
indium, arsenic, phosphorus, antimony, or nitrogen;
a.3. Molecular beam epitaxial growth equipment using gas or
solid sources;
b. Equipment designed for ion implantation and having any of the
following:
b.1. [Reserved]
b.2. Being designed and optimized to operate at a beam energy of
20 keV or more and a beam current of 10 mA or more for hydrogen,
deuterium, or helium implant;
b.3. Direct write capability;
b.4. A beam energy of 65 keV or more and a beam current of 45 mA
or more for high energy oxygen implant into a heated semiconductor
material ``substrate''; or
b.5. Being designed and optimized to operate at beam energy of
20 keV or more and a beam current of 10mA or more for silicon
implant into a semiconductor material ``substrate'' heated to 600
[deg]C or greater;
c. [Reserved]
d. [Reserved]
e. Automatic loading multi-chamber central wafer handling
systems having all of the following:
e.1. Interfaces for wafer input and output, to which more than
two functionally different `semiconductor process tools' controlled
by 3B001.a.1, 3B001.a.2, 3B001.a.3 or 3B001.b are designed to be
connected; and
e.2. Designed to form an integrated system in a vacuum
environment for `sequential multiple wafer processing';
Note: 3B001.e does not control automatic robotic wafer handling
systems ``specially designed'' for parallel wafer processing.
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 3B001.e.1, `semiconductor process tools'
refers to modular tools that provide physical processes for
semiconductor production that are functionally different, such as
deposition, implant or thermal processing.
2. For the purposes of 3B001.e.2, `sequential multiple wafer
processing' means the capability to process each wafer in different
`semiconductor process tools', such as by transferring each wafer
from one tool to a second tool and on to a third tool with the
automatic loading multi-chamber central wafer handling systems.
f. Lithography equipment as follows:
f.1. Align and expose step and repeat (direct step on wafer) or
step and scan (scanner) equipment for wafer processing using photo-
optical or X-ray methods and having any of the following:
f.1.a. A light source wavelength shorter than 193 nm; or
f.1.b. Capable of producing a pattern with a ``Minimum
Resolvable Feature size'' (MRF) of 45 nm or less;
Technical Note: For the purposes of 3B001.f.1.b, the `Minimum
Resolvable Feature size' (MRF) is calculated by the following
formula:
MRF = (an exposure light source wavelength in nm) x (K factor)/
numerical aperture
where the K factor = 0.35
f.2 Imprint lithography equipment capable of production features
of 45 nm or less;
Note: 3B001.f.2 includes:
--Micro contact printing tools
--Hot embossing tools
--Nano-imprint lithography tools
--Step and flash imprint lithography (S-FIL) tools
f.3. Equipment ``specially designed'' for mask making having all
of the following:
f.3.a. A deflected focused electron beam, ion beam or ``laser''
beam; and
f.3.b. Having any of the following:
f.3.b.1. A Full-Width Half-Maximum (FWHM) spot size smaller than
65 nm and an image placement less than 17 nm (mean + 3 sigma); or
f.3.b.2. [Reserved]
f.3.b.3. A second-layer overlay error of less than 23 nm (mean +
3 sigma) on the mask;
f.4. Equipment designed for device processing using direct
writing methods, having all of the following:
f.4.a. A deflected focused electron beam; and
f.4.b. Having any of the following:
f.4.b.1. A minimum beam size equal to or smaller than 15 nm; or
f.4.b.2. An overlay error less than 27 nm (mean + 3 sigma);
g. Masks and reticles, designed for integrated circuits
controlled by 3A001;
h. Multi-layer masks with a phase shift layer not specified by
3B001.g and designed to be used by lithography equipment having a
light source wavelength less than 245 nm;
Note: 3B001.h. does not control multi-layer masks with a phase
shift layer designed for the fabrication of memory devices not
controlled by 3A001.
N.B.: For masks and reticles, ``specially designed'' for optical
sensors, see 6B002.
i. Imprint lithography templates designed for integrated
circuits by 3A001;
j. Mask ``substrate blanks'' with multilayer reflector structure
consisting of molybdenum and silicon, and having all of the
following:
j.1. ``Specially designed'' for `Extreme Ultraviolet (EUV)'
lithography; and
j.2. Compliant with SEMI Standard P37.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 3B001.j, `Extreme
Ultraviolet (EUV)' refers to electromagnetic spectrum wavelengths
greater than 5 nm and less than 124 nm.
* * * * *
3D003 `Computational lithography' ``software'' ``specially
designed''for the ``development'' of patterns on EUV-lithography
masks or reticles.
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Country chart (see supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 1
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
TSR: Yes
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: N/A
Related Definitions: For the purposes of 3D003, `computational
lithography' is the use of computer modelling to predict, correct,
optimize and verify imaging performance of the lithography process
over a range of patterns, processes, and system conditions.
Items:
The list of items controlled is contained in the ECCN heading.
* * * * *
3D006 `Electronic Computer-Aided Design' (`ECAD') ``software''
``specially designed'' for the ``development'' of integrated
circuits having any ``Gate-All-Around Field-Effect Transistor''
(``GAAFET'') structure, and having any of the following (see List of
Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Country chart (see supp. no.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for Description of All
License Exceptions)
TSR: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: N/A
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. ``Specially designed'' for implementing `Register Transfer
Level' (`RTL') to `Geometrical Database Standard II' (`GDSII') or
equivalent standard; or
b. ``Specially designed'' for optimization of power or timing
rules.
[[Page 71957]]
Technical Notes: For the purposes of 3D006:
1. `Electronic Computer-Aided Design' (`ECAD') is a category of
``software'' tools used for designing, analyzing, optimizing, and
validating the performance of an integrated circuit or printed
circuit board.
2. `Register Transfer Level' (`RTL') is a design abstraction
which models a synchronous digital circuit in terms of the flow of
digital signals between hardware registers and the logical
operations performed on those signals.
3. `Geometrical Database Standard II' (`GDSII') is a database
file format for data exchange of integrated circuit or integrated
circuit layout artwork.
* * * * *
3E001 ``Technology'' according to the General Technology Note for
the ``development'' or ``production'' of commodities controlled by
3A (except 3A980, 3A981, 3A991, 3A992, or 3A999), 3B (except 3B991
or 3B992) or 3C (except 3C992).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, NP, RS, AT
Country chart (see supp. no.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to ``technology'' for NS Column 1
commodities controlled by 3A001, 3A002,
3A003, 3B001, 3B002, or 3C001 to 3C006.
MT applies to ``technology'' for MT Column 1
commodities controlled by 3A001 or 3A101
for MT reasons.
NP applies to ``technology'' for NP Column 1
commodities controlled by 3A001, 3A201,
or 3A225 to 3A234 for NP reasons.
RS applies to ``technology'' for China and Macau (See Sec.
commodities controlled by 3A090 or 3B090. 742.6(a)(6))
RS applies to ``technology'' for Worldwide (See Sec.
commodities controlled in 3A090, when 742.6(a)(6))
exported from China or Macau.
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
License Requirements Note: See Sec. 744.17 of the EAR for
additional license requirements for microprocessors having a
processing speed of 5 GFLOPS or more and an arithmetic logic unit
with an access width of 32 bit or more, including those
incorporating ``information security'' functionality, and associated
``software'' and ``technology'' for the ``production'' or
``development'' of such microprocessors.
Reporting Requirements
See Sec. 743.1 of the EAR for reporting requirements for
exports under License Exceptions, Special Comprehensive Licenses,
and Validated End-User authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
TSR: Yes, except N/A for MT, and ``technology'' for the
``development'' or ``production'' of: (a) vacuum electronic device
amplifiers described in 3A001.b.8, having operating frequencies
exceeding 19 GHz; (b) solar cells, coverglass-interconnect-cells or
covered-interconnect-cells (CIC) ``assemblies'', solar arrays and/or
solar panels described in 3A001.e.4; (c) ``Monolithic Microwave
Integrated Circuit'' (``MMIC'') amplifiers in 3A001.b.2; and (d)
discrete microwave transistors in 3A001.b.3.
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be used to ship or transmit
``technology'' according to the General Technology Note for the
``development'' or ``production'' of equipment specified by ECCNs
3A002.g.1 or 3B001.a.2 to any of the destinations listed in Country
Group A:6 (See Supplement No.1 to part 740 of the EAR). License
Exception STA may not be used to ship or transmit ``technology''
according to the General Technology Note for the ``development'' or
``production'' of components specified by ECCN 3A001.b.2 or b.3 to
any of the destinations listed in Country Group A:5 or A:6 (See
Supplement No.1 to part 740 of the EAR).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) ``Technology'' according to the General
Technology Note for the ``development'' or ``production'' of certain
``space-qualified'' atomic frequency standards described in Category
XV(e)(9), MMICs described in Category XV(e)(14), and oscillators
described in Category XV(e)(15) of the USML are ``subject to the
ITAR'' (see 22 CFR parts 120 through 130). See also 3E101, 3E201 and
9E515. (2) ``Technology'' for ``development'' or ``production'' of
``Microwave Monolithic Integrated Circuits'' (``MMIC'') amplifiers
in 3A001.b.2 is controlled in this ECCN 3E001; 5E001.d refers only
to that additional ``technology'' ``required'' for
telecommunications.
Related Definition: N/A
Items:
The list of items controlled is contained in the ECCN heading.
Note 1: 3E001 does not control ``technology'' for equipment or
``components'' controlled by 3A003.
Note 2: 3E001 does not control ``technology'' for integrated
circuits controlled by 3A001.a.3 to a.14, having all of the
following:
(a) Using ``technology'' at or above 0.130 [mu]m; and
(b) Incorporating multi-layer structures with three or fewer
metal layers.
Note 3: 3E001 does not apply to `Process Design Kits' (`PDKs')
unless they include libraries implementing functions or technologies
for items specified by 3A001 or 3A090.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 3E001 Note 3, a `Process
Design Kit' (`PDK') is a software tool provided by a semiconductor
manufacturer to ensure that the required design practices and rules
are taken into account in order to successfully produce a specific
integrated circuit design in a specific semiconductor process, in
accordance with technological and manufacturing constraints (each
semiconductor manufacturing process has its particular `PDK').
3E002 ``Technology'' according to the General Technology Note other
than that controlled in 3E001 for the ``development'' or
``production'' of a ``microprocessor microcircuit'', ``micro-
computer microcircuit'' and microcontroller microcircuit core,
having an arithmetic logic unit with an access width of 32 bits or
more and any of the following features or characteristics (see List
of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Country Chart (See Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 1
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
License Requirements Note: See Sec. 744.17 of the EAR for
additional license requirements for microprocessors having a
processing speed of 5 GFLOPS or more and an arithmetic logic unit
with an access width of 32 bit or more, including those
incorporating ``information security'' functionality, and associated
``software'' and ``technology'' for the ``production'' or
``development'' of such microprocessors.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
TSR: Yes
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: N/A
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. A `vector processor unit' designed to perform more than two
calculations on `floating-point' vectors (one-dimensional arrays of
32-bit or larger numbers) simultaneously;
Technical Note: For the purposes of 3E002.a, a `vector processor
unit' is a processor element with built-in instructions that perform
multiple calculations on `floating-point' vectors (one-dimensional
arrays of 32-bit or larger numbers) simultaneously, having at least
one vector arithmetic logic unit and vector registers of at least 32
elements each.
b. Designed to perform more than four 64-bit or larger
`floating-point' operation results per cycle; or
c. Designed to perform more than eight 16-bit `fixed-point'
multiply-accumulate results
[[Page 71958]]
per cycle (e.g., digital manipulation of analog information that has
been previously converted into digital form, also known as digital
``signal processing'').
Note 1: 3E002 does not control ``technology'' for multimedia
extensions.
Note 2: 3E002 does not control ``technology'' for microprocessor
cores, having all of the following:
a. Using ``technology'' at or above 0.130 [mu]m; and
b. Incorporating multi-layer structures with five or fewer metal
layers.
Note 3: 3E002 includes ``technology'' for the ``development'' or
``production'' of digital signal processors and digital array
processors.
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 3E002.a and 3E002.b, `floating-point' is
defined by IEEE-754.
2. For the purposes of 3E002.c, `fixed-point' refers to a fixed-
width real number with both an integer component and a fractional
component, and which does not include integer-only formats.
* * * * *
Category 4--Computers
* * * * *
Technical Note: For the purposes of Note 2, `main storage' is
the primary storage for data or instructions for rapid access by a
central processing unit. It consists of the internal storage of a
``digital computer'' and any hierarchical extension thereto, such as
cache storage or non-sequentially accessed extended storage.
* * * * *
4A004 Computers as follows (see List of Items Controlled) and
``specially designed'' related equipment, ``electronic assemblies''
and ``components''therefor.
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Country Chart (See Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: $5000
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: N/A
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. `Systolic array computers';
b. `Neural computers';
c. `Optical computers'.
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 4A004.a, `systolic array computers' are
computers where the flow and modification of the data is dynamically
controllable at the logic gate level by the user.
2. For the purposes of 4A004.b, `neural computers' are
computational devices designed or modified to mimic the behaviour of
a neuron or a collection of neurons, i.e., computational devices
which are distinguished by their hardware capability to modulate the
weights and numbers of the interconnections of a multiplicity of
computational components based on previous data.
3. For the purposes of 4A004.c, `optical computers' are
computers designed or modified to use light to represent data and
whose computational logic elements are based on directly coupled
optical devices.
* * * * *
4D001 ``Software'' as follows (see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, CC, AT
Country Chart (See Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 1
CC applies to ``software'' for CC Column 1
computerized finger-print equipment
controlled by 4A003 for CC reasons.
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements
See Sec. 743.1 of the EAR for reporting requirements for
exports under License Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
TSR: Yes, except for ``software'' for the ``development'' or
``production'' of the following:
(1) Commodities with an ``Adjusted Peak Performance'' (``APP'')
exceeding 70 WT; or
(2) Commodities controlled by 4A005 or ''software'' controlled by
4D004.
APP: Yes to specific countries (see Sec. 740.7 of the EAR for
eligibility criteria)
ACE: Yes for 4D001.a (for the ``development'', ``production'' or
``use'' of equipment or ``software'' specified in ECCN 4A005 or
4D004), except to Country Group E:1 or E:2. See Sec. 740.22 of the
EAR for eligibility criteria.
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be used to ship or transmit
``software'' ``specially designed'' or modified for the
``development'' or ``production'' of equipment specified by ECCN
4A001.a.2 or for the ``development'' or ``production'' of ``digital
computers'' having an `Adjusted Peak Performance' (`APP') exceeding
70 Weighted TeraFLOPS (WT) to any of the destinations listed in
Country Group A:6 (See Supplement No. 1 to part 740 of the EAR); and
may not be used to ship or transmit ''software'' specified in
4D001.a ''specially designed'' for the ''development'' or
''production'' of equipment specified by ECCN 4A005 to any of the
destinations listed in Country Group A:5 or A:6.
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: N/A
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. ``Software'' ``specially designed'' or modified for the
``development'' or ``production'', of equipment or ``software''
controlled by 4A001, 4A003, 4A004, 4A005 or 4D (except 4D090, 4D980,
4D993 or 4D994).
b. ``Software'', other than that controlled by 4D001.a,
``specially designed'' or modified for the ``development'' or
``production'' of equipment as follows:
b.1. ``Digital computers'' having an ``Adjusted Peak
Performance'' (``APP'') exceeding 24 Weighted TeraFLOPS (WT);
b.2. ``Electronic assemblies'' ``specially designed'' or
modified for enhancing performance by aggregation of processors so
that the ``APP'' of the aggregation exceeds the limit in 4D001.b.1.
* * * * *
4E001 ``Technology'' as follows (see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, RS, CC, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry, except 4A090 NS Column 1
or ``software'' specified by 4D090.
MT applies to ``technology'' for items MT Column 1
controlled by 4A001.a and 4A101 for MT
reasons.
RS applies to ``technology'' for China and Macau (See Sec.
commodities controlled by 4A090 or 742.6(a)(6))
``software'' specified by 4D090.
CC applies to ``software'' for CC Column 1
computerized finger-print equipment
controlled by 4A003 for CC reasons.
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements
See Sec. 743.1 of the EAR for reporting requirements for
exports under License Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
TSR: Yes, except for the following:
(1) ``Technology'' for the ``development'' or ``production'' of
commodities with an ``Adjusted Peak Performance'' (``APP'')
exceeding 70 WT or for the ''development'' or ''production'' of
commodities controlled
[[Page 71959]]
by 4A005 or ''software'' controlled by 4D004; or
(2) ``Technology'' for the ''development'' of ''intrusion
software''.
APP: Yes to specific countries (see Sec. 740.7 of the EAR for
eligibility criteria).
ACE: Yes for 4E001.a (for the ``development'', ``production'' or
``use'' of equipment or ``software'' specified in ECCN 4A005 or
4D004) and for 4E001.c, except to Country Group E:1 or E:2. See
Sec. 740.22 of the EAR for eligibility criteria.
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be used to ship or transmit
``technology'' according to the General Technology Note for the
``development'' or ``production'' of any of the following equipment
or ``software'': a. Equipment specified by ECCN 4A001.a.2; b.
``Digital computers'' having an `Adjusted Peak Performance' (`APP')
exceeding 70 Weighted TeraFLOPS (WT); or c. ``software'' specified
in the License Exception STA paragraph found in the License
Exception section of ECCN 4D001 to any of the destinations listed in
Country Group A:6 (See Supplement No. 1 to part 740 of the EAR); and
may not be used to ship or transmit ''technology'' specified in
4E001.a (for the ''development'', ''production'' or ''use'' of
equipment or ''software'' specified in ECCN 4A005 or 4D004) and
4E001.c to any of the destinations listed in Country Group A:5 or
A:6.
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: N/A
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. ``Technology'' according to the General Technology Note, for
the ``development'', ``production'', or ``use'' of equipment or
``software'' controlled by 4A (except 4A980 or 4A994) or 4D (except
4D980, 4D993, 4D994).
b. ``Technology'' according to the General Technology Note,
other than that controlled by 4E001.a, for the ``development'' or
``production'' of equipment as follows:
b.1. ``Digital computers'' having an ``Adjusted Peak
Performance'' (``APP'') exceeding 24 Weighted TeraFLOPS (WT);
b.2. ``Electronic assemblies'' ``specially designed'' or
modified for enhancing performance by aggregation of processors so
that the ``APP'' of the aggregation exceeds the limit in 4E001.b.1.
c. ``Technology'' for the ``development'' of ``intrusion
software.''
Note 1: 4E001.a and 4E001.c do not apply to ``vulnerability
disclosure'' or ``cyber incident response''.
Note 2: Note 1 does not diminish national authorities' rights to
ascertain compliance with 4E001.a and 4E001.c.
* * * * *
5A001 Telecommunications systems, equipment, ``components'' and
``accessories,'' as follows (see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, SL, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to 5A001.a, b.5, .e, .f.3 and NS Column 1
.h.
NS applies to 5A001.b (except .b.5), .c, NS Column 2
.d, .f (except f.3), .g, and .j.
SL applies to 5A001.f.1................... A license is required for
all destinations, as
specified in Sec. 742.13
of the EAR. Accordingly, a
column specific to this
control does not appear on
the Commerce Country Chart
(Supplement No. 1 to Part
738 of the EAR). Note to SL
paragraph: This licensing
requirement does not
supersede, nor does it
implement, construe or
limit the scope of any
criminal statute,
including, but not limited
to the Omnibus Safe Streets
Act of 1968, as amended
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements
See Sec. 743.1 of the EAR for reporting requirements for
exports under License Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A for 5A001.a, b.5, .e, f.3 and .h;
$5000 for 5A001.b.1, .b.2, .b.3, .b.6, .d, f.2, f.4, and .g;
$3000 for 5A001.c.
GBS: Yes, except 5A001.a, b.5, e, and h.
ACE: Yes for 5A001.j, except to Country Group E:1 or E:2. See Sec.
740.22 of the EAR for eligibility criteria
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be used to ship any commodity in
5A001.j to any of the destinations listed in Country Group A:5 or
A:6 (See Supplement No. 1 to part 740 of the EAR), or any commodity
in 5A001.b.3, .b.5 or .h to any of the destinations listed in
Country Group A:6 (See Supplement No. 1 to part 740 of the EAR).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See USML Category XI for controls on
direction-finding ``equipment'' including types of ``equipment'' in
ECCN 5A001.e and any other military or intelligence electronic
``equipment'' that is ``subject to the ITAR.'' (2) See USML Category
XI(a)(4)(iii) for controls on electronic attack and jamming
``equipment'' defined in 5A001.f and .h that are subject to the
ITAR. (3) See also ECCNs 5A101, 5A980, and 5A991.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Any type of telecommunications equipment having any of the
following characteristics, functions or features:
a.1. ``Specially designed'' to withstand transitory electronic
effects or electromagnetic pulse effects, both arising from a
nuclear explosion;
a.2. Specially hardened to withstand gamma, neutron or ion
radiation;
a.3. ``Specially designed'' to operate below 218 K (-55 [deg]C);
or
a.4. ``Specially designed'' to operate above 397 K (124 [deg]C);
Note: 5A001.a.3 and 5A001.a.4 apply only to electronic
equipment.
b. Telecommunication systems and equipment, and ``specially
designed'' ``components'' and ``accessories'' therefor, having any
of the following characteristics, functions or features:
b.1 Being underwater untethered communications systems having
any of the following:
b.1.a. An acoustic carrier frequency outside the range from 20
kHz to 60 kHz;
b.1.b. Using an electromagnetic carrier frequency below 30 kHz;
or
b.1.c. Using electronic beam steering techniques; or
b.1.d. Using ``lasers'' or light-emitting diodes (LEDs), with an
output wavelength greater than 400 nm and less than 700 nm, in a
``local area network'';
b.2. Being radio equipment operating in the 1.5 MHz to 87.5 MHz
band and having all of the following:
b.2.a. Automatically predicting and selecting frequencies and
``total digital transfer rates'' per channel to optimize the
transmission; and
b.2.b. Incorporating a linear power amplifier configuration
having a capability to support multiple signals simultaneously at an
output power of 1 kW or more in the frequency range of 1.5 MHz or
more but less than 30 MHz, or 250 W or more in the frequency range
of 30 MHz or more but not exceeding 87.5 MHz, over an
``instantaneous bandwidth'' of one octave or more and with an output
harmonic and distortion content of better than -80 dB;
b.3. Being radio equipment employing ``spread spectrum''
techniques, including ``frequency hopping'' techniques, not
controlled in 5A001.b.4 and having any of the following:
b.3.a. User programmable spreading codes; or
b.3.b. A total transmitted bandwidth which is 100 or more times
the bandwidth of any one information channel and in excess of 50
kHz;
Note: 5A001.b.3.b does not control radio equipment ``specially
designed'' for use with any of the following:
a. Civil cellular radio-communications systems; or
b. Fixed or mobile satellite Earth stations for commercial civil
telecommunications.
Note: 5A001.b.3 does not control equipment operating at an
output power of 1 W or less.
[[Page 71960]]
b.4. Being radio equipment employing ultra-wideband modulation
techniques, having user programmable channelizing codes, scrambling
codes, or network identification codes and having any of the
following:
b.4.a. A bandwidth exceeding 500 MHz; or
b.4.b. A ``fractional bandwidth'' of 20% or more;
b.5. Being digitally controlled radio receivers having all of
the following:
b.5.a. More than 1,000 channels;
b.5.b. A `channel switching time ' of less than 1 ms;
b.5.c. Automatic searching or scanning of a part of the
electromagnetic spectrum; and
b.5.d. Identification of the received signals or the type of
transmitter; or
Note: 5A001.b.5 does not control radio equipment ``specially
designed'' for use with civil cellular radio-communications systems.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 5A001.b.5.b, `channel
switching time' means the time (i.e., delay) to change from one
receiving frequency to another, to arrive at or within 0.05% of the final specified receiving frequency.
Items having a specified frequency range of less than 0.05% around their center frequency are defined to
be incapable of channel frequency switching.
b.6. Employing functions of digital ``signal processing'' to
provide 'voice coding' output at rates of less than 700 bit/s.
Technical Notes:
1. For variable rate 'voice coding', 5A001.b.6 applies to the
'voice coding' output of continuous speech.
2. For the purposes of 5A001.b.6, `voice coding' is defined as
the technique to take samples of human voice and then convert these
samples of human voice into a digital signal taking into account
specific characteristics of human speech.
c. Optical fibers of more than 500 m in length and specified by
the manufacturer as being capable of withstanding a `proof test'
tensile stress of 2 x 10\9\ N/m\2\ or more;
N.B.: For underwater umbilical cables, see 8A002.a.3.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 5A001.c, `proof test' is the
on-line or off-line production screen testing that dynamically
applies a prescribed tensile stress over a 0.5 to 3 m length of
fiber at a running rate of 2 to 5 m/s while passing between capstans
approximately 150 mm in diameter. The ambient temperature is a
nominal 293 K (20 [deg]C) and relative humidity 40%. Equivalent
national standards may be used for executing the proof test.
d. ``Electronically steerable phased array antennae'' as
follows:
d.1. Rated for operation above 31.8 GHz, but not exceeding 57
GHz, and having an Effective Radiated Power (ERP) equal to or
greater than +20 dBm (22.15 dBm Effective Isotropic Radiated Power
(EIRP));
d.2. Rated for operation above 57 GHz, but not exceeding 66 GHz,
and having an ERP equal to or greater than +24 dBm (26.15 dBm EIRP);
d.3. Rated for operation above 66 GHz, but not exceeding 90 GHz,
and having an ERP equal to or greater than +20 dBm (22.15 dBm EIRP);
d.4. Rated for operation above 90 GHz;
Note 1: 5A001.d does not control `electronically steerable
phased array antennae' for landing systems with instruments meeting
ICAO standards covering Microwave Landing Systems (MLS).
Note 2: 5A001.d does not apply to antennae ``specially
designed'' for any of the following:
a. Civil cellular or WLAN radio-communications systems;
b. IEEE 802.15 or wireless HDMI; or
c. Fixed or mobile satellite earth stations for commercial civil
telecommunications.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 5A001.d, `electronically
steerable phased array antenna' is an antenna which forms a beam by
means of phase coupling, (i.e., the beam direction is controlled by
the complex excitation coefficients of the radiating elements) and
the direction of that beam can be varied (both in transmission and
reception) in azimuth or in elevation, or both, by application of an
electrical signal.
e. Radio direction finding equipment operating at frequencies
above 30 MHz and having all of the following, and ``specially
designed'' ``components'' therefor:
e.1. ``Instantaneous bandwidth'' of 10 MHz or more; and
e.2. Capable of finding a Line Of Bearing (LOB) to non-
cooperating radio transmitters with a signal duration of less than 1
ms;
f. Mobile telecommunications interception or jamming equipment,
and monitoring equipment therefor, as follows, and ``specially
designed'' ``components'' therefor:
f.1. Interception equipment designed for the extraction of voice
or data, transmitted over the air interface;
f.2. Interception equipment not specified in 5A001.f.1, designed
for the extraction of client device or subscriber identifiers (e.g.,
IMSI, TIMSI or IMEI), signaling, or other metadata transmitted over
the air interface;
f.3. Jamming equipment ``specially designed'' or modified to
intentionally and selectively interfere with, deny, inhibit, degrade
or seduce mobile telecommunication services and performing any of
the following:
f.3.a. Simulate the functions of Radio Access Network (RAN)
equipment;
f.3.b. Detect and exploit specific characteristics of the mobile
telecommunications protocol employed (e.g., GSM); or
f.3.c. Exploit specific characteristics of the mobile
telecommunications protocol employed (e.g., GSM);
f.4. Radio Frequency (RF) monitoring equipment designed or
modified to identify the operation of items specified in 5A001.f.1,
5A001.f.2 or 5A001.f.3.
Note: 5A001.f.1 and 5A001.f.2 do not apply to any of the
following:
a. Equipment ``specially designed'' for the interception of
analog Private Mobile Radio (PMR), IEEE 802.11 WLAN;
b. Equipment designed for mobile telecommunications network
operators; or
c. Equipment designed for the ``development'' or ``production''
of mobile telecommunications equipment or systems.
N.B. 1: See also the International Traffic in Arms Regulations
(ITAR) (22 CFR parts 120-130). For items specified by 5A001.f.1
(including as previously specified by 5A001.i), see also 5A980 and
the U.S. Munitions List (22 CFR part 121).
N.B. 2: For radio receivers see 5A001.b.5.
g. Passive Coherent Location (PCL) systems or equipment,
``specially designed'' for detecting and tracking moving objects by
measuring reflections of ambient radio frequency emissions, supplied
by non-radar transmitters.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 5A001.g, non-radar
transmitters may include commercial radio, television or cellular
telecommunications base stations.
Note: 5A001.g. does not control:
a. Radio-astronomical equipment; or
b. Systems or equipment, that require any radio transmission
from the target.
h. Counter Improvised Explosive Device (IED) equipment and
related equipment, as follows:
h.1. Radio Frequency (RF) transmitting equipment, not specified
by 5A001.f, designed or modified for prematurely activating or
preventing the initiation of Improvised Explosive Devices (IEDs);
h.2. Equipment using techniques designed to enable radio
communications in the same frequency channels on which co-located
equipment specified by 5A001.h.1 is transmitting.
N.B.: See also Category XI of the International Traffic in Arms
Regulations (ITAR) (22 CFR parts 120-130).
i. [Reserved]
N.B.: See 5A001.f.1 for items previously specified by 5A001.i.
j. IP network communications surveillance systems or equipment,
and ``specially designed'' components therefor, having all of the
following:
j.1. Performing all of the following on a carrier class IP
network (e.g., national grade IP backbone):
j.1.a. Analysis at the application layer (e.g., Layer 7 of Open
Systems Interconnection (OSI) model (ISO/IEC 7498-1));
j.1.b. Extraction of selected metadata and application content
(e.g., voice, video, messages, attachments); and
j.1.c. Indexing of extracted data; and
j.2. Being ``specially designed'' to carry out all of the
following:
j.2.a. Execution of searches on the basis of ``hard selectors'';
and
j.2.b. Mapping of the relational network of an individual or of
a group of people.
Note: 5A001.j does not apply to ``systems'' or ``equipment'',
``specially designed'' for any of the following:
a. Marketing purpose;
b. Network Quality of Service (QoS); or
c. Quality of Experience (QoE).
N.B.: See also the International Traffic in Arms Regulations
(ITAR) (22 CFR parts 120-130). Defense articles described in USML
Category XI(b) are ``subject to the ITAR.''
* * * * *
Category 5--Telecommunications and ``Information Security''
Part 2--``Information Security''
* * * * *
Technical Note: For the purposes of the Cryptography Note,
`executable software' means ``software'' in executable form, from
[[Page 71961]]
an existing hardware component excluded from 5A002, by the
Cryptography Note.
* * * * *
5A002 ``Information security'' systems, equipment and
``components,'' as follows (see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT, EI
Country Chart (See Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 1
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
EI applies to entire entry................ Refer to Sec. 742.15 of
the EAR.
License Requirements Note: See Sec. 744.17 of the EAR for
additional license requirements for microprocessors having a
processing speed of 5 GFLOPS or more and an arithmetic logic unit
with an access width of 32 bit or more, including those
incorporating ``information security'' functionality, and associated
``software'' and ``technology'' for the ``production'' or
``development'' of such microprocessors.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: Yes: $500 for ``components''.
N/A for systems and equipment.
GBS: N/A
ENC: Yes for certain EI controlled commodities, see Sec. 740.17 of
the EAR for eligibility.
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) ECCN 5A002.a controls ``components'' providing
the means or functions necessary for ``information security.'' All
such ``components'' are presumptively ``specially designed'' and
controlled by 5A002.a. (2) See USML Categories XI (including XI(b))
and XIII(b) (including XIII(b)(2)) for controls on systems,
equipment, and components described in 5A002.d or .e that are
subject to the ITAR. (3) For ``satellite navigation system''
receiving equipment containing or employing decryption see 7A005,
and for related decryption ``software'' and ``technology'' see 7D005
and 7E001. (4) Noting that items may be controlled elsewhere on the
CCL, examples of items not controlled by ECCN 5A002.a.4 include the
following: (a) An automobile where the only `cryptography for data
confidentiality' having a `described security algorithm' is
performed by a Category 5--Part 2 Note 3 eligible mobile telephone
that is built into the car. In this case, secure phone
communications support a non-primary function of the automobile but
the mobile telephone (equipment), as a standalone item, is not
controlled by ECCN 5A002 because it is excluded by the Cryptography
Note (Note 3) (See ECCN 5A992.c). (b) An exercise bike with an
embedded Category 5--Part 2 Note 3 eligible web browser, where the
only controlled cryptography is performed by the web browser. In
this case, secure web browsing supports a non-primary function of
the exercise bike but the web browser (``software''), as a
standalone item, is not controlled by ECCN 5D002 because it is
excluded by the Cryptography Note (Note 3) (See ECCN 5D992.c). (5)
After classification or self-classification in accordance with Sec.
740.17(b) of the EAR, mass market encryption commodities that meet
eligibility requirements are released from ``EI'' and ``NS''
controls. These commodities are designated 5A992.c.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Designed or modified to use `cryptography for data
confidentiality' having a `described security algorithm', where that
cryptographic capability is usable, has been activated, or can be
activated by any means other than secure ``cryptographic
activation'', as follows:
a.1. Items having ``information security'' as a primary
function;
a.2. Digital communication or networking systems, equipment or
components, not specified in paragraph 5A002.a.1;
a.3. Computers, other items having information storage or
processing as a primary function, and components therefor, not
specified in paragraphs 5A002.a.1 or .a.2;
N.B.: For operating systems see also 5D002.a.1 and .c.1.
a.4. Items, not specified in paragraphs 5A002.a.1 to a.3, where
the `cryptography for data confidentiality' having a `described
security algorithm' meets all of the following:
a.4.a. It supports a non-primary function of the item; and
a.4.b. It is performed by incorporated equipment or ``software''
that would, as a standalone item, be specified by ECCNs 5A002,
5A003, 5A004, 5B002 or 5D002.
N.B. to paragraph a.4: See Related Control Paragraph (4) of this
ECCN 5A002 for examples of items not controlled by 5A002.a.4.
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 5A002.a, `cryptography for data
confidentiality' means ``cryptography'' that employs digital
techniques and performs any cryptographic function other than any of
the following:
1.a. ``Authentication;''
1.b. Digital signature;
1.c. Data integrity;
1.d. Non-repudiation;
1.e. Digital rights management, including the execution of copy-
protected ``software;''
1.f. Encryption or decryption in support of entertainment, mass
commercial broadcasts or medical records management; or
1.g. Key management in support of any function described in
paragraphs 1.a to 1.f of this Technical Note paragraph 1.
2. For the purposes of 5A002.a, `described security algorithm'
means any of the following:
2.a. A ``symmetric algorithm'' employing a key length in excess
of 56 bits, not including parity bits;
2.b. An ``asymmetric algorithm'' where the security of the
algorithm is based on any of the following:
2.b.1. Factorization of integers in excess of 512 bits (e.g.,
RSA);
2.b.2. Computation of discrete logarithms in a multiplicative
group of a finite field of size greater than 512 bits (e.g., Diffie-
Hellman over Z/pZ); or
2.b.3. Discrete logarithms in a group other than mentioned in
paragraph 2.b.2 of this Technical Note in excess of 112 bits (e.g.,
Diffie-Hellman over an elliptic curve); or
2.c. An ``asymmetric algorithm'' where the security of the
algorithm is based on any of the following:
2.c.1. Shortest vector or closest vector problems associated
with lattices (e.g., NewHope, Frodo, NTRUEncrypt, Kyber, Titanium);
2.c.2. Finding isogenies between Supersingular elliptic curves
(e.g., Supersingular Isogeny Key Encapsulation); or
2.c.3. Decoding random codes (e.g., McEliece, Niederreiter).
Technical Note: An algorithm described by Technical Note 2.c.
may be referred to as being post-quantum, quantum-safe or quantum-
resistant.
Note 1: Details of items must be accessible and provided upon
request, in order to establish any of the following:
a. Whether the item meets the criteria of 5A002.a.1 to a.4; or
b. Whether the cryptographic capability for data confidentiality
specified by 5A002.a is usable without ``cryptographic activation.''
Note 2: 5A002.a does not control any of the following items, or
specially designed ``information security'' components therefor:
a. Smart cards and smart card `readers/writers' as follows:
a.1. A smart card or an electronically readable personal
document (e.g., token coin, e-passport) that meets any of the
following:
a.1.a. The cryptographic capability meets all of the following:
a.1.a.1. It is restricted for use in any of the following:
a.1.a.1.a. Equipment or systems, not described by 5A002.a.1 to
a.4;
a.1.a.1.b. Equipment or systems, not using `cryptography for
data confidentiality' having a `described security algorithm'; or
a.1.a.1.c. Equipment or systems, excluded from 5A002.a by
entries b. to f. of this Note; and
a.1.a.2. It cannot be reprogrammed for any other use; or
a.1.b. Having all of the following:
a.1.b.1. It is specially designed and limited to allow
protection of `personal data' stored within;
a.1.b.2. Has been, or can only be, personalized for public or
commercial transactions or individual identification; and
a.1.b.3. Where the cryptographic capability is not user-
accessible;
Technical Note to paragraph a.1.b.1 of Note 2: For the purposes
of 5A002.a Note 2.a.1.b.1, `personal data' includes any data
specific to a particular person or entity, such as the amount of
money stored and data necessary for ``authentication.''
a.2. `Readers/writers' specially designed or modified, and
limited, for items specified by paragraph a.1 of this Note;
Technical Note to paragraph a.2 of Note 2: For the purposes of
5A002.a Note 2.a.2, `readers/writers' include equipment that
communicates with smart cards or electronically readable documents
through a network.
[[Page 71962]]
b. Cryptographic equipment specially designed and limited for
banking use or `money transactions';
Technical Note to paragraph b of Note 2: For the purposes of
5A002.a Note 2.b, `money transactions' in 5A002 Note 2 paragraph b.
includes the collection and settlement of fares or credit functions.
c. Portable or mobile radiotelephones for civil use (e.g., for
use with commercial civil cellular radio communication systems) that
are not capable of transmitting encrypted data directly to another
radiotelephone or equipment (other than Radio Access Network (RAN)
equipment), nor of passing encrypted data through RAN equipment
(e.g., Radio Network Controller (RNC) or Base Station Controller
(BSC));
d. Cordless telephone equipment not capable of end-to-end
encryption where the maximum effective range of unboosted cordless
operation (i.e., a single, unrelayed hop between terminal and home
base station) is less than 400 meters according to the
manufacturer's specifications;
e. Portable or mobile radiotelephones and similar client
wireless devices for civil use, that implement only published or
commercial cryptographic standards (except for anti-piracy
functions, which may be non-published) and also meet the provisions
of paragraphs a.2 to a.4 of the Cryptography Note (Note 3 in
Category 5--Part 2), that have been customized for a specific civil
industry application with features that do not affect the
cryptographic functionality of these original non-customized
devices;
f. Items, where the ``information security'' functionality is
limited to wireless ``personal area network'' functionality
implementing only published or commercial cryptographic standards;
g. Mobile telecommunications Radio Access Network (RAN)
equipment designed for civil use, which also meet the provisions of
paragraphs a.2 to a.4 of the Cryptography Note (Note 3 in Category
5--Part 2), having an RF output power limited to 0.1W (20 dBm) or
less, and supporting 16 or fewer concurrent users;
h. Routers, switches, gateways or relays, where the
``information security'' functionality is limited to the tasks of
``Operations, Administration or Maintenance'' (``OAM'') implementing
only published or commercial cryptographic standards;
i. General purpose computing equipment or servers, where the
``information security'' functionality meets all of the following:
i.1. Uses only published or commercial cryptographic standards;
and
i.2. Is any of the following:
i.2.a. Integral to a CPU that meets the provisions of Note 3 in
Category 5--Part 2;
i.2.b. Integral to an operating system that is not specified by
5D002; or
i.2.c. Limited to ``OAM'' of the equipment; or
j. Items specially designed for a `connected civil industry
application', meeting all of the following:
j.1. Being any of the following:
j.1.a. A network-capable endpoint device meeting any of the
following:
j.1.a.1. The ``information security'' functionality is limited
to securing `non-arbitrary data' or the tasks of ``Operations,
Administration or Maintenance'' (``OAM''); or
j.1.a.2. The device is limited to a specific `connected civil
industry application'; or
j.1.b. Networking equipment meeting all of the following:
j.1.b.1. Being specially designed to communicate with the
devices specified by paragraph j.1.a. above; and
j.1.b.2. The ``information security'' functionality is limited
to supporting the `connected civil industry application' of devices
specified by paragraph j.1.a. above, or the tasks of ``OAM'' of this
networking equipment or of other items specified by paragraph j. of
this Note; and
j.2. Where the ``information security'' functionality implements
only published or commercial cryptographic standards, and the
cryptographic functionality cannot easily be changed by the user.
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 5A002.a Note 2.j, `connected civil
industry application' means a network-connected consumer or civil
industry application other than ``information security'', digital
communication, general purpose networking or computing.
2. For the purposes of 5A002.a Note 2.j.1.a.1, `non-arbitrary
data' means sensor or metering data directly related to the
stability, performance or physical measurement of a system (e.g.,
temperature, pressure, flow rate, mass, volume, voltage, physical
location, etc.), that cannot be changed by the user of the device.
b. Being a `cryptographic activation token';
Technical Note: For the purposes of 5A002.b, a `cryptographic
activation token' is an item designed or modified for any of the
following:
1. Converting, by means of ``cryptographic activation'', an item
not specified by Category 5-Part 2 into an item specified by 5A002.a
or 5D002.c.1, and not released by the Cryptography Note (Note 3 in
Category 5-Part 2); or
2. Enabling by means of ``cryptographic activation'', additional
functionality specified by 5A002.a of an item already specified by
Category 5-Part 2;
c. Designed or modified to use or perform ``quantum
cryptography'';
Technical Note: For the purposes of 5A002.c, ``quantum
cryptography'' is also known as Quantum Key Distribution (QKD).
d. Designed or modified to use cryptographic techniques to
generate channelizing codes, scrambling codes or network
identification codes, for systems using ultra-wideband modulation
techniques and having any of the following:
d.1. A bandwidth exceeding 500 MHz; or
d.2. A ``fractional bandwidth'' of 20% or more;
e. Designed or modified to use cryptographic techniques to
generate the spreading code for ``spread spectrum'' systems, not
specified by 5A002.d, including the hopping code for ``frequency
hopping'' systems.
* * * * *
5A004 ``Systems,'' ``equipment'' and ``components'' for defeating,
weakening or bypassing ``information security,'' as follows (see
List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT, EI
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 1
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
EI applies to entire entry................ Refer toSec. 742.15 of the
EAR
License Requirements Note: See Sec. 744.17 of the EAR for
additional license requirements for microprocessors having a
processing speed of 5 GFLOPS or more and an arithmetic logic unit
with an access width of 32 bit or more, including those
incorporating ``information security'' functionality, and associated
``software'' and ``technology'' for the ``production'' or
``development'' of such microprocessors.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: Yes: $500 for ``components.''
N/A for systems and equipment.
GBS: N/A
ENC: Yes for certain EI controlled commodities. See Sec. 740.17 of
the EAR for eligibility.
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: ECCN 5A004.a controls ``components'' providing the
means or functions necessary for ``information security.'' All such
``components'' are presumptively ``specially designed'' and
controlled by 5A004.a.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Designed or modified to perform `cryptanalytic functions.'
Note: 5A004.a includes systems or equipment, designed or
modified to perform `cryptanalytic functions' by means of reverse
engineering.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 5A004.a, `cryptanalytic
functions' are functions designed to defeat cryptographic mechanisms
in order to derive confidential variables or sensitive data,
including clear text passwords or cryptographic keys.
b. Items, not specified by ECCNs 4A005 or 5A004.a, designed to
perform all of the following:
b.1. `Extract raw data' from a computing or communications
device; and
b.2. Circumvent ``authentication'' or authorization controls of
the device, in order to perform the function described in 5A004.b.1.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 5A004.b.1, `extract raw
data' from a computing or communications device means to retrieve
binary data from a storage medium, e.g., RAM, flash or hard disk, of
the device without interpretation by the device's operating system
or filesystem.
Note 1: 5A004.b does not apply to systems or equipment specially
designed for the ``development'' or ``production'' of a computing or
communications device.
Note 2: 5A004.b does not include:
a. Debuggers, hypervisors;
[[Page 71963]]
b. Items limited to logical data extraction;
c. Data extraction items using chip-off or JTAG; or
d. Items specially designed and limited to jail-breaking or
rooting.
* * * * *
6A001 Acoustic systems, equipment and ``components,'' as follows
(see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Country Chart (See Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements
See Sec. 743.1 of the EAR for reporting requirements for
exports under License Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: $3000; N/A for 6A001.a.1.b.1 object detection and location
systems having a transmitting frequency below 5 kHz or a sound
pressure level exceeding 210 dB (reference 1 [mu]Pa at 1 m) for
equipment with an operating frequency in the band from 2 kHz to 30
kHz inclusive; 6A001.a.1.e, 6A001.a.2.a.1, a.2.a.2, 6A001.a.2.a.3,
a.2.a.5, a.2.a.6, 6A001.a.2.b; processing equipment controlled by
6A001.a.2.c, and ``specially designed'' for real-time application
with towed acoustic hydrophone arrays; a.2.e.1, a.2.e.2; and bottom
or bay cable systems controlled by 6A001.a.2.f and having processing
equipment ``specially designed'' for real-time application with
bottom or bay cable systems.
GBS: Yes for 6A001.a.1.b.4.
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be used to ship commodities in
6A001.a.1.b, 6A001.a.1.e or 6A001.a.2 (except .a.2.a.4) to any of
the destinations listed in Country Group A:6 (See Supplement No.1 to
part 740 of the EAR).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: See also 6A991.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Marine acoustic systems, equipment and ``specially designed''
``components'' therefor, as follows:
a.1. Active (transmitting or transmitting-and-receiving)
systems, equipment and ``specially designed'' ``components''
therefor, as follows:
Note: 6A001.a.1 does not control equipment as follows:
a. Depth sounders operating vertically below the apparatus, not
including a scanning function exceeding
20[deg], and limited to measuring the depth of water, the distance
of submerged or buried objects or fish finding;
b. Acoustic beacons, as follows:
1. Acoustic emergency beacons;
2. Pingers ``specially designed'' for relocating or returning to
an underwater position.
a.1.a. Acoustic seabed survey equipment as follows:
a.1.a.1. Surface vessel survey equipment designed for sea bed
topographic mapping and having all of the following:
a.1.a.1.a. Designed to take measurements at an angle exceeding
20[deg] from the vertical;
a.1.a.1.b. Designed to measure seabed topography at seabed
depths exceeding 600 m;
a.1.a.1.c.`Sounding resolution' less than 2; and
a.1.a.1.d. 'Enhancement' of the depth ``accuracy'' through
compensation for all the following:
a.1.a.1.d.1. Motion of the acoustic sensor;
a.1.a.1.d.2. In-water propagation from sensor to the seabed and
back; and
a.1.a.1.d.3. Sound speed at the sensor;
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 6A001.a.1.a.1.c, `sounding resolution' is
the swath width (degrees) divided by the maximum number of soundings
per swath.
2. For the purposes of 6A001.a.1.a, `enhancement' includes the
ability to compensate by external means.
a.1.a.2. Underwater survey equipment designed for seabed
topographic mapping and having any of the following:
Technical Note: For the purposes of 6A001.a.1.a.2, the acoustic
sensor pressure rating determines the depth rating.
a.1.a.2.a. Having all of the following:
a.1.a.2.a.1. Designed or modified to operate at depths exceeding
300 m; and
a.1.a.2.a.2. `Sounding rate' greater than 3,800 m/s; or
Technical Note: For the purposes of 6A001.a.1.a.2.a.2, `sounding
rate' is the product of the maximum speed (m/s) at which the sensor
can operate and the maximum number of soundings per swath assuming
100% coverage. For systems that produce soundings in two directions
(3D sonars), the maximum of the `sounding rate' in either direction
should be used.
a.1.a.2.b. Survey equipment, not specified by 6A001.a.1.a.2.a,
having all of the following:
a.1.a.2.b.1. Designed or modified to operate at depths exceeding
100 m;
a.1.a.2.b.2. Designed to take measurements at an angle exceeding
20[deg] from the vertical;
a.1.a.2.b.3. Having any of the following:
a.1.a.2.b.3.a. Operating frequency below 350 kHz; or
a.1.a.2.b.3.b. Designed to measure seabed topography at a range
exceeding 200 m from the acoustic sensor; and
a.1.a.2.b.4. `Enhancement' of the depth ``accuracy'' through
compensation of all of the following:
a.1.a.2.b.4.a. Motion of the acoustic sensor;
a.1.a.2.b.4.b. In-water propagation from sensor to the seabed
and back; and
a.1.a.2.b.4.c. Sound speed at the sensor.
a.1.a.3. Side Scan Sonar (SSS) or Synthetic Aperture Sonar
(SAS), designed for seabed imaging and having all of the following,
and ``specially designed'' transmitting and receiving acoustic
arrays therefor:
a.1.a.3.a. Designed or modified to operate at depths exceeding
500 m; and
a.1.a.3.b. An 'area coverage rate' of greater than 570 m\2\/s
while operating at the maximum range that it can operate with an
`along track resolution' of less than 15 cm; and
a.1.a.3.c. An `across track resolution' of less than 15 cm;
Technical Notes:
For the purposes of 6A001.a.1.a.3:
1. `Area coverage rate' (m2/s) is twice the product of the sonar
range (m) and the maximum speed (m/s) at which the sensor can
operate at that range.
2. `Along track resolution' (cm), for SSS only, is the product
of azimuth (horizontal) beamwidth (degrees) and sonar range (m) and
0.873.
3. `Across track resolution' (cm) is 75 divided by the signal
bandwidth (kHz).
a.1.b Systems or transmitting and receiving arrays, designed for
object detection or location, having any of the following:
a.1.b.1. A transmitting frequency below 10 kHz;
a.1.b.2. Sound pressure level exceeding 224dB (reference 1
[micro]Pa at 1 m) for equipment with an operating frequency in the
band from 10 kHz to 24 kHz inclusive;
a.1.b.3. Sound pressure level exceeding 235 dB (reference 1
[micro]Pa at 1 m) for equipment with an operating frequency in the
band between 24 kHz and 30 kHz;
a.1.b.4. Forming beams of less than 1[deg] on any axis and
having an operating frequency of less than 100 kHz;
a.1.b.5. Designed to operate with an unambiguous display range
exceeding 5,120 m; or
a.1.b.6. Designed to withstand pressure during normal operation
at depths exceeding 1,000 m and having transducers with any of the
following:
a.1.b.6.a. Dynamic compensation for pressure; or
a.1.b.6.b. Incorporating other than lead zirconate titanate as
the transduction element;
a.1.c. Acoustic projectors, including transducers, incorporating
piezoelectric, magnetostrictive, electrostrictive, electrodynamic or
hydraulic elements operating individually or in a designed
combination and having any of the following:
Notes:
1. The control status of acoustic projectors, including
transducers, ``specially designed'' for other equipment is
determined by the control status of the other equipment.
2. 6A001.a.1.c does not control electronic sources that direct
the sound vertically only, or mechanical (e.g., air gun or vapor-
shock gun) or chemical (e.g., explosive) sources.
3. Piezoelectric elements specified in 6A001.a.1.c include those
made from lead-magnesium-niobate/lead-titanate (Pb(Mg1/3Nb2/3)O3-
PbTiO3, or PMN-PT) single crystals grown from solid solution or
lead-indium-niobate/lead-magnesium niobate/lead-titanate (Pb(In1/
2Nb1/2)O3-Pb(Mg1/3Nb2/3)O3-PbTiO3, or PIN-PMN-PT) single crystals
grown from solid solution.
a.1.c.1. Operating at frequencies below 10 kHz and having any of
the following:
a.1.c.1.a. Not designed for continuous operation at 100% duty
cycle and having a
[[Page 71964]]
radiated `free-field Source Level (SLRMS)' exceeding (10log(f) +
169.77)dB (reference 1 [mu]Pa at 1 m) where f is the frequency in
Hertz of maximum Transmitting Voltage Response (TVR) below 10 kHz;
or
a.1.c.1.b. Designed for continuous operation at 100% duty cycle
and having a continuously radiated `free-field Source Level (SLRMS)'
at 100% duty cycle exceeding (10log(f) + 159.77)dB (reference 1
[mu]Pa at 1 m) where f is the frequency in Hertz of maximum
Transmitting Voltage Response (TVR) below 10 kHz; or
Technical Note: For the purposes of 6A001.a.1.c.1, the `free-
field Source Level (SLRMS)' is defined along the maximum response
axis and in the far field of the acoustic projector. It can be
obtained from the Transmitting Voltage Response using the following
equation: SLRMS = (TVR + 20log VRMS) dB (ref 1[mu]Pa at 1 m), where
SLRMS is the source level, TVR is the Transmitting Voltage Response
and VRMS is the Driving Voltage of the Projector.
a.1.c.2. [Reserved]
N.B. See 6A001.a.1.c.1 for items previously specified in
6A001.a.1.c.2.
a.1.c.3. Side-lobe suppression exceeding 22 dB;
a.1.d. Acoustic systems and equipment, designed to determine the
position of surface vessels or underwater vehicles and having all of
the following, and ``specially designed'' ``components'' therefor:
a.1.d.1. Detection range exceeding 1,000 m; and
a.1.d.2. Determined position error of less than 10 m rms (root
mean square) when measured at a range of 1,000 m;
Note: 6A001.a.1.d includes:
a. Equipment using coherent ``signal processing'' between two or
more beacons and the hydrophone unit carried by the surface vessel
or underwater vehicle;
b. Equipment capable of automatically correcting speed-of-sound
propagation errors for calculation of a point.
a.1.e. Active individual sonars, ``specially designed'' or
modified to detect, locate and automatically classify swimmers or
divers, having all of the following, and ``specially designed''
transmitting and receiving acoustic arrays therefor:
a.1.e.1. Detection range exceeding 530 m;
a.1.e.2. Determined position error of less than 15 m rms (root
mean square) when measured at a range of 530 m; and
a.1.e.3. Transmitted pulse signal bandwidth exceeding 3 kHz;
N.B.: For diver detection systems ``specially designed'' or
modified for military use, see the U.S. Munitions List in the
International Traffic in Arms Regulations (ITAR) (22 CFR part 121).
Note: For 6A001.a.1.e, where multiple detection ranges are
specified for various environments, the greatest detection range is
used.
a.2. Passive systems, equipment and ``specially designed''
``components'' therefor, as follows:
Note: 6A001.a.2 also applies to receiving equipment, whether or
not related in normal application to separate active equipment, and
``specially designed'' components therefor.
a.2.a. Hydrophones having any of the following:
Note: The control status of hydrophones ``specially designed''
for other equipment is determined by the control status of the other
equipment.
Technical Notes:
For the purposes of 6A001.a.2.a:
1. Hydrophones consist of one or more sensing elements producing
a single acoustic output channel. Those that contain multiple
elements can be referred to as a hydrophone group.
2. Underwater acoustic transducers designed to operate as
passive receivers are hydrophones.
a.2.a.1. Incorporating continuous flexible sensing elements;
a.2.a.2. Incorporating flexible assemblies of discrete sensing
elements with either a diameter or length less than 20 mm and with a
separation between elements of less than 20 mm;
a.2.a.3. Having any of the following sensing elements:
a.2.a.3.a. Optical fibers;
a.2.a.3.b. `Piezoelectric polymer films' other than
polyvinylidene-fluoride (PVDF) and its co-polymers {P(VDF-TrFE) and
P(VDF-TFE){time} ;
a.2.a.3.c. `Flexible piezoelectric composites';
a.2.a.3.d. Lead-magnesium- niobate/lead-titanate (i.e., Pb(Mg1/
3Nb2/3)O3-PbTiO3, or PMN-PT) piezoelectric single crystals grown
from solid solution; or
a.2.a.3.e. Lead-indium-niobate/lead-magnesium niobate/lead-
titanate (i.e., Pb(In1/2Nb1/2)O3-
Pb(Mg1/3Nb2/3)O3-PbTiO3,
or PIN-PMN-PT) piezoelectric single crystals grown from solid
solution;
a.2.a.4. A `hydrophone sensitivity' better than -180dB at any
depth with no acceleration compensation;
a.2.a.5. Designed to operate at depths exceeding 35 m with
acceleration compensation; or
a.2.a.6. Designed for operation at depths exceeding 1,000 m and
having a `hydrophone sensitivity' better than -230 dB below 4 kHz;
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 6A001.a.2.a.3.b, `piezoelectric polymer
film' sensing elements consist of polarized polymer film that is
stretched over and attached to a supporting frame or spool
(mandrel).
2. For the purposes of 6A001.a.2.a.3.c, `flexible piezoelectric
composite' sensing elements consist of piezoelectric ceramic
particles or fibers combined with an electrically insulating,
acoustically transparent rubber, polymer or epoxy compound, where
the compound is an integral part of the sensing elements.
3. For the purposes of 6A001.a.2.a, `hydrophone sensitivity' is
defined as twenty times the logarithm to the base 10 of the ratio of
rms output voltage to a 1 V rms reference, when the hydrophone
sensor, without a pre-amplifier, is placed in a plane wave acoustic
field with an rms pressure of 1 [mu]Pa. For example, a hydrophone of
-160 dB (reference 1 V per [mu]Pa) would yield an output voltage of
10-8 V in such a field, while one of -180 dB sensitivity would yield
only 10-9 V output. Thus, -160 dB is better than -180 dB.
a.2.b. Towed acoustic hydrophone arrays having any of the
following:
Technical Note: For the purposes of 6A001.a.2.b, hydrophones
arrays consist of a number of hydrophones providing multiple
acoustic output channels.
a.2.b.1. Hydrophone group spacing of less than 12.5 m or `able
to be modified' to have hydrophone group spacing of less than 12.5
m;
a.2.b.2. Designed or `able to be modified' to operate at depths
exceeding 35m;
Technical Note: For the purposes of 6A001.a.2.b.2, `able to be
modified' in 6A001.a.2.b means having provisions to allow a change
of the wiring or interconnections to alter hydrophone group spacing
or operating depth limits. These provisions are: spare wiring
exceeding 10% of the number of wires, hydrophone group spacing
adjustment blocks or internal depth limiting devices that are
adjustable or that control more than one hydrophone group.
a.2.b.3. Heading sensors controlled by 6A001.a.2.d;
a.2.b.4. Longitudinally reinforced array hoses;
a.2.b.5. An assembled array of less than 40 mm in diameter;
a.2.b.6. [Reserved];
a.2.b.7. Hydrophone characteristics controlled by 6A001.a.2.a;
or
a.2.b.8. Accelerometer-based hydro-acoustic sensors specified by
6A001.a.2.g;
a.2.c. Processing equipment, ``specially designed'' for towed
acoustic hydrophone arrays, having ``user-accessible
programmability'' and time or frequency domain processing and
correlation, including spectral analysis, digital filtering and
beamforming using Fast Fourier or other transforms or processes;
a.2.d. Heading sensors having all of the following:
a.2.d.1. An ``accuracy'' of better than 0.5[deg];
and
a.2.d.2. Designed to operate at depths exceeding 35 m or having
an adjustable or removable depth sensing device in order to operate
at depths exceeding 35 m;
N.B.: For inertial heading systems, see 7A003.c.
a.2.e. Bottom or bay-cable hydrophone arrays having any of the
following:
a.2.e.1. Incorporating hydrophones controlled by 6A001.a.2.a;
a.2.e.2. Incorporating multiplexed hydrophone group signal
modules having all of the following characteristics:
a.2.e.2.a. Designed to operate at depths exceeding 35 m or
having an adjustable or removal depth sensing device in order to
operate at depths exceeding 35 m; and
a.2.e.2.b. Capable of being operationally interchanged with
towed acoustic hydrophone array modules; or
a.2.e.3. Incorporating accelerometer-based hydro-acoustic
sensors specified by 6A001.a.2.g;
a.2.f. Processing equipment, ``specially designed'' for bottom
or bay cable systems, having ``user-accessible programmability'' and
time or frequency domain processing and correlation, including
spectral analysis,
[[Page 71965]]
digital filtering and beamforming using Fast Fourier or other
transforms or processes;
a.2.g. Accelerometer-based hydro-acoustic sensors having all of
the following:
a.2.g.1. Composed of three accelerometers arranged along three
distinct axes;
a.2.g.2. Having an overall `acceleration sensitivity' better
than 48 dB (reference 1,000 mV rms per 1g);
a.2.g.3. Designed to operate at depths greater than 35 meters;
and
a.2.g.4. Operating frequency below 20 kHz;
Note: 6A001.a.2.g does not apply to particle velocity sensors or
geophones.
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 6A001.a.2.g, accelerometer-based hydro-
acoustic sensors are also known as vector sensors.
2. For the purposes of 6A001.a.2.g.2, `acceleration sensitivity'
is defined as twenty times the logarithm to the base 10 of the ratio
of rms output voltage to a 1 V rms reference, when the hydro-
acoustic sensor, without a preamplifier, is placed in a plane wave
acoustic field with an rms acceleration of 1 g (i.e., 9.81 m/s2).
b. Correlation-velocity and Doppler-velocity sonar log equipment
designed to measure the horizontal speed of the equipment carrier
relative to the sea bed, as follows:
b.1. Correlation-velocity sonar log equipment having any of the
following characteristics:
b.1.a. Designed to operate at distances between the carrier and
the sea bed exceeding 500 m; or
b.1.b. Having speed ``accuracy'' better than 1% of speed;
b.2. Doppler-velocity sonar log equipment having speed
``accuracy'' better than 1% of speed;
Note 1: 6A001.b does not apply to depth sounders limited to any
of the following:
a. Measuring the depth of water;
b. Measuring the distance of submerged or buried objects; or
c. Fish finding.
Note 2: 6A001.b does not apply to equipment ``specially
designed'' for installation on surface vessels.
c. [Reserved]
N.B.: For diver deterrent acoustic systems, see 8A002.r.
6A002 Optical sensors and equipment, and ``components'' therefor, as
follows (see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, CC, RS, AT, UN
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
MT applies to optical detectors in MT Column 1
6A002.a.1, or a.3 that are ``specially
designed'' or modified to protect
``missiles'' against nuclear effects
(e.g., Electromagnetic Pulse (EMP), X-
rays, combined blast and thermal
effects), and usable for ``missiles''.
RS applies to 6A002.a.1, a.2, a.3 (except RS Column 1
a.3.d.2.a and a.3.e for lead selenide
based focal plane arrays (FPAs)), .c, and
.f..
CC applies to police-model infrared CC Column 1
viewers in 6A002.c.
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
UN applies to 6A002.a.1, a.2, a.3 and .c.. See Sec. 746.1(b) for UN
controls
Reporting Requirements
See Sec. 743.1 of the EAR for reporting requirements for
exports under License Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: $500 for 6A002.f.
$3000; except N/A for MT and for 6A002.a.1, a.2, a.3, .c, and .f.
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See USML Category XII(e) for infrared focal
plane arrays, image intensifier tubes, and related parts and
components, subject to the ITAR. (2) See USML Category XV(e) for
space-qualified focal plane arrays subject to the ITAR. (3) See also
ECCNs 6A102, 6A202, and 6A992. (4) See ECCN 0A919 for foreign-made
military commodities that incorporate commodities described in
6A002. (5) Section 744.9 imposes a license requirement on
commodities described in ECCN 6A002 if being exported, reexported,
or transferred (in-country) for use by a military end-user or for
incorporation into an item controlled by ECCN 0A919. (6) See USML
Categories XII(e) and XV(e)(3) for read-out integrated circuits
``subject to the ITAR.'' (7) See 6B002 for masks and reticles,
``specially designed'' for optical sensors specified by 6A002.a.1.b
or 6A002.a.1.d.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Optical detectors as follows:
a.1. ``Space-qualified'' solid-state detectors as follows:
Note: For the purposes of 6A002.a.1, solid-state detectors
include ``focal plane arrays''.
a.1.a. ``Space-qualified'' solid-state detectors having all of
the following:
a.1.a.1. A peak response in the wavelength range exceeding 10 nm
but not exceeding 300 nm; and
a.1.a.2. A response of less than 0.1% relative to the peak
response at a wavelength exceeding 400 nm;
a.1.b. ``Space-qualified'' solid-state detectors having all of
the following:
a.1.b.1. A peak response in the wavelength range exceeding 900
nm but not exceeding 1,200 nm; and
a.1.b.2. A response ``time constant'' of 95 ns or less;
a.1.c. ``Space-qualified'' solid-state detectors having a peak
response in the wavelength range exceeding 1,200 nm but not
exceeding 30,000 nm;
a.1.d. ``Space-qualified'' ``focal plane arrays'' having more
than 2,048 elements per array and having a peak response in the
wavelength range exceeding 300 nm but not exceeding 900 nm;
a.2. Image intensifier tubes and ``specially designed''
``components'' therefor, as follows:
Note: 6A002.a.2 does not control non-imaging photomultiplier
tubes having an electron sensing device in the vacuum space limited
solely to any of the following:
a. A single metal anode; or
b. Metal anodes with a center to center spacing greater than 500
[mu]m.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 6A002.a.2, `charge
multiplication' is a form of electronic image amplification and is
defined as the generation of charge carriers as a result of an
impact ionization gain process. `Charge multiplication' sensors may
take the form of an image intensifier tube, solid state detector or
``focal plane array''.
a.2.a. Image intensifier tubes having all of the following:
a.2.a.1. A peak response in the wavelength range exceeding 400
nm but not exceeding 1,050 nm;
a.2.a.2. Electron image amplification using any of the
following:
a.2.a.2.a. A microchannel plate with a hole pitch (center-to-
center spacing) of 12 [mu]m or less; or
a.2.a.2.b. An electron sensing device with a non-binned pixel
pitch of 500 [mu]m or less, ``specially designed'' or modified to
achieve `charge multiplication' other than by a microchannel plate;
and
a.2.a.3. Any of the following photocathodes:
a.2.a.3.a. Multialkali photocathodes (e.g., S-20 and S-5) having
a luminous sensitivity exceeding 350 [mu]A/lm;
a.2.a.3.b. GaAs or GaInAs photocathodes; or
a.2.a.3.c. Other ``III-V compound'' semiconductor photocathodes
having a maximum ``radiant sensitivity'' exceeding 10 mA/W;
a.2.b. Image intensifier tubes having all of the following:
a.2.b.1. A peak response in the wavelength range exceeding 1,050
nm but not exceeding 1,800 nm;
a.2.b.2. Electron image amplification using any of the
following:
[[Page 71966]]
a.2.b.2.a. A microchannel plate with a hole pitch (center-to-
center spacing) of 12 [mu]m or less; or
a.2.b.2.b. An electron sensing device with a non-binned pixel
pitch of 500 [mu]m or less, ``specially designed'' or modified to
achieve `charge multiplication' other than by a microchannel plate;
and
a.2.b.3. ``III/V compound'' semiconductor (e.g., GaAs or GaInAs)
photocathodes and transferred electron photocathodes, having a
maximum ``radiant sensitivity'' exceeding 15 mA/W;
a.2.c. ``Specially designed'' ``components'' as follows:
a.2.c.1. Microchannel plates having a hole pitch (center-to-
center spacing) of 12 [mu]m or less;
a.2.c.2. An electron sensing device with a non-binned pixel
pitch of 500 [mu]m or less, ``specially designed'' or modified to
achieve `charge multiplication' other than by a microchannel plate;
a.2.c.3. ``III-V compound'' semiconductor (e.g., GaAs or GaInAs)
photocathodes and transferred electron photocathodes;
Note: 6A002.a.2.c.3 does not control compound semiconductor
photocathodes designed to achieve a maximum ``radiant sensitivity''
of any of the following:
a. 10 mA/W or less at the peak response in the wavelength range
exceeding 400 nm but not exceeding 1,050 nm; or
b. 15 mA/W or less at the peak response in the wavelength range
exceeding 1,050 nm but not exceeding 1,800 nm.
a.3. Non-``space-qualified'' ``focal plane arrays'' as follows:
N.B.: `Microbolometer' non-``space-qualified'' ``focal plane
arrays'' are only specified by 6A002.a.3.f.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 6A002.a.3, linear or two-
dimensional multi-element detector arrays are referred to as ``focal
plane arrays'';
Note 1: 6A002.a.3 includes photoconductive arrays and
photovoltaic arrays.
Note 2: 6A002.a.3 does not control:
a. Multi-element (not to exceed 16 elements) encapsulated
photoconductive cells using either lead sulphide or lead selenide;
b. Pyroelectric detectors using any of the following:
b.1. Triglycine sulphate and variants;
b.2. Lead-lanthanum-zirconium titanate and variants;
b.3. Lithium tantalate;
b.4. Polyvinylidene fluoride and variants; or
b.5. Strontium barium niobate and variants.
c. ``Focal plane arrays'' ``specially designed'' or modified to
achieve `charge multiplication' and limited by design to have a
maximum ``radiant sensitivity'' of 10 mA/W or less for wavelengths
exceeding 760 nm, having all of the following:
c.1. Incorporating a response limiting mechanism designed not to
be removed or modified; and
c.2. Any of the following:
c.2.a. The response limiting mechanism is integral to or
combined with the detector element; or
c.2.b. The ``focal plane array'' is only operable with the
response limiting mechanism in place.
d. Thermopile arrays having less than 5,130 elements;
Technical Note: For the purposes of 6A002.a.3 Note 2.c.2.a, a
response limiting mechanism integral to the detector element is
designed not to be removed or modified without rendering the
detector inoperable.
a.3.a. Non-``space-qualified'' ``focal plane arrays'' having all
of the following:
a.3.a.1. Individual elements with a peak response within the
wavelength range exceeding 900 nm but not exceeding 1,050 nm; and
a.3.a.2. Any of the following:
a.3.a.2.a. A response ``time constant'' of less than 0.5 ns; or
a.3.a.2.b. ``Specially designed'' or modified to achieve `charge
multiplication' and having a maximum ``radiant sensitivity''
exceeding 10 mA/W;
a.3.b. Non-``space-qualified'' ``focal plane arrays'' having all
of the following:
a.3.b.1. Individual elements with a peak response in the
wavelength range exceeding 1,050 nm but not exceeding 1,200 nm; and
a.3.b.2. Any of the following:
a.3.b.2.a. A response ``time constant'' of 95 ns or less; or
a.3.b.2.b. ``Specially designed'' or modified to achieve `charge
multiplication' and having a maximum ``radiant sensitivity''
exceeding 10 mA/W;
a.3.c. Non-``space-qualified'' non-linear (2-dimensional)
``focal plane arrays'' having individual elements with a peak
response in the wavelength range exceeding 1,200 nm but not
exceeding 30,000 nm;
N.B.: Silicon and other material based `microbolometer' non-
``space-qualified'' ``focal plane arrays'' are only specified by
6A002.a.3.f.
a.3.d. Non-``space-qualified'' linear (1-dimensional) ``focal
plane arrays'' having all of the following:
a.3.d.1. Individual elements with a peak response in the
wavelength range exceeding 1,200 nm but not exceeding 3,000 nm; and
a.3.d.2. Any of the following:
a.3.d.2.a. A ratio of `scan direction' dimension of the detector
element to the `cross-scan direction' dimension of the detector
element of less than 3.8; or
a.3.d.2.b. Signal processing in the detector elements;
Note: 6A002.a.3.d does not control ``focal plane arrays'' (not
to exceed 32 elements) having detector elements limited solely to
germanium material.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 6A002.a.3.d, `cross-scan
direction' is defined as the axis parallel to the linear array of
detector elements and the `scan direction' is defined as the axis
perpendicular to the linear array of detector elements.
a.3.e. Non-``space-qualified'' linear (1-dimensional) ``focal
plane arrays'' having individual elements with a peak response in
the wavelength range exceeding 3,000 nm but not exceeding 30,000 nm;
a.3.f. Non-``space-qualified'' non-linear (2-dimensional)
infrared ``focal plane arrays'' based on `microbolometer' material
having individual elements with an unfiltered response in the
wavelength range equal to or exceeding 8,000 nm but not exceeding
14,000 nm;
Technical Note: For the purposes of 6A002.a.3.f,
`microbolometer' is defined as a thermal imaging detector that, as a
result of a temperature change in the detector caused by the
absorption of infrared radiation, is used to generate any usable
signal.
a.3.g. Non-``space-qualified'' ``focal plane arrays'' having all
of the following:
a.3.g.1. Individual detector elements with a peak response in
the wavelength range exceeding 400 nm but not exceeding 900 nm;
a.3.g.2. ``Specially designed'' or modified to achieve `charge
multiplication' and having a maximum ``radiant sensitivity''
exceeding 10 mA/W for wavelengths exceeding 760 nm; and
a.3.g.3. Greater than 32 elements;
b. ``Monospectral imaging sensors'' and ``multispectral imaging
sensors'', designed for remote sensing applications and having any
of the following:
b.1. An Instantaneous-Field-Of-View (IFOV) of less than 200
[mu]rad (microradians); or
b.2. Specified for operation in the wavelength range exceeding
400 nm but not exceeding 30,000 nm and having all the following:
b.2.a. Providing output imaging data in digital format; and
b.2.b. Having any of the following characteristics:
b.2.b.1. ``Space-qualified''; or
b.2.b.2. Designed for airborne operation, using other than
silicon detectors, and having an IFOV of less than 2.5 mrad
(milliradians);
Note: 6A002.b.1 does not control ``monospectral imaging
sensors'' with a peak response in the wavelength range exceeding 300
nm but not exceeding 900 nm and only incorporating any of the
following non-``space-qualified'' detectors or non -``space-
qualified'' ``focal plane arrays'':
a. Charge Coupled Devices (CCD) not designed or modified to
achieve `charge multiplication'; or
b. Complementary Metal Oxide Semiconductor (CMOS) devices not
designed or modified to achieve `charge multiplication'.
c. `Direct view' imaging equipment incorporating any of the
following:
c.1. Image intensifier tubes having the characteristics listed
in 6A002.a.2.a or 6A002.a.2.b;
c.2. ``Focal plane arrays'' having the characteristics listed in
6A002.a.3; or
c.3. Solid state detectors specified by 6A002.a.1;
Technical Note: For the purposes of 6A002.c,`direct view' refers
to imaging equipment that presents a visual image to a human
observer without converting the image into an electronic signal for
television display, and that cannot record or store the image
photographically, electronically or by any other means.
Note: 6A002.c does not control equipment as follows, when
incorporating other than GaAs or GaInAs photocathodes:
a. Industrial or civilian intrusion alarm, traffic or industrial
movement control or counting systems;
[[Page 71967]]
b. Medical equipment;
c. Industrial equipment used for inspection, sorting or analysis
of the properties of materials;
d. Flame detectors for industrial furnaces;
e. Equipment ``specially designed'' for laboratory use.
d. Special support ``components'' for optical sensors, as
follows:
d.1. ``Space-qualified'' cryocoolers;
d.2. Non-``space-qualified'' cryocoolers having a cooling source
temperature below 218 K (-55 [deg]C), as follows:
d.2.a. Closed cycle type with a specified Mean-Time-To-Failure
(MTTF) or Mean-Time-Between-Failures (MTBF), exceeding 2,500 hours;
d.2.b. Joule-Thomson (JT) self-regulating minicoolers having
bore (outside) diameters of less than 8 mm;
d.3. Optical sensing fibers specially fabricated either
compositionally or structurally, or modified by coating, to be
acoustically, thermally, inertially, electromagnetically or nuclear
radiation sensitive.
Note: 6A002.d.3 does not apply to encapsulated optical sensing
fibers ``specially designed'' for bore hole sensing applications.
e. [Reserved]
f. `Read-Out Integrated Circuits' (`ROIC') ``specially
designed'' for ``focal plane arrays'' specified by 6A002.a.3.
Note: 6A002.f does not apply to read-out integrated circuits
``specially designed'' for civil automotive applications.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 6A002.f, a `Read-Out
Integrated Circuit' (`ROIC') is an integrated circuit designed to
underlie or be bonded to a ``focal plane array'' (``FPA'') and used
to read-out (i.e., extract and register) signals produced by the
detector elements. At a minimum the `ROIC' reads the charge from the
detector elements by extracting the charge and applying a
multiplexing function in a manner that retains the relative spatial
position and orientation information of the detector elements for
processing inside or outside the `ROIC'.
6A003 Cameras, systems or equipment, and ``components'' therefor, as
follows (see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, NP, RS, AT, UN
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
NP applies to cameras controlled by NP Column 1
6A003.a.3 or a.4 and to plug-ins in
6A003.a.6 for cameras controlled by
6A003.a.3 or a.4.
RS applies to 6A003.b.3, 6A003.b.4.a, RS Column 1
6A003.b.4.c and to items controlled in
6A003.b.4.b that have a frame rate
greater than 60 Hz or that incorporate a
focal plane array with more than 111,000
elements, or to items in 6A003.b.4.b when
being exported or reexported to be
embedded in a civil product. (But see
Sec. 742.6(a)(2)(iii) and (v) for
certain exemptions).
RS applies to items controlled in RS Column 2
6A003.b.4.b that have a frame rate of 60
Hz or less and that incorporate a focal
plane array with not more than 111,000
elements if not being exported or
reexported to be embedded in a civil
product.
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
UN applies to 6A003.b.3 and b.4........... See Sec. 746.1(b) for UN
controls
License Requirement Note: Commodities that are not subject to the
ITAR but are of the type described in USML Category XII(c) are
controlled as cameras in ECCN 6A003 when they incorporate a camera
controlled in this ECCN.
Reporting Requirements
See Sec. 743.3 of the EAR for thermal camera reporting for
exports that are not authorized by an individually validated license
of thermal imaging cameras controlled by ECCN 6A003.b.4.b to
destinations in Country Group A:1 (see Supplement No. 1 to part 740
of the EAR), must be reported to BIS.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: $1,500, except N/A for 6A003.a.3 through a.6, b.1, b.3 and b.4
GBS: N/A
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be used to ship any commodity in
6A003.b.3 or b.4 to any of the destinations listed in Country Group
A:6 (See Supplement No. 1 to part 740 of the EAR).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See ECCNs 6E001 (``development''), 6E002
(``production''), and 6E201 (``use'') for technology for items
controlled under this entry. (2) Also see ECCN 6A203. (3) See ECCN
0A919 for foreign made military commodities that incorporate cameras
described in 6A003. (4) Section 744.9 imposes a license requirement
on cameras described in 6A003 if being exported, reexported, or
transferred (in-country) for use by a military end-user or for
incorporation into a commodity controlled by ECCN 0A919. (5) See
USML Category XII(c) and (e) for cameras subject to the ITAR.
Related Definitions: N/A.
Items:
a. Instrumentation cameras and ``specially designed''
``components'' therefor, as follows:
Note: Instrumentation cameras, controlled by 6A003.a.3 to
6A003.a.5, with modular structures should be evaluated by their
maximum capability, using plug-ins available according to the camera
manufacturer's specifications.
a.1. [Reserved]
a.2. [Reserved]
a.3. Electronic streak cameras having temporal resolution better
than 50 ns;
a.4. Electronic framing cameras having a speed exceeding
1,000,000 frames/s;
a.5. Electronic cameras having all of the following:
a.5.a. An electronic shutter speed (gating capability) of less
than 1[micro]s per full frame; and
a.5.b. A read out time allowing a framing rate of more than 125
full frames per second;
a.6. Plug-ins having all of the following characteristics:
a.6.a. ``Specially designed'' for instrumentation cameras which
have modular structures and that are controlled by 6A003.a; and
a.6.b. Enabling these cameras to meet the characteristics
specified by 6A003.a.3, 6A003.a.4 or 6A003.a.5, according to the
manufacturer's specifications;
b. Imaging cameras as follows:
Note: 6A003.b does not control television or video cameras
``specially designed'' for television broadcasting.
b.1. Video cameras incorporating solid state sensors, having a
peak response in the wavelength range exceeding 10 nm, but not
exceeding 30,000 nm and having all of the following:
b.1.a. Having any of the following:
b.1.a.1. More than 4 x 10\6\ ``active pixels'' per solid state
array for monochrome (black and white) cameras;
b.1.a.2. More than 4 x 10\6\ ``active pixels'' per solid state
array for color cameras incorporating three solid state arrays; or
b.1.a.3. More than 12 x 10\6\ ``active pixels'' for solid state
array color cameras incorporating one solid state array; and
b.1.b. Having any of the following:
b.1.b.1. Optical mirrors controlled by 6A004.a.;
b.1.b.2. Optical control equipment controlled by 6A004.d.; or
b.1.b.3. The capability for annotating internally generated
`camera tracking data';
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 6A003.b.1, digital video cameras should
be evaluated by the maximum number of ``active pixels'' used for
capturing moving images.
2. For the purposes of 6A003.b.1.b.3, `camera tracking data' is
the information
[[Page 71968]]
necessary to define camera line of sight orientation with respect to
the earth. This includes: (1) the horizontal angle the camera line
of sight makes with respect to the earth's magnetic field direction
and; (2) the vertical angle between the camera line of sight and the
earth's horizon.
b.2. Scanning cameras and scanning camera systems, having all of
the following:
b.2.a. A peak response in the wavelength range exceeding 10 nm,
but not exceeding 30,000 nm;
b.2.b. Linear detector arrays with more than 8,192 elements per
array; and
b.2.c. Mechanical scanning in one direction;
Note: 6A003.b.2 does not apply to scanning cameras and scanning
camera systems, ``specially designed'' for any of the following:
a. Industrial or civilian photocopiers;
b. Image scanners ``specially designed'' for civil, stationary,
close proximity scanning applications (e.g., reproduction of images
or print contained in documents, artwork or photographs); or
c. Medical equipment.
b.3. Imaging cameras incorporating image intensifier tubes
having the characteristics listed in 6A002.a.2.a or 6A002.a.2.b;
b.4. Imaging cameras incorporating ``focal plane arrays'' having
any of the following:
b.4.a. Incorporating ``focal plane arrays'' controlled by
6A002.a.3.a to 6A002.a.3.e;
b.4.b. Incorporating ``focal plane arrays'' controlled by
6A002.a.3.f; or
b.4.c. Incorporating ``focal plane arrays'' controlled by
6A002.a.3.g;
Note 1: Imaging cameras described in 6A003.b.4 include ``focal
plane arrays'' combined with sufficient ``signal processing''
electronics, beyond the read out integrated circuit, to enable as a
minimum the output of an analog or digital signal once power is
supplied.
Note 2: 6A003.b.4.a does not control imaging cameras
incorporating linear ``focal plane arrays'' with 12 elements or
fewer, not employing time-delay-and-integration within the element
and designed for any of the following:
a. Industrial or civilian intrusion alarm, traffic or industrial
movement control or counting systems;
b. Industrial equipment used for inspection or monitoring of
heat flows in buildings, equipment or industrial processes;
c. Industrial equipment used for inspection, sorting or analysis
of the properties of materials;
d. Equipment ``specially designed'' for laboratory use; or
e. Medical equipment.
Note 3: 6A003.b.4.b does not control imaging cameras having any
of the following:
a. A maximum frame rate equal to or less than 9 Hz;
b. Having all of the following:
1. Having a minimum horizontal or vertical `Instantaneous-Field-
of-View (IFOV)' of at least 2 mrad (milliradians);
2. Incorporating a fixed focal-length lens that is not designed
to be removed;
3. Not incorporating a `direct view' display; and
Technical Note: For the purposes of 6A003.b.4 Note 3.b.3,
'direct view' refers to an imaging camera operating in the infrared
spectrum that presents a visual image to a human observer using a
near-to-eye micro display incorporating any light-security
mechanism.
4. Having any of the following:
a. No facility to obtain a viewable image of the detected field-
of-view; or
b. The camera is designed for a single kind of application and
designed not to be user modified; or
Technical Note:
For the purposes of 6A003.b.4 Note 3.b.1, `Instantaneous-Field-
of-View (IFOV)' is the lesser figure of the `Horizontal IFOV' or the
`Vertical IFOV'.
`Horizontal IFOV' = horizontal Field-of-View (FOV)/number of
horizontal detector elements.
`Vertical IFOV' = vertical Field-of-View (FOV)/number of
vertical detector elements.
c. The camera is ``specially designed'' for installation into a
civilian passenger land vehicle and having all of the following:
1. The placement and configuration of the camera within the
vehicle are solely to assist the driver in the safe operation of the
vehicle;
2. Is operable only when installed in any of the following:
a. The civilian passenger land vehicle for which it was intended
and the vehicle weighs less than 4,500 kg (gross vehicle weight); or
b. A ``specially designed'', authorized maintenance test
facility; and
3. Incorporates an active mechanism that forces the camera not
to function when it is removed from the vehicle for which it was
intended.
Note: When necessary, details of the items will be provided,
upon request, to the Bureau of Industry and Security in order to
ascertain compliance with the conditions described in Note 3.b.4 and
Note 3.c in this Note to 6A003.b.4.b.
Note 4: 6A003.b.4.c does not apply to `imaging cameras' having
any of the following characteristics:
a. Having all of the following:
1. Where the camera is ``specially designed'' for installation
as an integrated component into indoor and wall-plug-operated
systems or equipment, limited by design for a single kind of
application, as follows:
a. Industrial process monitoring, quality control, or analysis
of the properties of materials;
b. Laboratory equipment ``specially designed'' for scientific
research;
c. Medical equipment;
d. Financial fraud detection equipment; and
2. Is only operable when installed in any of the following:
a. The system(s) or equipment for which it was intended; or
b. A ``specially designed,'' authorized maintenance facility;
and
3. Incorporates an active mechanism that forces the camera not
to function when it is removed from the system(s) or equipment for
which it was intended;
b. Where the camera is ``specially designed'' for installation
into a civilian passenger land vehicle or passenger and vehicle
ferries and having all of the following:
1. The placement and configuration of the camera within the
vehicle or ferry are solely to assist the driver or operator in the
safe operation of the vehicle or ferry;
2. Is only operable when installed in any of the following:
a. The civilian passenger land vehicle for which it was intended
and the vehicle weighs less than 4,500 kg (gross vehicle weight);
b. The passenger and vehicle ferry for which it was intended and
having a length overall (LOA) 65 m or greater; or
c. A ``specially designed'', authorized maintenance test
facility; and
3. Incorporates an active mechanism that forces the camera not
to function when it is removed from the vehicle for which it was
intended;
c. Limited by design to have a maximum ``radiant sensitivity''
of 10 mA/W or less for wavelengths exceeding 760 nm, having all of
the following:
1. Incorporating a response limiting mechanism designed not to
be removed or modified; and
2. Incorporates an active mechanism that forces the camera not
to function when the response limiting mechanism is removed; and
3. Not ``specially designed'' or modified for underwater use; or
d. Having all of the following:
1. Not incorporating a `direct view' or electronic image
display;
2. Has no facility to output a viewable image of the detected
field of view;
3. The ``focal plane array'' is only operable when installed in
the camera for which it was intended; and
4. The ``focal plane array'' incorporates an active mechanism
that forces it to be permanently inoperable when removed from the
camera for which it was intended.
Note: When necessary, details of the item will be provided, upon
request, to the Bureau of Industry and Security in order to
ascertain compliance with the conditions described in Note 4 above.
b.5. Imaging cameras incorporating solid-state detectors
specified by 6A002.a.1.
6A004 Optical equipment and ``components,'' as follows (see List of
Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements
See Sec. 743.1 of the EAR for reporting requirements for
exports under License Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: $3000
GBS: Yes for 6A004.a.1, a.2, a.4, .b, d.2, and .f.
[[Page 71969]]
Special Conditions for STA
STA: Paragraph (c)(2) of License Exception STA may not be used to
ship any commodity in 6A004.c or .d to any of the destinations
listed in Country Group A:6 (See Supplement No. 1 to part 740 of the
EAR).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) For optical mirrors or `aspheric optical
elements' ``specially designed'' for lithography ``equipment,'' see
ECCN 3B001. (2) See USML Category XII(e) for gimbals ``subject to
the ITAR.'' (3) See also 6A994.
Related Definitions: An `aspheric optical element' is any element
used in an optical system whose imaging surface or surfaces are
designed to depart from the shape of an ideal sphere.
Items:
a. Optical mirrors (reflectors) as follows:
Technical Note: For the purposes of 6A004.a, Laser Induced
Damage Threshold (LIDT) is measured according to ISO 21254-1:2011.
a.1. `Deformable mirrors' having an active optical aperture
greater than 10 mm and having any of the following, and ``specially
designed'' components therefor:
a.1.a. Having all the following:
a.1.a.1. A mechanical resonant frequency of 750 Hz or more; and
a.1.a.2. More than 200 actuators; or
a.1.b. A Laser Induced Damage Threshold (LIDT) being any of the
following:
a.1.b.1. Greater than 1 kW/cm\2\ using a ``CW laser''; or
a.1.b.2. Greater than 2 J/cm\2\ using 20 ns ``laser'' pulses at
20 Hz repetition rate;
Technical Notes:
For the purposes of 6A004.a.1:
1. `Deformable mirrors' are mirrors having any of the following:
a. A single continuous optical reflecting surface which is
dynamically deformed by the application of individual torques or
forces to compensate for distortions in the optical waveform
incident upon the mirror; or
b. Multiple optical reflecting elements that can be individually
and dynamically repositioned by the application of torques or forces
to compensate for distortions in the optical waveform incident upon
the mirror.
2. `Deformable mirrors' are also known as adaptive optic
mirrors.
a.2. Lightweight monolithic mirrors having an average
``equivalent density'' of less than 30 kg/m\2\ and a total mass
exceeding 10 kg;
a.3. Lightweight ``composite'' or foam mirror structures having
an average ``equivalent density'' of less than 30 kg/m\2\ and a
total mass exceeding 2 kg;
Note: 6A004.a.2 and 6A004.a.3 do not apply to mirrors
``specially designed'' to direct solar radiation for terrestrial
heliostat installations.
a.4. Mirrors ``specially designed'' for beam steering mirror
stages specified in 6A004.d.2.a with a flatness of [lambda]/10 or
better ([lambda] is equal to 633 nm) and having any of the
following:
a.4.a. Diameter or major axis length greater than or equal to
100 mm; or
a.4.b. Having all of the following:
a.4.b.1. Diameter or major axis length greater than 50 mm but
less than 100 mm; and
a.4.b.2. A Laser Induced Damage Threshold (LIDT) being any of
the following:
a.4.b.2.a. Greater than 10 kW/cm2 using a ``CW laser''; or
a.4.b.2.b. Greater than 20 J/cm2 using 20 ns ``laser'' pulses at
20 Hz repetition rate;
N.B. For optical mirrors ``specially designed'' for lithography
equipment, see 3B001.
b. Optical ``components'' made from zinc selenide (ZnSe) or zinc
sulfide (ZnS) with transmission in the wavelength range exceeding
3,000 nm but not exceeding 25,000 nm and having any of the
following:
b.1. Exceeding 100 cm\3\ in volume; or
b.2. Exceeding 80 mm in diameter or length of major axis and 20
mm in thickness (depth);
c. ``Space-qualified'' ``components'' for optical systems, as
follows:
c.1. ``Components'' lightweighted to less than 20% ``equivalent
density'' compared with a solid blank of the same aperture and
thickness;
c.2. Raw substrates, processed substrates having surface
coatings (single-layer or multi-layer, metallic or dielectric,
conducting, semiconducting or insulating) or having protective
films;
c.3. Segments or assemblies of mirrors designed to be assembled
in space into an optical system with a collecting aperture
equivalent to or larger than a single optic 1 m in diameter;
c.4. ``Components'' manufactured from ``composite'' materials
having a coefficient of linear thermal expansion, in any coordinate
direction, equal to or less than 5 x 10-6/K;
d. Optical control equipment as follows:
d.1. Equipment ``specially designed'' to maintain the surface
figure or orientation of the ``space-qualified'' ``components''
controlled by 6A004.c.1 or 6A004.c.3;
d.2. Steering, tracking, stabilisation and resonator alignment
equipment as follows:
d.2.a. Beam steering mirror stages designed to carry mirrors
having diameter or major axis length greater than 50 mm and having
all of the following, and ``specially designed'' electronic control
equipment therefor:
d.2.a.1. A maximum angular travel of 26 mrad or
more;
d.2.a.2. A mechanical resonant frequency of 500 Hz or more; and
d.2.a.3. An angular ``accuracy'' of 10 [mu]rad (microradians) or
less (better);
d.2.b. Resonator alignment equipment having bandwidths equal to
or more than 100 Hz and an ``accuracy'' of 10 [mu]rad or less
(better);
d.3. Gimbals having all of the following:
d.3.a. A maximum slew exceeding 5[deg];
d.3.b. A bandwidth of 100 Hz or more;
d.3.c. Angular pointing errors of 200 [mu]rad (microradians) or
less; and
d.3.d. Having any of the following:
d.3.d.1. Exceeding 0.15 m but not exceeding 1 m in diameter or
major axis length and capable of angular accelerations exceeding 2
rad (radians)/s\2\; or
d.3.d.2. Exceeding 1 m in diameter or major axis length and
capable of angular accelerations exceeding 0.5 rad (radians)/s\2\;
d.4. [Reserved]
e. `Aspheric optical elements' having all of the following:
e.1. Largest dimension of the optical-aperture greater than 400
mm;
e.2. Surface roughness less than 1 nm (rms) for sampling lengths
equal to or greater than 1 mm; and
e.3. Coefficient of linear thermal expansion's absolute
magnitude less than 3 x 10-6/K at 25[deg]C;
Technical Note:
1. For the purposes of 6A004.e, an `aspheric optical element' is
any element used in an optical system whose imaging surface or
surfaces are designed to depart from the shape of an ideal sphere.
2. For the purposes of 6A004.e.2, manufacturers are not required
to measure the surface roughness unless the optical element was
designed or manufactured with the intent to meet, or exceed, the
control parameter.
Note: 6A004.e does not control `aspheric optical elements'
having any of the following:
a. Largest optical-aperture dimension less than 1 m and focal
length to aperture ratio equal to or greater than 4.5:1;
b. Largest optical-aperture dimension equal to or greater than 1
m and focal length to aperture ratio equal to or greater than 7:1;
c. Designed as Fresnel, flyeye, stripe, prism or diffractive
optical elements;
d. Fabricated from borosilicate glass having a coefficient of
linear thermal expansion greater than 2.5 x 10-6/K at 25 [deg]C; or
e. An x-ray optical element having inner mirror capabilities
(e.g., tube-type mirrors).
f. Dynamic wavefront measuring equipment having all of the
following:
f.1. `Frame rates' equal to or more than 1 kHz; and
f.2. A wavefront accuracy equal to or less (better) than
[lambda]/20 at the designed wavelength.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 6A004.f, `frame rate' is a
frequency at which all ``active pixels'' in the ``focal plane
array'' are integrated for recording images projected by the
wavefront sensor optics.
6A005 ``Lasers'', ``components'' and optical equipment, as follows
(see List of Items Controlled), excluding items that are subject to
the export licensing authority of the Nuclear Regulatory Commission
(see 10 CFR part 110).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, NP, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
NP applies to lasers controlled by NP Column 1
6A005.a.2, a.3, a.4, b.2.b, b.3, b.4,
b.6.c, c.1.b, c.2.b, d.2, d.3.c, or d.4.c
that meet or exceed the technical
parameters described in 6A205.
[[Page 71970]]
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A for NP items
$3000 for all other items
GBS: Neodymium-doped (other than glass) ``lasers'' controlled by
6A005.b.6.d.2 (except 6A005.b.6.d.2.b) that have an output
wavelength exceeding 1,000 nm, but not exceeding 1,100 nm, and an
average or CW output power not exceeding 2 kW, and operate in a
pulse-excited, non- ``Q-switched'' multiple-transverse mode, or in a
continuously excited, multiple-transverse mode; Dye and Liquid
Lasers controlled by 6A005.c.1, c.2 and c.3, except for a pulsed
single longitudinal mode oscillator having an average output power
exceeding 1 W and a repetition rate exceeding 1 kHz if the ``pulse
duration'' is less than 100 ns; CO ``lasers'' controlled by
6A005.d.2 having a CW maximum rated single or multimode output power
not exceeding 10 kW; CO2 or CO/CO2 ``lasers''
controlled by 6A005.d.3 having an output wavelength in the range
from 9,000 to 11,000 nm and having a pulsed output not exceeding 2 J
per pulse and a maximum rated average single or multimode output
power not exceeding 5 kW; and CO2 ``lasers'' controlled
by 6A005.d.3 that operate in CW multiple-transverse mode, and having
a CW output power not exceeding 15 kW.
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls (1) See ECCN 6D001 for ``software'' for items
controlled under this entry. (2) See ECCNs 6E001 (``development''),
6E002 (``production''), and 6E201 (``use'') for technology for items
controlled under this entry. (3) Also see ECCNs 6A205 and 6A995. (4)
See ECCN 3B001 for excimer ``lasers'' ``specially designed'' for
lithography equipment. (5) ``Lasers'' ``especially designed'' or
prepared for use in isotope separation are subject to the export
licensing authority of the Nuclear Regulatory Commission (see 10 CFR
part 110). (6) See USML Category XII(b) and (e) for laser systems or
lasers subject to the ITAR. (7) See USML Category XVIII for certain
laser-based directed energy weapon systems, equipment, and
components subject to the ITAR.
Related Definitions: For the purposes of 6A005: (1) `Wall-plug
efficiency' is defined as the ratio of ``laser'' output power (or
``average output power'') to total electrical input power required
to operate the ``laser'', including the power supply/conditioning
and thermal conditioning/heat exchanger, see 6A005.a.6.b.1 and
6A005.b.6; (2) `Non-repetitive pulsed' refers to ``lasers'' that
produce either a single output pulse or that have a time interval
between pulses exceeding one minute, see Note 2 of 6A005 and
6A005.d.6.
Items:
Notes:
1. Pulsed ``lasers'' include those that run in a continuous wave
(CW) mode with pulses superimposed.
2. Excimer, semiconductor, chemical, CO, CO2, and `non-
repetitive pulsed' Nd:glass ``lasers'' are only specified by
6A005.d.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 6A005 Note 2, `non-
repetitive pulsed' refers to ``lasers'' that produce either a single
output pulse or that have a time interval between pulses exceeding
one minute.
3. 6A005 includes fiber ``lasers''.
4. The control status of ``lasers'' incorporating frequency
conversion (i.e., wavelength change) by means other than one
``laser'' pumping another ``laser'' is determined by applying the
control parameters for both the output of the source ``laser'' and
the frequency-converted optical output.
5. 6A005 does not control ``lasers'' as follows:
a. Ruby with output energy below 20 J;
b. Nitrogen;
c. Krypton.
6. For the purposes of 6A005.a and 6A005.b, `single transverse
mode' refers to ``lasers'' with a beam profile having an M2-factor
of less than 1.3, while `multiple transverse mode' refers to
``lasers'' with a beam profile having an M2-factor of 1.3 or higher
a. Non-``tunable'' continuous wave ``(CW) lasers'' having any of
the following:
a.1. Output wavelength less than 150 nm and output power
exceeding 1W;
a.2. Output wavelength of 150 nm or more but not exceeding 510
nm and output power exceeding 30 W;
Note: 6A005.a.2 does not control Argon ``lasers'' having an
output power equal to or less than 50 W.
a.3. Output wavelength exceeding 510 nm but not exceeding 540 nm
and any of the following:
a.3.a. `Single transverse mode' output and output power
exceeding 50 W; or
a.3.b. `Multiple transverse mode' output and output power
exceeding 150 W;
a.4. Output wavelength exceeding 540 nm but not exceeding 800 nm
and output power exceeding 30 W;
a.5. Output wavelength exceeding 800 nm but not exceeding 975 nm
and any of the following:
a.5.a. `Single transverse mode' output and output power
exceeding 50 W; or
a.5.b. `Multiple transverse mode' output and output power
exceeding 80 W;
a.6. Output wavelength exceeding 975 nm but not exceeding 1,150
nm and any of the following;
a.6.a. `Single transverse mode' output and any of the following:
a.6.a.1. Output power exceeding 1,000 W; or
a.6.a.2. Having all of the following:
a.6.a.2.a. Output power exceeding 500 W; and
a.6.a.2.b. Spectral bandwidth less than 40 GHz; or
a.6.b. `Multiple transverse mode' output and any of the
following:
a.6.b.1. `Wall-plug efficiency' exceeding 18% and output power
exceeding 1,000 W; or
a.6.b.2. Output power exceeding 2 kW;
Note 1: 6A005.a.6.b does not control `multiple transverse mode',
industrial ``lasers'' with output power exceeding 2 kW and not
exceeding 6 kW with a total mass greater than 1,200 kg. For the
purpose of this note, total mass includes all ``components''
required to operate the ``laser,'' e.g., ``laser,'' power supply,
heat exchanger, but excludes external optics for beam conditioning
or delivery.
Note 2: 6A005.a.6.b does not apply to `multiple transverse
mode', industrial ``lasers'' having any of the following:
a. [Reserved];
b. Output power exceeding 1 kW but not exceeding 1.6 kW and
having a BPP exceeding 1.25 mm[middot]mrad;
c. Output power exceeding 1.6 kW but not exceeding 2.5 kW and
having a BPP exceeding 1.7 mm[middot]mrad;
d. Output power exceeding 2.5 kW but not exceeding 3.3 kW and
having a BPP exceeding 2.5 mm[middot]mrad;
e. Output power exceeding 3.3 kW but not exceeding 6 kW and
having a BPP exceeding 3.5 mm[middot]mrad;
f. [Reserved]
g. [Reserved]
h. Output power exceeding 6 kW but not exceeding 8 kW and having
a BPP exceeding 12 mm[middot]mrad; or
i. Output power exceeding 8 kW but not exceeding 10 kW and
having a BPP exceeding 24 mm[middot]mrad;
a.7. Output wavelength exceeding 1,150 nm but not exceeding
1,555 nm and any of the following:
a.7.a. `Single transverse mode' and output power exceeding 50 W;
or
a.7.b. `Multiple transverse mode' and output power exceeding 80
W;
a.8. Output wavelength exceeding 1,555 nm but not exceeding
1,850 nm and output power exceeding 1 W;
a.9. Output wavelength exceeding 1,850 nm but not exceeding
2,100 nm, and any of the following:
a.9.a. `Single transverse mode' and output power exceeding 1 W;
or
a.9.b. `Multiple transverse mode' output and output power
exceeding 120 W; or
a.10. Output wavelength exceeding 2,100 nm and output power
exceeding 1 W;
b. Non-``tunable'' ``pulsed lasers'' having any of the
following:
b.1. Output wavelength less than 150 nm and any of the
following:
b.1.a. Output energy exceeding 50 mJ per pulse and ``peak
power'' exceeding 1 W; or
b.1.b. ``Average output power'' exceeding 1 W;
b.2. Output wavelength of 150 nm or more but not exceeding 510
nm and any of the following:
b.2.a. Output energy exceeding 1.5 J per pulse and ``peak
power'' exceeding 30 W; or
b.2.b. ``Average output power'' exceeding 30 W;
Note: 6A005.b.2.b does not control Argon ``lasers'' having an
``average output power'' equal to or less than 50 W.
b.3. Output wavelength exceeding 510 nm, but not exceeding 540
nm and any of the following:
b.3.a. `Single transverse mode' output and any of the following:
[[Page 71971]]
b.3.a.1. Output energy exceeding 1.5 J per pulse and ``peak
power'' exceeding 50 W; or
b.3.a.2. ``Average output power'' exceeding 80 W; or
b.3.b. `Multiple transverse mode' output and any of the
following:
b.3.b.1. Output energy exceeding 1.5 J per pulse and ``peak
power'' exceeding 150 W; or
b.3.b.2. ``Average output power'' exceeding 150 W;
b.4. Output wavelength exceeding 540 nm but not exceeding 800 nm
and any of the following:
b.4.a. ``Pulse duration'' less than 1 ps and any of the
following:
b.4.a.1. Output energy exceeding 0.005 J per pulse and ``peak
power'' exceeding 5 GW; or
b.4.a.2. ``Average output power'' exceeding 20 W; or
b.4.b. ``Pulse duration'' equal to or exceeding 1 ps and any of
the following:
b.4.b.1. Output energy exceeding 1.5 J per pulse and ``peak
power'' exceeding 30 W; or
b.4.b.2. ``Average output power'' exceeding 30 W;
b.5. Output wavelength exceeding 800 nm but not exceeding 975 nm
and any of the following:
b.5.a. ``Pulse duration'' less than 1ps and any of the
following:
b.5.a.1. Output energy exceeding 0.005 J per pulse and ``peak
power'' exceeding 5 GW; or
b.5.a.2. `Single transverse mode' output and ``average output
power'' exceeding 20 W;
b.5.b. ``Pulse duration'' equal to or exceeding 1 ps and not
exceeding 1 [mu]s and any of the following:
b.5.b.1. Output energy exceeding 0.5 J per pulse and ``peak
power'' exceeding 50 W;
b.5.b.2. `Single transverse mode' output and ``average output
power'' exceeding 20 W; or
b.5.b.3. `Multiple transverse mode' output and ``average output
power'' exceeding 50 W; or
b.5.c. ``Pulse duration'' exceeding 1 [mu]s and any of the
following:
b.5.c.1. Output energy exceeding 2 J per pulse and ``peak
power'' exceeding 50 W;
b.5.c.2. `Single transverse mode' output and ``average output
power'' exceeding 50 W; or
b.5.c.3. `Multiple transverse mode' output and ``average output
power'' exceeding 80 W.
b.6. Output wavelength exceeding 975 nm but not exceeding 1,150
nm and any of the following:
b.6.a. ``Pulse duration'' of less than 1 ps, and any of the
following:
b.6.a.1. Output ``peak power'' exceeding 2 GW per pulse;
b.6.a.2. ``Average output power'' exceeding 30 W; or
b.6.a.3. Output energy exceeding 0.002 J per pulse;
b.6.b. ``Pulse duration'' equal to or exceeding 1 ps and less
than 1 ns, and any of the following:
b.6.b.1. Output ``peak power'' exceeding 5 GW per pulse;
b.6.b.2. ``Average output power'' exceeding 50 W; or
b.6.b.3. Output energy exceeding 0.1 J per pulse;
b.6.c. ``Pulse duration'' equal to or exceeding 1 ns but not
exceeding 1 [mu]s and any of the following:
b.6.c.1. `Single transverse mode' output and any of the
following:
b.6.c.1.a. ``Peak power'' exceeding 100 MW;
b.6.c.1.b. ``Average output power'' exceeding 20 W limited by
design to a maximum pulse repetition frequency less than or equal to
1 kHz;
b.6.c.1.c. `Wall-plug efficiency' exceeding 12%, ``average
output power'' exceeding 100 W and capable of operating at a pulse
repetition frequency greater than 1 kHz;
b.6.c.1.d. ``Average output power'' exceeding 150 W and capable
of operating at a pulse repetition frequency greater than 1 kHz; or
b.6.c.1.e. Output energy exceeding 2 J per pulse; or
b.6.c.2. `Multiple transverse mode' output and any of the
following:
b.6.c.2.a. ``Peak power'' exceeding 400 MW;
b.6.c.2.b. `Wall-plug efficiency' exceeding 18% and ``average
output power'' exceeding 500 W;
b.6.c.2.c. ``Average output power'' exceeding 2 kW; or
b.6.c.2.d. Output energy exceeding 4 J per pulse; or
b.6.d. ``Pulse duration'' exceeding 1 [mu]s and any of the
following:
b.6.d.1. `Single transverse mode' output and any of the
following:
b.6.d.1.a. ``Peak power'' exceeding 500 kW;
b.6.d.1.b. `Wall-plug efficiency' exceeding 12% and ``average
output power'' exceeding 100 W; or
b.6.d.1.c. ``Average output power'' exceeding 150 W; or
b.6.d.2. `Multiple transverse mode' output and any of the
following:
b.6.d.2.a. ``Peak power'' exceeding 1 MW;
b.6.d.2.b. `Wall-plug efficiency' exceeding 18% and ``average
output power'' exceeding 500 W; or
b.6.d.2.c. ``Average output power'' exceeding 2 kW;
b.7. Output wavelength exceeding 1,150 nm but not exceeding
1,555 nm and any of the following:
b.7.a. ``Pulse duration'' not exceeding 1 [mu]s and any of the
following:
b.7.a.1. Output energy exceeding 0.5 J per pulse and ``peak
power'' exceeding 50 W;
b.7.a.2. `Single transverse mode' output and ``average output
power'' exceeding 20 W; or
b.7.a.3. `Multiple transverse mode' output and ``average output
power'' exceeding 50 W; or
b.7.b. ``Pulse duration'' exceeding 1 [mu]s and any of the
following:
b.7.b.1. Output energy exceeding 2 J per pulse and ``peak
power'' exceeding 50 W;
b.7.b.2. `Single transverse mode' output and ``average output
power'' exceeding 50 W; or
b.7.b.3. `Multiple transverse mode' output and ``average output
power'' exceeding 80 W;
b.8. Output wavelength exceeding 1,555 nm but not exceeding
1,850 nm, and any of the following:
b.8.a. Output energy exceeding 100 mJ per pulse and ``peak
power'' exceeding 1 W; or
b.8.b. ``Average output power'' exceeding 1 W;
b.9. Output wavelength exceeding 1,850 nm but not exceeding
2,100 nm, and any of the following:
b.9.a. `Single transverse mode' and any of the following:
b.9.a.1. Output energy exceeding 100 mJ per pulse and ``peak
power'' exceeding 1 W; or
b.9.a.2. ``Average output power'' exceeding 1 W;
b.9.b. `Multiple transverse mode' and any of the following:
b.9.b.1. Output energy exceeding 100 mJ per pulse and ``peak
power'' exceeding 10 kW; or
b.9.b.2. ``Average output power'' exceeding 120 W; or
b.10. Output wavelength exceeding 2,100 nm and any of the
following:
b.10.a. Output energy exceeding 100 mJ per pulse and ``peak
power'' exceeding 1 W; or
b.10.b. ``Average output power'' exceeding 1 W;
c. ``Tunable'' lasers having any of the following:
c.1. Output wavelength less than 600 nm and any of the
following:
c.1.a. Output energy exceeding 50 mJ per pulse and ``peak
power'' exceeding 1 W; or
c.1.b. Average or CW output power exceeding 1W;
Note: 6A005.c.1 does not apply to dye ``lasers'' or other liquid
``lasers,'' having a multimode output and a wavelength of 150 nm or
more but not exceeding 600 nm and all of the following:
1. Output energy less than 1.5 J per pulse or a ``peak power''
less than 20 W; and
2. Average or CW output power less than 20 W.
c.2. Output wavelength of 600 nm or more but not exceeding 1,400
nm, and any of the following:
c.2.a. Output energy exceeding 1 J per pulse and ``peak power''
exceeding 20 W; or
c.2.b. Average or CW output power exceeding 20 W; or
c.3. Output wavelength exceeding 1,400 nm and any of the
following:
c.3.a. Output energy exceeding 50 mJ per pulse and ``peak
power'' exceeding 1 W; or
c.3.b. Average or CW output power exceeding 1 W;
d. Other ``lasers'', not controlled by 6A005.a, 6A005.b, or
6A005.c as follows:
d.1. Semiconductor ``lasers'' as follows:
Notes:
1. 6A005.d.1 includes semiconductor ``lasers'' having optical
output connectors (e.g., fiber optic pigtails).
2. The control status of semiconductor ``lasers'' ``specially
designed'' for other equipment is determined by the control status
of the other equipment.
d.1.a. Individual single-transverse mode semiconductor
``lasers'' having any of the following:
d.1.a.1. Wavelength equal to or less than 1,570 nm and average
or CW output power, exceeding 2.0 W; or
d.1.a.2. Wavelength greater than 1,570 nm and average or CW
output power, exceeding 500 mW;
[[Page 71972]]
d.1.b. Individual `multiple-transverse mode' semiconductor
``lasers'' having any of the following:
d.1.b.1. Wavelength of less than 1,400 nm and average or CW
output power, exceeding 25 W;
d.1.b.2. Wavelength equal to or greater than 1,400 nm and less
than 1,900 nm and average or CW output power, exceeding 2.5 W; or
d.1.b.3. Wavelength equal to or greater than 1,900 nm and
average or CW output power, exceeding 1 W;
d.1.c. Individual semiconductor ``laser'' `bars' having any of
the following:
d.1.c.1. Wavelength of less than 1,400 nm and average or CW
output power, exceeding 100 W;
d.1.c.2. Wavelength equal to or greater than 1,400 nm and less
than 1,900 nm and average or CW output power, exceeding 25 W; or
d.1.c.3. Wavelength equal to or greater than 1,900 nm and
average or CW output power, exceeding 10 W;
d.1.d. Semiconductor ``laser'' `stacked arrays' (two dimensional
arrays) having any of the following:
d.1.d.1. Wavelength less than 1,400 nm and having any of the
following:
d.1.d.1.a. Average or CW total output power less than 3 kW and
having average or CW output `power density' greater than 500 W/
cm\2\;
d.1.d.1.b. Average or CW total output power equal to or
exceeding 3 kW but less than or equal to 5 kW, and having average or
CW output `power density' greater than 350W/cm\2\;
d.1.d.1.c. Average or CW total output power exceeding 5 kW;
d.1.d.1.d. Peak pulsed `power density' exceeding 2,500 W/cm\2\;
or
Note: 6A005.d.1.d.1.d does not apply to epitaxially-fabricated
monolithic devices.
d.1.d.1.e. Spatially coherent average or CW total output power,
greater than 150 W;
d.1.d.2. Wavelength greater than or equal to 1,400 nm but less
than 1,900 nm, and having any of the following:
d.1.d.2.a. Average or CW total output power less than 250 W and
average or CW output `power density' greater than 150 W/cm2;
d.1.d.2.b. Average or CW total output power equal to or
exceeding 250 W but less than or equal to 500 W, and having average
or CW output `power density' greater than 50W/cm\2\;
d.1.d.2.c. Average or CW total output power exceeding 500 W;
d.1.d.2.d. Peak pulsed `power density' exceeding 500 W/cm\2\; or
Note: 6A005.d.1.d.2.d does not apply to epitaxially-fabricated
monolithic devices.
d.1.d.2.e. Spatially coherent average or CW total output power,
exceeding 15 W;
d.1.d.3. Wavelength greater than or equal to 1,900 nm and having
any of the following:
d.1.d.3.a. Average or CW output `power density' greater than 50
W/cm\2\;
d.1.d.3.b. Average or CW output power greater than 10 W; or
d.1.d.3.c. Spatially coherent average or CW total output power,
exceeding 1.5 W; or
d.1.d.4. At least one ``laser'' `bar' specified by 6A005.d.1.c;
Technical Note: For the purposes of 6A005.d.1.d, 'power density'
means the total ``laser'' output power divided by the emitter
surface area of the `stacked array'.
d.1.e. Semiconductor ``laser'' `stacked arrays', other than
those specified by 6A005.d.1.d, having all of the following:
d.1.e.1. ``Specially designed'' or modified to be combined with
other `stacked arrays' to form a larger `stacked array'; and
d.1.e.2. Integrated connections, common for both electronics and
cooling;
Note 1: `Stacked arrays', formed by combining semiconductor
``laser'' `stacked arrays' specified by 6A005.d.1.e, that are not
designed to be further combined or modified are specified by
6A005.d.1.d.
Note 2: `Stacked arrays', formed by combining semiconductor
``laser'' `stacked arrays' specified by 6A005.d.1.e, that are
designed to be further combined or modified are specified by
6A005.d.1.e.
Note 3: 6A005.d.1.e does not apply to modular assemblies of
single `bars' designed to be fabricated into end to end stacked
linear arrays.
Technical Notes:
For the purposes of 6A005.d.1.e:
1. Semiconductor ``lasers'' are commonly called ``laser''
diodes.
2. A `bar' (also called a semiconductor ``laser'' `bar', a
``laser'' diode `bar' or diode `bar') consists of multiple
semiconductor ``lasers'' in a one-dimensional array.
3. A `stacked array' consists of multiple `bars' forming a two-
dimensional array of semiconductor ``lasers''.
d.2. Carbon monoxide (CO) ``lasers'' having any of the
following:
d.2.a. Output energy exceeding 2 J per pulse and ``peak power''
exceeding 5 kW; or
d.2.b. Average or CW output power, exceeding 5 kW;
d.3. Carbon dioxide (CO2) ``lasers'' having any of
the following:
d.3.a. CW output power exceeding 15 kW;
d.3.b. Pulsed output with ``pulse duration'' exceeding 10 [mu]s
and any of the following:
d.3.b.1. ``Average output power'' exceeding 10 kW; or
d.3.b.2. ``Peak power'' exceeding 100 kW; or
d.3.c. Pulsed output with a ``pulse duration'' equal to or less
than 10 [mu]s and any of the following:
d.3.c.1. Pulse energy exceeding 5 J per pulse; or
d.3.c.2. ``Average output power'' exceeding 2.5 kW;
d.4. Excimer ``lasers'' having any of the following:
d.4.a. Output wavelength not exceeding 150 nm and any of the
following:
d.4.a.1. Output energy exceeding 50 mJ per pulse; or
d.4.a.2. ``Average output power'' exceeding 1 W;
d.4.b. Output wavelength exceeding 150 nm but not exceeding 190
nm and any of the following:
d.4.b.1. Output energy exceeding 1.5 J per pulse; or
d.4.b.2. ``Average output power'' exceeding 120 W;
d.4.c. Output wavelength exceeding 190 nm but not exceeding 360
nm and any of the following:
d.4.c.1. Output energy exceeding 10 J per pulse; or
d.4.c.2. ``Average output power'' exceeding 500 W; or
d.4.d. Output wavelength exceeding 360 nm and any of the
following:
d.4.d.1. Output energy exceeding 1.5 J per pulse; or
d.4.d.2. ``Average output power'' exceeding 30 W;
Note: For excimer ``lasers'' ``specially designed'' for
lithography equipment, see 3B001.
d.5. ``Chemical lasers'' as follows:
d.5.a. Hydrogen Fluoride (HF) ``lasers';
d.5.b. Deuterium Fluoride (DF) ``lasers'';
d.5.c. `Transfer lasers' as follows:
d.5.c.1. Oxygen Iodine (O2-I) ``lasers'';
d.5.c.2. Deuterium Fluoride-Carbon dioxide (DF-CO2)
``lasers'';
Technical Note: For the purposes of 6A005.d.5.c, `transfer
lasers' are ``lasers'' in which the lasing species are excited
through the transfer of energy by collision of a non-lasing atom or
molecule with a lasing atom or molecule species.
d.6. `Non-repetitive pulsed' Neodymium (Nd) glass ``lasers''
having any of the following:
d.6.a. A ``pulse duration'' not exceeding 1 [mu]s and output
energy exceeding 50 J per pulse; or
d.6.b. A ``pulse duration'' exceeding 1 [mu]s and output energy
exceeding 100 J per pulse;
e. ``Components'' as follows:
e.1. Mirrors cooled either by `active cooling' or by heat pipe
cooling;
Technical Note: For the purposes of 6A005.e.1, `active cooling'
is a cooling technique for optical ``components'' using flowing
fluids within the subsurface (nominally less than 1 mm below the
optical surface) of the optical component to remove heat from the
optic.
e.2. Optical mirrors or transmissive or partially transmissive
optical or electro-optical-''components,'' other than fused tapered
fiber combiners and Multi-Layer Dielectric gratings (MLDs),
``specially designed'' for use with controlled ``lasers'';
Note to 6A005.e.2: Fiber combiners and MLDs are specified by
6A005.e.3.
e.3. Fiber ``laser'' ``components'' as follows:
e.3.a. Multimode to multimode fused tapered fiber combiners
having all of the following:
e.3.a.1. An insertion loss better (less) than or equal to 0.3 dB
maintained at a rated total average or CW output power (excluding
output power transmitted through the single mode core if present)
exceeding 1,000 W; and
e.3.a.2. Number of input fibers equal to or greater than 3;
e.3.b. Single mode to multimode fused tapered fiber combiners
having all of the following:
e.3.b.1. An insertion loss better (less) than 0.5 dB maintained
at a rated total average or CW output power exceeding 4,600 W;
e.3.b.2. Number of input fibers equal to or greater than 3; and
e.3.b.3. Having any of the following:
e.3.b.3.a. A Beam Parameter Product (BPP) measured at the output
not exceeding 1.5 mm mrad for a number of input fibers less than or
equal to 5; or
e.3.b.3.b. A BPP measured at the output not exceeding 2.5 mm
mrad for a number of input fibers greater than 5;
[[Page 71973]]
e.3.c. MLDs having all of the following:
e.3.c.1. Designed for spectral or coherent beam combination of 5
or more fiber ``lasers;'' and
e.3.c.2. CW ``Laser'' Induced Damage Threshold (LIDT) greater
than or equal to 10 kW/cm\2\;
f. Optical equipment as follows:
N.B.: For shared aperture optical elements, capable of operating
in ``Super-High Power Laser'' (``SHPL'') applications, see the U.S.
Munitions List (22 CFR part 121).
f.1. [Reserved]
N.B.: For items previously specified by 6A005.f.1, see 6A004.f.
f.2. ``Laser'' diagnostic equipment ``specially designed'' for
dynamic measurement of ``SHPL'' system angular beam steering errors
and having an angular ``accuracy'' of 10 [mu]rad (microradians) or
less (better);
f.3. Optical equipment and ``components'', ``specially
designed'' for coherent beam combination in a phased-array ``SHPL''
system and having any of the following:
f.3.a. An ``accuracy'' of 0.1 [mu]m or less, for wavelengths
greater than 1 [mu]m; or
f.3.b. An ``accuracy'' of [lgr]/10 or less (better) at the
designed wavelength, for wavelengths equal to or less than 1 [mu]m;
f.4. Projection telescopes ``specially designed'' for use with
``SHPL'' systems;
g. `Laser acoustic detection equipment' having all of the
following:
g.1. CW ``laser'' output power greater than or equal to 20 mW;
g.2. ``Laser'' frequency stability equal to or better (less)
than 10 MHz;
g.3. ``Laser'' wavelengths equal to or exceeding 1,000 nm but
not exceeding 2,000 nm;
g.4. Optical system resolution better (less) than 1 nm; and
g.5. Optical Signal to Noise ratio equal to or exceeding 10\3\.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 6A005.g, `laser acoustic
detection equipment' is sometimes referred to as a ``Laser''
Microphone or Particle Flow Detection Microphone.
6A006 ``Magnetometers'', ``magnetic gradiometers'', ``intrinsic
magnetic gradiometers'', underwater electric field sensors,
``compensation systems'', and ``specially designed'' ``components''
therefor, as follows (see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements
See Sec. 743.1 of the EAR for reporting requirements for
exports under License Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: $1500, N/A for 6A006.a.1; ``Magnetometers'' and subsystems
defined in 6A006.a.2 using optically pumped or nuclear precession
(proton/Overhauser) having a `sensitivity' lower (better) than 2 pT
(rms) per square root Hz; and 6A006.d, and 6A006.e.
GBS: N/A
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be used to ship any commodity
in: 6A006.a.1; or 6A006.a.2; or 6A006.c.1 ``Magnetic gradiometers''
using multiple ``magnetometers'' specified by 6A006.a.1 or
6.A006.a.2; or 6A006.d or .e (only for underwater receivers
incorporating magnetometers specified in 6A006.a.1 or 6A006.a.2) to
any of the destinations listed in Country Group A:6 (See Supplement
No.1 to part 740 of the EAR).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: See also 6A996. This entry does not control
instruments ``specially designed'' for fishery applications or
biomagnetic measurements for medical diagnostics.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. ``Magnetometers'' and subsystems, as follows:
a.1. ``Magnetometers'' using ``superconductive'' (SQUID)
``technology'' and having any of the following:
a.1.a. SQUID systems designed for stationary operation, without
``specially designed'' subsystems designed to reduce in-motion
noise, and having a `sensitivity' equal to or lower (better) than 50
fT (rms) per square root Hz at a frequency of 1 Hz; or
a.1.b. SQUID systems having an in-motion-magnetometer
`sensitivity' lower (better) than 20 pT (rms) per square root Hz at
a frequency of 1 Hz and ``specially designed'' to reduce in-motion
noise;
a.2. ``Magnetometers'' using optically pumped or nuclear
precession (proton/Overhauser) ``technology'' having a `sensitivity'
lower (better) than 20 pT (rms) per square root Hz at a frequency of
1 Hz;
a.3. ``Magnetometers'' using fluxgate ``technology'' having a
'sensitivity' equal to or lower (better) than 10 pT (rms) per square
root Hz at a frequency of 1 Hz;
a.4. Induction coil ``magnetometers'' having a `sensitivity'
lower (better) than any of the following:
a.4.a. 0.05 nT (rms)/square root Hz at frequencies of less than
1 Hz;
a.4.b. 1 x 10-3 nT (rms)/square root Hz at
frequencies of 1 Hz or more but not exceeding 10 Hz; or
a.4.c. 1 x 10-4 nT (rms)/square root Hz at
frequencies exceeding 10 Hz;
a.5. Fiber optic ``magnetometers'' having a `sensitivity' lower
(better) than 1 nT (rms) per square root Hz;
b. Underwater electric field sensors having a `sensitivity'
lower (better) than 8 nanovolt per meter per square root Hz when
measured at 1 Hz;
c. ``Magnetic gradiometers'' as follows:
c.1. ``Magnetic gradiometers'' using multiple ``magnetometers''
controlled by 6A006.a;
c.2. Fiber optic ``intrinsic magnetic gradiometers'' having a
magnetic gradient field `sensitivity' lower (better) than 0.3 nT/m
(rms) per square root Hz;
c.3. ``Intrinsic magnetic gradiometers'', using ``technology''
other than fiber-optic ``technology'', having a magnetic gradient
field `sensitivity' lower (better) than 0.015 nT/m (rms) per square
root Hz;
d. ``Compensation systems'' for magnetic and underwater electric
field sensors resulting in a performance equal to or better than the
control parameters of 6A006.a, 6A006.b, and 6A006.c; and
e. Underwater electromagnetic receivers incorporating magnetic
field sensors specified by 6A006.a or underwater electric field
sensors specified by 6A006.b.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 6A006, `sensitivity' (noise
level) is the root mean square of the device-limited noise floor
which is the lowest signal that can be measured.
6A007 Gravity meters (gravimeters) and gravity gradiometers, as
follows (see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
MT applies to 6A007.b and .c when the MT Column 1
accuracies in 6A007.b.1 and b.2 are met
or exceeded.
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: $3000; N/A for MT
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See USML Category XII(d) for certain gravity
meters (gravimeters) and gravity gradiometers subject to the ITAR.
(2) See also ECCNs 6A107, 6A997, and 7A611.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Gravity meters designed or modified for ground use and having
a static ``accuracy'' of less (better) than 10 [mu]Gal;
Note: 6A007.a does not control ground gravity meters of the
quartz element (Worden) type.
b. Gravity meters designed for mobile platforms and having all
of the following:
b.1. A static ``accuracy'' of less (better) than 0.7 mGal; and
b.2. An in-service (operational) ``accuracy'' of less (better)
than 0.7 mGal having a `time-to-steady-state registration' of less
than 2 minutes under any combination of attendant corrective
compensations and motional influences;
[[Page 71974]]
Technical Note: For the purposes of 6A007.b.2, 'time-to-steady-
state registration' (also referred to as the gravimeter's response
time) is the time over which the disturbing effects of platform
induced accelerations (high frequency noise) are reduced.
c. Gravity gradiometers.
6A008 Radar systems, equipment and assemblies, having any of the
following (see List of Items Controlled), and ``specially designed''
``components'' therefor.
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, RS, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
MT applies to items that are designed for MT Column 1
airborne applications and that are usable
in systems controlled for MT reasons.
RS applies to 6A008.j.1................... RS Column 1
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements
See Sec. 743.1 of the EAR for reporting requirements for
exports under License Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: $5000; N/A for MT and for 6A008.j.1.
GBS: Yes, for 6A008.b, .c, and l.1 only
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be used to ship any commodity in
6A008.d, 6A008.h or 6A008.k to any of the destinations listed in
Country Group A:6 (See Supplement No. 1 to part 740 of the EAR).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See also ECCNs 6A108 and 6A998. ECCN 6A998
controls, inter alia, the Light Detection and Ranging (LIDAR)
equipment excluded by the note to paragraph j of this ECCN (6A008).
(2) See USML Category XII(b) for certain LIDAR, Laser Detection and
Ranging (LADAR), or range-gated systems subject to the ITAR.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
Note: 6A008 does not control:
--Secondary surveillance radar (SSR);
--Civil Automotive Radar;
--Displays or monitors used for air traffic control (ATC);
--Meteorological (weather) radar;
--Precision Approach Radar (PAR) equipment conforming to ICAO
standards and employing electronically steerable linear (1-
dimensional) arrays or mechanically positioned passive antennas.
a. Operating at frequencies from 40 GHz to 230 GHz and having
any of the following:
a.1. An average output power exceeding 100 mW; or
a.2. Locating ``accuracy'' of 1 m or less (better) in range and
0.2 degree or less (better) in azimuth;
b. A tunable bandwidth exceeding 6.25% of the
`center operating frequency';
Technical Note: For the purposes of 6A008.b, the `center
operating frequency' equals one half of the sum of the highest plus
the lowest specified operating frequencies.
c. Capable of operating simultaneously on more than two carrier
frequencies;
d. Capable of operating in synthetic aperture (SAR), inverse
synthetic aperture (ISAR) radar mode, or sidelooking airborne (SLAR)
radar mode;
e. Incorporating electronically scanned array antennae;
Technical Note: For the purposes of 6A008.e, electronically
scanned array antennae are also known as electronically steerable
array antennae.
f. Capable of heightfinding non-cooperative targets;
g. ``Specially designed'' for airborne (balloon or airframe
mounted) operation and having Doppler ``signal processing'' for the
detection of moving targets;
h. Employing processing of radar signals and using any of the
following:
h.1. ``Radar spread spectrum'' techniques; or
h.2. ``Radar frequency agility'' techniques;
i. Providing ground-based operation with a maximum `instrumented
range' exceeding 185 km;
Note: 6A008.i does not control:
a. Fishing ground surveillance radar;
b. Ground radar equipment ``specially designed'' for en route
air traffic control, and having all of the following:
1. A maximum `instrumented range' of 500 km or less;
2. Configured so that radar target data can be transmitted only
one way from the radar site to one or more civil ATC centers;
3. Contains no provisions for remote control of the radar scan
rate from the en route ATC center; and
4. Permanently installed;
c. Weather balloon tracking radars.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 6A008.i, `instrumented
range' is the specified unambiguous display range of a radar.
j. Being ``laser'' radar or Light Detection and Ranging (LIDAR)
equipment and having any of the following:
j.1. ``Space-qualified'';
j.2. Employing coherent heterodyne or homodyne detection
techniques and having an angular resolution of less (better) than 20
[mu]rad (microradians); or
j.3. Designed for carrying out airborne bathymetric littoral
surveys to International Hydrographic Organization (IHO) Order 1a
Standard (5th Edition February 2008) for Hydrographic Surveys or
better, and using one or more ``lasers'' with a wavelength exceeding
400 nm but not exceeding 600 nm;
Note 1: LIDAR equipment ``specially designed'' for surveying is
only specified by 6A008.j.3.
Note 2: 6A008.j does not apply to LIDAR equipment ``specially
designed'' for meteorological observation.
Note 3: Parameters in the IHO Order 1a Standard 5th Edition
February 2008 are summarized as follows:
Horizontal Accuracy (95% Confidence Level)= 5 m + 5% of depth.
Depth Accuracy for Reduced Depths (95% confidence level) =
[radic](a\2\ + (b*d)\2\) where:
a = 0.5 m = constant depth error, i.e., the sum of all constant
depth errors
b = 0.013 = factor of depth dependent error
b*d = depth dependent error, i.e., the sum of all depth dependent
errors
d = depth
Feature Detection = Cubic features 2 m in depths up
to 40 m; 10% of depth beyond 40 m.
k. Having ``signal processing'' sub-systems using ``pulse
compression'' and having any of the following:
k.1. A ``pulse compression'' ratio exceeding 150; or
k.2. A compressed pulse width of less than 200 ns; or
Note: 6A008.k.2 does not apply to two dimensional `marine radar'
or `vessel traffic service' radar, having all of the following:
a. ``Pulse compression'' ratio not exceeding 150;
b. Compressed pulse width of greater than 30 ns;
c. Single and rotating mechanically scanned antenna;
d. Peak output power not exceeding 250 W; and
e. Not capable of ``frequency hopping''.
l. Having data processing sub-systems and having any of the
following:
l.1. `Automatic target tracking' providing, at any antenna
rotation, the predicted target position beyond the time of the next
antenna beam passage; or
Note: 6A008.l.1 does not control conflict alert capability in
ATC systems, or `marine radar'.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 6A008.l.1, `automatic target
tracking' is a processing technique that automatically determines
and provides as output an extrapolated value of the most probable
position of the target in real time.
l.2. [Reserved]
l.3. [Reserved]
l.4. Configured to provide superposition and correlation, or
fusion, of target data within six seconds from two or more
`geographically dispersed' radar sensors to improve the aggregate
performance beyond that of any single sensor specified by 6A008.f,
or 6A008.i.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 6A008.l.4, sensors are
considered `geographically dispersed' when each location is distant
from any other more than 1,500 m in any direction. Mobile sensors
are always considered `geographically dispersed'.
N.B.: See also the U.S. Munitions List (22 CFR part 121).
Note: 6A008.l does not apply to systems, equipment and
assemblies designed for `vessel traffic services'.
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 6A008, `marine radar' is a radar that is
designed to navigate
[[Page 71975]]
safely at sea, inland waterways or near-shore environments.
2. For the purposes of 6A008, `vessel traffic service' is a
vessel traffic monitoring and control service similar to air traffic
control for ``aircraft.''
* * * * *
6B007 Equipment to produce, align and calibrate land-based gravity
meters with a static ``accuracy'' of less (better) than 0.1 mGal.
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: $5000
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: N/A
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
The list of items controlled is contained in the ECCN heading.
* * * * *
6C002 Optical sensor materials as follows (see List of Items
Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: $3000
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: See also 6C992.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Elemental tellurium (Te) of purity levels of 99.9995% or
more;
b. Single crystals (including epitaxial wafers) of any of the
following:
b.1. Cadmium zinc telluride (CdZnTe), with zinc content less
than 6% by `mole fraction';
b.2. Cadmium telluride (CdTe) of any purity level; or
b.3. Mercury cadmium telluride (HgCdTe) of any purity level.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 6C002.b.1, `mole fraction'
is defined as the ratio of moles of ZnTe to the sum of the moles of
CdTe and ZnTe present in the crystal.
* * * * *
6C005 ``Laser'' materials as follows (see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: $1500
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: N/A
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Synthetic crystalline ``laser'' host material in unfinished
form as follows:
a.1. Titanium doped sapphire;
a.2. [Reserved]
b. Rare-earth-metal doped double-clad fibers having any of the
following:
b.1. Nominal ``laser'' wavelength of 975 nm to 1,150 nm and
having all of the following:
b.1.a. Average core diameter equal to or greater than 25 [mu]m;
and
b.1.b. Core `Numerical Aperture' (`NA') less than 0.065; or
Note to 6C005.b.1: 6C005.b.1 does not apply to double-clad
fibers having an inner glass cladding diameter exceeding 150 [mu]m
and not exceeding 300 [mu]m.
b.2. Nominal ``laser'' wavelength exceeding 1,530 nm and having
all of the following:
b.2.a. Average core diameter equal to or greater than 20 [mu]m;
and
b.2.b. Core `NA' less than 0.1.
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 6C005.b.1.b, the core `Numerical
Aperture' (`NA') is measured at the emission wavelengths of the
fiber.
2. 6C005.b includes fibers assembled with end caps.
* * * * *
6D003 Other ``software'' as follows (see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, RS, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 1
RS applies to paragraph c................. RS Column 1
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements
See Sec. 743.1 of the EAR for reporting requirements for
exports under License Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
TSR: Yes, except for 6D003.c and exports or reexports to
destinations outside of those countries listed in Country Group A:5
(See Supplement No. 1 to part 740 of the EAR) of ``software'' for
items controlled by 6D003.a.
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be used to ship or transmit
software in 6D003.a to any of the destinations listed in Country
Group A:6 (See Supplement No.1 to part 740 of the EAR).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: See also ECCNs 6D103, 6D991, and 6D993.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
Acoustics
a. ``Software'' as follows:
a.1. ``Software'' ``specially designed'' for acoustic beam
forming for the ``real-time processing'' of acoustic data for
passive reception using towed hydrophone arrays;
a.2. ``Source code'' for the ``real-time processing'' of
acoustic data for passive reception using towed hydrophone arrays;
a.3. ``Software'' ``specially designed'' for acoustic beam
forming for the ``real-time processing'' of acoustic data for
passive reception using bottom or bay cable systems;
a.4. ``Source code'' for the ``real-time processing'' of
acoustic data for passive reception using bottom or bay cable
systems;
a.5. ``Software'' or ``source code'', ``specially designed'' for
all of the following:
a.5.a. ``Real-time processing'' of acoustic data from sonar
systems controlled by 6A001.a.1.e; and
a.5.b. Automatically detecting, classifying and determining the
location of divers or swimmers;
N.B.: For diver detection ``software'' or ``source code'',
``specially designed'' or modified for military use, see the U.S.
Munitions List of the International Traffic in Arms Regulations
(ITAR) (22 CFR part 121).
b. Optical sensors. None.
Cameras
c. ``Software'' designed or modified for cameras incorporating
``focal plane arrays'' specified by 6A002.a.3.f and designed or
modified to remove a frame rate restriction and allow the camera to
exceed the frame rate specified in 6A003.b.4 Note 3.a;
Optics
d. ``Software'' ``specially designed'' to maintain the alignment
and phasing of segmented mirror systems consisting of mirror
segments having a diameter or major axis length equal to or larger
than 1 m;
e. Lasers. None.
Magnetic and Electric Field Sensors
f. ``Software'' as follows:
f.1. ``Software'' ``specially designed'' for magnetic and
electric field ``compensation systems'' for magnetic sensors
designed to operate on mobile platforms;
[[Page 71976]]
f.2. ``Software'' ``specially designed'' for magnetic and
electric field anomaly detection on mobile platforms;
f.3. ``Software'' ``specially designed'' for ``real-time
processing'' of electromagnetic data using underwater
electromagnetic receivers specified by 6A006.e;
f.4. ``Source code'' for ``real-time processing'' of
electromagnetic data using underwater electromagnetic receivers
specified by 6A006.e;
Gravimeters
g. ``Software'' ``specially designed'' to correct motional
influences of gravity meters or gravity gradiometers;
Radar
h. ``Software'' as follows:
h.1. Air Traffic Control (ATC) ``software'' designed to be
hosted on general purpose computers located at Air Traffic Control
centers and capable of accepting radar target data from more than
four primary radars;
h.2. ``Software'' for the design or ``production'' of radomes
having all of the following:
h.2.a. ``Specially designed'' to protect the ``electronically
scanned array antennae'' specified by 6A008.e; and
h.2.b. Resulting in an antenna pattern having an `average side
lobe level' more than 40 dB below the peak of the main beam level.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 6D003.h.2.b `average side
lobe level' is measured over the entire array excluding the angular
extent of the main beam and the first two side lobes on either side
of the main beam.
* * * * *
6E003 Other ``technology'' as follows (see List of Items
Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 1
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
TSR: Yes
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: See also 6E993.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
Acoustics
a. [Reserved]
Optical Sensors
b. [Reserved]
Cameras
c. [Reserved]
Optics
d. ``Technology'' as follows:
d.1. ``Technology'' ``required'' for the coating and treatment
of optical surfaces to achieve an `optical thickness' uniformity of
99.5% or better for optical coatings 500 mm or more in diameter or
major axis length and with a total loss (absorption and scatter) of
less than 5 x 10-3;
N.B.: See also 2E003.f.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 6E003.d.1, `optical
thickness' is the mathematical product of the index of refraction
and the physical thickness of the coating.
d.2. ``Technology'' for the fabrication of optics using single
point diamond turning techniques to produce surface finish
``accuracies'' of better than 10 nm rms on non-planar surfaces
exceeding 0.5 m\2\;
Lasers
e. ``Technology'' ``required'' for the ``development,''
``production'' or ``use'' of ``specially designed'' diagnostic
instruments or targets in test facilities for ``SHPL'' testing or
testing or evaluation of materials irradiated by ``SHPL'' beams;
Magnetic and Electric Field Sensors
f. [Reserved]
Gravimeters
g. [Reserved]
Radar
h. [Reserved]
* * * * *
7A003 `Inertial measurement equipment or systems', having any of the
following.
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 1
MT applies to commodities in 7A003.d that MT Column 1
meet or exceed the parameters of 7A103.
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See also ECCNs 7A103, 7A611, and 7A994. (2)
See USML Category XII(d) for guidance or navigation systems subject
to the ITAR.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
7A003 does not apply to `inertial measurement equipment or
systems' which are certified for use on ``civil aircraft'' by civil
aviation authorities of one or more Wassenaar Arrangement
Participating States, see Supplement No. 1 to part 743 of the EAR.
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 7A003, 'inertial measurement equipment or
systems' incorporate accelerometers or gyroscopes to measure changes
in velocity and orientation in order to determine or maintain
heading or position without requiring an external reference once
aligned. 'Inertial measurement equipment or systems' include:
Attitude and Heading Reference Systems (AHRSs);
Gyrocompasses;
Inertial Measurement Units (IMUs);
Inertial Navigation Systems (INSs);
Inertial Reference Systems (IRSs);
Inertial Reference Units (IRUs).
2. For the purposes of 7A003, `positional aiding references'
independently provide position, and include:
a. ``Satellite navigation system'';
b.''Data-Based Referenced Navigation'' (``DBRN'').
a. Designed for ``aircraft'', land vehicles or vessels,
providing position without the use of `positional aiding
references', and having any of the following ``accuracies''
subsequent to normal alignment:
a.1. 0.8 nautical miles per hour (nm/hr) ``Circular Error
Probable'' (``CEP'') rate or less (better);
a.2. 0.5% distanced travelled ``CEP'' or less (better); or
a.3. Total drift of 1 nautical mile ``CEP'' or less (better) in
a 24 hr period;
Technical Note: For the purposes of 7A003.a.1, 7A003.a.2 and
7A003.a.3, the performance parameters typically apply to `inertia
measurement equipment or systems' designed for ``aircraft'',
vehicles and vessels, respectively. These parameters result from the
utilization of specialized non-`positional aiding references' (e.g.,
altimeter, odometer, velocity log). As a consequence, the specified
performance values cannot be readily converted between these
parameters. Equipment designed for multiple platforms are evaluated
against each applicable entry 7A003.a.1, 7A003.a.2, or 7A003.a.3.
b. Designed for ``aircraft'', land vehicles or vessels, with an
embedded `positional aiding reference' and providing position after
loss of all `positional aiding references' for a period of up to 4
minutes, having an ``accuracy'' of less (better) than 10 meters
``CEP'';
Technical Note: For the purposes of 7A003.b, this entry refers
to systems in which `inertial measurement equipment or systems' and
other independent `positional aiding references' are built into a
single unit (i.e., embedded) in order to achieve improved
performance.
c. Designed for ``aircraft'', land vehicles or vessels,
providing heading or True North determination and having any of the
following:
c.1. A maximum operating angular rate less (lower) than 500 deg/
s and a heading ``accuracy'' without the use of `positional aiding
references' equal to or less (better) than 0.07 deg sec (Lat)
(equivalent to 6 arc minutes rms at 45 degrees latitude); or
c.2. A maximum operating angular rate equal to or greater
(higher) than 500 deg/s and a heading ``accuracy'' without the use
of `positional aiding references' equal to or less (better) than 0.2
deg sec (Lat) (equivalent to 17 arc minutes rms at 45 degrees
latitude);
d. Providing acceleration measurements or angular rate
measurements, in more than one dimension, and having any of the
following:
[[Page 71977]]
d.1. Performance specified by 7A001 or 7A002 along any axis,
without the use of any aiding references; or
d.2. Being ``space-qualified'' and providing angular rate
measurements having an ``angle random walk'' along any axis of less
(better) than or equal to 0.1 degree per square root hour.
Note: 7A003.d.2 does not apply to `inertial measurement
equipment or systems' that contain ``spinning mass gyros'' as the
only type of gyro.
7A004 `Star trackers' and ``components'' therefor, as follows (see
List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 1
MT applies to entire entry................ MT Column 1
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See USML Category XV for certain `star
trackers' that are ``subject to the ITAR'' (see 22 CFR parts 120
through 130). (2) See also 7A104 and 7A994.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. `Star trackers' with a specified azimuth ``accuracy'' of
equal to or less (better) than 20 seconds of arc throughout the
specified lifetime of the equipment;
b. ``Components'' ``specially designed'' for equipment specified
in 7A004.a as follows:
b.1. Optical heads or baffles;
b.2. Data processing units.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 7A004.a, `star trackers' are
also referred to as stellar attitude sensors or gyro-astro
compasses.
7A005 ``Satellite navigation system'' receiving equipment having any
of the following and ``specially designed'' ``components'' therefor.
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT and AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to 7A005.b..................... NS Column 1
MT applies to commodities in 7A005.b that MT Column 1
meet or exceed the parameters of 7A105.
AT applies to 7A005.b..................... AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See also ECCNs 7A105, 7A611 and 7A994.
Commercially available ``satellite navigation system'' receivers do
not typically employ decryption or adaptive antennae and are
classified as 7A994. (2) See USML Category XII(d) for ``satellite
navigation system'' receiving equipment subject to the ITAR and USML
Category XI(c)(10) for antennae that are subject to the ITAR. (3)
Items that otherwise would be covered by ECCN 7A005.a are ``subject
to the ITAR'' (see 22 CFR parts 120 through 130).
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Employing a decryption algorithm ``specially designed'' or
modified for government use to access the ranging code for position
and time; or
b. Employing `adaptive antenna systems'.
Note: 7A005.b does not apply to ``satellite navigation system''
receiving equipment that only uses ``components'' designed to
filter, switch, or combine signals from multiple omni-directional
antennas that do not implement adaptive antenna techniques.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 7A005.b, `adaptive antenna
systems' dynamically generate one or more spatial nulls in an
antenna array pattern by signal processing in the time domain or
frequency domain.
7A006 Airborne altimeters operating at frequencies other than 4.2 to
4.4 GHz inclusive and having any of the following (see List of Items
Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 1
MT applies to commodities in this entry MT Column 1
that meet or exceed the parameters of
7A106.
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: See also 7A106, 7A994 and Category 6 for controls
on radar.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. `Power management'; or
Technical Note: For the purposes of 7A006.a, `power management'
is changing the transmitted power of the altimeter signal so that
received power at the ``aircraft'' altitude is always at the minimum
necessary to determine the altitude.
b. Using phase shift key modulation.
* * * * *
7B001 Test, calibration or alignment equipment, ``specially
designed'' for equipment controlled by 7A (except 7A994).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 1
MT applies to entire entry................ MT Column 1
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See also 7B101, 7B102 and 7B994. (2) This
entry does not control test, calibration or alignment equipment for
`Maintenance level I' or `Maintenance Level II'.
Related Definition: For the purposes of 7B001: (1) `Maintenance
Level I': The failure of an inertial navigation unit is detected on
the ``aircraft'' by indications from the Control and Display Unit
(CDU) or by the status message from the corresponding sub-system. By
following the manufacturer's manual, the cause of the failure may be
localized at the level of the malfunctioning Line Replaceable Unit
(LRU). The operator then removes the LRU and replaces it with a
spare. (2) `Maintenance Level II': The defective LRU is sent to the
maintenance workshop (the manufacturer's or that of the operator
responsible for level II maintenance). At the maintenance workshop,
the malfunctioning LRU is tested by various appropriate means to
verify and localize the defective Shop Replaceable Assembly (SRA)
module responsible for the failure. This SRA is removed and replaced
by an operative spare. The defective SRA (or possibly the complete
LRU) is then shipped to the manufacturer. `Maintenance Level II'
does not include the disassembly or repair of controlled
accelerometers or gyro sensors.
Items:
The list of items controlled is contained in the ECCN heading.
* * * * *
7D002 ``Source code'' for the operation or maintenance of any
inertial navigation equipment, including inertial equipment not
controlled by 7A003 or 7A004, or Attitude and Heading Reference
Systems (`AHRS').
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, AT
[[Page 71978]]
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 1
MT applies to entire entry................ MT Column 1
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements
See Sec. 743.1 of the EAR for reporting requirements for
exports under License Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
TSR: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1.) See also 7D102 and 7D994. (2.) This entry
does not control ``source code'' for the operation or maintenance of
gimballed `AHRS'.
Related Definition: For the purposes of 7D002, `AHRS' generally
differ from Inertial Navigation Systems (INS) in that an `AHRS'
provides attitude and heading information and normally does not
provide the acceleration, velocity and position information
associated with an INS.
Items:
The list of items controlled is contained in the ECCN heading.
* * * * *
7E004 Other ``technology'' as follows (see List of Items
Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 1
MT applies to ``technology'' for equipment MT Column 1
or systems controlled for MT reasons.
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
TSR: N/A
Special Conditions for STA
STA: (1) Paragraph (c)(1) of License Exception STA (Sec.
740.20(c)(1) of the EAR) may not be used for 7E004, except for
7E004.a.7. (2) Paragraph (c)(2) of License Exception STA (Sec.
740.20(c)(2) of the EAR) may not be used for 7E004, except for
7E004.a.7.
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See also 7E001, 7E002, 7E101, and 7E994. (2)
In addition to the Related Controls in 7E001, 7E002, and 7E101 that
include MT controls, also see the MT controls in 7E104 for design
``technology'' for the integration of the flight control, guidance,
and propulsion data into a flight management system, designed or
modified for rockets or missiles capable of achieving a ``range''
equal to or greater than 300 km, for optimization of rocket system
trajectory; and also see 9E101 for design ``technology'' for
integration of air vehicle fuselage, propulsion system and lifting
control surfaces, designed or modified for unmanned aerial vehicles
capable of achieving a ``range'' equal to or greater than 300 km, to
optimize aerodynamic performance throughout the flight regime of an
unmanned aerial vehicle.
Related Definitions: N/A.
Items:
a. ``Technology'' for the ``development'' or ``production'' of
any of the following:
a.1. [Reserved]
a.2. Air data systems based on surface static data only, i.e.,
which dispense with conventional air data probes;
a.3. Three dimensional displays for ``aircraft'';
a.4. [Reserved]
a.5. Electric actuators (i.e., electromechanical,
electrohydrostatic and integrated actuator package) ``specially
designed'' for `primary flight control';
Technical Note: For the purposes of 7E004.a.5, `primary flight
control' is ``aircraft'' stability or maneuvering control using
force/moment generators, i.e., aerodynamic control surfaces or
propulsive thrust vectoring.
a.6. `Flight control optical sensor array' ``specially
designed'' for implementing ``active flight control systems''; or
Technical Note: For the purposes of 7E004.a.6, a `flight control
optical sensor array' is a network of distributed optical sensors,
using ``laser'' beams, to provide real-time flight control data for
on-board processing.
a.7. ``DBRN'' systems designed to navigate underwater, using
sonar or gravity databases, that provide a positioning ``accuracy''
equal to or less (better) than 0.4 nautical miles;
b. ``Development'' ``technology'', as follows, for ``active
flight control systems'' (including ``fly-by-wire systems'' or
``fly-by-light systems''):
b.1. Photonic-based ``technology'' for sensing ``aircraft'' or
flight control component state, transferring flight control data, or
commanding actuator movement, ``required'' for ``fly-by-light
systems'' ``active flight control systems'';
b.2. [Reserved]
b.3. Real-time algorithms to analyze component sensor
information to predict and preemptively mitigate impending
degradation and failures of components within an ``active flight
control system'';
Note: 7E004.b.3 does not include algorithms for purpose of off-
line maintenance.
b.4. Real-time algorithms to identify component failures and
reconfigure force and moment controls to mitigate ``active flight
control system'' degradations and failures;
Note: 7E004.b.4 does not include algorithms for the elimination
of fault effects through comparison of redundant data sources, or
off-line pre-planned responses to anticipated failures.
b.5. Integration of digital flight control, navigation and
propulsion control data, into a digital flight management system for
``total control of flight'';
Note: 7E004.b.5 does not apply to:
1. ``Technology'' for integration of digital flight control,
navigation and propulsion control data, into a digital flight
management system for `flight path optimization';
2. ``Technology'' for ``aircraft'' flight instrument systems
integrated solely for VOR, DME, ILS or MLS navigation or approaches.
Technical Note: `Flight path optimization' is a procedure that
minimizes deviations from a four-dimensional (space and time)
desired trajectory based on maximizing performance or effectiveness
for mission tasks.
b.6. [Reserved]
b.7. ``Technology'' ``required'' for deriving the functional
requirements for ``fly-by-wire systems'' having all of the
following:
b.7.a. `Inner-loop' airframe stability controls requiring loop
closure rates of 40 Hz or greater; and
Technical Note: For the purposes of 7E004.b.7.a, `inner-loop'
refers to functions of ``active flight control systems'' that
automate airframe stability controls.
b.7.b. Having any of the following:
b.7.b.1. Corrects an aerodynamically unstable airframe, measured
at any point in the design flight envelope, that would lose
recoverable control if not corrected within 0.5 seconds;
b.7.b.2. Couples controls in two or more axes while compensating
for `abnormal changes in aircraft state';
Technical Note: For the purposes of 7E004.b.7.b.2, `abnormal
changes in aircraft state' include in-flight structural damage, loss
of engine thrust, disabled control surface, or destabilizing shifts
in cargo load.
b.7.b.3. Performs the functions specified in 7E004.b.5; or
Note: 7E004.b.7.b.3 does not apply to autopilots.
b.7.b.4. Enables ''aircraft'' to have stable controlled flight,
other than during take-off or landing, at greater than 18 degrees
angle of attack, 15 degrees side slip, 15 degrees/second pitch or
yaw rate, or 90 degrees/second roll rate;
b.8. ``Technology'' ``required'' for deriving the functional
requirements of ``fly-by-wire systems'' to achieve all of the
following:
b.8.a. No loss of control of the ''aircraft'' in the event of a
consecutive sequence of any two individual faults within the ``fly-
by-wire system''; and
b.8.b. Probability of loss of control of the ''aircraft'' being
less (better) than 1 x 10-9 failures per flight hour;
Note: 7E004.b does not apply to ``technology'' associated with
common computer elements and utilities (e.g., input signal
acquisition, output signal transmission, computer ``program'' and
data loading, built-in test, task scheduling mechanisms) not
providing a specific flight control system function.
c. ``Technology'' for the ``development'' of helicopter systems,
as follows:
c.1. Multi-axis fly-by-wire or fly-by-light controllers, which
combine the functions of at least two of the following into one
controlling element:
[[Page 71979]]
c.1.a. Collective controls;
c.1.b. Cyclic controls;
c.1.c. Yaw controls;
c.2. ``Circulation-controlled anti-torque or circulation-
controlled direction control systems'';
c.3. Rotor blades incorporating `variable geometry airfoils',
for use in systems using individual blade control.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 7E004.c.3, `variable
geometry airfoils' use trailing edge flaps or tabs, or leading edge
slats or pivoted nose droop, the position of which can be controlled
in flight.
* * * * *
8A001 Submersible vehicles and surface vessels, as follows (see List
of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements
See Sec. 743.1 of the EAR for reporting requirements for
exports under License Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: $5000; N/A for 8A001.b and .c.1
GBS: N/A
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be used to ship any commodity in
8A001.b, 8A001.c or 8A001.d to any of the destinations listed in
Country Group A:6 (See Supplement No.1 to part 740 of the EAR).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: For the control status of equipment for
submersible vehicles, see: Category 6 for sensors; Categories 7 and
8 for navigation equipment; Category 8A for underwater equipment.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Manned, tethered submersible vehicles designed to operate at
depths exceeding 1,000 m;
b. Manned, untethered submersible vehicles having any of the
following:
b.1. Designed to `operate autonomously' and having a lifting
capacity of all the following:
b.1.a. 10% or more of their weight in air; and
b.1.b. 15 kN or more;
b.2. Designed to operate at depths exceeding 1,000 m; or
b.3. Having all of the following:
b.3.a. Designed to continuously `operate autonomously' for 10
hours or more; and
b.3.b. `Range' of 25 nautical miles or more;
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 8A001.b, `operate autonomously' means
fully submerged, without snorkel, all systems working and cruising
at minimum speed at which the submersible can safely control its
depth dynamically by using its depth planes only, with no need for a
support vessel or support base on the surface, sea-bed or shore, and
containing a propulsion system for submerged or surface use.
2. For the purposes of 8A001.b, `range' means half the maximum
distance a submersible vehicle can `operate autonomously'.
c. Unmanned submersible vehicles as follows:
c.1. Unmanned submersible vehicles having any of the following:
c.1.a. Designed for deciding a course relative to any
geographical reference without real-time human assistance;
c.1.b. Acoustic data or command link; or
c.1.c. Wireless optical data or command link exceeding 1,000 m;
c.2. Unmanned, submersible vehicles, not specified in 8A001.c.1,
having all of the following:
c.2.a. Designed to operate with a tether;
c.2.b. Designed to operate at depths exceeding 1,000 m; and
c.2.c. Having any of the following:
c.2.c.1. Designed for self-propelled maneuver using propulsion
motors or thrusters specified by 8A002.a.2; or
c.2.c.2. Fiber optic data link;
d. [Reserved]
e. Ocean salvage systems with a lifting capacity exceeding 5 MN
for salvaging objects from depths exceeding 250 m and having any of
the following:
e.1. Dynamic positioning systems capable of position keeping
within 20 m of a given point provided by the navigation system; or
e.2. Seafloor navigation and navigation integration systems, for
depths exceeding 1,000 m and with positioning ``accuracies'' to
within 10 m of a predetermined point.
8A002 Marine systems, equipment, ``parts'' and ``components,'' as
follows (see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements
See Sec. 743.1 of the EAR for reporting requirements for
exports under License Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: $5000; N/A for 8A002.o.3.b
GBS: Yes for manipulators for civil end uses (e.g., underwater oil,
gas or mining operations) controlled by 8A002.i.2 and having 5
degrees of freedom of movement; and 8A002.r.
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be used to ship any commodity in
8A002.b, h, j, o.3, or p to any of the destinations listed in
Country Group A:6 (See Supplement No.1 to part 740 of the EAR).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See also 8A992 and for underwater
communications systems, see Category 5, Part I--Telecommunications.
(2) See also 8A992 for self-contained underwater breathing apparatus
that is not controlled by 8A002 or released for control by the
8A002.q Note. (3) For electronic imaging systems ``specially
designed'' or modified for underwater use incorporating image
intensifier tubes specified by 6A002.a.2.a or 6A002.a.2.b, see
6A003.b.3. (4) For electronic imaging systems ``specially designed''
or modified for underwater use incorporating ``focal plane arrays''
specified by 6A002.a.3.g, see 6A003.b.4.c. (5) Section 744.9 imposes
a license requirement on commodities described in 8A002.d if being
exported, reexported, or transferred (in-country) for use by a
military end-user or for incorporation into an item controlled by
ECCN 0A919.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Systems, equipment, ``parts'' and ``components,'' ``specially
designed'' or modified for submersible vehicles and designed to
operate at depths exceeding 1,000 m, as follows:
a.1. Pressure housings or pressure hulls with a maximum inside
chamber diameter exceeding 1.5 m;
a.2. Direct current propulsion motors or thrusters;
a.3. Umbilical cables, and connectors therefor, using optical
fiber and having synthetic strength members;
a.4. ``Parts'' and ``components'' manufactured from material
specified by ECCN 8C001;
Technical Note: For the purposes of 8A002.a.4, this entry should
not be defeated by the export of `syntactic foam' controlled by
8C001 when an intermediate stage of manufacture has been performed
and it is not yet in its final component form.
b. Systems ``specially designed'' or modified for the automated
control of the motion of submersible vehicles controlled by 8A001,
using navigation data, having closed loop servo-controls and having
any of the following:
b.1. Enabling a vehicle to move within 10 m of a predetermined
point in the water column;
b.2. Maintaining the position of the vehicle within 10 m of a
predetermined point in the water column; or
b.3. Maintaining the position of the vehicle within 10 m while
following a cable on or under the seabed;
c. Fiber optic pressure hull penetrators;
d. Underwater vision systems having all of the following:
d.1. ``Specially designed'' or modified for remote operation
with an underwater vehicle; and
[[Page 71980]]
d.2. Employing any of the following techniques to minimize the
effects of back scatter:
d.2.a. Range-gated illuminators; or
d.2.b. Range-gated ``laser'' systems;
e. [Reserved]
f. [Reserved]
g. Light systems ``specially designed'' or modified for
underwater use, as follows:
g.1. Stroboscopic light systems capable of a light output energy
of more than 300 J per flash and a flash rate of more than 5 flashes
per second;
g.2. Argon arc light systems ``specially designed'' for use
below 1,000 m;
h. ``Robots'' ``specially designed'' for underwater use,
controlled by using a dedicated computer and having any of the
following:
h.1. Systems that control the ``robot'' using information from
sensors which measure force or torque applied to an external object,
distance to an external object, or tactile sense between the
``robot'' and an external object; or
h.2. The ability to exert a force of 250 N or more or a torque
of 250 Nm or more and using titanium based alloys or ``composite''
``fibrous or filamentary materials'' in their structural members;
i. Remotely controlled articulated manipulators ``specially
designed'' or modified for use with submersible vehicles and having
any of the following:
i.1. Systems which control the manipulator using information
from sensors which measure any of the following:
i.1.a. Torque or force applied to an external object; or
i.1.b. Tactile sense between the manipulator and an external
object; or
i.2. Controlled by proportional master-slave techniques and
having 5 degrees of `freedom of movement' or more;
Technical Note: For the purposes of 8A002.i.2, only functions
having proportionally related motion control using positional
feedback are counted when determining the number of degrees of
`freedom of movement'.
j. Air independent power systems ``specially designed'' for
underwater use, as follows:
j.1. Brayton or Rankine cycle engine air independent power
systems having any of the following:
j.1.a. Chemical scrubber or absorber systems, ``specially
designed'' to remove carbon dioxide, carbon monoxide and
particulates from recirculated engine exhaust;
j.1.b. Systems ``specially designed'' to use a monoatomic gas;
j.1.c. Devices or enclosures, ``specially designed'' for
underwater noise reduction in frequencies below 10 kHz, or special
mounting devices for shock mitigation; or
j.1.d. Systems having all of the following:
j.1.d.1. ``Specially designed'' to pressurize the products of
reaction or for fuel reformation;
j.1.d.2. ``Specially designed'' to store the products of the
reaction; and
j.1.d.3. ``Specially designed'' to discharge the products of the
reaction against a pressure of 100 kPa or more;
j.2. Diesel cycle engine air independent systems having all of
the following:
j.2.a. Chemical scrubber or absorber systems, ``specially
designed'' to remove carbon dioxide, carbon monoxide and
particulates from recirculated engine exhaust;
j.2.b. Systems ``specially designed'' to use a monoatomic gas;
j.2.c. Devices or enclosures, ``specially designed'' for
underwater noise reduction in frequencies below 10 kHz, or special
mounting devices for shock mitigation; and
j.2.d. ``Specially designed'' exhaust systems that do not
exhaust continuously the products of combustion;
j.3. ``Fuel cell'' air independent power systems with an output
exceeding 2 kW and having any of the following:
j.3.a. Devices or enclosures, ``specially designed'' for
underwater noise reduction in frequencies below 10 kHz, or special
mounting devices for shock mitigation; or
j.3.b. Systems having all of the following:
j.3.b.1. ``Specially designed'' to pressurize the products of
reaction or for fuel reformation;
j.3.b.2. ``Specially designed'' to store the products of the
reaction; and
j.3.b.3. ``Specially designed'' to discharge the products of the
reaction against a pressure of 100 kPa or more;
j.4. Stirling cycle engine air independent power systems having
all of the following:
j.4.a. Devices or enclosures, ``specially designed'' for
underwater noise reduction in frequencies below 10 kHz, or special
mounting devices for shock mitigation; and
j.4.b. ``Specially designed'' exhaust systems which discharge
the products of combustion against a pressure of 100 kPa or more;
k. [Reserved]
l. [Reserved]
m. [Reserved]
n. [Reserved]
o. Propellers, power transmission systems, power generation
systems and noise reduction systems, as follows:
o.1. [Reserved]
o.2. Water-screw propeller, power generation systems or
transmission systems, designed for use on vessels, as follows:
o.2.a. Controllable-pitch propellers and hub assemblies, rated
at more than 30 MW;
o.2.b. Internally liquid-cooled electric propulsion motors with
a power output exceeding 2.5 MW;
o.2.c. ``Superconductive'' propulsion motors with a power output
exceeding 0.1 MW;
o.2.d. Power transmission shaft systems incorporating
``composite'' material ``parts'' or ``components'' and capable of
transmitting more than 2 MW;
o.2.e. Ventilated or base-ventilated propeller systems, rated at
more than 2.5 MW;
o.3. Noise reduction systems designed for use on vessels of
1,000 tonnes displacement or more, as follows:
o.3.a. Systems that attenuate underwater noise at frequencies
below 500 Hz and consist of compound acoustic mounts for the
acoustic isolation of diesel engines, diesel generator sets, gas
turbines, gas turbine generator sets, propulsion motors or
propulsion reduction gears, ``specially designed'' for sound or
vibration isolation and having an intermediate mass exceeding 30% of
the equipment to be mounted;
o.3.b. `Active noise reduction or cancellation systems' or
magnetic bearings, ``specially designed'' for power transmission
systems;
Technical Note: For the purposes of 8A002.o.3.b, 'active noise
reduction or cancellation systems' incorporate electronic control
systems capable of actively reducing equipment vibration by the
generation of anti-noise or anti-vibration signals directly to the
source.
o.4. Permanent magnet electric propulsion motors ``specially
designed'' for submersible vehicles, having a power output exceeding
0.1 MW.
Note: 8A002.o.4. includes rim-driven propulsion systems.
p. Pumpjet propulsion systems having all of the following:
p.1. Power output exceeding 2.5 MW; and
p.2. Using divergent nozzle and flow conditioning vane
techniques to improve propulsive efficiency or reduce propulsion-
generated underwater-radiated noise;
q. Underwater swimming and diving equipment as follows;
q.1. Closed circuit rebreathers;
q.2. Semi-closed circuit rebreathers;
Note: 8A002.q does not control individual rebreathers for
personal use when accompanying their users.
N.B. For equipment and devices ``specially designed'' for
military use see ECCN 8A620.f.
r. Diver deterrent acoustic systems ``specially designed'' or
modified to disrupt divers and having a sound pressure level equal
to or exceeding 190 dB (reference 1 [micro]Pa at 1 m) at frequencies
of 200 Hz and below.
Note 1: 8A002.r does not apply to diver deterrent systems based
on under-water-explosive devices, air guns or combustible sources.
Note 2: 8A002.r includes diver deterrent acoustic systems that
use spark gap sources, also known as plasma sound sources.
* * * * *
8C001 `Syntactic foam' designed for underwater use and having all of
the following (see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: See also 8A002.a.4.
Related Definition: For the purposes of 8C001, `Syntactic foam'
consists of hollow spheres of plastic or glass embedded in a resin
``matrix.''
[[Page 71981]]
Items:
a. Designed for marine depths exceeding 1,000 m; and
b. A density less than 561 kg/m\3\.
* * * * *
8E002 Other ``technology'' as follows (see List of Items
Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 1
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements
See Sec. 743.1 of the EAR for reporting requirements for
exports under License Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
TSR: N/A
License Exceptions Note: License Exception TSU is not applicable
for the repair ``technology'' controlled by 8E002.a or .b, see
Supplement No. 2 to part 774.
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be used to ship or transmit
technology in 8E002.a to any of the destinations listed in Country
Group A:6 (See Supplement No. 1 to part 740 of the EAR).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: See also 8E992.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. ``Technology'' for the ``development'', ``production'',
repair, overhaul or refurbishing (re-machining) of propellers
``specially designed'' for underwater noise reduction;
b. ``Technology'' for the overhaul or refurbishing of equipment
controlled by 8A001, 8A002.b, 8A002.j, 8A002.o or 8A002.p.
c. ``Technology'' according to the General Technology Note for
the ``development'' or ``production'' of any of the following:
c.1. Surface-effect vehicles (fully skirted variety) having all
of the following:
c.1.a. Maximum design speed, fully loaded, exceeding 30 knots in
a significant wave height of 1.25 m or more;
c.1.b. Cushion pressure exceeding 3,830 Pa; and
c.1.c. Light-ship-to-full-load displacement ratio of less than
0.70;
c.2. Surface-effect vehicles (rigid sidewalls) with a maximum
design speed, fully loaded, exceeding 40 knots in a significant wave
height of 3.25 m or more;
c.3. Hydrofoil vessels with active systems for automatically
controlling foil systems, with a maximum design speed, fully loaded,
of 40 knots or more in a significant wave height of 3.25 m or more;
or
c.4. `Small waterplane area vessels' having any of the
following:
c.4.a. Full load displacement exceeding 500 tonnes with a
maximum design speed, fully loaded, exceeding 35 knots in a
significant wave height of 3.25 m or more; or
c.4.b. Full load displacement exceeding 1,500 tonnes with a
maximum design speed, fully loaded, exceeding 25 knots in a
significant wave height of 4 m or more.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 8E002.c.4, a `small
waterplane area vessel' is defined by the following formula:
waterplane area at an operational design draft less than 2x
(displaced volume at the operational design draft)2/3.
* * * * *
9A001 Aero gas turbine engines having any of the following (see List
of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 1
MT applies to only to those engines that MT Column 1
meet the characteristics listed in 9A101.
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: See also 9A101 and 9A991.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Incorporating any of the ``technologies'' controlled by
9E003.a, 9E003.h, or 9E003.i;
Note 1: 9A001 does not control aero gas turbine engines which
meet all of the following:
a. Certified by the civil aviation authority in a country listed
in Supplement No. 1 to Part 743; and
b. Intended to power non-military manned ``aircraft'' for which
any of the following has been issued by a Wassenaar Arrangement
Participating State listed in Supplement No. 1 to Part 743 for the
``aircraft'' with this specific engine type:
b.1. A civil type certificate; or
b.2. An equivalent document recognized by the International
Civil Aviation Organization (ICAO).
Note 2: 9A001 does not apply to aero gas turbine engines
designed for Auxiliary Power Units (APUs) approved by the civil
aviation authority in a Wassenaar Arrangement Participating State
(see Supplement No. 1 to part 743 of the EAR).
b. [Reserved]
* * * * *
9A003 ``Specially designed'' assemblies or ``components'',
incorporating any of the ``technologies'' controlled by 9E003.a,
9E003.h, 9E003.i, or 9E003.k, for any of the following aero gas
turbine engines (see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 2
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: $5000
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: N/A
Related Definition: N/A
Items:
a. Controlled by 9A001; or
b. Whose design or production origins are either not from a
Wassenaar Participating State (see Supplement No. 1 to part 743 of
the EAR) or unknown to the manufacturer.
9A004 Space launch vehicles and ``spacecraft,'' ``spacecraft
buses'', ``spacecraft payloads'', ``spacecraft'' on-board systems or
equipment, terrestrial equipment, air-launch platforms, and ``sub-
orbital craft'', as follows (see List of Items Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS and AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to 9A004.g, .u, .v, .w and .x.. NS Column 1
AT applies to 9A004.g, .u, .v, .w, .x and AT Column 1
.y.
License Requirement Note: 9A004.b through .f, and .h are controlled
under ECCN 9A515.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See also 9A104, 9A515, and 9B515. (2) See
ECCNs 9E001 (``development'') and 9E002 (``production'') for
technology for items controlled by this entry. (3) See USML
Categories IV for the space launch vehicles and XV for other
spacecraft that are ``subject to the ITAR'' (see 22 CFR parts 120
through 130).
Related Definition: N/A
Items:
a. Space launch vehicles;
b. ``Spacecraft'';
c. ``Spacecraft buses'';
d. ``Spacecraft payloads'' incorporating items specified by
3A001.b.1.a.4, 3A002.g,
[[Page 71982]]
5A001.a.1, 5A001.b.3, 5A002.c, 5A002.e, 6A002.a.1, 6A002.a.2,
6A002.b, 6A002.d, 6A003.b, 6A004.c, 6A004.e, 6A008.d, 6A008.e,
6A008.k, 6A008.l or 9A010.c;
e. On-board systems or equipment, ``specially designed'' for
``spacecraft'' and having any of the following functions:
e.1. `Command and telemetry data handling';
Note: For the purposes of 9A004.e.1, `command and telemetry data
handling' includes bus data management, storage, and processing.
e.2. `Payload data handling'; or
Note: For the purposes of 9A004.e.2, `payload data handling'
includes payload data management, storage, and processing.
e.3. `Attitude and orbit control';
Note: For the purposes of 9A004.e.3, `attitude and orbit
control' includes sensing and actuation to determine and control the
position and orientation of a ``spacecraft''.
N.B.: Equipment ``specially designed'' for military use is
``subject to the ITAR''. See 22 CFR parts 120 through 130.
f. Terrestrial equipment ``specially designed'' for
``spacecraft'', as follows:
f.1. Telemetry and telecommand equipment ``specially designed''
for any of the following data processing functions:
f.1.a. Telemetry data processing of frame synchronization and
error corrections, for monitoring of operational status (also known
as health and safe status) of the ``spacecraft bus''; or
f.1.b. Command data processing for formatting command data being
sent to the ``spacecraft'' to control the ``spacecraft bus'';
f.2. Simulators ``specially designed'' for `verification of
operational procedures' of ``spacecraft''.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 9A004.f.2, `verification of
operational procedures' is any of the following:
1. Command sequence confirmation;
2. Operational training;
3. Operational rehearsals; or
4. Operational analysis.
g. ``Aircraft'' ``specially designed'' or modified to be air-
launch platforms for space launch vehicles or ``sub-orbital craft''.
h. ``Sub-orbital craft''.
i. through t. [Reserved]
u. The James Webb Space Telescope (JWST) being developed,
launched, and operated under the supervision of the U.S. National
Aeronautics and Space Administration (NASA).
v. ``Parts,'' ``components,'' ``accessories'' and
``attachments'' that are ``specially designed'' for the James Webb
Space Telescope and that are not:
v.1. Enumerated or controlled in the USML;
v.2. Microelectronic circuits;
v.3. Described in ECCN 7A004 or 7A104; or
v.4. Described in an ECCN containing ``space-qualified'' as a
control criterion (See ECCN 9A515.x.4).
w. The International Space Station being developed, launched,
and operated under the supervision of the U.S. National Aeronautics
and Space Administration.
x. ``Parts,'' ``components,'' ``accessories'' and
``attachments'' that are ``specially designed'' for the
International Space Station.
y. Items that would otherwise be within the scope of ECCN
9A004.v or .x but that have been identified in an interagency-
cleared commodity classification (CCATS) pursuant to Sec. 748.3(e)
as warranting control in 9A004.y.
9B005 On-line (real time) control systems, instrumentation
(including sensors) or automated data acquisition and processing
equipment, ``specially designed'' for use with any of the following
(see List of Items Controlled).
Reason for Control: NS, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 1
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
LVS: N/A
GBS: N/A
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: See also 9B105.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. Wind tunnels designed for speeds of Mach 1.2 or more;
Note: 9B005.a does not control wind tunnels ``specially
designed'' for educational purposes and having a `test section size'
(measured laterally) of less than 250 mm.
Technical Note: For the purposes of 9B005.a Note, `test section
size' means the diameter of the circle, or the side of the square,
or the longest side of the rectangle, at the largest test section
location.
b. Devices for simulating flow-environments at speeds exceeding
Mach 5, including hot-shot tunnels, plasma arc tunnels, shock tubes,
shock tunnels, gas tunnels and light gas guns; or
c. Wind tunnels or devices, other than two-dimensional sections,
capable of simulating Reynolds number flows exceeding 25 x 10\6\.
* * * * *
9E001 ``Technology'' according to the General Technology Note for
the ``development'' of equipment or ``software'', controlled by
9A004, 9A012, 9B (except for ECCNs 9B604, 9B610, 9B619, 9B990 and
9B991), or ECCN 9D001 to 9D004, 9D101, or 9D104.
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to ``technology'' for items NS Column 1
controlled by 9A004, 9A012, 9B001 to
9B010, 9D001 to 9D004 for NS reasons.
MT applies to ``technology'' for items MT Column 1
controlled by 9A012, 9B001, 9B002, 9B003,
9B004, 9B005, 9B007, 9B104, 9B105, 9B106,
9B115, 9B116, 9B117, 9D001, 9D002, 9D003,
or 9D004 for MT reasons.
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements
See Sec. 743.1 of the EAR for reporting requirements for
exports under License Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
TSR: N/A
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be used to ship or transmit any
technology in this entry to any of the destinations listed in
Country Group A:6 (See Supplement No. 1 to part 740 of the EAR)
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See also 9E101 and 1E002.f (for controls on
``technology'' for the repair of controlled structures, laminates or
materials). (2) ``Technology'' required for the ``development'' of
equipment described in ECCNs 9A005 to 9A011 or ``software''
described in ECCNs 9D103 and 9D105 is ``subject to the ITAR.''
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
The list of items controlled is contained in the ECCN heading.
9E002 ``Technology'' according to the General Technology Note for
the ``production'' of ``equipment'' controlled by ECCN 9A004 or 9B
(except for ECCNs 9B117, 9B604, 9B610, 9B619, 9B990, and 9B991).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, MT, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 1
MT applies to ``technology'' for equipment MT Column 1
controlled by 9B001, 9B002, 9B003, 9B004,
9B005, 9B007, 9B104, 9B105, 9B106, 9B115
or 9B116 for MT reasons.
[[Page 71983]]
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements
See Sec. 743.1 of the EAR for reporting requirements for
exports under License Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
TSR: N/A
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be used to ship or transmit
any technology in this entry to any of the destinations listed in
Country Group A:6 (See Supplement No.1 to part 740 of the EAR).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) See also 9E102. (2) See also 1E002.f for
`technology'' for the repair of controlled structures, laminates, or
materials. (3) ``Technology'' that is required for the
``production'' of equipment described in ECCNs 9A005 to 9A011 is
``subject to the ITAR.''
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
The list of items controlled is contained in the ECCN heading.
9E003 Other ``technology'' as follows (see List of Items
Controlled).
License Requirements
Reason for Control: NS, SI, AT
Country chart (see Supp. No.
Control(s) 1 to part 738)
NS applies to entire entry................ NS Column 1
SI applies to 9E003.a.1 through a.8, .h, See Sec. 742.14 of the EAR
.i, and .l. for additional information.
AT applies to entire entry................ AT Column 1
Reporting Requirements
See Sec. 743.1 of the EAR for reporting requirements for
exports under License Exceptions, and Validated End-User
authorizations.
List Based License Exceptions (See Part 740 for a Description of All
License Exceptions)
TSR: N/A
Special Conditions for STA
STA: License Exception STA may not be used to ship or transmit
any technology in 9E003.a.1 to a.5, 9E003.c., 9E003.h, or 9E003.i
(other than technology for fan or power turbines) to any of the
destinations listed in Country Group A:5 or A:6 (See Supplement No.1
to part 740 of the EAR).
License Exception STA may not be used to ship or transmit any
technology in 9E003.k to any of the destinations listed in Country
Group A:6 (See Supplement No.1 to part 740 of the EAR).
List of Items Controlled
Related Controls: (1) Hot section ``technology'' specifically
designed, modified, or equipped for military uses or purposes, or
developed principally with U.S. Department of Defense funding, is
``subject to the ITAR'' (see 22 CFR parts 120 through 130). (2)
``Technology'' is subject to the EAR when actually applied to a
commercial ``aircraft'' engine program. Exporters may seek to
establish commercial application either on a case-by-case basis
through submission of documentation demonstrating application to a
commercial program in requesting an export license from the
Department of Commerce in respect to a specific export, or in the
case of use for broad categories of ``aircraft,'' engines, ``parts''
or ``components,'' a commodity jurisdiction determination from the
Department of State.
Related Definitions: N/A
Items:
a. ``Technology'' ``required'' for the ``development'' or
``production'' of any of the following gas turbine engine ``parts,''
``components'' or systems:
a.1. Gas turbine blades, vanes or ``tip shrouds'', made from
Directionally Solidified (DS) or Single Crystal (SC) alloys and
having (in the 001 Miller Index Direction) a stress-rupture life
exceeding 400 hours at 1,273 K (1,000 [deg]C) at a stress of 200
MPa, based on the average property values;
Technical Note: For the purposes of 9E003.a.1, stress-rupture
life testing is typically conducted on a test specimen.
a.2. Combustors having any of the following:
a.2.a. `Thermally decoupled liners' designed to operate at
`combustor exit temperature' exceeding 1,883 K (1,610 [deg]C);
a.2.b. Non-metallic liners;
a.2.c. Non-metallic shells; or
a.2. d. Liners designed to operate at 'combustor exit
temperature' exceeding 1,883 K (1,610 [deg]C) and having holes that
meet the parameters specified by 9E003.c;
a.2.e. Utilizing `pressure gain combustion';
Technical Note: For the purposes of 9E003.a.2.e, in `pressure
gain combustion' the bulk average stagnation pressure at the
combustor outlet is greater than the bulk average stagnation
pressure at the combustor inlet due primarily to the combustion
process, when the engine is running in a ``steady state mode'' of
operation.
Note: The ``required'' ``technology'' for holes in 9E003.a.2 is
limited to the derivation of the geometry and location of the holes.
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 9E003.a.2.a, `thermally decoupled liners'
are liners that feature at least a support structure designed to
carry mechanical loads and a combustion facing structure designed to
protect the support structure from the heat of combustion. The
combustion facing structure and support structure have independent
thermal displacement (mechanical displacement due to thermal load)
with respect to one another, i.e., they are thermally decoupled.
2. For the purposes of 9E003.a.2.d, `combustor exit temperature'
is the bulk average gas path total (stagnation) temperature between
the combustor exit plane and the leading edge of the turbine inlet
guide vane (i.e., measured at engine station T40 as defined in SAE
ARP 755A) when the engine is running in a ``steady state mode'' of
operation at the certificated maximum continuous operating
temperature.
N.B.: See 9E003.c for ``technology'' ``required'' for
manufacturing cooling holes.
a.3. ``Parts'' or ``components,'' that are any of the following:
a.3.a. Manufactured from organic ``composite'' materials
designed to operate above 588 K (315 [deg]C);
a.3.b. Manufactured from any of the following:
a.3.b.1. Metal ``matrix'' ``composites'' reinforced by any of
the following:
a.3.b.1.a. Materials controlled by 1C007;
a.3.b.1.b. ``Fibrous or filamentary materials'' specified by
1C010; or
a.3.b.1.c. Aluminides specified by 1C002.a; or
a.3.b.2. Ceramic ``matrix'' ``composites'' specified by 1C007;
or
a.3.c. Stators, vanes, blades, tip seals (shrouds), rotating
blings, rotating blisks or `splitter ducts', that are all of the
following:
a.3.c.1. Not specified in 9E003.a.3.a;
a.3.c.2. Designed for compressors or fans; and
a.3.c.3. Manufactured from material controlled by 1C010.e with
resins controlled by 1C008;
Technical Note: For the purposes of 9E003.a.3.c, a `splitter
duct' performs the initial separation of the air-mass flow between
the bypass and core sections of the engine.
a.4. Uncooled turbine blades, vanes or ``tip shrouds'' designed
to operate at a `gas path temperature' of 1,373 K (1,100 [deg]C) or
more;
a.5. Cooled turbine blades, vanes or ``tip shrouds'', other than
those described in 9E003.a.1, designed to operate at a `gas path
temperature' of 1,693 K (1,420 [deg]C) or more;
Technical Note: For the purposes of 9E003.a.5, `gas path
temperature' is the bulk average gas path total (stagnation)
temperature at the leading-edge plane of the turbine component when
the engine is running in a ``steady state mode'' of operation at the
certificated or specified maximum continuous operating temperature.
a.6. Airfoil-to-disk blade combinations using solid state
joining;
a.7. [Reserved]
a.8. `Damage tolerant' gas turbine engine rotor ``parts'' or
``components'' using powder metallurgy materials controlled by
1C002.b; or
Technical Note: For the purposes of 9E003.a.8, `damage tolerant'
``parts'' and ``components'' are designed using methodology and
substantiation to predict and limit crack growth.
a.9. [Reserved]
N.B.: For ``FADEC systems'', see 9E003.h.
a.10. [Reserved]
N.B.: For adjustable flow path geometry, see 9E003.i.
a.11. `Fan blades' having all of the following:
a.11.a. 20% or more of the total volume being one or more closed
cavities containing vacuum or gas only; and
[[Page 71984]]
a.11.b. One or more closed cavities having a volume of 5 cm\3\
or larger;
Technical Note: For the purposes of 9E003.a.11, a `fan blade' is
the aerofoil portion of the rotating stage or stages, which provide
both compressor and bypass flow in a gas turbine engine.
b. ``Technology'' ``required'' for the ``development'' or
``production'' of any of the following:
b.1. Wind tunnel aero-models equipped with non-intrusive sensors
capable of transmitting data from the sensors to the data
acquisition system; or
b.2. ``Composite'' propeller blades or prop-fans, capable of
absorbing more than 2,000 kW at flight speeds exceeding Mach 0.55;
c. ``Technology'' ``required'' for manufacturing cooling holes
in gas turbine engine ``parts'' or ``components'' incorporating any
of the ``technologies'' specified by 9E003.a.1, 9E003.a.2, or
9E003.a.5, and having any of the following:
c.1. Having all of the following:
c.1.a. Minimum `cross-sectional area' less than 0.45 mm\2\;
c.1.b. `Hole shape ratio' greater than 4.52; and
c.1.c. `Incidence angle' equal to or less than 25[deg]; or
c.2. Having all of the following:
c.2.a. Minimum `cross-sectional area' less than 0.12 mm\2\;
c.2.b. `Hole shape ratio' greater than 5.65; and
c.2.c. `Incidence angle' more than 25[deg];
Note: 9E003.c does not apply to ``technology'' for manufacturing
constant radius cylindrical holes that are straight through and
enter and exit on the external surfaces of the component.
Technical Notes:
1. For the purposes of 9E003.c, the `cross-sectional area' is
the area of the hole in the plane perpendicular to the hole axis.
2. For the purposes of 9E003.c, `hole shape ratio' is the
nominal length of the axis of the hole divided by the square root of
its minimum 'cross-sectional area'.
3. For the purposes of 9E003.c, `incidence angle' is the acute
angle measured between the plane tangential to the airfoil surface
and the hole axis at the point where the hole axis enters the
airfoil surface.
4. For the purposes of 9E003.c, methods for manufacturing holes
include ``laser'' beam machining, water jet machining, Electro-
Chemical Machining (ECM) or Electrical Discharge Machining (EDM).
d. ``Technology'' ``required'' for the ``development'' or
``production'' of helicopter power transfer systems or tilt rotor or
tilt wing ``aircraft'' power transfer systems;
e. ``Technology'' for the ``development'' or ``production'' of
reciprocating diesel engine ground vehicle propulsion systems having
all of the following:
e.1. `Box volume' of 1.2 m\3\ or less;
e.2. An overall power output of more than 750 kW based on 80/
1269/EEC, ISO 2534 or national equivalents; and
e.3. Power density of more than 700 kW/m\3\ of `box volume';
Technical Note: For the purposes of 9E003.e.1., `box volume' is
the product of three perpendicular dimensions measured in the
following way:
Length: The length of the crankshaft from front flange to
flywheel face;
Width: The widest of any of the following:
a. The outside dimension from valve cover to valve cover;
b. The dimensions of the outside edges of the cylinder heads; or
c. The diameter of the flywheel housing;
Height: The largest of any of the following:
a. The dimension of the crankshaft center-line to the top plane
of the valve cover (or cylinder head) plus twice the stroke; or
b. The diameter of the flywheel housing.
f. ``Technology'' ``required'' for the ``production'' of
``specially designed'' ``parts'' or ``components'' for high output
diesel engines, as follows:
f.1. ``Technology'' ``required'' for the ``production'' of
engine systems having all of the following ``parts'' and
``components'' employing ceramics materials controlled by 1C007:
f.1.a Cylinder liners;
f.1.b. Pistons;
f.1.c. Cylinder heads; and
f.1.d. One or more other ``part'' or ``component'' (including
exhaust ports, turbochargers, valve guides, valve assemblies or
insulated fuel injectors);
f.2. ``Technology'' ``required'' for the ``production'' of
turbocharger systems with single-stage compressors and having all of
the following:
f.2.a. Operating at pressure ratios of 4:1 or higher;
f.2.b. Mass flow in the range from 30 to 130 kg per minute; and
f.2.c. Variable flow area capability within the compressor or
turbine sections;
f.3. ``Technology'' ``required'' for the ``production'' of fuel
injection systems with a ``specially designed'' multifuel (e.g.,
diesel or jet fuel) capability covering a viscosity range from
diesel fuel (2.5 cSt at 310.8 K (37.8 [deg]C)) down to gasoline fuel
(0.5 cSt at 310.8 K (37.8 [deg]C)) and having all of the following:
f.3.a. Injection amount in excess of 230 mm\3\ per injection per
cylinder; and
f.3.b. Electronic control features ``specially designed'' for
switching governor characteristics automatically depending on fuel
property to provide the same torque characteristics by using the
appropriate sensors;
g. ``Technology'' ``required'' for the ``development'' or
``production'' of `high output diesel engines' for solid, gas phase
or liquid film (or combinations thereof) cylinder wall lubrication
and permitting operation to temperatures exceeding 723 K (450
[deg]C), measured on the cylinder wall at the top limit of travel of
the top ring of the piston;
Technical Note: For the purposes of 9E003.g, `high output diesel
engines' are diesel engines with a specified brake mean effective
pressure of 1.8 MPa or more at a speed of 2,300 r.p.m., provided the
rated speed is 2,300 r.p.m. or more.
h. ``Technology'' for gas turbine engine ``FADEC systems'' as
follows:
h.1. ``Development'' ``technology'' for deriving the functional
requirements for the ``parts'' or ``components'' necessary for the
``FADEC system'' to regulate engine thrust or shaft power (e.g.,
feedback sensor time constants and accuracies, fuel valve slew
rate);
h.2. ``Development'' or ``production'' ``technology'' for
control and diagnostic ``parts'' or ``components'' unique to the
``FADEC system'' and used to regulate engine thrust or shaft power;
h.3. ``Development'' ``technology'' for the control law
algorithms, including ``source code'', unique to the ``FADEC
system'' and used to regulate engine thrust or shaft power;
Note: 9E003.h does not apply to technology related to engine-
``aircraft'' integration required by civil aviation authorities of
one or more Wassenaar Arrangement Participating States (See
Supplement No. 1 to part 743 of the EAR) to be published for general
airline use (e.g., installation manuals, operating instructions,
instructions for continued airworthiness) or interface functions
(e.g., input/output processing, airframe thrust or shaft power
demand).
i. ``Technology'' for adjustable flow path systems designed to
maintain engine stability for gas generator turbines, fan or power
turbines, or propelling nozzles, as follows:
i.1. ``Development'' ``technology'' for deriving the functional
requirements for the ``parts'' or ``components'' that maintain
engine stability;
i.2. ``Development'' or ``production'' ``technology'' for
``parts'' or ``components'' unique to the adjustable flow path
system and that maintain engine stability;
i.3. ``Development'' ``technology'' for the control law
algorithms, including ``source code'', unique to the adjustable flow
path system and that maintain engine stability;
Note: 9E003.i does not apply to ``technology'' for any of the
following:
a. Inlet guide vanes;
b. Variable pitch fans or prop-fans;
c. Variable compressor vanes;
d. Compressor bleed valves; or
e. Adjustable flow path geometry for reverse thrust.
j. ``Technology'' ``required'' for the ``development'' of wing-
folding systems designed for fixed-wing ``aircraft'' powered by gas
turbine engines.
N.B.: For ``technology'' ``required'' for the ``development'' of
wing-folding systems designed for fixed-wing ``aircraft'' specified
in USML Category VIII (a), see USML Category VIII (i).
k. ``Technology'', not specified in 9E003.a, 9E003.h, or
9E003.i, ``required'' for the ``development'' of any of the
following components or systems, ``specially designed'' for aero gas
turbine engines to enable ``aircraft'' to cruise at Mach 1 or
greater for more than 30 minutes:
k.1. Propulsion inlet systems;
k.2. Propulsion exhaust systems;
k.3. 'Reheat systems';
k.4. `Active thermal management systems' to condition fluids
used to lubricate or cool `engine rotor supports';
k.5. Oil-free 'engine rotor supports'; or
k.6. Systems to remove heat from 'compression system' core gas
path flow.
Technical Notes: For the purposes of 9E003.k:
1. Propulsion inlet systems include core flow pre-coolers.
[[Page 71985]]
2. 'Reheat systems' provide additional thrust by combusting fuel
in exhaust and/or bypass flow downstream of the last turbomachinery
stage. 'Reheat systems' are also referred to as afterburners.
3. 'Active thermal management systems' employ methods other than
passive oil-to-air cooling or oil-to-fuel cooling, such as vapor
cycle systems.
4. 'Compression system' is any stage or combination of stages
between the engine inlet face and the combustor that increases gas
path pressure through mechanical work.
5. An 'engine rotor support' is the bearing supporting the main
engine shaft that drives the compression system or turbine rotors.
N.B. 1 See 9E003.h, for engine control technology.
N.B. 2 See 9E003.i, for adjustable flow path systems technology.
l. ``Technology'' not otherwise controlled in 9E003.a.1 through
a.8, a.10, and .h and used in the ``development'', ``production'',
or overhaul of hot section ``parts'' or ``components'' of civil
derivatives of military engines controlled on the U.S. Munitions
List.
* * * * *
0
13. Supplement no. 6 to part 774 is amended by revising paragraph (4)
to read as follows:
Supplement No. 6 to Part 774--Sensitive List
* * * * *
(4) Category 4
(i) 4A001.a.2.
(ii) [Reserved]
* * * * *
Thea D. Rozman Kendler,
Assistant Secretary for Export Administration.
[FR Doc. 2023-22299 Filed 10-12-23; 4:15 pm]
BILLING CODE 3510-33-P